Manual de Breakers
Manual de Breakers
Manual de Breakers
2.1
Introduction
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Typical Applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Eaton Molded Case Circuit Breakers in Assemblies . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.2
Series G
Globally Accepted Breakers
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for Selective Coordination . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2.3
Series
2.5
2.6
2.7
V4-T2-329
Learn
Online
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-339
V4-T2-345
V4-T2-358
V4-T2-370
V4-T2-396
V4-T2-410
Handle Mechanisms
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-336
Specialty
Specialty Breakers
Engine Generator Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct Current Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
E2 Mining Service Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Classic Mining Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
Definite Purpose
Optimized solution for HVAC/R and Pumping Applications.
Definite Purpose Molded Case Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
V4-T2-4
V4-T2-6
V4-T2-7
V4-T2-9
V4-T2-14
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2.4
V4-T2-2
V4-T2-2
V4-T2-3
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-425
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-1
2.1
2
Contents
Description
Page
Introduction
Series G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Series C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Definite Purpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PM3 Monitoring and Metering Module . . . . . . . .
Specialty Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
Learn
Online
V4-T2-4
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-329
V4-T2-336
V4-T2-339
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
2
Product Overview
Application Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Electrical OEMs
Machinery OEMs
Navy breakers:
UL 489 Supplement SB
MIL-C-17588
MIL-C-17361
ABS/NVR
Mining breakers up to 1100
Vac
Earth leakage
DC breakers 125750 Vdc
Engine generator breakers
151200 amperes
Current limiting breakers
Feeder Pillars
In distribution systems to
provide main and branch
circuit protection.
Individual Enclosures
Completely assembled in
enclosures to meet specific
customer requirements.
Switchgear
In distribution systems to
provide main and branch
circuit protection up to 2500
amperes (RG-Frame).
Additional Applications
Special versions of each Eaton
frame are available to provide
safe equipment control and
protection in mining and other
applications. Contact your
Eaton agent or distributor for
additional information.
Typical Applications
Machine Tool Control Panels
and Motor Control Centers
Designed for these
equipment requirements,
including new world-class
accessories.
Panelboard
Panelboards
As both main and branch
circuit protection devices.
Individual Circuit
Breaker Enclosure
Busbar Trunking
Tap-Off
Machine Tool
Control Panel
Switchboard
2
V4-T2-2
2.1
Applications
Panelboards
Ampere
Frame Range
Switchboards
1A
2A
1A-LX 2A-LX 3A
3E
4B
4D
5P
PRL-C PRL-i
PRL-C/i Freedom
IT.
Enclosed
Control
Bus
Plugs
Enclosed
Breaker
Series G
EG
15160 1
JG
20250
LG
100630 2
NG
4001600
FD/ED 15225
JD
70250
KD
70400
LD
400600
MDL
300800
ND
4001200
RD
8002500
RG
8002500
2
2
2
2
Series C
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 125 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for EG.
2 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for LG.
3 1200 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for NG.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-3
2.2
2
Contents
Description
Page
Series G
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB). . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module. . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Learn
Online
V4-T2-5
V4-T2-6
V4-T2-7
V4-T2-9
V4-T2-14
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Overview
Series G, 152500 Amperes for
UL, CSA and IEC Applications
Eaton Series G molded case
circuit breakers provide
increased performance in
considerably less space than
standard circuit breakers or
comparable fusible devices.
The G signifies global
applications: Series G circuit
breakers are marked with UL,
CSA, CE, IEC and KEMA
KEUR listings. Other
advantages include:
Field-fit accessories
Common accessories
through 630 amperes
Electronic trip units from
20 to 2500 amperes
UL-listed and IEC-rated,
30 mA ground fault/earth
leakage modules
Built-in ground fault
protection down to
20 amperes
2
2
2
V4-T2-4
Current Limiting
Characteristics
Circuit breakers are current
limiting because of their
high repulsion contact
arrangement and use of
state-of-the-art arc
extinguishing technology.
Eaton offers one of the most
complete lines of current
limiting breakers in the
industry. The industrial
breakers are available in
current limiting versions with
interrupting capacities up to
200 kA at 480 V without
fuses in the same physical
size as standard and high
interrupting capacity
breakers.
2.2
Operating Mechanisms
Eaton circuit breakers have
a toggle handle operating
mechanism, which also
serves as a switching position
indicator. The indicator shows
the positions of: ON, OFF and
TRIPPED.
As an additional switching
position indicator for EG- to
RG-Frame circuit breakers,
there are two windows on
the right and on the left of the
toggle handle, in which the
switching state is indicated
by means of the colors
red, green and white
corresponding to the ON,
OFF and TRIPPED positions
respectively.
OFF
Reset
ON
Tripped
2
2
2
Global Third-Party
Certification
Australian Standard AS
2184 and AS 3947-2
molded case circuit
breakers
British Standards
Institution Standard
EN60947.2
International
Electromechanical
Commission
Recommendations IEC
60947.2 circuit breakers
National Electrical
Manufacturers Association
Standards Publication No.
AB1-1993 molded case
circuit breakers
South African Bureau of
Standards, Standard SANS
156, Standard Specification
for molded case circuit
breakers
Swiss Electro-Technical
Association Standard SEV
947.2, Safety Regulations
for circuit breakers
Union Technique de
lElectricite Standard NF C
63-120, low voltage
switchgear and control
gear circuit breaker
requirements
Verband Deutscher
Elektrotechnike
(Association of German
Electrical Engineers)
Standard VDE 0660, low
voltage switchgear and
control gear, circuit
breakers
ISO Certification
Eaton circuit breakers are
manufactured in ISO
certified facilities.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-5
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-6
2.2
RMS 610
RMS 910
JG
2
RG
LG/NG
Breaker Type
Series G frame(s)
RG-Frame
RG-Frame
Ampere rating
202500 A
8002500 A
8002500 A
70, 100 kA
70, 100 kA
Yes
Yes
Yes
Long delay
Short delay
Instantaneous
Ground fault
Ordering options
LS, LSG
LSI, LSIG
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Overtemperature trip
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Adjustable lr switch
Yes
Yes
No
No
VAR/frame
VAR/frame
0.51.0 x (ln)
0.51.0 x (ln)
10 seconds 2
10 seconds 2
224 seconds
224 seconds
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
1.05 lr
1.05 lr
0.85 x Ir
0.85 x Ir
2
2
VAR/frame 4
VAR/frame 4
100 ms
No
No
I300 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes 5
Yes
Yes
Instantaneous setting
No
VAR/frame
Discriminator
No
No
Yes 6
Yes 6
Instantaneous override
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
VAR/Frame 7
VAR/Frame 7
25100% x (ln) 7
25100% x (ln) 7
No
No
I300 ms
I300 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
Yes
Yes
2
3
4
5
6
7
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
In = Rating plug rating.
Ir = Long delay setting.
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-7
2.2
2
RMS 610
RMS 910
2
JG
2
2
2
2
2
2
RG
LG/NG
LS, LSG
LSI, LSIG
Yes 1 2
Yes 1 2
Yes
Yes
No
No
Yes
Yes
No
No
Yes
Yes
System Diagnostics
System Monitoring
Digital display
Yes 3
Yes 3
Yes
Yes
Current
Yes 3
Yes 3
Yes
Yes
Voltage
No
No
No
Yes
No
No
No
Yes
Power qualityharmonics
No
No
No
Yes
Power factor
No
No
No
Yes
No
No
No
Yes
Test set 4
Test set 4
Integral
Integral
System Communications
Field Testing
2
2
2
PowerNet
Testing method
Notes
1 Using cause of trip module (catalog number TRIP-LED).
2 RG 310+ trip units include integrated cause of trip LEDs.
3 Using ammeter or remote ammeter/cause of trip display (catalog number DIGIVIEW and DIGIVIEWR06).
4 Test kit available for field testing 310+ trip units (catalog number MTST230V).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-8
2.2
Ratings
JG
LG
2
2
2
Maximum rated current (amperes)
125, 160 1
Breaker type 3
Number of poles
2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 1
400, 630 2
250
E
2, 3, 4 1
2, 3, 4 3, 4
2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 2, 3, 4 3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
85
100
65
200
200
65
85
100
200
200
200
240 Vac
25
25
35
85
100
200
85
100
200
480 Vac
18
25
35
65
100
25
35
65
100
150
200
35
50
65
100
150
200
600 Vac 4
18
22
25
35
18
18
25
35
50
50
18
25
35
50
65
65
10 6
10
10
35 6
35
42 6
42
42
10
22
22
42
50
50
22
22
42
42
50
50
125/250 Vdc 5
Icu
25
25
35
85
85
100
100
200
65
85
100
200
200
200
65
85
100
200
200
200
Ics
25
25
35
43
43
50
50
200
65
85
100
200
200
200
65
85
100
200
200
200
380415 Vac
Icu
18
25
40
70
100
25
40
70
100
150
200
35
50
70
100
150
200
Ics
18
25
30
35
100
25
40
70
100
150
200
35
50
53
100
150
200
Icu
12
12
14
16
18
18
12
20
25
30
35
35
Ics
12
14
14
10
13
15
18
18
Icu
10 6
10
10
35 6
35
42 6
42
42
10
22
22
42
50
50
22
22
42
42
50
50
Ics
10 6
10
10
35 6
35
42 6
42
42
10
22
22
42
50
50
22
22
42
42
50
50
660690 Vac
125/250 Vdc 5
Ampere range
15160 A 1
20250 A
100630 A 2
Trip Units
F = Fixed
A = Adjustable
T = Thermal
M = Magnetic
FT-FM
AT-FM
FT-AM
AT-AM
Electronic (Digitrip RMS 310)
FT-AM
AT-AM
Electronic (Digitrip RMS 310)
Thermal
magnetic
Electronic
RMS 7
2
2
2
2
2
2
Built-in
Fixed thermal
Adjustable
thermal
Magnetic
Fixed
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
ALSI
ALSIG
Utilization category
Interchangeable
Adjustable
Adjustable
Notes
1 125 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the EG.
2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
3 Breaker type C, U and X are current limiting per UL 489.
4 EG breaker rated 600/347 Vac.
5 Two poles in series.
6 125 Vdc only for single-pole breakers.
7 Not suitable for DC application. Four-pole ground fault not available.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-9
2.2
2
Frames NG and RG
NG
RG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
800
C2
Number of poles
2, 3, 4
2, 3, 4
2, 3, 4
3, 4
3, 4
240 Vac
85
100
200
200
125
200
480 Vac
50
65
100
150
65
100
600 Vac
25
35
65
65
50
65
IEC 60947-2
220240 Vac
380415 Vac
660690 Vac
250 Vdc
1600 1
800, 1200
800, 1200
Breaker type
2
2
800, 1200
Icu
85
100
200
85
135
200
Ics
85
100
100
85
100
100
Icu
50
70
100
50
70
100
Ics
50
50
50
50
50
50
Icu
20 3
25 3
35
20 3
25 3
35 3
Ics
10
13
18
10
13
18
Icu
Ics
Ampere range
4001200 A
4001200 A
4001200 A
1600 A
800 A
8002500 A
8002500 A
Trip units
Electronic
(Digitrip RMS 310+)
Electronic
(Digitrip RMS 310+ and 910)
Interchangeable
Built-in
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
ALSI
ALSIG
2
2
2
2
Electronic 4
Utilization category
Notes
1 NG 1600 ampere frame is not UL or CSA listed.
2 Not KEMA-KEUR listed.
3 IEC 60947-2 H.5 Annex H is not KEMA-KEUR tested.
4 Not suitable for DC application. Four-pole ground fault not available.
5 RG 310+ are interchangeable with the exception of: FROM not ground fault equipped TO ground fault equipped
6 Available only on Digitrip 910 trip units.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-10
2.2
General Specifications
EG
JG
LG
NG
RG
160 A 1
250 A
400, 630 A 2
500 Vac
750 Vac
750 Vac
750 Vac
750 Vac
Auxiliary circuits
500 Vac
690 Vac
690 Vac
690 Vac
690 Vac
6 kV
8 kV
8 kV
8 kV
8 kV
Auxiliary circuits
4 kV
4 kV
4 kV
4 kV
4 kV
IEC
415 Vac
690 Vac
690 Vac
690 Vac
690 Vac
NEMA
2
2
2
2
2
600Y/347 Vac
600 Vac
600 Vac
600 Vac
600 Vac
Yes 1
Yes
Yes 2
Yes 3
Yes
20 to 70 C
20 to 70 C
20 to 70 C
At 40 C
100%
100%
100%
100%
100%
100%
100%
100%
At 50 C
96%
92%
96%
94%
96%
91%
91%
91%
At 55 C
93%
87%
94%
90%
93%
86%
85%
85%
At 60 C
91%
83%
92%
87%
90%
82%
81%
81%
At 70 C
86%
73%
88%
80%
84%
70%
70%
70%
2
2
20 to 70 C
20 to 70 C
2
2
2
2
2
100%
100%
At 50 C
100%
100%
At 55 C
100%
100%
At 60 C
100%
100%
At 70 C
90%
90%
At 40 C
100%
100%
100%
100%
100%
At 50 C
100%
100%
100%
91%
91%
At 55 C
96%
96%
95%
85%
85%
At 60 C
91%
82%
90%
81%
81%
At 70 C
86%
88%
84%
42 kA max.
42 kA max.
42 kA max.
42 kA max.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
42 kA max.
42 kA max.
Notes
1 125 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the EG.
2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the LG.
3 1200 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the NG.
4 Thermal overload release set to the lower value.
5 Thermal overload release set to the upper value.
6 Not suitable for DC switching.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-11
2.2
2
JG
LG
NG
RG
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
10,000
10,000
8,000
3,000
3,000
300 1/h
240 1/h
240 1/h
60 1/h
60 1/h
Box terminals
Box terminals
Box terminals
Solid or stranded
2.5 to 95 mm2
50 to 150 mm2
95 to 240 mm2
35 to 120 mm2
70 to 150 mm2
2
2
2
600 A
Optional
Optional
5.6 Nm
20 Nm
42 Nm
31 Nm
31 Nm
5.6 Nm
15 Nm
30 Nm
6 Nm
50 Nm
20 Nm
Up to 2x4 mm2
Up to 2x4 mm2
Up to 2x2.5 mm2
Up to 2x2.5 mm2
0.8 to 1.4 Nm
0.8 to 1.4 Nm
0.8 to 1.4 Nm
0.8 to 1.4 Nm
2
2
2
2
2
2
400 A:
600 A:
40 W
45 W
65 W
120 W
87/210 W
220/270/400 W
40 W
45 W
65 W
120 W
87/210 W
220/270/400 W
40 W
45 W
65 W
120 W
45 W
65 W
120 W
90
90
90
Busbar
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Auxiliary Switches
Rated thermal current lth
6A
6A
6A
6A
6A
20 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
AC-14
AC-14
AC-14
AC-15
AC-15
230/400/600 V
230/400/600 V
230/400/600 V
600 V
600 V
6/3/0.25 A
6/3/0.25 A
6/3/0.25 A
6A
6A
DC-13
DC-13
125/250V
125/250V
125/250V
125/250V
125/250V
0.5/0.25 A
0.5/0.15 A
0.5/0.15 A
0.5/0.15 A
0.5/0.25 A
Backup fuse
6/4/4 A
(4) 6/4/4 A
(4) 6/4/4 A
(4) 6/4/4 A
(4) 6/4/4 A
6/4 A
6/4 A
6/4 A
6/4 A
6/4 A
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-12
2.2
JG
LG
NG
RG
Releases
Undervoltage releases (r releases)
Response voltage:
Drop (breaker tripped) Us
3570%
3570%
3570%
3570%
3570%
85110%
85110%
85110%
85110%
85110%
50/60 Hz 12 Vac
1.9 VA
2.9 VA
50/60 Hz 24 Vac
0.72 VA
3.9 VA
3.9 VA
2.4 VA
3.1 VA
1.151.78 VA
2.53.8 VA
2.53.8 VA
2.34.1 VA
3.46.0 VA
0.961.25 VA
1.82.4 VA
1.82.4 VA
3.44.2 VA
3.33.8 VA
1.281.68 VA
2.73.8 VA
2.73.8 VA
4.86.5 VA
4.27.2 VA
2.23.9 VA
3.45.8 VA
3.45.8 VA
6.812.0 VA
3.810.0 VA
3.44.3 VA
3.44.3 VA
3.44.3 VA
12 Vdc
2.6W
3.4W
24 Vdc
0.70 W
3.1W
3.1W
3.6W
4.3W
4860 Vdc
1.121.76W
2.03.1W
2.03.1W
3.55.5W
4.87.2W
110125 Vdc
0.941.21W
1.62.2W
1.62.2W
2.93.6W
3.33.8W
220250 Vdc
Maximum opening time
1.451.86W
3.14W
3.14W
4.86.3W
6.67.5W
50 ms
50 ms
50 ms
62 ms
62 ms
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Shunt Trips
Shunt trips (f releases)
Response voltage:
Pickup (breaker tripped) Us
70110%
70110%
70110%
70110%
50/60 Hz 24 Vac
1041 VA
139210 VA
70110%
87405 VA
87405 VA
7101105 VA
7101105 VA
98475 VA
612 VA
2450 VA
403666 VA
83360 VA
66432 VA
66432 VA
67432 VA
3961896 VA
127188 VA
127188 VA
76110 VA
15962156 VA
4181080 VA
3460 VA
3460 VA
1942 VA
230384 VA
1224 Vdc
29120 W
164631 W
164631 W
145610 W
396 W
4860 Vdc
475720 W
8301580 W
8301580 W
67102 W
341528 W
110125 Vdc
99121 W
112150 W
112150 W
121150 W
264350 W
220250 Vdc
4058W
4058 W
4655 W
374475 W
Interrupts automatically
Interrupts automatically
Interrupts automatically
Interrupts automatically
Interrupts automatically
50 ms
50 ms
50 ms
62 ms
62 ms
2
2
2
2
2
2
65 (70)
65 (70)
65 (70)
65 (70)
65 (70)
2500
4000/6300
12,500
20,000
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-13
2.2
2
2
EG
JG
LG
Single-pole
5.50 (139.7)
1.00 (25.4)
2.99 (76.0)
Two-pole
5.50 (139.7)
2.00 (50.8)
2.99 (76.0)
7.00 (177.8)
4.13 (105.0)
3.57 (87.4)
Three-pole
5.50 (139.7)
3.00 (76.2)
2.99 (76.0)
7.00 (177.8)
4.13 (105.0)
3.57 (87.4)
10.13 (258.0)
5.48 (140.0)
4.09 (104.0)
Four-pole
5.50 (139.7)
4.00 (101.6)
2.99 (76.0)
7.00 (177.8)
5.34 (135.6)
3.57 (87.4)
10.13 (258.0)
7.22 (183.0)
4.09 (104.0)
RG
Single-pole
Two-pole
Three-pole
16.00 (406.0)
8.25 (210.0)
5.50 (140.0)
16.00 (406.0)
15.50 (394.0)
9.75 (229.0)
Four-pole
16.00 (406.0)
11.13 (280.0)
5.50 (140.0)
16.00 (406.0)
20.00 (508.0)
9.75 (229.0)
2
2
JG
LG
NG
RG
Single-pole
0.85 (0.39)
Two-pole
1.57 (0.71)
11.3 (5.13)
Three-pole
2.28 (1.04)
46.8 (21.3)
103.0 (47.0)
Four-pole
2.85 (1.29)
62.0 (28.3)
118.4 (54.0)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-14
2.2
Contents
Description
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-16
V4-T2-17
V4-T2-26
V4-T2-27
V4-T2-27
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-15
2.2
2
2
2
E G H 3 015 FF G
2
Frame
2
2
E
Amperes
2
2
2
2
2
B
E
S
H
C
K
Performance
600Y/347
480
415
18
18
18
25
25
22
35
40
25
65
70
35
100
100
Molded case switch 2
2
2
2
Number of Poles
Standard/Application
G = IEC/CE/UL/CSA
240
25
35
85
100
200
1 = One
2 = Two
3 = Three
4 = Fourneutral 0% protected
7 = Fourneutral 100% protected
016 1
015
020
025
030
032 1
035
040
045
050
060
063 1
070
080
090
100
110
125
160 1
Notes
1 Cannot be UL rated.
2 Available only as 125 and 160 A sizes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-16
Terminations/Hardware
Terminals
Mounting Hardware
M = Metric end caps
Metric
E = Imperial end caps
Imperial
G = Line/load standard
Metric
B = Bolt-on
Trip Unit
FF = Fixed fixed
AF = Adjustable thermal fixed magnetic
KS = Molded case switch
2.2
Product Selection
EG-Frame18/18
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Four-Pole 3
Three-Pole
Maximum
Continuous
Amps at 40 C 1
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Number
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Number
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Number
Adjustable 2
Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Number
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Number
Adjustable 2
Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Catalog
Number
15
EGB1015FFG
EGB2015FFG
EGB3015FFG
EGB4015FFG
16
EGB1016FFG
EGB2016FFG
EGB3016FFG
EGB4016FFG
20
EGB1020FFG
EGB2020FFG
EGB3020FFG
EGB4020FFG
EGB4020AFG
25
EGB1025FFG
EGB2025FFG
EGB3025FFG
EGB3025AFG
EGB4025FFG
EGB4025AFG
30
EGB1030FFG
EGB2030FFG
EGB3030FFG
EGB4030FFG
32
EGB1032FFG
EGB2032FFG
EGB3032FFG
EGB3032AFG
EGB4032FFG
EGB4032AFG
35
EGB1035FFG
EGB2035FFG
EGB3035FFG
EGB4035FFG
40
EGB1040FFG
EGB2040FFG
EGB3040FFG
EGB3040AFG
EGB4040FFG
EGB4040AFG
45
EGB1045FFG
EGB2045FFG
EGB3045FFG
EGB4045FFG
50
EGB1050FFG
EGB2050FFG
EGB3050FFG
EGB3050AFG
EGB4050FFG
EGB4050AFG
60
EGB1060FFG
EGB2060FFG
EGB3060FFG
EGB4060FFG
63
EGB1063FFG
EGB2063FFG
EGB3063FFG
EGB3063AFG
EGB4063FFG
EGB4063AFG
70
EGB1070FFG
EGB2070FFG
EGB3070FFG
EGB4070FFG
80
EGB1080FFG
EGB2080FFG
EGB3080FFG
EGB3080AFG
EGB4080FFG
EGB4080AFG
90
EGB1090FFG
EGB2090FFG
EGB3090FFG
EGB4090FFG
100
EGB1100FFG
EGB2100FFG
EGB3100FFG
EGB3100AFG
EGB4100FFG
EGB4100AFG
110
EGB1110FFG
EGB2110FFG
EGB3110FFG
EGB4110FFG
125
EGB1125FFG
EGB2125FFG
EGB3125FFG
EGB3125AFG
EGB4125FFG
EGB4125AFG
160
EGB3160FFG
EGB3160AFG
EGB4160FFG
EGB4160AFG
2
2
2
Notes
1 16, 32, 63 and 160 A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal are not UL listed.
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100% neutral protection. Neutral is on the LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-17
2.2
EG-Frame
EG-Frame25/25
Two-Pole
Four-Pole 3
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable 2
Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Maximum Continuous
Amps at 40 C 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
EGE2015FFG
EGE3015FFG
EGE4015FFG
16
EGE2016FFG
EGE3016FFG
EGE4016FFG
20
EGE2020FFG
EGE3020FFG
EGE4020FFG
EGE4020AFG
25
EGE2025FFG
EGE3025FFG
EGE3025AFG
EGE4025FFG
EGE4025AFG
30
EGE2030FFG
EGE3030FFG
EGE4030FFG
32
EGE2032FFG
EGE3032FFG
EGE3032AFG
EGE4032FFG
EGE4032AFG
35
EGE2035FFG
EGE3035FFG
EGE4035FFG
40
EGE2040FFG
EGE3040FFG
EGE3040AFG
EGE4040FFG
EGE4040AFG
2
2
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable 2
Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
45
EGE2045FFG
EGE3045FFG
EGE3050AFG
EGE4045FFG
50
EGE2050FFG
EGE3050FFG
EGE4050FFG
EGE4050AFG
60
EGE2060FFG
EGE3060FFG
EGE4060FFG
63
EGE2063FFG
EGE3063FFG
EGE3063AFG
EGE4063FFG
EGE4063AFG
70
EGE2070FFG
EGE3070FFG
EGE4070FFG
80
EGE2080FFG
EGE3080FFG
EGE3080AFG
EGE4080FFG
EGE4080AFG
90
EGE2090FFG
EGE3090FFG
EGE4090FFG
100
EGE2100FFG
EGE3100FFG
EGE3100AFG
EGE4100FFG
EGE4100AFG
125
EGE2125FFG
EGE3125FFG
EGE3125AFG
EGE4125FFG
EGE4125AFG
160
EGE3160FFG
EGE3160AFG
EGE4160FFG
EGE4160AFG
Notes
1 16, 32, 63 and 160 A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal are not UL listed.
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100% neutral protection. Neutral is on the LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-18
2.2
EG-Frame
EG-Frame40/35
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Four-Pole 3
Three-Pole
2
Maximum
Continuous
Amps at 40 C 1
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable
Thermal, Fixed
Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable
Thermal, Fixed
Magnetic
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
EGS1015FFG
EGS2015FFG
EGS3015FFG
EGS4015FFG
16
EGS1016FFG
EGS2016FFG
EGS3016FFG
EGS4016FFG
20
EGS1020FFG
EGS2020FFG
EGS3020FFG
EGS4020FFG
EGS4020AFG
25
EGS1025FFG
EGS2025FFG
EGS3025FFG
EGS3025AFG
EGS4025FFG
EGS4025AFG
30
EGS1030FFG
EGS2030FFG
EGS3030FFG
EGS4030FFG
32
EGS1032FFG
EGS2032FFG
EGS3032FFG
EGS3032AFG
EGS4032FFG
EGS4032AFG
35
EGS1035FFG
EGS2035FFG
EGS3035FFG
EGS4035FFG
40
EGS1040FFG
EGS2040FFG
EGS3040FFG
EGS3040AFG
EGS4040FFG
EGS4040AFG
45
EGS1045FFG
EGS2045FFG
EGS3045FFG
EGS4045FFG
50
EGS1050FFG
EGS2050FFG
EGS3050FFG
EGS3050AFG
EGS4050FFG
EGS4050AFG
60
EGS1060FFG
EGS2060FFG
EGS3060FFG
EGS4060FFG
63
EGS1063FFG
EGS2063FFG
EGS3063FFG
EGS3063AFG
EGS4063FFG
EGS4063AFG
70
EGS1070FFG
EGS2070FFG
EGS3070FFG
EGS4070FFG
80
EGS1080FFG
EGS2080FFG
EGS3080FFG
EGS3080AFG
EGS4080FFG
EGS4080AFG
90
EGS1090FFG
EGS2090FFG
EGS3090FFG
EGS4090FFG
100
EGS1100FFG
EGS2100FFG
EGS3100FFG
EGS3100AFG
EGS4100FFG
EGS4100AFG
125
EGS1125FFG
EGS2125FFG
EGS3125FFG
EGS3125AFG
EGS4125FFG
EGS4125AFG
160
EGS3160FFG
EGS3160AFG
EGS4160FFG
EGS4160AFG
2
2
2
Notes
1 16, 32, 63 and 160 A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal are not UL listed.
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100% neutral protection. Neutral is on the LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-19
2.2
2
EG-Frame
EG-Frame70/65
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Four-Pole 3
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable 2
Thermal, Fixed
Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable 2
Thermal, Fixed
Magnetic
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Maximum
Continuous
Amps at 40 C 1
15
EGH1015FFG
EGH2015FFG
EGH3015FFG
EGH4015FFG
16
EGH1016FFG
EGH2016FFG
EGH3016FFG
EGH4016FFG
20
EGH1020FFG
EGH2020FFG
EGH3020FFG
EGH3020AFG
EGH4020FFG
EGH4020AFG
25
EGH1025FFG
EGH2025FFG
EGH3025FFG
EGH3025AFG
EGH4025FFG
EGH4025AFG
30
EGH1030FFG
EGH2030FFG
EGH3030FFG
EGH4030FFG
32
EGH1032FFG
EGH2032FFG
EGH3032FFG
EGH3032AFG
EGH4032FFG
EGH4032AFG
35
EGH1035FFG
EGH2035FFG
EGH3035FFG
EGH4035FFG
40
EGH1040FFG
EGH2040FFG
EGH3040FFG
EGH3040AFG
EGH4040FFG
EGH4040AFG
45
EGH1045FFG
EGH2045FFG
EGH3045FFG
EGH4045FFG
EGH4050AFG
50
EGH1050FFG
EGH2050FFG
EGH3050FFG
EGH3050AFG
EGH4050FFG
60
EGH1060FFG
EGH2060FFG
EGH3060FFG
EGH4060FFG
63
EGH1063FFG
EGH2063FFG
EGH3063FFG
EGH3063AFG
EGH4063FFG
EGH4063AFG
70
EGH1070FFG
EGH2070FFG
EGH3070FFG
EGH4070FFG
80
EGH1080FFG
EGH2080FFG
EGH3080FFG
EGH3080AFG
EGH4080FFG
EGH4080AFG
90
EGH1090FFG
EGH2090FFG
EGH3090FFG
EGH4090FFG
100
EGH1100FFG
EGH2100FFG
EGH3100FFG
EGH3100AFG
EGH4100FFG
EGH4100AFG
125
EGH1125FFG
EGH2125FFG
EGH3125FFG
EGH3125AFG
EGH4125FFG
EGH4125AFG
2
2
Notes
1 16, 32, 63A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal are not UL listed.
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100% neutral protection. Neutral is on the LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-20
2.2
EG-Frame
2
2
EG-Frame100/100
Four-Pole 0% Protected Neutral 3
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable 2
Thermal, Fixed Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable 2
Thermal, Fixed Magnetic
Maximum Continuous
Amps at 40 C 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
EGC3015FFG
EGC7015FFG
16
EGC3016FFG
EGC7016FFG
20
EGC3020FFG
EGC3020AFG
EGC7020FFG
EGC7020AFG
25
EGC3025FFG
EGC3025AFG
EGC7025FFG
EGC7025AFG
30
EGC3030FFG
EGC7030FFG
32
EGC3032FFG
EGC3032AFG
EGC7032FFG
EGC7032AFG
35
EGC3035FFG
EGC7035FFG
40
EGC3040FFG
EGC3040AFG
EGC7040FFG
EGC7040AFG
45
EGC3045FFG
EGC7045FFG
50
EGC3050FFG
EGC3050AFG
EGC7050FFG
EGC7050AFG
60
EGC3060FFG
EGC7060FFG
63
EGC3063FFG
EGC3063AFG
EGC7063FFG
EGC7063AFG
70
EGC3070FFG
EGC7070FFG
80
EGC3080FFG
EGC3080AFG
EGC7080FFG
EGC7080AFG
90
EGC3090FFG
EGC7090FFG
100
EGC3100FFG
EGC3100AFG
EGC7100FFG
EGC7100AFG
125
EGC3125FFG
EGC3125AFG
EGC7125FFG
EGC7125AFG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
EGK3125KSG
EGK7125KSG
EGK3160KSG
EGK7160KSG
Notes
1 16, 32, 63A are not UL listed ratings.
2 Adjustable thermal is not UL listed.
3 Change the fourth digit to 7 for 100%
neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
4 Molded case switches may open above 1250 A.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-21
2.2
EG Bolt-On Complete Breaker (Includes Frame, Trip Unit and Mounting Hardware)
EG-Frame
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Maximum
Continuous
Amps at 40 C
Catalog
Number 1
Catalog
Number 2
Catalog
Number 3
15
EGB1015FFB
EGB2015FFB
EGB3015FFB
20
EGB1020FFB
EGB2020FFB
EGB3020FFB
25
EGB1025FFB
EGB2025FFB
EGB3025FFB
30
EGB1030FFB
EGB2030FFB
EGB3030FFB
35
EGB1035FFB
EGB2035FFB
EGB3035FFB
40
EGB1040FFB
EGB2040FFB
EGB3040FFB
45
EGB1045FFB
EGB2045FFB
EGB3045FFB
50
EGB1050FFB
EGB2050FFB
EGB3050FFB
60
EGB1060FFB
EGB2060FFB
EGB3060FFB
70
EGB1070FFB
EGB2070FFB
EGB3070FFB
80
EGB1080FFB
EGB2080FFB
EGB3080FFB
90
EGB1090FFB
EGB2090FFB
EGB3090FFB
100
EGB1100FFB
EGB2100FFB
EGB3100FFB
110
EGB1110FFB
EGB2110FFB
EGB3110FFB
125
EGB1125FFB
EGB2125FFB
EGB3125FFB
2
2
2
2
2
EG-Frame
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Maximum
Continuous
Amps at 40 C
Catalog
Number 1
Catalog
Number 2
Catalog
Number 3
15
EGS1015FFB
EGS2015FFB
EGS3015FFB
20
EGS1020FFB
EGS2020FFB
EGS3020FFB
25
EGS1025FFB
EGS2025FFB
EGS3025FFB
30
EGS1030FFB
EGS2030FFB
EGS3030FFB
35
EGS1035FFB
EGS2035FFB
EGS3035FFB
40
EGS1040FFB
EGS2040FFB
EGS3040FFB
45
EGS1045FFB
EGS2045FFB
EGS3045FFB
50
EGS1050FFB
EGS2050FFB
EGS3050FFB
60
EGS1060FFB
EGS2060FFB
EGS3060FFB
70
EGS1070FFB
EGS2070FFB
EGS3070FFB
80
EGS1080FFB
EGS2080FFB
EGS3080FFB
90
EGS1090FFB
EGS2090FFB
EGS3090FFB
100
EGS1100FFB
EGS2100FFB
EGS3100FFB
110
EGS1110FFB
EGS2110FFB
EGS3110FFB
125
EGS1125FFB
EGS2125FFB
EGS3125FFB
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For bulk pack 24, add suffix BP24 and order quantities of 24.
2 For bulk pack 12, add suffix BP12 and order quantities of 12.
3 For bulk pack 8, add suffix BP8 and order quantities of 8.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-22
EG-Frame
2.2
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Maximum
Continuous
Amps at 40 C
Catalog
Number 1
Catalog
Number 2
Catalog
Number 3
15
EGH1015FFB
EGH2015FFB
EGH3015FFB
20
EGH1020FFB
EGH2020FFB
EGH3020FFB
25
EGH1025FFB
EGH2025FFB
EGH3025FFB
30
EGH1030FFB
EGH2030FFB
EGH3030FFB
35
EGH1035FFB
EGH2035FFB
EGH3035FFB
40
EGH1040FFB
EGH2040FFB
EGH3040FFB
45
EGH1045FFB
EGH2045FFB
EGH3045FFB
50
EGH1050FFB
EGH2050FFB
EGH3050FFB
60
EGH1060FFB
EGH2060FFB
EGH3060FFB
70
EGH1070FFB
EGH2070FFB
EGH3070FFB
80
EGH1080FFB
EGH2080FFB
EGH3080FFB
90
EGH1090FFB
EGH2090FFB
EGH3090FFB
100
EGH1100FFB
EGH2100FFB
EGH3100FFB
110
EGH1110FFB
EGH2110FFB
EGH3110FFB
125
EGH1125FFB
EGH2125FFB
EGH3125FFB
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Load Terminals
Maximum Breaker
Amps
Terminal,
Body
Material
Wire Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Aluminum
Cu/Al
2.550
#141/0
3TA125EF
60125
Aluminum
Cu/Al
1670
#63/0
3TA150EF
2
2
Notes
1 For bulk pack 24, add suffix BP24 and order quantities of 24.
2 For bulk pack 12, add suffix BP12 and order quantities of 12.
3 For bulk pack 8, add suffix BP8 and order quantities of 8.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-23
2.2
EG-Frame
2
2
2
2
2
2
3T125EF
3TA125EF
3TA150EF
3TA160EFK
EF2RTWK, Two-PoleMetric
EF3RTWK, Three-PoleMetric
EF4RTWK, Four-PoleMetric
EF2RTDK, Two-PoleImperial
EF3RTDK, Three-PoleImperial
EF4RTDK, Four-PoleImperial
2
2
2
Maximum
Breaker
Amps
2
2
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
AWG Wire
Range
(Package of
Three Terminals)
Catalog
Number
Steel
Al
46
#12-10
3T125EF 1
125
Steel
Cu
2.595
#14-3/0
3T125EF 1
125
Aluminum
Cu/Al
2.550
#14-1/0
3TA125EF
160
Aluminum
Cu/Al
1670
#6-3/0
3TA150EF
160
Aluminum
Cu/Al
35120
#3-250
3TA160EFK
160
Aluminum
Cu/Al
35120
#3-250
4TA160EFK 2
2
2
EG-Frame circuit breakers and molded case switches have line and load terminals
as standard equipment.
Insert collar enclosing conductor as shown. Locate nut on top of conductor and tighten securely
with screw and washer.
2
2
2
Insert collar enclosing conductor and center on extrusion. Tighten securely with screw and washer.
Endcap kits are used on the E-Frame breaker line side to connect busbar or similar electrical
connections. Includes hardware.
Notes
1 Standard line and load terminals.
2 Four-pole kit with four terminals.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-24
Control Wire
Terminal Kit
GCWTK
Multiwire
Connectors
Catalog
Number
Control wire terminal kit
5652B38G01
Interphase Barriers
Catalog
Number
EIPBK
EF1DIN
EGDIN
EF34DIN
Catalog
Number
6.35 (0.25)
EEC3K
10.41 (0.41)
EEC4K
Multiwire Connectors
Field-installed multiwire connectors for the load side (OFF) end
terminals. They are used to distribute the load from the circuit
breaker to multiple devices without the use of separate
distribution terminal blocks.
EFTS3K
EFTS4K
2
2
2
Maximum
Amperes
Wires per
Terminal
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
Kit Catalog
Number
125
142
3TA125E3K
125
146
3TA125E6K
Note
1 For four-pole kit, change 3 at beginning of catalog number to 4.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal Shields
The terminal shield is available for line terminal areas in threeand four-pole circuit breakers. Special terminal shields are also
available for use when an electrical (solenoid) operator is
mounted on the circuit breaker. The standard style number by
pole for each terminal shield is for a package of 10 and is priced
per each package. Special terminal shields are packaged
individually.
Number
of Poles
2
2
For use with steel or stainless steel standard line and load
terminals only.
Interphase barriers
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-25
2.2
Accessories
EG-Frame Accessories
2
2
2
2
2
Reference
Page
Description
SinglePole
Two-Pole
Center
Left
Right
Left
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Internal Accessories
(Only one internal accessory per pole)
Alarm lockout (Make/Break)
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-110
External Accessories
V4-T2-25
V4-T2-25
Multiwire connectors
V4-T2-25
V4-T2-25
Terminal shields
V4-T2-25
V4-T2-25
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-25
2
2
2
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-107
Electrical operator
V4-T2-107
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-105
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-26
2.2
Volts DC 1
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
120
Icu
Ics
277
347
Icu
Ics
480
600Y/ 347
Icu
Ics
Icu
Ics
Icu
Ics
EGB125
35
25
25
18
10
10
2, 3, 4
25
25
18
18
18
10
10
220240
690 2
380415
250 34
125
EGE125
2, 3, 4
35
35
25
25
25
18
10
10
EGS125
100
85
43
35
22
35
35
EGH125
2, 3, 4
85
43
40
30
35
22
35
35
200
100
50
65
30
42
42
100
50
70
35
65
25
42
42
EGC125 5 3, 4
2, 3, 4
200
200
100
100
100
35
42
42
EGB160 2 3, 4
25
25
18
18
18
10
10
EGE160 2 3, 4
35
35
25
25
25
18
10
10
EGS160 2 3, 4
85
43
40
30
35
22
35
35
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
EG-Frame
Number
of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
1.00 (25.4)
5.50 (139.7)
2.99 (75.9)
2.00 (50.8)
5.50 (139.7)
2.99 (75.9)
3.00 (76.2)
5.50 (139.7)
2.99 (75.9)
4.00 (101.6)
5.50 (139.7)
2.99 (75.9)
2
2
2
2
EG-Frame
Front Cover Cutout
Side View
CL
Breaker
1.85
(47.0)
0.14 (3.6) R
0.90
(22.9)
1.30 Dia.
(33.0)
0.47 (11.9)
0.94 (23.9)
3.00
(76.2)
5.50
(139.7)
3.03
(77.0)
CL
Handle
2
2
2.77
(70.4)
EG-Frame
Breaker Type
Number of Poles
1
Breaker Type
Number of Poles
3
EGB125
1.5 (0.68)
2.0 (0.91)
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
EGB160
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
EGC125
1.5 (0.68)
2.0 (0.91)
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
EGE160
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
EGE125
1.5 (0.68)
2.0 (0.91)
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
EGS160
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
EGH125
1.5 (0.68)
2.0 (0.91)
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
EGS125
1.5 (0.68)
2.0 (0.91)
3.0 (1.36)
4.9 (1.82)
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 DC ratings apply to substantially non-inductive circuits.
2 IEC only.
3 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
4 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum at 42 kA.
5 Current limiting per UL 489.
2
2
2
V4-T2-27
2.2
2
4.75
(120.6)
0.55 (14.0)
1.49
1.00 (37.8)
(25.4)
0.50
(12.7)
1.50 0.50
(38.1) (12.7)
2
2
4.78
(121.4)
8.59
(218.2)
0.70 (17.8)
0.35 (8.9)
2
2
0.09
(2.29)
2
EG-Frame With Current Limiter Module
2
2
0.56
(14.2)
2
2
2
3.01
(76.5)
2.75
(69.9)
0.78
(19.8)
2.00
(50.8)
0.90 (22.9)
3-Pole
2.98
(75.7)
1.00
(25.4)
1.00
(25.4)
3.00
(76.2)
9.66
(245.4)
4.17
(105.9)
3.61
(91.7)
0.50
1.00 (12.7)
(25.4)
1.00
(25.4)
2
2
3.20
(81.3)
4.17
(105.9)
2
2
2
2.75 0.09
(69.9) (2.3)
0.78
(19.8)
0.41
(10.4)
2
V4-T2-28
3.98
(101.1)
3.17
(80.5)
2.2
Contents
Description
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-15
2
2
V4-T2-30
V4-T2-31
V4-T2-42
V4-T2-43
V4-T2-45
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-29
2.2
2
2
2
J G S 3 250 FA G C
2
Frame
2
2
Standard/Application
G = IEC/CE/UL/CSA
2
2
E
S
H
C
U
X
K
2
2
2
Performance
600
480
415
18
25
25
18
35
40
25
65
70
35
100
100
50
150
150
50
200
200
Molded case switch
Number of Poles
240
65
85
100
200
200
200
2 = Two
3 = Three
4 = FourNeutral 0% Protected
8 = FourNeutral 060% Protected
9 = FourNeutral 100% Protected
Amperes
050
070
080
090
100
125
150
160
175
200
225
250
2
2
2
Trip
JT
Number of Poles
2 = Two
3 = Three
4 = FourNeutral 0% Protected
8 = FourNeutral 060%% Protected
9 = FourNeutral 100% Protected
2
2
2
2
2
2
Trip Unit
AA = Adj. adj.
FA = Fixed adj.
KS = Molded case switch
33 = 310+ electronic LS
32 = 310+ electronic LSI
35 = 310+ electronic LSG
36 = 310+ electronic LSIG
NN = Frame only (250 A only; no trip unit)
JT 4 100 FA B20
Terminations/Hardware
Terminals
Mounting Hardware
M = Metric end caps
Metric
E = Imperial end caps
Imperial
G = Line/load standard
Metric
W = Without terminals
Trip Unit
2
2
Rating
Blank = 80% rated
C = 100% rated
F01 = Freeze tested for 70F (57C)
F02 = Freeze tested for 22F (30C)
Amperes
T/M
ETU
080
050
090
100
100
160
110
250
125
150
160
175
200
225
250
Trip Unit
AA = Adj. adj.
FA = Fixed adj.
KS = Molded case switch
33 = 310+ electronic LS
32 = 310+ electronic LSI
35 = 310+ electronic LSG
36 = 310+ electronic LSIG
Notes
1 Bxx features cannot be combined with other Bxx features.
2 B21 and B22 available with LSG and LSIG trip units.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-30
2.2
Product Selection
JG-Frame
JG-Frame
JG-FrameIEC/CE/UL/CSA25/25
Four-Pole 0%2
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic 1
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic 1
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGE2070FAG
JGE3070FAG
JGE4070FAG
90
450900
JGE2090FAG
JGE3090FAG
JGE4090FAG
100
5001000
JGE2100FAG
JGE3100FAG
JGE3100AAG
JGE4100FAG
JGE4100AAG
125
6251250
JGE2125FAG
JGE3125FAG
JGE3125AAG
JGE4125FAG
JGE4125AAG
150
7501550
JGE2150FAG
JGE3150FAG
JGE4150FAG
160
8001600
JGE3160AAG
JGE4160AAG
175
8751750
JGE2175FAG
JGE3175FAG
JGE4175FAG
200
10002000
JGE2200FAG
JGE3200FAG
JGE3200AAG
JGE4200FAG
JGE4200AAG
225
11252250
JGE2225FAG
JGE3225FAG
JGE4225FAG
250
12502500
JGE2250FAG
JGE3250FAG
JGE3250AAG
JGE4250FAG
JGE4250AAG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
JG-FrameIEC/CE/UL/CSA40/35, Two-Pole
Four-Pole 0%2
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic 1
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic 1
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGS2070FAG
JGS3070FAG
JGS4070FAG
90
450900
JGS2090FAG
JGS3090FAG
JGS4090FAG
100
5001000
JGS2100FAG
JGS3100FAG
JGS3100AAG
JGS4100FAG
JGS4100AAG
125
6251250
JGS2125FAG
JGS3125FAG
JGS3125AAG
JGS4125FAG
JGS4125AAG
150
7501550
JGS2150FAG
JGS3150FAG
JGS4150FAG
160
8001600
JGS3160AAG
JGS4160AAG
175
8751750
JGS2175FAG
JGS3175FAG
JGS4175FAG
200
10002000
JGS2200FAG
JGS3200FAG
JGS3200AAG
JGS4200FAG
JGS4200AAG
225
11252250
JGS2225FAG
JGS3225FAG
JGS4225FAG
250
12502500
JGS2250FAG
JGS3250FAG
JGS3250AAG
JGS4250FAG
JGS4250AAG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is 0.8 and 1.0.
2 Change the fourth digit to 8 for adjustable 060% neutral protection, 9 for 0100% neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-31
2.2
2
JG-Frame
JG-FrameIEC/CE/UL/CSA70/65
Four-Pole 0%2
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable
Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Thermal, Adjustable
1
Magnetic
Fixed Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Fixed Magnetic 1
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGH2070FAG
JGH3070FAG
JGH4070FAG
90
450900
JGH2090FAG
JGH3090FAG
JGH4090FAG
100
5001000
JGH2100FAG
JGH3100FAG
JGH3100AAG
JGH4100FAG
JGH4100AAG
125
6251250
JGH2125FAG
JGH3125FAG
JGH3125AAG
JGH4125FAG
JGH4125AAG
150
7501550
JGH2150FAG
JGH3150FAG
JGH4150FAG
160
8001600
JGH3160AAG
JGH4160AAG
175
8751750
JGH2175FAG
JGH3175FAG
JGH4175FAG
200
10002000
JGH2200FAG
JGH3200FAG
JGH3200AAG
JGH4200FAG
JGH4200AAG
225
11252250
JGH2225FAG
JGH3225FAG
JGH4225FAG
250
12502500
JGH2250FAG
JGH3250FAG
JGH3250AAG
JGH4250FAG
JGH4250AAG
2
2
Notes
1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is 0.8 and 1.0.
2 Change the fourth digit to 8 for adjustable 060% neutral protection, 9 for 0100% neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-32
2.2
Four-Pole 0% 2
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGC3070FAG
JGC4070FAG
80
400800
JGC3080AAG
JGC4080AAG
90
450900
JGC3090FAG
JGC4090FAG
100
5001000
JGC3100FAG
JGC3100AAG
JGC4100FAG
JGC4100AAG
125
6251250
JGC3125FAG
JGC3125AAG
JGC4125FAG
JGC4125AAG
150
7501550
JGC3150FAG
JGC4150FAG
160
8001600
JGC3160AAG
JGC4160AAG
175
8751750
JGC3175FAG
JGC4175FAG
200
10002000
JGC3200FAG
JGC3200AAG
JGC4200FAG
JGC4200AAG
225
11252250
JGC3225FAG
JGC4225FAG
250
12502500
JGC3250FAG
JGC3250AAG
JGC4250FAG
JGC4250AAG
2
2
2
2
2
2
JG-Frame
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGU3070FAG
JGU4070FAG
80
400800
JGU3080AAG
JGU4080AAG
90
450900
JGU3090FAG
JGU4090FAG
100
5001000
JGU3100FAG
JGU3100AAG
JGU4100FAG
JGU4100AAG
125
6251250
JGU3125FAG
JGU3125AAG
JGU4125FAG
JGU4125AAG
150
7501550
JGU3150FAG
JGU4150FAG
160
8001600
JGU3160AAG
JGU4160AAG
175
8751750
JGU3175FAG
JGU4175FAG
200
10002000
JGU3200FAG
JGU3200AAG
JGU4200FAG
JGU4200AAG
225
11252250
JGU3225FAG
JGU4225FAG
250
12502500
JGU3250FAG
JGU3250AAG
JGU4250FAG
JGU4250AAG
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is 0.8 and 1.0.
2 Change the fourth digit to 8 for adjustable 060% neutral protection, 9 for 0100% neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-33
2.2
JG-Frame
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGX3070FAG
JGX4070FAG
80
400800
JGX3080AAG
JGX4080AAG
90
450900
JGX3090FAG
JGX4090FAG
100
5001000
JGX3100FAG
JGX3100AAG
JGX4100FAG
JGX4100AAG
125
6251250
JGX3125FAG
JGX3125AAG
JGX4125FAG
JGX4125AAG
150
7501550
JGX3150FAG
JGX4150FAG
160
8001600
JGX3160AAG
JGX4160AAG
175
8751750
JGX3175FAG
JGX4175FAG
200
10002000
JGX3200FAG
JGX3200AAG
JGX4200FAG
JGX4200AAG
225
11252250
JGX3225FAG
JGX4225FAG
250
12502500
JGX3250FAG
JGX3250AAG
JGX4250FAG
JGX4250AAG
2
2
JGK3250KSG
JGK7250KSG
Notes
1 EC-EN 60947-2 only. Adjustment is
0.8 and 1.0.
2 Change the fourth digit to 8 for adjustable
060% neutral protection, 9 for 0100%
neutral protection. Neutral is on LH side.
3 Molded case switches will trip above
2500 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-34
2.2
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole 0%
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
JGE2250NN
JGE3250NN
JGE4250NN
JGS2250NN
JGS3250NN
JGS4250NN
JGH2250NN
JGH3250NN
JGH4250NN
JGC4250NN
25/25
250
40/35
250
70/65
250
JGC3250NN
JGU4250NN
JGX3250NN
JGX4250NN
JGE3250NNC
JGS3250NNC
JGH3250NNC
JGU3250NN
2
2
Range
Catalog
Number
Range
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JT2070FA
JT3070FA
JT4070FA
80
400800
JT3080FA
JT3080AA 3
64100
JT4080AA 3
90
450900
JT2090FA
JT3090FA
JT4090FA
100
5001000
JT2100FA
JT3100FA
JT3100AA 3
80100
JT4100FA
JT4100AA 3
125
6251250
JT2125FA
JT3125FA
JT3125AA 3
100125
JT4125FA
JT4125AA 3
150
7501550
JT2150FA
JT3150FA
JT4150FA
160
8001600
JT3160AA 3
128160
JT4160AA 3
175
8751750
JT2175FA
JT3175FA
JT4175FA
200
10002000
JT2200FA
JT3200FA
JT3200AA 3
160200
JT4200FA
JT4200AA 3
225
11252250
JT2225FA
JT3225FA
JT4225FA
250
12502500
JT2250FA
JT3250FA
JT3250AA 3
200250
JT4250FA
JT4250AA 3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Standard line and load terminals.
2 Components100% rated frame.
3 Adjustable thermal trip units are typically used in IEC markets and are not UL or CSA listed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-35
2.2
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JT305033
JT305032
JT305035
JT305036
JGFCT050
100
JT310033
JT310032
JT310035
JT310036
JGFCT100
160
JT316033
JT316032
JT316035
JT316036
JGFCT160
250
JT325033
JT325032
JT325035
JT325036
JGFCT250
50
JT405033
JT405032
JT405035
JT405036
100
JT410033
JT410032
JT410035
JT410036
160
JT416033
JT416032
JT416035
JT416036
250
JT425033
JT425032
JT425035
JT425036
2
2
Ampere
Rating
Three-Pole
Four-Pole 23
Description
Catalog
Number
MTST230V
5108A03H01
JGFCT250
JGFCT160
JGFCT100
JGFCT050
TRIP-LED
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For use on a three-pole breaker used in a four-wire system if ground fault protection for the
neutral is required.
2 Neutral protection 4 = 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100% electronic trip unit neutral protection is
not adjustable.
3 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-36
2.2
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA25/25
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGE305033G
JGE305032G
JGE305035G
JGE305036G
JGFCT050
100
JGE310033G
JGE310032G
JGE310035G
JGE310036G
JGFCT100
160
JGE316033G
JGE316032G
JGE316035G
JGE316036G
JGFCT160
250
JGE325033G
JGE325032G
JGE325035G
JGE325036G
JGFCT250
50
JGE405033G
JGE405032G
JGE405035G
JGE405036G
100
JGE410033G
JGE410032G
JGE410035G
JGE410036G
160
JGE416033G
JGE416032G
JGE416035G
JGE416036G
250
JGE425033G
JGE425032G
JGE425035G
JGE425036G
Ampere
Rating
2
2
Three-Pole
2
2
Four-Pole 2
2
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA40/35
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGS305033G
JGS305032G
JGS305035G
JGS305036G
JGFCT050
100
JGS310033G
JGS310032G
JGS310035G
JGS310036G
JGFCT100
160
JGS316033G
JGS316032G
JGS316035G
JGS316036G
JGFCT160
250
JGS325033G
JGS325032G
JGS325035G
JGS325036G
JGFCT250
50
JGS405033G
JGS405032G
JGS405035G
JGS405036G
100
JGS410033G
JGS410032G
JGS410035G
JGS410036G
160
JGS416033G
JGS416032G
JGS416035G
JGS416036G
250
JGS425033G
JGS425032G
JGS425035G
JGS425036G
Ampere
Rating
Three-Pole
2
2
Four-Pole 23
2
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA70/65
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGH305033G
JGH305032G
JGH305035G
JGH305036G
JGFCT050
100
JGH310033G
JGH310032G
JGH310035G
JGH310036G
JGFCT100
160
JGH316033G
JGH316032G
JGH316035G
JGH316036G
JGFCT160
250
JGH325033G
JGH325032G
JGH325035G
JGH325036G
JGFCT250
50
JGH405033G
JGH405032G
JGH405035G
JGH405036G
100
JGH410033G
JGH410032G
JGH410035G
JGH410036G
160
JGH416033G
JGH416032G
JGH416035G
JGH416036G
250
JGH425033G
JGH425032G
JGH425035G
JGH425036G
Ampere
Rating
Three-Pole
Four-Pole 2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2 Neutral protection 4 = 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100% electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
3 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
V4-T2-37
2.2
2
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGC305033G
JGC305032G
JGC305035G
JGC305036G
JGFCT050
100
JGC310033G
JGC310032G
JGC310035G
JGC310036G
JGFCT100
160
JGC316033G
JGC316032G
JGC316035G
JGC316036G
JGFCT160
250
JGC335033G
JGC325032G
JGC325035G
JGC325036G
JGFCT250
Four-Pole 2
2
2
2
Ampere
Rating
Three-Pole
50
JGC405033G
JGC405032G
JGC405035G
JGC405036G
100
JGC410033G
JGC410032G
JGC410035G
JGC410036G
160
JGC416033G
JGC416032G
JGC416035G
JGC416036G
250
JGC435033G
JGC425032G
JGC425035G
JGC425036G
2
2
2
2
Ampere
Rating
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Three-Pole
50
JGU305033G
JGU305032G
JGU305035G
JGU305036G
JGFCT050
100
JGU310033G
JGU310032G
JGU310035G
JGU310036G
JGFCT100
160
JGU316033G
JGU316032G
JGU316035G
JGU316036G
JGFCT160
250
JGU335033G
JGU325032G
JGU325035G
JGU325036G
JGFCT250
50
JGU405033G
JGU405032G
JGU405035G
JGU405036G
100
JGU410033G
JGU410032G
JGU410035G
JGU410036G
160
JGU416033G
JGU416032G
JGU416035G
JGU416036G
250
JGU435033G
JGU425032G
JGU425035G
JGU425036G
2
2
2
Four-Pole 23
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGX305033G
JGX305032G
JGX305035G
JGX305036G
JGFCT050
100
JGX310033G
JGX310032G
JGX310035G
JGX310036G
JGFCT100
160
JGX316033G
JGX316032G
JGX316035G
JGX316036G
JGFCT160
250
JGX325033G
JGX325032G
JGX325035G
JGX325036G
JGFCT250
2
2
2
Ampere
Rating
Three-Pole
Four-Pole 2
50
JGX405033G
JGX405032G
JGX405035G
JGX405036G
100
JGX410033G
JGX410032G
JGX410035G
JGX410036G
160
JGX416033G
JGX416032G
JGX416035G
JGX416036G
250
JGX425033G
JGX425032G
JGX425035G
JGX425036G
2
2
2
Notes
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2 Neutral protection 4 = 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100% electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
3 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
V4-T2-38
2.2
Complete Breaker (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and Mounting Hardware)IC Rating at 415/480 Volts
JG-Frame
JG-FrameIEC/CE/UL/CSA25/25
JG-FrameIEC/CE/UL/CSA70/65
Three-Pole
Three-Pole
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
Magnetic
Range
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGE3070FAGC
70
350700
JGH3070FAGC
90
450900
JGE3090FAGC
90
450900
JGH3090FAGC
100
5001000
JGE3100FAGC
100
5001000
JGH3100FAGC
125
6251250
JGE3125FAGC
125
6251250
JGH3125FAGC
150
7501550
JGE3150FAGC
150
7501550
JGH3150FAGC
160
8001600
160
8001600
175
8751750
JGE3175FAGC
175
8751750
JGH3175FAGC
200
10002000
JGE3200FAGC
200
10002000
JGH3200FAGC
225
11252250
JGE3225FAGC
225
11252250
JGH3225FAGC
250
12502500
JGE3250FAGC
250
12502500
JGH3250FAGC
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Catalog
Number
70
350700
JGS3070FAGC
90
450900
JGS3090FAGC
100
5001000
JGS3100FAGC
125
6251250
JGS3125FAGC
150
7501550
JGS3150FAGC
160
8001600
175
8751750
JGS3175FAGC
200
10002000
JGS3200FAGC
225
11252250
JGS3225FAGC
250
12502500
JGS3250FAGC
2
2
Three-Pole
Magnetic
Range
2
2
JG-FrameIEC/CE/UL/CSA40/35
Maximum
Continuous
Amperes
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-39
2.2
IEC/UL/CSA25/25
2
2
2
2
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGE305033GC
JGE305032GC
JGE305035GC
JGE305036GC
JGFCT050
100
JGE310033GC
JGE310032GC
JGE310035GC
JGE310036GC
JGFCT100
160
JGE316033GC
JGE316032GC
JGE316035GC
JGE316036GC
JGFCT160
250
JGE325033GC
JGE325032GC
JGE325035GC
JGE325036GC
JGFCT250
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGS305033GC
JGS305032GC
JGS305035GC
JGS305036GC
JGFCT050
100
JGS310033GC
JGS310032GC
JGS310035GC
JGS310036GC
JGFCT100
160
JGS316033GC
JGS316032GC
JGS316035GC
JGS316036GC
JGFCT160
250
JGS325033GC
JGS325032GC
JGS325035GC
JGS325036GC
JGFCT250
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA40/35
IEC/UL/CSA70/65
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGH305033GC
JGH305032GC
JGH305035GC
JGH305036GC
JGFCT050
100
JGH310033GC
JGH310032GC
JGH310035GC
JGH310036GC
JGFCT100
160
JGH316033GC
JGH316032GC
JGH316035GC
JGH316036GC
JGFCT160
250
JGH325033GC
JGH325032GC
JGH325035GC
JGH325036GC
JGFCT250
2
2
Note
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-40
2.2
JG-Frame
2
2
2
2
2
2
T250FJ
TA250FJ
Endcap Kit
Control Wire
Terminal Kit
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire Type
AWG Wire
Metric Wire Range/ Number Catalog
Range mm2 of Conductors Number
Multiwire Connectors
250
Stainless steel Cu
25185
#4350 (1)
T250FJ
250
Aluminum
10185
#8350 (1)
TA250FJ 12
Cu/Al
Number of Poles
Catalog Number
Line or Load
2, 3
FJTS3K
FJTS4K
Catalog Number
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
Number of Poles
Metric
Imperial
FJIPBK 3
FJ3RTWK
FJ3RTDK
FJIPBK4 3
FJ4RTWK
FJ4RTDK
Catalog
Number
FJCWTK
2
2
Multiwire Connectors
Field-installed multiwire connectors for the load side (OFF) end
terminals are used to distribute the load from the circuit breaker
to multiple devices without the use of separate distribution
terminal blocks.
250
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
#4350 kcmil
Catalog
Number
TA250JGRF
Maximum
Amperes
Wires per
Terminal
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
Kit Catalog
Number
250
142
3TA250FJ3
250
146
3TA250FJ6
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3TA250JGRF
Maximum
Amperes
Interphase Barriers
Endcap Kits
Notes
1 Individually packed.
2 Standard line and load.
3 Individually priced.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-41
2.2
Accessories
JG-Frame Accessories
Description
Internal Accessories
(Only one internal accessory per pole)
2
2
Reference
Page
Four-Pole
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-110
External Accessories
V4-T2-41
V4-T2-41
V4-T2-41
Multiwire connectors
V4-T2-41
V4-T2-41
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-41
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
Electrical operator
V4-T2-107
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-107
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-92
Drawout cassette
V4-T2-114
V4-T2-36
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-105
2
2
2
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
Note
1
Contact Eaton.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-42
2.2
Volts DC 1
250 23
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
JGE250
2, 3, 4
65
65
25
25
25
18
12
10
JGS250
2, 3, 4
85
85
40
40
35
18
12
22
JGH250
2, 3, 4
100
100
70
70
65
25
14
22
JGC250 4
3, 4
200
200
100
100
100
35
16
12
42
JGU250 4
3, 4
200
200
150
150
150
50
18
14
50
JGX250 4
3, 4
200
200
200
200
200
50
18
14
50
220240
Icu
690 2
380415
Ics
Icu
Ics
480
600
Icu
Ics
2
2
2
2
2
JG 310+ Specifications
Description
Specification
2
2
Breaker Type
Frame designation
JG
Frames available
20250A
10250A
100% rated
Yes
2
2
2
2
Protection
Ordering options
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
LSI, LSIG
Yes
Thru-cover accessories
Yes
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 DC ratings apply to substantially non-inductive circuits.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
3 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum at 22 kA.
4 Current limiting per UL 489.
5 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-43
2.2
310+ Settings
JG Frame
50 A
100 A
160 A
250 A
20
40
63
100
20
45
80
125
25
50
90
150
30
63
100
160
32
70
110
175
40
80
125
200
45
90
150
225
H (= In)
50
100
160
250
Position 1
Position 2
Position 3
Position 4
10
10
10
10
Position 5
12
12
12
12
Position 6
15
15
15
15
Position 7
20
20
20
20
Position 8
24
24
24
24
Position 1
2x
2x
2x
2x
Position 2
3x
3x
3x
3x
Position 3
4x
4x
4x
4x
Position 4
5x
5x
5x
5x
Position 5
6x
6x
6x
6x
Position 6
7x
7x
7x
7x
Position 7
8x
8x
8x
8x
Position 8
10x
10x
10x
10x
Position 9
14x
14x
14x
14x
tsd
(LS, LSG)
Fixed
67 at10x
67 at10x
67 at10x
67 at10x
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
120
2
2
2
2
2
Ir
Position 3
300
300
300
300
Position 1
10
20
32
50
Position 2
15
30
48
75
Position 3
20
40
64
100
Position 4
30
60
96
150
Position 5
40
80
128
200
Position 6
50
100
160
250
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
120
Position 3
300
300
300
300
N/A
N/A
Notes
1 Not available for JG. Independently adjustable Ii setting available in LG, NG and RG ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode not available for JG frames. It is available for KD, LD, MDL, LG, NG, and RG.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-44
2.2
JG-Frame
Number
of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
2, 3
4.13 (104.9)
7.00 (177.8)
3.57 (90.7)
5.34 (135.6)
7.00 (177.8)
3.57 (90.7)
2
2
JG-Frame
2
Front View Three-Pole
Side View
CL
0.63 (16.0)
Breaker
3.06
(77.7)
3.95
(100.3)
0.19 (4.8) R
0.28 (7.1)
0.50
(12.7)
1.25 (31.8)
2.05 (52.1)
CL
Handle
4.00
(101.6)
7.00
(177.8)
1.06 (27.0)
4.13
(104.9)
3.44
(87.4)
JG-Frame
Breaker Type
Number of Poles
2, 3
JGC
6.00 (2.70)
8.00 (3.60)
JGE
6.00 (2.70)
8.00 (3.60)
JGH
6.00 (2.70)
8.00 (3.60)
JGS
6.00 (2.70)
8.00 (3.60)
JGU
6.00 (2.70)
8.00 (3.60)
JGX
6.00 (2.70)
8.00 (3.60)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-45
2.2
2
4-Pole
5.50 (139.7)
3-Pole
4.13 (104.9)
0.69
2.06
1.38 (17.5)
(52.3)
(35.1)
2
2
2
Series G
3.92
(99.6)
5.50
(139.7)
1.25
(31.8)
3.57
(90.7)
3.92
(99.6)
5.50
(139.7)
0.63
(16.0)
1.88
(47.8)
R 0.19
(4.8)
11.25
(285.8)
6.97
(177.0)
4.93
(125.2)
0.28
(7.1)
7.00
(177.8)
2.05
(52.1)
11.25
(285.8)
1.06
(26.9)
0.50
(139.7)
2
2
RESET
TEST
3.37
(85.6)
4.25
(108.0)
2
2
3.31
(84.1)
3.69
(93.7)
3.57
(90.7)
3.81
(96.8)
4.78
(121.4)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-46
2.05
(52.1)
4.09
(103.9)
2.2
Contents
Description
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-48
V4-T2-49
V4-T2-60
V4-T2-61
V4-T2-63
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-47
2.2
2
2
2
L G S 3 600 FA G C
2
Frame
Rating
Blank = 80% rated
C = 100% rated (for LGE, LGS and LGH only)
Standard/Application
G = IEC/CE/UL/CSA
2
2
E
S
H
C
U
X
K
2
2
2
Performance
600
480
415
18
35
35
25
50
50
35
65
70
50
100
100
65
150
150
65
200
200
Molded case switch
Number of Poles
240
65
85
100
200
200
200
3 = Three
4 = FourNeutral 0% protected
6 = FourNeutral 60% protected
7 = FourNeutral 100% protected
8 = FourNeutral 060% protected
9 = FourNeutral 0100 protected
Amperes
250
300
350
400
500
600
630
Trip Unit
AA = Adj. adj.
FA = Fixed adj.
KS = Molded case switch
33 = 310+ electronic LS
32 = 310+ electronic LSI
35 = 310+ electronic LSG
36 = 310+ electronic LSIG
38 = 310+ electronic ALSI
39 = 310+ electronic ALSIG
NN = Frame only (630 A only; no trip unit)
2
2
2
2
Trip Unit
LT 3 600 FA B20
2
2
Trip
LT
Number of Poles
3 = Three
4 = Fourneutral 0% protected
8 = Fourneutral 0/60% protected
9 = Fourneutral 0/100% protected
2
2
2
2
2
Terminations/Hardware
Terminals
Mounting Hardware
M = Metric end caps
Metric
E = Imperial end caps
Imperial
G = Line/load standard
Metric
W = Without terminals
Amperes
250
300
350
400
500
600
630
Trip Unit
AA = Adj. adj., thermal-magnetic
FA = Fixed adj., thermal-magnetic
KS = Molded case switch
33 = 310+ electronic LS
32 = 310+ electronic LSI
35 = 310+ electronic LSG
36 = 310+ electronic LSIG
38 = 310+ electronic ALSI
39 = 310+ electronic ALSIG
Notes
1 Bxx features cannot be combined with other Bxx features.
2 B21 and B22 available with LSG and LSIG trip units.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-48
2.2
Product Selection
Complete Breaker (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and Mounting Hardware)
LG-Frame
Three-Pole 2
LG-Frame
2
Four-Pole (0%) 3
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGE3250FAG
LGE3250AAG
LGE4250FAG
LGE4250AAG
300
LGE3300FAG
LGE4300FAG
320
LGE3320AAG
LGE4320AAG
350
LGE3350FAG
LGE4350FAG
400
LGE3400FAG
LGE3400AAG
LGE4400FAG
LGE4400AAG
500
LGE3500FAG
LGE3500AAG
LGE4500FAG
LGE4500AAG
600
LGE3600FAG
LGE4600FAG
630 4
LGE3630AAG
LGE4630AAG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
LG-Frame
2
Four-Pole (0%) 3
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGS3250FAG
LGS3250AAG
LGS4250FAG
LGS4250AAG
300
LGS3300FAG
LGS4300FAG
320
LGS3320AAG
LGS4320AAG
350
LGS3350FAG
LGS4350FAG
400
LGS3400FAG
LGS3400AAG
LGS4400FAG
LGS4400AAG
500
LGS3500FAG
LGS3500AAG
LGS4500FAG
LGS4500AAG
600
LGS3600FAG
LGS4600FAG
630 4
LGS3630AAG
LGS4630AAG
2
2
2
2
2
Four-Pole (0%) 3
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGH3250FAG
LGH3250AAG
LGH4250FAG
LGH4250AAG
300
LGH3300FAG
LGH4300FAG
320
LGH3320AAG
LGH4320AAG
350
LGH3350FAG
LGH4350FAG
400
LGH3400FAG
LGH3400AAG
LGH4400FAG
LGH4400AAG
500
LGH3500FAG
LGH3500AAG
LGH4500FAG
LGH4500AAG
LGH3600FAG
LGH4600FAG
LGH3630AAG
LGH4630AAG
600
630
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
3 Neutral protection is indicated by the fourth character: 4 = 0%, 7 = 100%, 8 = adjustable 060% and 9 = 0100%. Neutral is on LH side.
4 320/630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the LG.
5 Adjustable thermal units are typically used in IEC markets and are not UL or CSA listed.
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
2
2
V4-T2-49
2.2
Complete Breaker (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and Mounting Hardware)
LG-Frame
LG-Frame630 Amperes (600 Amperes UL, CSA), Current Limiting Per UL 489
IC Rating: 100 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac 1
Three-Pole 2
Four-Pole (0%) 3
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGC3250FAG
LGC3250AAG
LGC4250FAG
LGC4250AAG
300
LGC3300FAG
LGC4300FAG
320
LGC3320AAG
LGC4320AAG
350
LGC3350FAG
LGC4350FAG
400
LGC3400FAG
LGC3400AAG
LGC4400FAG
LGC4400AAG
500
LGC3500FAG
LGC3500AAG
LGC4500FAG
LGC4500AAG
600
LGC3600FAG
LGC4600FAG
LGC3630AAG
LGC4630AAG
2
2
2
2
630
2
2
LG-Frame
LG-Frame630 Amperes (600 Amperes UL, CSA), Current Limiting Per UL 489
IC Rating: 150 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac 1
Three-Pole 2
Four-Pole (0%) 3
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGU3250FAG
LGU3250AAG
LGU4250FAG
LGU4250AAG
300
LGU3300FAG
LGU4300FAG
320
LGU3320AAG
LGU4320AAG
350
LGU3350FAG
LGU4350FAG
400
LGU3400FAG
LGU3400AAG
LGU4400FAG
LGU4400AAG
500
LGU3500FAG
LGU3500AAG
LGU4500FAG
LGU4500AAG
600
LGU3600FAG
LGU4600FAG
630 4
LGU3630AAG
LGU4630AAG
2
2
2
2
LG-Frame
LG-Frame630 Amperes (600 Amperes UL, CSA), Current Limiting Per UL 489
IC Rating: 200 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac 1
Three-Pole 2
Four-Pole (0%) 3
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 45
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGX3250FAG
LGX3250AAG
LGX4250FAG
LGX4250AAG
300
LGX3300FAG
LGX4300FAG
320
LGX3320AAG
LGX4320AAG
350
LGX3350FAG
LGX4350FAG
400
LGX3400FAG
LGX3400AAG
LGX4400FAG
LGX4400AAG
500
LGX3500FAG
LGX3500AAG
LGX4500FAG
LGX4500AAG
600
LGX3600FAG
LGX4600FAG
630 4
LGX3630AAG
LGX4630AAG
2
2
Notes
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
3 Neutral protection is indicated by the fourth character: 4 = 0%, 7 = 100%, 8 = adjustable 060% and 9 = 0100%. Neutral is on LH side.
4 320/630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the LG.
5 Adjustable thermal units are typically used in IEC markets and are not UL or CSA listed.
2
2
V4-T2-50
2.2
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
400
32
LGK3400KSG
LGK4400KSG
630 3
32
LGK3630KSG
LGK4630KSG
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole 2
Four-Pole 0%
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
LGE3630NN
LGE4630NN
LGE3630NNWC
LGS3630NN
LGS4630NN
LGS3630NNWC
LGH3630NN
LGH4630NN
LGH3630NNWC
LGC4630NN
35/35
630 3
2
2
50/50
630 3
2
2
70/53
630 3
LGC3630NN
LGU3630NN
LGU4630NN
LGX3630NN
LGX4630NN
2
2
Four-Pole (0%)
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 4
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Adjustable Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic 4
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LT3250FA
LT3250AA
LT4250FA
LT4250AA
300
LT3300FA
LT4300FA
320
LT3320AA
LT4320AA
350
LT3350FA
LT4350FA
400
LT3400FA
LT3400AA
LT4400FA
LT4400AA
500
LT3500FA
LT3500AA
LT4500FA
LT4500AA
600
LT3600FA
LT4600FA
630
LT3630AA
LT4630AA
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Molded case switches will trip above 6300 amperes.
2 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
3 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for the LG.
4 Adjustable thermal, adjustable magnetic trip units are typically used in IEC markets and are not UL or CSA listed.
5 Neutral protection is indicated by the third character: 4 = 0%, 7 = 100%, 8 = adjustable 060% and 9 = 0100%.
6 100% rated frame.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-51
2.2
2
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Three-Pole
250
LT325033
LT325032
LT325035
LT325036
LGFCT250
400
LT340033
LT340032
LT340035
LT340036
LGFCT400
600
LT360033
LT360032
LT360035
LT360036
LGFCT600
630 2
LT363033
LT363032
LT363035
LT363036
LGFCT600
Four-Pole 34
250
LT425033
LT425032
LT425035
LT425036
400
LT440033
LT440032
LT440035
LT440036
600
LT460033
LT460032
LT460035
LT460036
630 2
LT463033
LT463032
LT463035
LT463036
2
2
Description
Catalog
Number
MTST230V
5108A03H01
LGFCT630
LGFCT600
LGFCT400
LGFCT250
TRIP-LED
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
2
2
Notes
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
3 Neutral protection: 4= 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100%. Electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
4 Four-pole LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-52
2.2
IC Rating at 415/480 V
Complete LG Breakers with Electronic Trip Unit (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and
Mounting Hardware) 1
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-62.
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGE325033G
LGE325032G
LGE325035G
LGE325036G
LGFCT250
400
LGE340033G
LGE340032G
LGE340035G
LGE340036G
LGFCT400
600
LGE360033G
LGE360032G
LGE360035G
LGE360036G
LGFCT600
630 4
LGE363033G
LGE363032G
LGE363035G
LGE363036G
LGFCT600
250
LGE425033G
LGE425032G
LGE425035G
LGE425036G
400
LGE440033G
LGE440032G
LGE440035G
LGE440036G
600
LGE460033G
LGE460032G
LGE460035G
LGE460036G
630 4
LGE463033G
LGE463032G
LGE463035G
LGE463036G
Ampere
Rating
2
2
2
Three-Pole 3
2
2
2
Four-Pole 5
2
2
2
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGS325033G
LGS325032G
LGS325035G
LGS325036G
LGFCT250
400
LGS340033G
LGS340032G
LGS340035G
LGS340036G
LGFCT400
600
LGS360033G
LGS360032G
LGS360035G
LGS360036G
LGFCT600
630 4
LGS363033G
LGS363032G
LGS363035G
LGS363036G
LGFCT600
250
LGS425033G
LGS425032G
LGS425035G
LGS425036G
400
LGS440033G
LGS440032G
LGS440035G
LGS440036G
600
LGS460033G
LGS460032G
LGS460035G
LGS460036G
630 4
LGS463033G
LGS463032G
LGS463035G
LGS463036G
Ampere
Rating
Three-Pole 3
2
2
Four-Pole 56
2
2
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGH325033G
LGH325032G
LGH325035G
LGH325036G
LGFCT250
400
LGH340033G
LGH340032G
LGH340035G
LGH340036G
LGFCT400
600
LGH360033G
LGH360032G
LGH360035G
LGH360036G
LGFCT600
LGH363033G
LGH363032G
LGH363035G
LGH363036G
LGFCT600
250
LGH425033G
LGH425032G
LGH425035G
LGH425036G
400
LGH440033G
LGH440032G
LGH440035G
LGH440036G
600
LGH460033G
LGH460032G
LGH460035G
LGH460036G
630 4
LGH463033G
LGH463032G
LGH463035G
LGH463036G
Ampere
Rating
2
2
Three-Pole 3
630 4
Four-Pole
56
2
2
Notes
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
4 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
5 Neutral protection: 4= 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100%. Electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
6 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
2
2
2
V4-T2-53
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
IC Rating at 415/480 V
Complete LG Breakers with Electronic Trip Unit (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and
Mounting Hardware) 1
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-62.
IC Rating: 100 kAIC at 415 Vac and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
Ampere
Rating
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Three-Pole 3
250
LGC325033G
LGC325032G
LGC325035G
LGC325036G
LGFCT250
400
LGC340033G
LGC340032G
LGC340035G
LGC340036G
LGFCT400
600
LGC360033G
LGC360032G
LGC360035G
LGC360036G
LGFCT600
630 4
LGC363033G
LGC363032G
LGC363035G
LGC363036G
LGFCT600
Four-Pole 56
250
LGC425033G
LGC425032G
LGC425035G
LGC425036G
400
LGC440033G
LGC440032G
LGC440035G
LGC440036G
600
LGC460033G
LGC460032G
LGC460035G
LGC460036G
630 4
LGC463033G
LGC463032G
LGC463035G
LGC463036G
IC Rating: 150 kAIC at 415 Vac and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
2
2
2
Ampere
Rating
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Three-Pole 3
250
LGU325033G
LGU325032G
LGU325035G
LGU325036G
LGFCT250
400
LGU340033G
LGU340032G
LGU340035G
LGU340036G
LGFCT400
600
LGU360033G
LGU360032G
LGU360035G
LGU360036G
LGFCT600
630 4
LGU363033G
LGU363032G
LGU363035G
LGU363036G
LGFCT600
250
LGU425033G
LGU425032G
LGU425035G
LGU425036G
400
LGU440033G
LGU440032G
LGU440035G
LGU440036G
600
LGU460033G
LGU460032G
LGU460035G
LGU460036G
630 4
LGU463033G
LGU463032G
LGU463035G
LGU463036G
2
2
2
2
2
Four-Pole 5
IC Rating: 200 kAIC at 415 Vac and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
Ampere
Rating
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG 2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Three-Pole 3
250
LGX325033G
LGX325032G
LGX325035G
LGX325036G
LGFCT250
400
LGX340033G
LGX340032G
LGX340035G
LGX340036G
LGFCT400
600
LGX360033G
LGX360032G
LGX360035G
LGX360036G
LGFCT600
630 4
LGX363033G
LGX363032G
LGX363035G
LGX363036G
LGFCT600
Four-Pole 5
250
LGX425033G
LGX425032G
LGX425035G
LGX425036G
400
LGX440033G
LGX440032G
LGX440035G
LGX440036G
600
LGX460033G
LGX460032G
LGX460035G
LGX460036G
630 4
LGX463033G
LGX463032G
LGX463035G
LGX463036G
2
2
2
Notes
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
4 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
5 Neutral protection: 4= 0%, 6 = 60%, 7 = 100%. Electronic trip unit neutral protection is not adjustable.
6 Four-pole breakers with LSG and LSIG trip units are only available with 0% neutral protection.
V4-T2-54
2.2
Complete Breaker (Includes Frame, Trip Unit, Standard Terminals and Mounting Hardware)
LG-Frame
Three-Pole 2
Three-Pole 2
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Ampere Rating
Catalog Number
Ampere Rating
Catalog Number
250
LGE3250FAGC
250
LGH3250FAGC
300
LGE3300FAGC
300
LGH3300FAGC
320
320
350
LGE3350FAGC
350
LGH3350FAGC
400
LGE3400FAGC
400
LGH3400FAGC
500
LGE3500FAGC
500
LGH3500FAGC
600
LGE3600FAGC
600
LGH3600FAGC
630 4
630 4
250
LGS3250FAGC
300
LGS3300FAGC
320
350
LGS3350FAGC
400
LGS3400FAGC
500
LGS3500FAGC
600
630
2
2
2
Notes
1 Replace suffix G with W for no line and load terminals.
2 For two-pole applications, use two outer poles.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
LGS3600FAGC
4
Fixed Thermal,
Adjustable Magnetic
Catalog Number
Three-Pole 2
Ampere Rating
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-55
2.2
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGE325033GC
LGE325032GC
LGE325035GC
LGE325036GC
LGFCT250
400
LGE340033GC
LGE340032GC
LGE340035GC
LGE340036GC
LGFCT400
600
LGE360033GC
LGE360032GC
LGE360035GC
LGE360036GC
LGFCT600
630 2
LGE363033GC
LGE363032GC
LGE363035GC
LGE363036GC
LGFCT600
2
2
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGS325033GC
LGS325032GC
LGS325035GC
LGS325036GC
LGFCT250
400
LGS340033GC
LGS340032GC
LGS340035GC
LGS340036GC
LGFCT400
600
LGS360033GC
LGS360032GC
LGS360035GC
LGS360036GC
LGFCT600
630 2
LGS363033GC
LGS363032GC
LGS363035GC
LGS363036GC
LGFCT600
2
2
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGH325033GC
LGH325032GC
LGH325035GC
LGH325036GC
LGFCT250
400
LGH340033GC
LGH340032GC
LGH340035GC
LGH340036GC
LGFCT400
600
LGH360033GC
LGH360032GC
LGH360035GC
LGH360036GC
LGFCT600
630 2
LGH363033GC
LGH363032GC
LGH363035GC
LGH363036GC
LGFCT600
2
2
Notes
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2 630 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA listed rating for the LG.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-56
2.2
2
interruption times than the
standard (digital)
instantaneous protection.
Work locations downstream
of a circuit breaker with an
Arcflash Reduction
Ampere
Rating
ALSI
ALSIG
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
2
2
2
2
2
250
LGE325038G
LGE365039G
LGFCT250
400
LGE340038G
LGE340039G
LGFCT400
600
LGE360038G
LGE360039G
LGFCT600
630
LGE363038G
LGE363039G
LGFCT600
2
2
LGS325038G
LGS365039G
LGFCT250
400
LGS340038G
LGS340039G
LGFCT400
600
LGS360038G
LGS360039G
LGFCT600
630
LGS363038G
LGS363039G
LGFCT600
2
2
LGH325038G
LGH365039G
LGFCT250
400
LGH340038G
LGH340039G
LGFCT400
600
LGH360038G
LGH360039G
LGFCT600
630
LGH363038G
LGH363039G
LGFCT600
2
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA 100 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
250
LGC325038G
LGC365039G
LGFCT250
400
LGC340038G
LGC340039G
LGFCT400
600
LGC360038G
LGC360039G
LGFCT600
630
LGC363038G
LGC363039G
LGFCT600
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA 150 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
250
LGU325038G
LGU365039G
LGFCT250
400
LGU340038G
LGU340039G
LGFCT400
600
LGU360038G
LGU360039G
LGFCT600
630
LGU363038G
LGU363039G
LGFCT600
2
2
2
IEC/UL/CSA 200 kAIC at 415 and 480 Vac, Current Limiting Per UL 489
250
LGX325038G
LGX365039G
LGFCT250
400
LGX340038G
LGX340039G
LGFCT400
600
LGX360038G
LGX360039G
LGFCT600
630
LGX363038G
LGX363039G
LGFCT600
2
2
2
2
ALSIG
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 1
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LT325038
LT325039
LGFCT250
400
LT340038
LT340039
LGFCT400
600
LT360038
LT360039
LGFCT600
630
LT363038
LT363039
LGFCT600
2
2
2
2
Note
1 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is required.
2
V4-T2-57
2.2
Maximum
Breaker
Amperes
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire
Type
AWG
Wire Range/
Number of
Conductors
Metric
Wire Range
(mm2)
Number of
Terminals
Included
Catalog
Number
400
Aluminum
Cu/Al
500750 (1)
240380 (1)
3TA631LK 1
400
Aluminum
Cu/Al
500750 (1)
240380 (1)
4TA631LK 1
400
Copper
Cu
500750 (1)
240380 (1)
3T631LK 1
400
Copper
Cu
500750 (1)
240380 (1)
4T631LK 1
630
Aluminum
Cu/Al
2500 (2)
35240 (2)
TA632L
630
Aluminum
Cu/Al
2500 (2)
35240 (2)
3TA632LK 12
630
Aluminum
Cu/Al
2500 (2)
35240 (2)
4TA632LK 12
630
Copper
Cu
2500 (2)
35240 (2)
3T632LK 1
630
Copper
Cu
2500 (2)
35240 (2)
4T632LK 1
400
Aluminum
Cu/Al
3500 (1)
35240 (1)
TA350LK 2
400
Copper
Cu
3500 (1)
35240 (1)
T350LK
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
LTS3K
LTS4K
Catalog
Number
L3RTWK
L4RTWK
Description
Terminal
Body Type
Catalog
Number
Three-pole kit
Aluminum
3TA632LKW
Four-pole kit
Aluminum
4TA632LKW
Three-pole kit
Copper
3T632LKW
Four-pole kit
Copper
4T632LKW
Terminal Spreaders
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
LGTEW3
LGTEW4
Terminal Extensions
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
LGTES3
LGTES4
Handle Extension
Description
Catalog
Number
Handle extension
HEXLG
V4-T2-58
Package of 2
Catalog
Number
Interphase barrier
IPB3
Description
Three-pole terminal cover
Interphase Barrier
Maximum
Amperes
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
Catalog
Number
400
2500 kcmil
TA350LKRF
400
2500 kcmil
3TA350LKRF
630
TA632LKRF
630
3TA632LKRF
Wires per
Terminal
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
Kit Catalog
Number
600
141/0
3TA600L6K
Notes
1 Includes LTS3K (three-pole) or LTS4K (four-pole) terminal covers.
2 Standard terminal included with complete breaker.
3 Included in TA63IL, T63IL, TA632L kits listed above.
2.2
Terminals and Terminal Cover for the LG BreakerIncludes LTS3K (Three-Pole) or LTS4K (Four-Pole) Terminal Covers
Note: Extended terminal covers add 2.13 inches (54.0 mm) to breaker length.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-59
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
Accessories
LG-Frame Accessories
Description
Reference
Page
Three-Pole
Left
Four-Pole
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-110
Neu.
External Accessories
V4-T2-58
Handle extension
V4-T2-58
Terminal cover
V4-T2-58
V4-T2-58
Multiwire connectors
V4-T2-58
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
Electrical operator
V4-T2-107
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-92
Drawout cassette
V4-T2-114
V4-T2-52
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-105
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
Note
Contact Eaton.
2
2
V4-T2-60
2.2
Volts DC 1
240240
Icu
380415
Ics
Icu
480
600
690
Ics
Icu
250
Ics
Icu
Ics
LGE630
3, 4
65
65
35
35
35
18
12
22
22
LGS630
3, 4
85
85
50
50
50
25
20
10
22
22
LGH630
3, 4
100
100
70
70
65
35
25
13
42
42
LGC630 4
3, 4
200
200
100
100
100
50
30
15
42
42
LGU630 4
3, 4
200
200
150
150
150
65
35
18
50
50
200
200
200
200
65
35
18
50
50
LGX630
3, 4
200
23
2
2
2
2
2
LG 310+ Specifications
Description
Specification
2
2
Breaker Type
Frame designation
LG
Frames available
100600 A
50600 A
2
2
2
100% rated
Yes
Ordering options
Yes
Protection
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Thru-cover accessories
Yes
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 DC rating apply to substantially non-inductive circuits.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuits.
3 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum atkA.
4 Current limiting per UL 489.
5 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-61
2.2
310+ Settings
LG Frame
250 A
400 A
600 A
100
160
250
125
200
300
150
225
315
160
250
350
175
300
400
200
315
450
225
350
500
H (= In)
250
400
600
Position 1
Position 2
Position 3
Position 4
10
10
10
Position 5
12
12
12
Position 6
15
15
15
Position 7
20
20
20
Position 8
24
24
24
Position 1
2x
2x
2x
Position 2
3x
3x
3x
Position 3
4x
4x
4x
Position 4
5x
5x
5x
Position 5
6x
6x
6x
Position 6
7x
7x
7x
Position 7
8x
8x
8x
Position 8
10x
10x
10x
Position 9
12x
12x
12x
tsd
(LS, LSG)
Fixed
67 at10x
67 at10x
67 at10x
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
Position 3
300
300
300
Position 1
50
80
120
Position 2
75
120
180
Position 3
100
160
240
Position 4
150
240
360
Position 5
200
320
480
Position 6
250
400
600
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
Position 3
300
300
300
Yes
Fixed
2.5x
Notes
1 50 ms for ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode is enabled remotely using a 24 Vdc circuit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Ir
2
V4-T2-62
2.2
LG-Frame
Number of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
2, 3
5.48 (139.2)
10.13 (257.3)
4.09 (103.9)
7.22 (183.4)
10.13 (257.3)
4.09 (103.9)
2
2
2
LG-Frame
Note: TA63IL, T63IL, T632L, TA632L terminals add 1.19 inches (30.2 mm) to line or load side of LG. LTS3K or
LTS4K terminal covers add 2.13 inches (54.1 mm) to line or load side of LG.
2.43 (61.7)
R 0.25
(6.4)
CL
2
2
4.06
(103.1)
Breaker
3.16
(80.3)
5.58
(141.7)
2.00
(50.8)
10.13
(257.3)
1.92
(48.8)
2.69
(68.3)
5.38
(136.7)
5.48
(139.2)
2
2
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
16 (7.3)
20 (9.1)
2
2
Notes
1 DC rating apply to substantially non-inductive circuits.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuits.
3 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum atkA.
4 Three-poles in series. 750 Vdc ratings available (four-pole in series, not UL listed). Contact Eaton.
5 IEC rating is 300 kA at 240 Vac.
6 Current limiting per UL 489.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-63
2.2
2
5.16
(131.1)
3.44
(87.4)
1.72
(43.7)
2
2
2
2
4.06
(103.1)
3.98
(101.1)
0.86
(21.8)
5.58
(141.7)
5.58
(141.7)
4.73
(120.1)
3.44
(87.4)
1.72
(43.7)
4.73
(120.1)
2
2
8.44
(214.4)
8.44
(214.4)
10.13
(257.3)
2
2
2
15.38
(390.7)
13.69
(347.7)
13.68
(347.5)
15.38
(390.7)
2
2
3-Pole
5.48 (139.2)
4-Pole
7.22 (183.4)
2
2
4-Pole
2.75 (69.9)
3-Pole
2.74 (69.6)
3.97
(100.8)
4.30
(109.2)
4.55
(115.6)
5.43
(137.9)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-64
4-Pole
7.22 (183.4)
3-Pole
5.48 (139.2)
4-Pole
2.75 (69.9)
3-Pole
2.74 (69.6)
2.2
Contents
Description
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection Guide and Ordering
Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
2
2
2
V4-T2-66
V4-T2-67
V4-T2-70
V4-T2-71
V4-T2-73
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-65
2.2
2
2
2
NG H 3 080 39 ZG E C
Rating
Frame
NG
2
2
Performance
at 480 Vac
S = 50 kAIC
H = 65 kAIC
C = 100 kAIC
U = 150 kAIC 1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Amperes
080 = 800
120 = 1200
Poles
3 = Three
4 = Four; neutral 2
0% protected
7 = Four; neutral 2
100% protected
9 = Four; neutral 2
0/60/100% adjustable
protection
Trip Unit
33
32
35
36
38
39
=
=
=
=
=
=
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
310+ Electronic ALSI with maintenance mode
310+ Electronic ALSIG with maintenance mode
Notes
1 800 A only.
2 Neutral inn left pole on GN; right pole on NG.
3 Breakers do not ship with lugs.
Trip units are factory installable only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-66
Terminations 3
M = Metric tapped line/load
conductors
E = Imperial tapped line/load
conductors
Feature
Blank
B20
B21
B22
ZG
=
=
=
=
=
No feature
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip
Ground fault alarm, no trip
Zone selective interlocking
2.2
Type NGS Standard Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 50 kA lcu at 480 Vac or 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-72.
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 12
Number
of Poles
800
NGH308033E
NGH308032E
NGH308035E
NGH308036E
NGH308038E
NGH308039E
NGFCT120
44
NGH408033E
NGH408032E
NGH408035E
NGH408036E
NGH408038E
NGH408039E
45
NGH708033E
NGH708032E
NGH708038E
46
NGH908033E
NGH908032E
NGH908038E
NGH312033E
NGH312032E
NGH312035E
NGH312036E
NGH312038E
NGH312039E
NGFCT120
44
NGH412033E
NGH412032E
NGH412035E
NGH412036E
NGH412039E
NGH712033E
NGH712032E
NGH712038E
46
NGH912033E
NGH912032E
NGH912038E
1200 3
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip Electronic Trip Unit with Imperial Tapped Conductors
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
ALSI
ALSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Type NGS Standard Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 50 kA Icu at 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-72.
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 12
Number
of Poles
800
NGH308033E
NGH308032E
NGH308035E
NGH308036E
NGH308038E
NGH308039E
NGFCT120
44
NGH408033E
NGH408032E
NGH408035E
NGH408036E
NGH408038E
NGH408039E
45
NGH708033E
NGH708032E
NGH708038E
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip Electronic Trip Unit with Metric Tapped Conductors
4
1200
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
ALSI
ALSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG
2
2
2
NGH908033E
NGH908032E
NGH908038E
NGH312033E
NGH312032E
NGH312035E
NGH312036E
NGH312038E
NGH312039E
NGFCT120
44
NGH412033E
NGH412032E
NGH412035E
NGH412036E
NGH412039E
45
NGH712033E
NGH712032E
NGH712038E
46
NGH912033E
NGH912032E
NGH912038E
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole
Catalog
Number
Four-Pole
Catalog
Number
NGK4080KSE
800
NGK3080KSE
1200
NGK3120KSE
NGK4120KSE
1250
NGK3125KSE
NGK43125KSE
Notes
1 For AC use only.
2 NG MCCBs are suitable for 40 C or 50 C applications. Order suffix V3 to eliminate standard 40 C labeling.
3 Non-UL listed NG 1250 with 1250 ampere trip unit is also available.
4 Neutral 0% protected. NG, neutral in right pocket; GN, neutral in left pocket.
5 Neutral 100% protected (denoted by 7 in digit four); no neutral protection available with LSG or LSIG trip units.
6 Neutral 0%/60%/100% adjustable protection (denoted by 9 in digit four).
7 For AC use only. Molded case switch will trip above 14,000 amperes.
8 For two-pole applications, use outer poles of three-pole molded case switch.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-67
2.2
2
2
2
2
Series G
Type NGH High Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 65 kA lcu at 480 Vac or 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-72.
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 12
Number
of Poles
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
ALSI
ALSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG
800
NGH308033E
NGH308032E
NGH308035E
NGH308036E
NGH308038E
NGH308039E
NGFCT120
43
NGH408033E
NGH408032E
NGH408035E
NGH408036E
NGH408038E
NGH408039E
44
NGH708033E
NGH708032E
NGH708038E
45
NGH908033E
NGH908032E
NGH908038E
NGH312033E
NGH312032E
NGH312035E
NGH312036E
NGH312038E
NGH312039E
NGFCT120
43
NGH412033E
NGH412032E
NGH412035E
NGH412036E
NGH412039E
44
NGH712033E
NGH712032E
NGH712038E
45
NGH912033E
NGH912032E
NGH912038E
ALSI
ALSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG
2
2
1200
2
2
2
2
2
Type NGC Very High CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 100 kA lcu at 480 Vac or 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-72.
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 12
Number
of Poles
800
NGH308033E
NGH308032E
NGH308035E
NGH308036E
NGH308038E
NGH308039E
NGFCT120
43
NGH408033E
NGH408032E
NGH408035E
NGH408036E
NGH408038E
NGH408039E
44
NGH708033E
NGH708032E
NGH708038E
45
NGH908033E
NGH908032E
NGH908038E
NGH312033E
NGH312032E
NGH312035E
NGH312036E
NGH312038E
NGH312039E
NGFCT120
43
NGH412033E
NGH412032E
NGH412035E
NGH412036E
NGH412039E
44
NGH712033E
NGH712032E
NGH712038E
45
NGH912033E
NGH912032E
NGH912038E
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1200
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Notes
1 For AC use only.
2 NG MCCBs are suitable for 40 C or 50 C applications. Order suffix V3 to eliminate standard 40 C labeling.
3 Neutral 0% protected. NG, neutral in right pocket; GN, neutral in left pocket.
4 Neutral 100% protected (denoted by 7 in digit four); no neutral protection available with LSG or LSIG trip units.
5 Neutral 0%/60%/100% adjustable protection (denoted by 9 in digit four).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-68
2.2
Maximum
Breaker Amperes
Terminal
Body Material
Wire Type
AWG Wire
(Number of
Conductors)
AWG Wire
Catalog
Number 1
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Metric
Catalog
Number 1
2
2
Aluminum
Cu/Al
1500 (2)
TA700NB1
50240
TA700NB1M
1000
Aluminum
Cu/Al
3/0400 (3)
TA1000NB1
95185
TA1000NB1M
1200
Aluminum
Cu/Al
4/0500 (4)
TA1200NB1
120240
TA1200NB1M
1200
Aluminum
Cu/Al
500750 (3)
TA1201NB1
300400
TA1201NB1M
2
2
2
Copper
Cu
2/0500 (2)
T700NB1
70240
T700NB1M
1000
Copper
Cu
3/0500 (3)
T1000NB1
95240
T1000NB1M
1200
Copper
Cu
3/0400 (4)
T1200NB3
95185
T1200NB3M
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
MTST230V
Description
Catalog
Number
5108A03H01
5104A24G04
NGFCT120
5104A24G02
NGFCT120
TRIP-LED
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
Description
Catalog
Number
Imperial hardware:
0.312518 x 1.25
pan-head steel screws and lock washers
BMH5
Terminal Shield
Terminal Shield
Description
Three-pole terminal shield
NTS3K
2
2
2
Keeper Nut
Not required on NG-Frame. Terminals are threaded.
Handle Extension
Included with breaker. Additional handle extensions are
available.
2
2
Handle Extension
Description
Catalog
Number
HEX5
Interphase Barriers
The interphase barriers provide additional electrical clearance
between circuit breaker poles for special termination
applications. Barriers are high dielectric insulating plates that
are installed in the molded slots between the terminals.
(Field installation only.)
2
2
2
2
Interphase Barriers
Catalog
Number
Description
Catalog
Number
IPB5
Notes
1 Single terminals individually packed.
2 Metric hardware included with breaker.
3 Included as standard on 100% rated 800/1200 A breakers.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-69
2.2
Accessories
2
2
2
2
NG-Frame Accessories
Reference
Page
Description
Three-Pole
Left
Four-Pole
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neu.
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-110
External Accessories
Base mounting hardware
V4-T2-69
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-69
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
Electrical operator
V4-T2-107
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-107
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-413
Drawout cassette
V4-T2-114
Handle extension
V4-T2-69
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-105
2
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
Note
Contact Eaton.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-70
2.2
220240
380415
690
Number
of Poles
240 (UL)
Icu
Ics
Icu
Ics
480
600
Icu
Ics
2, 3, 4
65
85
85
50
50
50
25
20
10
NGH
2, 3, 4
100
100
100
70
50
65
35
25
13
NGC
2, 3, 4
200
200
100
100
50
100
65
35
18
NGS
2
2
2
2
NG 310+ Specifications
Description
Specification
2
2
Breaker Type
Frame designation
NG
Frames available
800 A, 1200 A
3201200A
1601200A
100% rated
Yes
2
2
2
2
Protection
Ordering options
Yes
No
Yes
B22) 2
2
2
2
Yes
Yes
LSI, LSIG, ALSI, ALSIG
Yes
Thru-cover accessories
No
2
2
Notes
1 1600 amperes is not a UL or CSA listed rating. 1200 amperes is the maximum UL and CSA rating for NG.
2 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-71
2.2
310+ Settings
RG Frame
800 A
1200 A
320
500
400
600
450
630
500
700
600
800
630
900
700
1000
H (= In)
800
1200
Position 1
Position 2
Position 3
Position 4
10
Position 5
10
12
Position 6
12
15
Position 7
14
20
Position 8
14
24
Position 1
2x
2x
Position 2
3x
3x
Position 3
4x
4x
Position 4
5x
5x
Position 5
6x
6x
Position 6
7x
7x
Position 7
8x
8x
Position 8
9x
9x
Position 9
9x
9x
tsd
(LS, LSG)
Fixed
67 at10x
67 at10x
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
Position 3
300
300
Position 1
160
240
Position 2
240
360
Position 3
320
480
Position 4
480
720
Position 5
640
960
Position 6
800
1200
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
Position 3
300
300
Yes
Fixed
2.5x
2.5x
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Ir
Notes
1 50 ms for ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode is enabled remotely using a 24 Vdc circuit.
2
2
V4-T2-72
2.2
NG-Frame
Number of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
5.50 (139.7)
11.13 (282.6)
16.00 (406.4)
5.50 (139.7)
2
2
2
NG-Frame
Front View Three-Pole
Side View
3.44
(87.4)
BREAKER
9.25
(235.0)
R .25
(6.4)
1.91
(48.5)
16.00
(406.4)
3.68
1.50 (93.5)
(38.1)
2
2
3.19
(81.0)
6.38
(162.1)
8.25
(209.6)
5.50
(139.7)
NG-Frame
2
Complete Breaker
Breaker Type
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
45 (20.4)
58 (26.3)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-73
2.2
2
Contents
Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-74
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-75
V4-T2-76
V4-T2-81
V4-T2-82
V4-T2-84
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2.2
RG H 3 250 39 ZG E C
2
2
Rating
Frame
RG
Performance
at 480 Vac
H = 65 kAIC
C = 100 kAIC
Poles
3 = Three
4 = Four
Trip Unit
33
32
35
36
38
39
=
=
=
=
=
=
Terminations
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
310+ Electronic LSI w/ Maintenance Mode
310+ Electronic LSIG w/ Maintenance Mode
2
2
Feature
Blank
B20
B21
B22
ZG
=
=
=
=
=
No feature
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip
Ground fault alarm, no trip
Zone selective interlocking
2
2
2
RT 3 250 39 ZG
Type
Trip Unit
Poles
3 = Three
Feature
RT
Amperes
160 = 1600
200 = 2000
250 = 2500
33
32
35
36
38
Blank
B20
B21
B22
ZG
=
=
=
=
=
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
310+ Electronic LSI
w/ Maintenance Mode
39 = 310+ Electronic LSIG
w/ Maintenance Mode
=
=
=
=
=
No feature
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip
Ground fault alarm, no trip
Zone selective interlocking
2
2
2
2
RG Circuit Breaker with OPTIM 610 and 910 Electronic Trip Unit
RGH 3 16 T92 W
Type
RGH 65K
RGC 100K
Poles
3 = Three
4 = Four
Amperes
16 = 1600
20 = 2000
25 = 2500
Trip Function
Digitrip 610
T61 = LI
T62 = LSI
T63 = LS
T64 = LIG
T65 = LSG
T66 = LSIG
Digitrip 910
T91 = LI
T92 = LSI
T93 = LS
T94 = LIG
T95 = LSG
T96 = LSIG
R =
E =
P =
V3 =
W =
K =
Modification Suffix
Ground fault remote
RES trip
100% protection
(new design 310)
RES trip unit
100% prot. neut.
4P RES trip unit
Electronic trip without
ambient temperature
marked on trip unit
w/o terms
Molded case switch
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-75
2.2
Product Selection
2
2
Type RGH with Digitrip 310+ High Interrupting CapacityUe Maximum 690 Vac, 70 kA Icu at 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-83.
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 1
Number
of Poles
LS
LSI
LSG 3
LSIG 3
ALSI
ALSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG
1600 1
RGH316033E
RGH316032E
RGH316035E
RGH316036E
RGH316038E
RGH316039E
RGFCT160A
2000
RGH320033E
RGH320032E
RGH320035E
RGH320036E
RGH320038E
RGH320039E
RGFCT200A
2500
RGH325033E
RGH325032E
RGH325035E
RGH325036E
RGH325038E
RGH325039E
RGFCT250A
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 310+ Electronic Trip Unit with
Adjustable Rating PlugsCatalog Number 2
2
2
Type RGH with Digitrip 310+ High Interrupting CapacityUe Maximum 690 Vac, 70 kA Icu at 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-83.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 1
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 310+ Electronic Trip Unit with
Adjustable Rating PlugsCatalog Number 2
Number
of Poles
LS
LSI
LSG 34
LSIG 34
ALSI
ALSIG 34
RGH416033E
RGH416032E
RGH416038E
2000
45
RGH420033E
RGH420032E
RGH420038E
2500
45
RGH425033E
RGH425032E
RGH425038E
1600
Notes
1 For SCR application, use 2000 ampere frame.
2 Order terminals separately. Mounting hardware not included.
3 Ground fault equipped trip units available with remote indicating panel. Add R to catalog number, for example, RGH316035RW.
4 No neutral protection available on four-pole breakers with LSG or LSIG trip units.
5 Unprotected left pole neutral. Add P to catalog number for 100% protected left pole neutral, add E for 60% protected, for example, RGH416033PW, RGH416033EW.
RG MCCBs have English threading on line and load conductors. Use suffix M for metric threading.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-76
2.2
Type RGC with Digitrip 310+ Very High Interrupting CapacityUe Maximum 690 Vac, 100 kA Icu at 415 Vac
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-83.
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 1
Number
of Poles
LS
LSI
LSG 3
LSIG 3
ALSI
ALSIG
Neutral CT
for LSG and LSIG
1600 1
RGC316033E
RGC316032E
RGC316035E
RGC316036E
RGC316038E
RGC316039E
RGFCT160A
2000
RGC320033E
RGC320032E
RGC320035E
RGC320036E
RGC320038E
RGC320039E
RGFCT200A
2500
RGC325033E
RGC325032E
RGC325035E
RGC325036E
RGC325038E
RGC325039E
RGFCT250A
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 310+ Electronic Trip Unit with
Adjustable Rating PlugsCatalog Number 2
2
2
2
2
Type RGC with Digitrip 310+ Very High Interrupting CapacityUe Maximum 690 Vac, 100 kA Icu at 415 Vac, continued
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-83.
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 1
Number
of Poles
LS
LSI
LSG 34
LSIG 34
ALSI
ALSIG 34
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 310+ Electronic Trip Unit with
Adjustable Rating PlugsCatalog Number 2
1600 1
45
RGC416033E
RGC416032E
RGC416038E
2000
45
RGC420033E
RGC420032E
RGC420038E
2500
45
RGC425033E
RGC425032E
RGC425038E
2
2
2
2
Ampere
Rating
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
1600
RGK3160KSE
2000
RGK3200KSE
1600
RGK4160KSE
2000
RGK4200KSE
2
2
2
Notes
1 For SCR application, use 2000 ampere frame.
2 Order terminals separately. Mounting hardware not included.
3 Ground fault equipped trip units available with remote indicating panel. Add R to catalog number, for example, RGH316035RW.
4 No neutral protection available on four-pole breakers with LSG or LSIG trip units.
5 Unprotected left pole neutral. Add P to catalog number for 100% protected left pole neutral, add E for 60% protected, for example, RGH416033PW, RGH416033EW.
6 Molded case switch will trip above 17,500 amperes.
RG MCCBs have English threading on line and load conductors. Use suffix M for metric threading.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-77
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
Digitrip RMS
Interchangeable
Rating Plug
(Order as Individual
Component)
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
26 x M1 and M2
0.5I.0n
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
26 x M1 and M2
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
26 x M1 and M2
0.251.0 x In 2
100500 ms
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
0.251.0 x In 2
100500 ms
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
26 x M1 and M2
0.251.0 x In 2
100500 ms
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
RGH316T66WP44
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1250
RP6R16A125
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1250
RP6R20A125
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1250
RP6R16A125
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1250
RP6R20A125
1600
RP6R20A160
Type RGH with Digitrip 610 High Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 70 kA Icu at 415 Vac
1600
RGH316T61WP44
RGH316T63WP44
RGH316T62WP44
RGH316T64WP44
RGH316T65WP44
2
2
2
RGH320T61WP49
RGH320T63WP49
RGH320T62WP49
RGH320T64WP49
RGH320T65WP49
RGH320T66WP49
2
2
2
2
2
RGH325T61WP53
RGH325T63WP53
RGH325T62WP53
RGH325T64WP53
RGH325T65WP53
RGH325T66WP53
Type RGC with Digitrip 610 Very High Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 100 kA Icu at 415 Vac
1600
RGC316T61WP44
RGC316T63WP44
RGC316T62WP44
RGC316T64WP44
RGC316T65WP44
RGC316T66WP44
2
2
2
RGC320T61WP49
RGC320T63WP49
RGC320T62WP49
RGC320T64WP49
RGC320T65WP49
RGC320T66WP49
2
2
2
2
2
2
RGC325T61WP53
RGC325T63WP53
RGC325T62WP53
RGC325T64WP53
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-78
RGC325T65WP53
RGC325T66WP53
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
2.2
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 610 and 910 Electronic Trip Unit with Rating Plugs
Order as Individual ComponentCatalog Number 1
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Number
of Poles
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Digitrip RMS
Interchangeable
Rating Plug
(Order as Individual
Component)
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
26 x M1 and M2
0.5I.0n
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
26 x M1 and M2
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
26 x M1 and M2
0.251.0 x In 2
100500 ms
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
0.251.0 x In 2
100500 ms
0.51.0 x In
224 Seconds
26 x Ir
100500 ms
26 x M1 and M2
0.251.0 x In 2
100500 ms
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
RGH316T96WP44
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1250
RP6R16A125
Type RGH with Digitrip 910 High Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 70 kA Icu at 415 Vac
1600
RGH316T91WP44
RGH316T93WP44
RGH316T92WP44
RGH316T94WP44
RGH316T95WP44
RGH320T91WP49
RGH320T93WP49
RGH320T92WP49
RGH320T94WP49
RGH320T95WP49
RGH320T96WP49
RGH325T91WP53
RGH325T93WP53
RGH325T92WP53
RGH325T94WP53
RGH325T95WP53
RGH325T96WP53
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1250
RP6R20A125
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
RGC316T91WP44
RGC316T93WP44
RGC316T92WP44
RGC316T94WP44
RGC316T95WP44
RGC316T96WP44
RGC320T91WP49
RGC320T93WP49
RGC320T92WP49
RGC320T94WP49
RGC320T95WP49
RGC320T96WP49
RGC325T91WP53
RGC325T93WP53
RGC325T92WP53
RGC325T94WP53
RGC325T95WP53
RGC25T96WP53
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1250
RP6R16A125
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1250
RP6R20A125
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
Type RGC with Digitrip 910 Very High Interrupting CapacityUe Max. 690 Vac, 100 kA Icu at 415 Vac
1600
Notes
1 Order terminals separately. Mounting hardware not included.
2 Not to exceed 1200 ampere ground fault pickup.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
RG MCCBs have metric threading on line and load conductors. Use RD MCCBs if imperial threading is required.
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-79
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire
Type
Hardware
AWG/kcmil
Wire Range/
Number of Conductors
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
Description
Wire Terminals
1600
Aluminum
Cu/Al
Metric
5001000 (4)
300500
TA1600RDM 1
1600
Copper
Cu
Metric
1600 (4)
50300
T1600RDM 1
2000
Aluminum
Cu/Al
Metric
2600 (6)
35300
TA2000RDM 2
2000
Copper
Metric
B2016RDM 1
2000
Copper
Metric
B2016RDLM 1
2500
Copper
Metric
B2500RDM 1
Rear Connectors
Conductor
(Viewed from Rear
of Circuit Breaker and Cut
Away for Clarity)
Conductor
(Viewed from Front
of Circuit Breaker)
Cu Only
Terminal
Catalog Number
T1600RDM 3
(For 1600 A
Frame Only)
2
2
OR
Al/Cu
Terminal
Catalog
Number
TA1600RDM 3
(For 1600 A
Frame Only)
2
2
2
2
Securing Hardware
Note: Order one TA2000RDM kit per three poles. Catalog number
includes bus connection, terminals and hardware for either line side or
load side of three-pole breaker.
Breaker Line/Load
Conductors
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-80
Single handle
extension
Catalog
Number
HEX6
Wire Seal
The wire seal can be used to
secure the cover on the trip
unit to prevent adjustments
after settings are confirmed.
Wire Seal
Securing
Hardware
Handle Extension
Description
Catalog
Number
Wire seal
5108A03H01
Notes
1 Order one per polesingle terminals
individually packed.
2 Order one TA2000RD kit per three poles.
Catalog number includes bus connection,
terminals and hardware for either line
side or load side of three-pole breaker.
3 For use with 2500 A Frame. Do not order
separately unless for replacement
purposes. Included in breaker carton
when 2500 A frame is ordered.
RG MCCBs have metric threading on line
and load conductors. Use RD MCCBs if
imperial threading is required.
2.2
Accessories
2
2
RG-Frame Accessories
Reference
Page
Description
Three-Pole
Left
Four-Pole
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-109
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-110
2
2
2
2
External Accessories
V4-T2-80
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-107
Electrical operator
V4-T2-107
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-413
Handle extension
V4-T2-80
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-105
2
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2
2
Catalog
Number
MTST230V
5108A03H01
RGFCT250A
RGFCT200A
RGFCT160A
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Contact Eaton.
2 Cause-of-trip indication LEDs integrated in RG 310+ trip units.
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-81
2.2
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
RGH
3, 4
125
RGC
3, 4
200
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
277
480
600
65
50
100
65
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
RGH
3, 4
415
690
Icu
135
70
25
Ics
100
50
13
Icu
200
100
35
Ics
100
50
18
RGC
3, 4
2
2
RG 310+ Specifications
Description
Specification
Frame designation
RG
Frames available
8002500 A
2001200 A
65, 100
100% rated
Yes
Breaker Type
Protection
Ordering options
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Thru-cover accessories
No
Notes
1 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
2 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-82
2.2
RG Frame
310+ Settings
Ir = continuous current or long delay pickup (amperes)
(All 310+)
1600 A
2000 A
800
1000
1600
900
1200
1700
1000
1400
1800
1100
1600
2000
1200
1700
2100
1400
1800
2200
1500
1900
2400
H (= In)
1600
2000
2500
Position 1
Position 2
Position 3
Position 4
10
10
10
Position 5
12
12
12
Position 6
15
15
15
Position 7
20
20
20
Position 8
24
24
24
Position 1
2x
2x
2x
Position 2
3x
3x
2x
Position 3
4x
4x
2x
Position 4
5x
5x
3x
Position 5
6x
6x
4x
Position 6
7x
7x
5x
Position 7
8x
8x
6x
Position 8
8x
8x
6x
Position 9
9x
9x
6x
Fixed
67 at10x
67 at10x
67 at10x
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
Position 3
300
300
300
Position 1
200
200
200
Position 2
400
400
400
Position 3
600
600
600
Position 4
800
800
800
Position 5
1000
1000
1000
2500 A
Ir
Position 6
1200
1200
1200
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
Position 3
300
300
300
Yes
Fixed
2.5x
2.5x
2.5x
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 50 ms for ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode is enabled remotely using a 24 Vdc circuit.
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-83
2.2
2
2
Number
of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
15.50 (393.7)
16.00 (406.4)
9.75 (247.7)
20.00 (508.0)
16.00 (406.4)
9.75 (247.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
Side View
14.50
(368.3)
2.25 (57.2)
7.25
(184.2)
0.16 R
(4.1)
8.25
(209.6)
7.75
(196.9)
5.10
(129.5)
CL
Handle
9.70
(246.4)
.44 R
(11.2)
16.00
(406.4)
Tee
Connectors
May Be
Rotated 90
15.00
(381.0)
2
2
2
4 Holes
0.44 Dia.
(11.2)
6.57
(166.9)
13.13
(333.5)
RG-Frame
2
2
Complete Breaker
Breaker
Type
Number of Poles
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
102 (46.3)
135 (61.2)
102 (46.3)
135 (61.2)
135 (61.2)
182 (82.6)
1600 Amperes
RGH, RGC
RGH, RGC
15.50
(393.7)
2000 Amperes
2500 Amperes
RGH, RGC
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-84
9.00
(228.6)
6.75
(171.5)
13.00
(330.2)
2.2
Contents
Description
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP)
Product Selection Guide and Ordering
Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-86
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-85
2.2
Continuous
Amperes
Cam
Setting
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes 2
2
2
2
2
MCP
Trip
Setting 3
MCP
Catalog
Number
0.69 0.91
HMCPE003A0C
1.11.3
15
1.61.7
21
2.02.2
27
2.32.5
30
2.6 2.8
33
1.52.0
21
2.63.1
35
3.73.9
49
4.85.2
63
5.35.7
70
5.86.1
77
3.44.5
45
5.76.8
75
8.09.1
105
10.411.4
135
15
11.512.6
150
12.713.0
165
3.99.1
90
11.513.7
150
16.118.3
210
20.722.9
270
23.025.2
300
25.326.1
330
2
2
2
2
2
30
HMCPE007C0C
HMCPE015E0C
HMCPE030H1C
Notes
1 UL listed for use with Eaton Motor Starters.
2 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 times the minimum FLA value shown.
Where a 13 times setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
3 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-86
2.2
Continuous
Amperes
50
70
100
100
Cam
Setting
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes 2
MCP
Trip
Setting 3
MCP
Catalog
Number
HMCPE050K2C
11.515.2
150
19.222.9
250
26.930.6
350
34.638.3
450
38.442.1
500
42.243.5
550
16.130.6
210
26.932.2
350
37.642.9
490
48.453.7
630
53.859.1
700
59.260.9
770
23.030.6
300
38.446.0
500
53.861.4
700
69.276.8
900
76.984.5
1000
84.687.0
1100
38.446.0
500
57.665.2
750
76.984.5
1000
1250
1375
1500
2
2
2
HMCPE070M2C
2
2
2
2
HMCPE100R3C
2
2
2
HMCPE100T3C
2
2
2
2
MCP
Trip Range
(Amperes)
MCP
Catalog
Number
5001000
HMCPJ250D5L
6251250
HMCPJ250F5L
7501500
HMCPJ250G5L
8751750
HMCPJ250J5L
10002000
HMCPJ250K5L
11252250
HMCPJ250L5L
12502500
HMCPJ250W5L
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 UL listed for use with Eaton Motor Starters.
2 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 times the minimum FLA value shown.
Where a 13 times setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
3 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
4 Settings above 10 x I are for special applications. Where the ampere rating of the disconnecting means cannot be
n
less than 115% of the motor full load ampere rating.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-87
2.2
Continuous
Amperes
MCP
Trip Range
(Amperes)
MCP
Catalog
Number
600
12502500
HMCPL600L6G
15003000
HMCPL600N6G
17503500
HMCPL600R6G
20004000
HMCPL600X6G
22504500
HMCPL600Y6G
25005000
HMCPL600P6G
30006000
HMCPL600M6G
2
2
Notes
1 UL listed for use with Eaton Motor Starters.
800 and 1200 ampere, 600 Vac maximum motor circuit protectors are available as Series C HMCP product.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-88
2.2
Contents
Description
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-90
V4-T2-91
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Application Description
Disconnecting means
Overload protection
Phase unbalance
protection
Phase loss protection
Hot trip/cold trip
High load alarm
Pre-detection trip relay
option
Class 10, 15, 20, 30
protection
IEC 60947-2
UL 489 100% rated
UL 508
CSA C22.2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-89
2.2
Product Selection
65 kAIC
Continuous Amperes
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
JGMPS050G
JGMPH050G
100
JGMPS100G
JGMPH100G
160
JGMPS160G
JGMPH160G
250
JGMPS250G
JGMPH250G
2
2
Continuous Amperes
50
20
20
25
30
32
40
45
50
100
40
45
50
63
70
80
90
100
160
63
80
90
100
110
125
150
160
250
100
125
150
160
175
200
225
250
2
2
65 kAIC
Continuous Amperes
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGMPS250G
LGMPH250G
400
LGMPS400G
LGMPH400G
600
LGMPS600G
LGMPH600G
630 1
LGMPS630G
LGMPH630G
2
2
250
100
125
150
160
175
200
225
250
400
160
200
225
250
300
315
350
400
600
250
300
315
350
400
450
500
600
630 1
250
300
315
350
400
500
600
630
2
2
Notes
1 630 amperes is not a UL listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL or CSA for LG breaker.
For pre-trip alarm option, order Style Number 5721B31G02.
For additional breaker solutions, see Page V4-T2-265.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-90
2.2
Breaker Type
Breaker Capacity (kA rms) AC 5060 Hz
IEC 60947-2
220240 Vac
380415 Vac
660690 Vac
JGMPS
JGMPH
I cu
85
100
I cs
85
100
I cu
40
70
I cs
40
70
I cu
12
14
I cs
240 Vac
85
100
480 Vac
35
65
600 Vac
25
35
Number of poles
Ampere range
50250
50 250
NEMA UL 489
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Breaker Type
Breaker Capacity (kA rms) AC 5060 Hz
IEC 60947-2
220240 Vac
380415 Vac
660690 Vac
NEMA UL 489
LGMPS
LGMPH
I cu
85
100
I cs
85
100
I cu
50
70
I cs
50
53
I cu
20
25
I cs
10
13
240 Vac
85
100
480 Vac
50
65
600 Vac
25
35
Number of poles
Ampere range
250630 1
250 630 1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 630 amperes is not a UL listed rating. 600 amperes is the maximum UL or CSA for LG breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-91
2.2
2
Contents
Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
V4-T2-93
V4-T2-94
V4-T2-96
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
2.2
Product Selection
EG-Frame
JG-Frame
2
EG-Frame Ground Fault Modules,
UL-Rated (Bottom Mounted, 120480 Vac,
50/60 Hz) 1
LG-Frame
Ampere
Rating
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
125
ELEBN3125G
400
ELLBN3400W
125
ELEBN4125G
400
ELLBN4400W
600
ELLBN3600W
600
ELLBN4600W
2
2
2
2
Ampere
Rating
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
125
ELEBE3125G
400
ELLBE3400W
125
ELEBE4125G
400
ELLBE4400W
630
ELLBE3630W
630
ELLBE4630W
2
2
2
2
2
2
Ampere
Rating
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
150
ELJBN3150W
150
ELJBN4150W
250
ELJBN3250W
250
ELJBN4250W
2
2
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
160
ELJBE3160W
160
ELJBE4160W
250
ELJBE3250W
250
ELJBE4250W
2
2
2
2
2
Note
1 Shunt trip and undervoltage release cannot be used in an EG
breaker connected to an earth leakage module.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-93
2.2
2
2
2
2
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
Assembled Breaker and Earth Leakage Module
Frame
Height
Width
Depth
Three-Pole
EG
10.25 (260.3)
3.00 (76.2)
2.98 (75.8)
JG
11.25 (285.8)
4.13 (104.9)
3.57 (90.7)
LG
15.38 (390.7)
5.48 (139.2)
4.06 (103.1)
Four-Pole
EG
10.25 (260.3)
4.00 (101.6)
2.98 (75.8)
JG
11.25 (285.8)
5.50 (139.7)
3.57 (90.7)
LG
15.38 (390.7)
7.23 (183.6)
4.06 (103.1)
2
2
2
4.75
(120.6)
0.55 (14.0)
2
2
1.49
1.00 (37.8)
(25.4)
0.50
(12.7)
3-Pole
2.98
(75.7)
1.00
(25.4)
1.50 0.50
(38.1) (12.7)
2
2
8.59
(218.2)
4.78
(121.4)
2.00
(50.8)
0.70 (17.8)
0.90 (22.9)
0.35 (8.9)
2
2
0.09
(2.29)
3.01
(76.5)
2.75
(69.9)
0.78
(19.8)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-94
3.98
(101.1)
3.17
(80.5)
2.2
4-Pole
5.50 (139.7)
3-Pole
4.13 (104.9)
0.69
2.06
1.38 (17.5)
(52.3)
(35.1)
3.92
(99.6)
2
5.50
(139.7)
1.25
(31.8)
3.57
(90.7)
3.92
(99.6)
5.50
(139.7)
1.88
(47.8)
6.97
(177.0)
4.93
(125.2)
0.28
(7.1)
11.25
(285.8)
0.63
(16.0)
R 0.19
(4.8)
7.00
(177.8)
2.05
(52.1)
11.25
(285.8)
1.06
(26.9)
0.50
(139.7)
2
TEST
3.37
(85.6)
4.25
(108.0)
RESET
2
2
2.05
(52.1)
4.09
(103.9)
3.57
3.69 (90.7)
(93.7) 3.81
(96.8)
4.78
(121.4)
3.31
(84.1)
2
2
2
8.44
(214.4)
3.44
(87.4)
1.72
(43.7)
4.06
(103.1)
3.98
(101.1)
2
2
0.86
(21.8)
5.58
(141.7)
5.58
(141.7)
4.73
(120.1)
4.31
(109.5)
5.16
(131.1)
3.44
(87.4)
1.72
(43.7)
2
2
4.73
(120.1)
2
2
8.44
(214.4)
10.13
(257.3)
2
2
15.38
(390.7)
13.69
(347.7)
3-Pole
5.48 (139.2)
4-Pole
7.22 (183.4)
4-Pole
2.75 (69.9)
3-Pole
2.74 (69.6)
13.68
(347.5)
15.38
(390.7)
2
3.97
(100.8)
4.30
(109.2)
4.55
(115.6)
5.43
(137.9)
4-Pole
7.22 (183.4)
3-Pole
5.48 (139.2)
4-Pole
2.75 (69.9)
3-Pole
2.74 (69.6)
2
2
2
V4-T2-95
2.2
2
Contents
Description
Page
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-97
V4-T2-98
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
Product Overview
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Application Description
High-performance breakers
are most commonly applied
when very high fault levels
are available and with
applications where the
current limiting capability is
used upstream of the final
load to limit current. Typical
loads include lighting, power
distribution, and motor
control applications.
2
2
2
V4-T2-96
IEC 60947-2
UL 489
CSA C22.2
2.2
Product Selection
2
2
Product
Amperes
480 Vac
(UL)
600 Vac
(UL)
15125
100
35 1
1
Icu
Ics
100
100
With limiter
15100
150
100
150
150
70250
200
50
200
200
18
14
JG 3P electronic
With limiter
70225
200
200
200
150
70
18
Breaker only
20250
200
50
200
200
18
14
With limiter
100250
200
200
200
150
70
18
250600
200
65
200
200
35
18
LG3P electronic
100600
200
65
200
200
35
18
Breaker only
Icu
2
2
2
2
2
2
EG-Frame
UL Listed
(NEMA/IEC Rated)
Base Molded Case
Circuit Breaker
Breaker with
Line Side Mounted
Current Limiter
Breaker with
Load Side Mounted
Current Limiter
Interphase Barrier
Included for Limiter
EGC3015FFG
EGC3015FFGQ01
EGC3015FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3016FFG
EGC3016FFGQ01
EGC3016FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3020FFG
EGC3020FFGQ01
EGC3020FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3025FFG
EGC3025FFGQ01
EGC3025FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3030FFG
EGC3030FFGQ01
EGC3030FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3032FFG
EGC3032FFGQ01
EGC3032FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3035FFG
EGC3035FFGQ01
EGC3035FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3040FFG
EGC3040FFGQ01
EGC3040FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3045FFG
EGC3045FFGQ01
EGC3045FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3050FFG
EGC3050FFGQ01
EGC3050FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3060FFG
EGC3060FFGQ01
EGC3060FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3063FFG
EGC3063FFGQ01
EGC3063FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3070FFG
EGC3070FFGQ01
EGC3070FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3080FFG
EGC3080FFGQ01
EGC3080FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3090FFG
EGC3090FFGQ01
EGC3090FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
EGC3100FFG
EGC3100FFGQ01
EGC3100FFGQ02
T125EF
EIPBSK
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 600Y/347V.
2 Two interphase barriers included on line end mounted limiter; (2) line end of limiter. Four interphase barriers included on load end mounted limiter; (2) line end of breaker
(2) load end of limiter.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-97
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
Height
Width
Depth
EG
9.66 (245.7)
3.00 (76.2)
2.98 (75.8)
2.91 (1.32)
HMCP
9.66 (245.7)
3.00 (76.2)
2.98 (75.8)
4.18 (1.90)
2
2
0.56
(14.2)
2
2
2
2
2
1.00
(25.4)
3.00
(76.2)
9.66
(245.4)
4.17
(105.9)
3.61
(91.7)
0.50
1.00 (12.7)
(25.4)
1.00
(25.4)
3.20
(81.3)
4.17
(105.9)
2
2
2
2.75 0.09
(69.9) (2.3)
2
0.78
(19.8)
2
2
0.41
(10.4)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-98
2.2
JG Frame
Magnetic
Range
2
2
2
70
350700
JGH3070FAGQ01
JGH3070FAGQ02
90
450900
JGH3090FAGQ01
JGH3090FAGQ02
100
5001000
JGH3100FAGQ01
JGH3100FAGQ02
JGH3100AAGQ01
JGH3100AAGQ02
125
6251250
JGH3125FAGQ01
JGH3125FAGQ02
JGH3125AAGQ01
JGH3125AAGQ02
150
7501550
JGH3150FAGQ01
JGH3150FAGQ02
160
8001600
JGH3160AAGQ01
JGH3160AAGQ02
175
8751750
JGH3175FAGQ01
JGH3175FAGQ02
200
10002000
JGH3200FAGQ01
JGH3200FAGQ02
JGH3200AAGQ01
JGH3200AAGQ02
225
11252250
JGH3225FAGQ01
JGH3225FAGQ02
JGH325033GQ02
JGH325032GQ02
JGH325035GQ02
JGH325036GQ02
2
2
2
2
Electronic Trip LS
250
250
250
250
JGH325033GQ01
Electronic Trip LSI
JGH325032GQ01
Series G HMCP
Ampere
Rating
250
HMCPJ250D5LQ01
HMCPJ250D5LQ02
250
HMCPJ250F5LQ01
HMCPJ250F5LQ02
250
HMCPJ250G5LQ01
HMCPJ250G5LQ02
250
HMCPJ250J5LQ01
HMCPJ250J5LQ02
250
HMCPJ250K5LQ01
HMCPJ250K5LQ02
250
HMCPJ250L5LQ01
HMCPJ250L5LQ02
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
AWG Wire
Range/ Number
of Conductors
Catalog
Number
Cu/Al
10185
#8350 (1)
TA250FJ 3
2
2
Aluminum
Notes
1 Two interphase barriers provided, mounted on line end of limiter, catalog number FJIPBK.
2 Four interphase barriers provided, (2) line end of breaker, (2) load end of limiter.
3 Line and load terminals included with products listed above.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-99
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
Height
Width
Depth
JG + limiter
13.06 (331.7)
4.13 (104.9)
3.44 (87.4)
9.87 (4.48)
HMCP
13.06 (331.7)
4.13 (104.9)
3.44 (87.4)
9.87 (4.48)
2
2
2
4.13
(104.9)
4.12
(104.6)
2
2
2
2
13.06
(331.7)
2
2
4.41
(112.0)
2
2
3.34
(84.8)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-100
3.44
(87.4)
2.2
Contents
Description
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-102
V4-T2-103
V4-T2-103
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-101
2.2
Product Selection
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Proven Technology
and Performance
The LHH is based on the
Series G L-Frame circuit
breaker, sharing the same
small footprint and field-fit
accessories as the L-Frame
breaker. The NHH is based
on the Series G N-Frame
circuit breaker and shares
the same footprint and
accessories as the N-Frame
breaker. NHH accessories
must be factory installed.
The LHH incorporates a
thermal-magnetic trip unit
with fixed thermal and
fixed magnetic settings.
The NHH has an OPTIM
electronic trip unit with
LSI adjustment capabilities.
The instantaneous setting is
adjustable from 10004000 A
or may be turned off to
default to the frame override
of 14,000 A. A hand-held
OPTIMizer must be used
with the NHH to adjust
short-time delay and
instantaneous, however,
the long delay pickup is fixed
and cannot be adjusted.
LHH
LSI Electronic
Trip Unit
Ampere
Rating
LHH Frame
NHH Frame
125
LHH3125FFG
150
LHH3150FFG
NHH3150T52X15
175
LHH3175FFG
NHH3175T52X15
200
LHH3200FFG
NHH3200T52X15
225
LHH3225FFG
NHH3225T52X15
250
LHH3250FFG
NHH3250T52X15
300
LHH3300FFG
NHH3300T52X15
350
LHH3350FFG
NHH3350T52X15
400
LHH3400FFG
UL
CSA
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-102
2.2
Dimensions
Three-pole
65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125400 ampere LHH
150350 ampere NHH
Trip units:
LHHthermal-magnetic
NHHLSI electronic trip unit
No rating plugs required
Factory-sealed breakers
LHH uses same internal and external accessories
as standard Series G L-Frame circuit breaker
NHH uses same internal and external accessories
as standard Series G N-Frame circuit breaker
Dimensions
Description
Height
Width
5.48 (139.2)
4.09 (103.9)
12.36 (5.6)
16.00 (406.4)
8.25 (209.5)
5.50 (139.7)
46.80 (21.2)
R 0.25
(6.4)
CL
4.06
(103.1)
Breaker
3.16
(80.3)
5.58
(141.7)
400
350
2
2
10.13
(257.3)
1.92
(48.8)
2.69
(68.3)
5.48
(139.2)
5.38
(136.7)
Three-Pole
N-Frame
NEMA UL 489
240 Vac
100
100
480 Vac
65
65
600 Vac
35
35
250 Vac
42
220 Vac
100
100
415 Vac
70
70
690 Vac
25
25
125/250 Vdc
22
Number of poles
Ampere range
125400 A
150350 A
IEC 60947-2
6.38
(162.1)
3.68
(93.5)
3.19
(81.0)
2
2
2.43 (61.7)
Breaker Type
10.13 (257.3)
NHH
LHH
2.00
(50.8)
LHH
Weight in
Lbs (kg)
L-Frame
Description
Depth
Side View
2
2
2
9.25
(235.0)
16.00
(406.4)
2
2
8.25
(209.6)
5.50
(139.7)
2
2
2
Magnetic
Trip Point
Continuous
Current
Multiplier
Instantaneous
Trip Point
Continuous
Current
Multiplier
Short Delay
Pickup
125 A
2500 A
20x
150 A
2500 A
16x
14,000 A
93x
2251200 A
175 A
4000 A
22x
14,000 A
80x
2601400 A
200 A
4000 A
20x
14,000 A
70x
3001600 A
225 A
6000 A
26x
14,000 A
62x
3381800 A
250 A
6000 A
24x
14,000 A
56x
3752000 A
300 A
6000 A
20x
14,000 A
47x
4502400 A
350 A
6000 A
17x
14,000 A
40x
5252800 A
400 A
6000 A
15x
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-103
2.2
Contents
Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-106
V4-T2-107
V4-T2-109
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
Thermal-magnetic trip
breakers
Electronic rms trip
breakers
Molded case switches
Motor circuit protectors
Current limiting breakers
Special application
breakers
Modified Breakers
Eaton breakers can be ordered
with internal accessories
installed. These modified
breakers will be subject to an
addition charge.
Special Calibration
Special non-UL listed
calibrations are available for
certain ambient temperatures
other than 40 C and for
frequencies other than
50/60 Hz or DC. Reduced
interrupting ratings will apply
for 400 Hz applications.
50 C Calibration
Note: Breakers equipped with
electronic trip units can operate
reliably in ambient temperatures
of 50 C. Add suffix V3 to NG
MCCBs to remove standard
40 C labeling.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-104
EG JG LG NG RG
Special
calibration
Moisturefungus
treatment
2.2
Marine Applications
E- to R-Framed circuit
breakers can be supplied to
meet the following marine
specifications:
These specifications
generally require molded
case circuit breakers to be
supplied with 50 C ambient,
and plug-in adapter kits.
When plug-in adapter kits are
used, no terminals need be
supplied (switchboard
applications).
Circuit breakers can also be
supplied to meet UL 489
Supplement SA (Marine use)
and UL 489 Supplement SB
(Naval Use).
UL 489 Supplement SA
applies to vessels over 65 feet
(19.8m) in length.
Requirements include 40 C
ambient calibration, special
labeling, and no use of
aluminum conductors or
terminals. (No 50 C.)
UL 489 Supplement SB
requires partial 50 C ambient
calibration, vibration testing,
special nameplating and no
use of aluminum conductors
or terminals. Eaton chooses
to always fully calibrate to 50
C ambient. (Naval labeled
per UL but no UL mark due
to 50 C label.)
Underwriters Laboratories
Inc., Standard UL 489,
molded case circuit
breakers and circuit
breaker enclosures
National Electrical
Manufacturers Association
(NEMA) Standards
Publication No. AB1-1993,
molded case circuit
breakers
Australian Standard AS
2184, molded case circuit
breakers
British Standards Institution
Standard BS 4752: Part 1,
switchgear and control
gear Part 1: circuit breakers
Canadian Standards
Association (CSA) Standard
C22.2 No. 5, service
entrance and branch circuit
breakers
International
Electrotechnical
Commission
Recommendations IEC
60947-2, circuit breakers
Japanese T-Mark Standard
molded case circuit
breakers
South African Bureau of
Standards, Standard SABS
156, Standard Specification
for molded case circuit
breakers
Swiss Electro-Technical
Association Standard SEV
157-1, safety regulations
for circuit breakers
Union Technique de
lElectricite Standard NF C
63-120, low voltage
switchgear and control gear
circuit breaker
requirements
Verband Deutscher
Elektrotechniker
(Association of German
Electrical Engineers)
Standard VDE 0660, low
voltage switchgear and
control gear, circuit
breakers
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-105
2.2
Internal Accessories
Alarm Lockout
The alarm switches operate
when the circuit breaker is
tripped by a short circuit or
overcurrent, but also when it
is tripped by a shunt trip or
undervoltage release.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Auxiliary Switches
Auxiliary switches are used
for signaling and control
purposes. The various
functions of the auxiliary
switches (changeover) are
shown on Page V4-T2-108.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
TRIP-LED
2
2
V4-T2-106
Wire Seal
The wire seal can be used to
secure the cover of the trip
unit to prevent adjustments
after settings are confirmed.
Wire Seal
Catalog
Number
5108A03H01
2.2
External Accessories
Description
Fit
Type
Frame
EG
JG
LG
NG
RG
Field
EFHB
LKD4
Field
EFPHB
Field
EFPHBOFF
FJPHBOFF
LBHPOFF
Field
EFPLK
FJPHL
LPHL
PLK5
HLK6
Field
EFPHLOFF
FJPHLOFF
LPHLOFF
PLK55OFF
HLK6OFF
Field
KYKJG
KYKLG
KYK4
KYK6
Field
CTKJG
CTKLG
CTK4
CTK6
Field
EFSBI
FJSBI
LGSBI
SBK5
Three-pole
EG3WBI
JG3WBI
LG3WBI
WBL5
WBL6
Four-pole
EG4WBI
JG4WBI
LG4WBI
WBL5
120 Vac
MOPEG240C
MOPJG120C
MOPLG120C
EOP5T07
EOP6T08K
240 Vac
MOPEG240C
MOPJG240C
MOPLG240C
EOP5T11
EOP6T11K
24 Vdc
MOPEG48D
MOPJG24D
MOPLG24D
EOP5T21
48 Vdc
MOPEG48D
EOP5T22
EOP6T21K
125 Vdc
MOPEG120C
MOPJG120C
MOPLG120C
EOP5T26
220 Vdc
MOPJG240C
MOPLG240C
250 Vdc
MOPJG240C
MOPLG240C
Three-pole
PAD3E
PAD3J
PAD3L
PAD53
Four-pole
PAD4E
PAD4J
PAD4L
Field
EFRCSDL
FJRCSDL
LRCS3WK (3P)
EFRCSDS
FJRCSDS
LRCS4WK (4P)
EFRCSWL
FJRCSWL
EFRCSWS
FJRCSWS
Electrical operator 5
Plug-in adapters
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Provision only.
2 See Page V4-T2-314 for bolt projection dimensions.
3 Castell bolt mounting hole must be 10 mm.
4 Requires two breakers.
5 Contact Eaton for availability of operators for EG- and NG-Frames before December 2004.
6 D = Imperial threads UL, W = metric threads IEC, L = long studs, S = short studs.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-107
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-108
2.2
Accessories
Alarm Lockout
Description
Make/Break
2 Make/2 Break
Pole
Location
Frame
EG, JG and LG
NG
RG 1
Left
A1L5LPK
Right
ALM1M1BEPK 2
A1L5RPK
A1L6RPK
Left
A2L5LPK
Right
ALM2M2BEPK 3
A2L5RPK
A2L6RPK
EG, JG and LG
NG
RG 1
2
2
2
Auxiliary Switch
Description
1A, 1B
2A, 2B
3A, 3B
4A, 4B
Pole
Location
Frame
Left
A1X5PK
Right
AUX1A1BPK
A1X5PK
Left
A2X5PK
Right
AUX2A2BPK
A2X5PK
A2X6RPK
Left
A3X5LPK
Right
A3X5RPK
Left
Right
A4X6RPK
2
2
2
2
2
2
Shunt TripStandard
ST
Frame
Description
Pole
Location
EG, JG and LG
NG
RG 1
Left
AA115LPK
Right
AUXALRMEPK 4
AA115RPK
2
2
2
Shunt TripStandard
Frame
Description
Pole
Location
EG, JG and LG 5
NG
RG 1
4860 Vac
Left
SNT060CPK
SNT5LP05K
Right
SNT6P05K
110240 Vac
Left
SNT120CPK
SNT5LP11K
Right
SNT6P11K
Left
SNT480CPK 6
Right
SNT5LP14K
SNT6P14K
480600 Vac
SNT5LP18K
SNT6P18K
380600 Vac
12 Vdc
24 Vac/dc
4860 Vdc
110125 Vdc
250 Vdc
Left
SNT012CPK
Right
Left
SNT060CPK
SNT5LP03K
Right
SNT6P03K
Left
SNT060CPK
SNT5LP23K
Right
SNT6P23K
Left
SNT125DPK
SNT5LP26K
Right
SNT6P26K
Left
SNT250DPK
Right
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 All accessories mount in the RH cavity which will accept one each of shunt trip, UVR, auxiliary switch and alarm switch.
2 Part number for JG and LG is ALM1M1BJPK.
3 Part number for JG and LG is ALM2M2BJPK.
4 Part number for JG and LG is AUXALRMJPK.
5 LH cavity not available for EG frame with earth leakage module.
6 380600 Vdc, 50/60 Hz.
2
2
2
V4-T2-109
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Description
Frame
RG 1
EG, JG and LG
NG
Left
LST5LPK
Right
LST6RPK
RG 1
Frame
Description
Pole
Location
EG, JG and LG 3
NG
110127 Vac
Left
UVR120APK
UVH5LP08K
Right
UVH6RP08K
208240 Vac
24 Vdc
24 Vac
4860 Vac
120 Vdc
220250 Vdc
380500 Vac
525600 Vac
12 Vdc
12 Vac
Pole
Location
4860 Vdc
Series G
Left
UVR240APK
UVH5LP11K
Right
UVH6RP11K
Left
UVR024DPK
UVH5LP21K 2
Right
UVH6RP21K 2
Left
UVR024APK
UVH5LP21K 2
Right
UVH6RP21K 2
Left
UVR048DPK
UVH5LP23K
Right
UVH6RP23K
Left
UVR048APK
UVH5LP05K
Right
UVH6RP05K
Left
UVR125DPK
UVH5LP26K
Right
UVH6RP26K
Left
UVR250DPK
UVH5LP28K
Right
UVH6RP28K
Left
UVR480APK
UVH5LP29K
Right
UVH6RP29K
Left
UVR600APK
Right
Left
UVH5LP20K
Right
UVH6RP20K
Left
UVH5LP02K
Right
UVH6RP02K
Notes
1 All accessories mount in the RH cavity which will accept one each of shunt trip, UVR, auxiliary switch and alarm switch.
2 24 Vdc only use UVH5LP03K (NG) UVH6RP03K (RG) for 24 Vac.
3 LH cavity not available for EG frame with earth leakage module.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-110
2.2
Contents
Description
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators
Features, Benefits and Functions . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-112
V4-T2-112
V4-T2-112
V4-T2-113
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Motor Operators
Product Description
Eatons motor operator
mechanism enables local and
remote ON, OFF and reset
switching of a circuit breaker.
The motor operator is
mounted on the circuit
breaker cover within
the dimensions of the
circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-111
2.2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Series G
2
2
Product Selection
A key is provided to
manually operate the
circuit breaker
A special pull-out locking
mechanism provides a
method for padlocking the
circuit breaker handle in
the OFF position
The locking device will
accept three padlock
shackles with a maximum
diameter of 1/4-inch
(6.4 mm) each
The cover provides visual
status of the circuit
breaker: ON, OFF or
TRIPPED. A PUSH-TO-TRIP
button allows the user to
manually trip the breaker
Motor Operators
Frame
Voltage
Frequency
Series G E-Frame
100240 Vac
50/60 Hz
1A
MOPEG240C
Series C F-Frame
Series G J-Frame
Series G L-Frame
2
Circuit Breaker
Status Indication
Window
2
2
2
PUSH-TO-TRIP Button
2
2
2
2
2
DC
1A
MOPEG240C
24/48 Vdc
DC
3A
MOPEG48D
208240 Vac
50/60 Hz
1A
MOPFD240C
110127 Vac
50/60 Hz
1A
MOPFD120C
220250 Vdc
DC
1A
MOPFD240C
110125 Vdc
DC
1A
MOPFD120C
24 Vdc
DC
3A
MOPFD24D
208240 Vac
50/60 Hz
1A
MOPJG240C
110127 Vac
50/60 Hz
1A
MOPJG120C
220250 Vdc
DC
1A
MOPJG240C
110125 Vdc
DC
1A
MOPJG120C
24 Vdc
DC
3A
MOPJG24D
208240 Vac
50/60 Hz
2A
MOPLG240C
110127 Vac
50/60 Hz
2A
MOPLG120C
220250 Vdc
DC
2A
MOPLG240C
110125 Vdc
DC
2A
MOPLG120C
24 Vdc
DC
6A
MOPLG24D
2
2
100220 Vdc
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-112
2.2
Contents
Description
EG-Frame (15125 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
JG-Frame (63250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
LG-Frame (250630 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
NG-Frame (3201200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
RG-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protector Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
30 mA Ground Fault (Earth Leakage) Module . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . .
High Instantaneous Circuit Breaker for
Selective Coordination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Special Features and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Operators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Plug-In Blocks
Drawout Cassette . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-114
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Plug-In Blocks
Product Description
Plug-in adapters simplify
installation and front removal
of circuit breakers. Plug-ins
are available for rear
connection applications on
three- and four-pole circuit
breakers. Trip on drawout
interlock kits are included.
Stabs for EG, JG and LG plugins rotate 90 for flexible
installation. Use terminal
shields for IP30 protection.
Product Selection
Plug-In Blocks
Breaker
Frame
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
PAD3E
EG
PAD4E
JG
PAD3J
JG
PAD4J
LG
PAD3L
LG
PAD4L
2
2
2
2
3, 4
PIILEG
JG
3, 4
PIILJG
LG
3, 4
PIILLG
EG
EFTS3K
EG
EFTS4K
JG
FJTS3K
JG
FJTS4K
LG
LTS3K
LG
LTS4K
EG
3, 4
PADILE
JG
3, 4
PADILJ
LG
3, 4
PADILL
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Position Switch
2
2
Note
1 Included with plug-in block. Trips the breaker when breaker is removed from plug-in block.
2
2
2
V4-T2-113
2.2
2
Contents
Drawout Cassettes
Description
Page
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-15
V4-T2-29
V4-T2-47
V4-T2-65
V4-T2-74
V4-T2-85
V4-T2-89
V4-T2-92
V4-T2-96
V4-T2-101
V4-T2-104
V4-T2-111
V4-T2-113
2
2
2
Drawout Cassette
Product Description
Features
2
2
2
2
2
2
Trip on drawoutbreaker
will trip if it is in the ON
position when withdrawn
from the cassette
Secondary terminal block
the drawout cassettes
include a secondary
terminal block for easier
access when wiring low
voltage accessories,
including shunts and
undervoltage releases
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
JG Drawout Cassette
LG Drawout Cassette
Connectedthe breaker is
fully connected to the
primary stabs and
secondary contacts
Disconnectedboth the
primary stabs and the
secondary contacts are
disconnected
Withdrawthe breaker
can be removed from the
cassette
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-114
Number
of Poles
Catalog
Number
JG
JG3DOM
JG4DOM
LG3DOM
LG4DOM
NG3DOM
NG4DOM
LG
NG
2.3
Contents
Description
Page
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Overview
Eatons molded case circuit
breakers are designed to
provide circuit protection for
low voltage distribution
systems. They are described
by NEMA as, ... a device for
closing and interrupting a
circuit between separable
contacts under both normal
and abnormal conditions,
and furthermore as, ... a
breaker assembled as an
integral unit in a supporting
and enclosing housing of
insulating material. The
National Electrical Code
(NEC) describes them as, A
device designed to open and
close a circuit by nonautomatic means, and to
open the circuit automatically
on a predetermined overload
of current, without injury to
itself when properly applied
within its rating.
Thermal-magnetic trip
breakers
Electronic rms trip
breakers
Molded case switches
Motor circuit protectors
Current limiting breakers
Special application
breakers
Modified Breakers
Eaton breakers can be ordered
with internal accessories
installed. These modified
breakers will be subject to an
addition charge.
Special Calibration
Special non-UL-listed
calibrations are available for
certain ambient temperatures
other than 40 C and for
frequencies other than 50/60
Hz or DC. Reduced
interrupting ratings will apply
for 400 Hz applications.
50 C Calibration
Add suffix V to catalog
Number for complete
breaker, listed above, when
ordering listed ampere ratings
for breakers to be used in 50
C ambients. (No price
adder.) (No UL label.)
Moisture-Fungus Treatment
All circuit breaker cases are
molded from glass-polyester
which does not support the
growth of fungus. Any parts
which are susceptible to the
growth of fungus will require
special treatment.
Freeze-Tested Circuit
Breakers
The circuit breakers may be
ordered with freeze testing.
This option uses special
lubrication and mechanical
operation is verified at 40 C.
Marine Applications
E- to R-Framed circuit
breakers can be supplied to
meet the following marine
specifications:
These specifications
generally require molded
case circuit breakers to be
supplied with 50 C ambient,
and plug-in adapter kits.
When plug-in adapter kits are
used, no terminals need be
supplied (switchboard
applications).
Circuit breakers can also be
supplied to meet UL 489
Supplement SA (Marine use)
and UL 489 Supplement SB
(Naval Use).
UL 489 Supplement SA
applies to vessels over 65 feet
(19.8 m) in length.
Requirements include 40 C
ambient calibration, special
labeling, and no use of
aluminum conductors or
terminals. (No 50 C.)
Suffix H08
Suffix VH08
UL 489 Supplement SB
requires partial 50 C ambient
calibration, vibration testing,
special nameplating and no
use of aluminum conductors
or terminals. Eaton chooses
to always fully calibrate to 50
C ambient. (Naval labeled
per UL, and UL now allows
50 C label here.)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Suffix VH09
V4-T2-115
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Underwriters Laboratories
Inc., Standard UL 489,
molded case circuit
breakers and circuit
breaker enclosures
National Electrical
Manufacturers Association
(NEMA) Standards
Publication No. AB1-1993,
molded case circuit
breakers
Australian Standard AS
2184, molded case circuit
breakers
British Standards Institution
Standard BS 4752: Part 1,
switchgear and control
gear Part 1: circuit breakers
Canadian Standards
Association (CSA) Standard
C22.2 No. 5, service
entrance and branch circuit
breakers
International
Electrotechnical
Commission
Recommendations IEC
60947-2, circuit breakers
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-116
2.3
Quick Reference
2
2
G-Frame
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
No. of
Poles
AC
GHB
15100 3
120
Volts
DC
Type
of Trip 1
Federal
Specification
W-C-375b
120
120/240
240
277
480
600
125
250
Page
Number
125
N.I.T.U.
11a
65
14
V4-T2-125
DC (kA) 2
AC (kA)
GHB
15100
2, 3
240
125/250
N.I.T.U.
11a10b, 11b
65
14
V4-T2-125
GHB
15100
277
125
N.I.T.U.
12b, 14b
14
14
V4-T2-125
GHB
15100
2, 3
480Y/277
125/250
N.I.T.U.
15b
14
14
14
V4-T2-125
HGHB
1530
277
125
N.I.T.U.
65
25
14
V4-T2-125
GHQ
1520
277
N.I.T.U.
65
14
V4-T2-125
GHBS
1530
1, 2
480Y/277
65
65
14
V4-T1-34
GBHS
1520
1, 2
600Y/347
N.I.T.U.
10
V4-T1-34
GDB
1550
480
125/250
N.I.T.U.
14
10
V4-T2-123
GDB
15100
480
250
N.I.T.U.
14
10
V4-T2-123
GD
1550
480
125/250
N.I.T.U.
13b
65
14
10
V4-T2-122
GD
15100
480
250
N.I.T.U.
13b
65
22
10
V4-T2-122
GHC
15100
120
125
N.I.T.U.
12c, 13a
65
14
V4-T2-130
GHC
15100
2, 3
240
125/250
N.I.T.U.
13b
65
V4-T2-130
GHC
15100
277
125
N.I.T.U.
12c, 13a
14
14
V4-T2-130
GHC
15100
2, 3
480Y/277
125/250
N.I.T.U.
13b
14
14
14
V4-T2-130
HGHC
1530
277
125
N.I.T.U.
65
25
14
V4-T2-130
Notes
1 N.I.T.U. is non-interchangeable trip unit and I.T.U. is interchangeable trip unit.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker at 250 Vdc.
3 Maximum 70 A for 124 Vdc rating.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-117
2.3
F-Frame
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
No. of
Poles
AC
EDB
100225
2, 3
EDS
100225
2, 3
ED
15225
EDH
Volts
DC
Type
of Trip 1
Federal
Specification
W-C-375b
120
120/240
240
277
480
600
125
250
Page
Number
240
125
N.I.T.U.
22
10
V4-T2-134
240
125
N.I.T.U.
42
10
V4-T2-134
2, 3
240
125
N.I.T.U.
12b
65
10
V4-T2-134
100225
2, 3
240
125
N.I.T.U.
14b
100
10
V4-T2-134
EDC
100225
2, 3
240
125
N.I.T.U.
200
10
V4-T2-134
EHD
15100
277
125
N.I.T.U.
13a
14
10
V4-T2-134
EHD
15100
2, 3
480
250
N.I.T.U.
13b
18
14
10
V4-T2-134
FDB
15150
2, 3
600
250
N.I.T.U.
18a
18
14
14
10
V4-T2-134
FDB
15150
600
250
N.I.T.U.
18
14
14
10
V4-T2-134
FD
15150
277
125
N.I.T.U.
13a
35
10
V4-T2-134
FD
15225
2, 3
600
250
N.I.T.U.
22a
65
35
18
10
V4-T2-134
FD
15225
600
250
N.I.T.U.
65
35
18
10
V4-T2-134
FDE
15225
600
N.I.T.U.
65
35
18
V4-T2-134
HFD
15150
277
125
N.I.T.U.
13a
65
10
V4-T2-134
HFD
15225
2,3
600
250
N.I.T.U.
22a
100
65
25
22
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-134
DC (kA) 2
AC (kA)
HFD
15225
600
250
N.I.T.U.
100
65
25
22
HFDE
15225
600
N.I.T.U.
100
65
25
V4-T2-134
FDC 4
15225
2, 3
600
250
N.I.T.U.
24a
200
100
35
22
V4-T2-134
FDC 4
15225
600
250
N.I.T.U.
200
100
35
22
V4-T2-134
FDCE 45
15225
600
N.I.T.U.
200
100
25
V4-T2-134
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 N.I.T.U. is non-interchangeable trip unit and I.T.U. is interchangeable trip unit.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker at 250 Vdc.
3 Not defined in W-C-375b.
4 Current limiting.
5 Check with Eaton for availability.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-118
2.3
J-Frame
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
No. of
Poles
AC
Volts
DC
Type
of
Trip 1
Federal
Specification
W-C-375b
AC (kA)
120
120/240
240
277
480
600
DC (kA)
125
250
Page
Number
JDB
70250
2, 3
600
250
N.I.T.U.
22a
65
35
18
10
V4-T2-154
JD
70250
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
22a
65
35
18
10
V4-T2-153
70250
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
22a
100
65
25
22
V4-T2-153
70250
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
22a
200
100
35
22
V4-T2-153
HJD
JDC
2
2
2
2
2
K-Frame
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
No. of
Poles
AC
DK
250400
2, 3
KDB
100400
KD
Volts
DC
Type
of
Trip 1
Federal
Specification
W-C-375b
120
120/240
240
277
480
600
125
240
250
N.I.T.U.
14b
65
2, 3
600
250
N.I.T.U.
23a
65
35
100400
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
65
CKD
100400
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
65
HKD
100400
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
CHKD
100400
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
KDC 3
100400
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
DC (kA) 2
AC (kA)
250
Page
Number
10
V4-T2-165
25
10
V4-T2-165
35
25
10
V4-T2-162, V4-T2-163,
V4-T2-167, V4-T2-170
35
25
V4-T2-164, V4-T2-173,
V4-T2-175
100
65
35
22
V4-T2-162, V4-T2-163,
V4-T2-167, V4-T2-170
100
65
35
V4-T2-164, V4-T2-173,
V4-T2-175
200
100
65
22
V4-T2-162, V4-T2-163,
V4-T2-167, V4-T2-170
2
2
2
L-Frame
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
No. of
Poles
AC
LDB
300600
2, 3
LD
300600
CLD
Volts
DC
Type
of
Trip 1
Federal
Specification
W-C-375b
120
120/240
240
277
480
600
125
250
Page
Number
600
250
N.I.T.U.
23a
65
35
25
22
V4-T2-188
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
65
35
25
22
V4-T2-186, V4-T2-187,
V4-T2-192
300600
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
65
35
25
V4-T2-188, V4-T2-198
HLD
300600
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
100
65
35
25
V4-T2-186, V4-T2-187,
V4-T2-192
CHLD
300600
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
100
65
35
V4-T2-188, V4-T2-198
LDC 3
300600
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
200
100
50
30
V4-T2-186, V4-T2-187,
V4-T2-194
CLDC 3
300600
2, 3, 4
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
200
100
50
30
V4-T2-188, V4-T2-200
DC (kA) 2
AC (kA)
2
2
2
M-Frame
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
No. of
Poles
AC
MDL
300800
2, 3
CMDL
300800
2, 3
HMDL
300800
CHMDL
300800
Volts
DC
Type
of
Trip 1
Federal
Specification
W-C-375b
120
120/240
240
277
480
600
125
250
Page
Number
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
65
50
25
22
V4-T2-211, V4-T2-213
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
65
50
25
V4-T2-213
2, 3
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
100
65
35
25
V4-T2-211, V4-T2-213
2, 3
600
250
I.T.U.
23a
100
65
35
V4-T2-213
DC (kA) 2
AC (kA)
2
2
Notes
1 N.I.T.U. is non-interchangeable trip unit and I.T.U. is interchangeable trip unit.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker at 250 Vdc.
3 Current limiting.
2
2
V4-T2-119
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-120
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-121
V4-T2-121
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
2
2
Circuit Breaker/Frame
GD 3 100 K
Circuit Breaker Type
GD
HGHB
GDB
HGHC
GHB
GHBGFEP
GHC
GHCGFEP
GHQ
2
Suffix
Number of Poles
1 = 1 pole
2 = 2 poles
3 = 3 poles
Trip Amperes
035
040
045
050
060
015
020
024
030
K
D
C
V
070
080
090
100
2
2
2
2
2
Volts DC
Circuit
Breaker Type
Number
of Poles
GDB
2, 3
14
10
GD
65
14
10
GD
65
22
10
GHQ
65
14
GHB
65
14
14
GHB
2, 3
65
14
14
HGHB
65
25
14
GHC
65
14
14
GHC
2, 3
65
14
14
HGHC
65
25
14
120
240
277
480
480Y/277
125
250 23
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal Types
For line and load-side. Terminals are UL listed as suitable for wire type and size given below.
2
2
Terminal Types
Terminal Type Material
Wire Type
1520
Slotted
Cu/Al
1410
2.54
25100
Slotted
Cu/Al
101/0
450
Slotted
Cu
143
Standard
OptionalGD Only
15100
Notes
1 HID suffix only applies to the GHB and GHC single-pole, 1520 A circuit breakers.
2 Time constant is 8 milliseconds minimum.
3 Two poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
4 Not UL listed sizes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-121
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Type GD Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip Units (15100 Amperes)
Product Description
2
2
UL/CSA
Product Selection
2
2
Includes Binding
Head Screws and Clamps
1032 x 0.312
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Three-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
GD2015
GD3015
GD3015D
20
GD2020
GD3020
GD3020D
25
GD2025
GD3025
GD3025D
30
GD2030
GD3030
GD3030D
35
GD2035
GD3035
GD3035D
40
GD2040
GD3040
GD3040D
45
GD2045
GD3045
GD3045D
50
GD2050
GD3050
GD3050D
60
GD3060
GD3060D
70
GD3070
GD3070D
80
GD3080
GD3080D
90
GD3090
GD3090D
100
GD3100
GD3100D
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-122
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
Three-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
GDB2015
GDB3015
20
GDB2020
GDB3020
25
GDB2025
GDB3025
30
GDB2030
GDB3030
35
GDB2035
GDB3035
40
GDB2040
GDB3040
45
GDB2045
GDB3045
50
GDB2050
GDB3050
60
GDB3060
70
GDB3070
80
GDB3080
90
GDB3090
100
GDB3100
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Catalog Number
(Includes Line and Load Terminals)
60
GD3060K
60
GD3060KC 1
100
GD3100K
100
GD3100KD 2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Includes line and load steel terminals.
2 Includes binding head screws and clamps 1032 x 0.312.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-123
2.3
2
2
2
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
GD-Frame, Three-Pole
Front View
Side View
2
2
2
2
2
4.88
(123.8)
Off
2
2
2
2
3.00
(76.2)
2.63
(66.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-124
Typical GHB
2.3
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Types GHB and HGHB Bolt-On Panelboard Circuit Breakers (15100 Amperes)
2
2
Two-, three-pole:
Classes 10b, 11b, 12b,
14b, 15b
UL/CSA
Single-pole:
Classes 12c, 13a
Two-, three-pole:
Class 13b
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-125
2.3
2
2
Product Selection
Typical GHB
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
GHB1015 45
GHB2015 4
GHB3015 4
20
GHB1020 45
GHB2020 4
GHB3020 4
25
GHB1025
GHB2025
GHB3025
30
GHB1030
GHB2030
GHB3030
35
GHB1035
GHB2035
GHB3035
40
GHB1040
GHB2040
GHB3040
45
GHB1045
GHB2045
GHB3045
50
GHB1050
GHB2050
GHB3050
60
GHB1060
GHB2060
GHB3060
70
GHB1070
GHB2070
GHB3070
80
GHB1080
GHB2080
GHB3080
90
GHB1090
GHB2090
GHB3090
100
GHB1100
GHB2100
GHB3100
2
2
2
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Single-Pole
15
HGHB1015 6
20
HGHB1020 6
25
HGHB1025
30
HGHB1030
Catalog
Number
2
2
2
2
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Single-Pole
15
GHQ1015 7
20
GHQ1020 7
Catalog
Number
Notes
1 480Y/277 V, circuit breakers (Type GHB) not suitable for three-phase delta (480 V).
2 15 through 70 ampere circuit breakers only.
3 Use two outside poles.
4 Uses 0.190 (4.83) 32 screw type clamp terminals.
5 Add suffix HID for High Intensity Discharge (HID) applications. 15 and 20 ampere, single-pole are SWD rated.
6 15 and 20 ampere, single-pole are SWD rated.
7 Includes 4A33462H01 load clip.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-126
2.3
Dimensions
GDB-Frame, Three-Pole
Front View
Side View
2
2
2
2
4.00
(101.6)
2
2
2
3.00
(76.2)
Max.
2.63
(66.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-127
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Type GHBGFEP Bolt-On Panelboard 30 mA Industrial Ground Fault Circuit Protectors (15100 Amperes)
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
Type GHBGFEP Bolt-On Panelboard 30 mA Industrial Ground
Fault Circuit Protectors with Non-Interchangeable Trip Units
Single-Phase (Requires Two Poles)
277 Vac, 30 mA
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
15
GHBGFEP1015
20
GHBGFEP1020
30
GHBGFEP1030
40
GHBGFEP1040
50
GHBGFEP1050
60
GHBGFEP1060
2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
GHBGFEP
14,000
2
2
2
V4-T2-128
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
Dimensions
GHB-Frame, Three-Pole
Front View
Side View
2
2
2
2
4.00
(101.6)
2
2
2
3.00
(76.2)
2.63
(66.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-129
2.3
2
Contents
Typical GHC
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
15100 amperes
120, 240, 277, 480Y/277V,
50/60 Hz, 125, 125/250 Vdc
Single-, two- and
three-pole
Cable in, cable out
Does not include mounting
hardware
2
2
Single-pole:
Classes 12c, 13a
Two-, three-pole:
Class 13b
UL/CSA
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-130
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
Product Selection
2
2
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
GHC1015 34
GHC2015 3
GHC3015 3
20
GHC1020 34
GHC2020 3
GHC3020 3
25
GHC1025
GHC2025
GHC3025
30
GHC1030
GHC2030
GHC3030
35
GHC1035
GHC2035
GHC3035
40
GHC1040
GHC2040
GHC3040
45
GHC1045
GHC2045
GHC3045
50
GHC1050
GHC2050
GHC3050
60
GHC1060
GHC2060
GHC3060
70
GHC1070
GHC2070
GHC3070
80
GHC1080
GHC2080
GHC3080
90
GHC1090
GHC2090
GHC3090
100
GHC1100
GHC2100
GHC3100
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Single-Pole
15
HGHC1015 5
20
HGHC1020 5
25
HGHC1025
30
HGHC1030
Catalog
Number
2
2
2
Notes
1 15 through 70 ampere circuit breakers only.
2 Use two outside poles.
3 Uses 0.19032 screw type clamp terminals.
4 Add suffix HID for High Intensity Discharge (HID) applications. 15 and 20 ampere, single-pole are SWD rated.
5 15 and 20 ampere, single-pole are SWD rated.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-131
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Type GHCGFEP Cable-In/Cable-Out 30 mA Industrial Ground Fault Circuit Protectors (15100 Amperes)
Product Description
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
2
2
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
15
GHCGFEP1015
20
GHCGFEP1020
30
GHCGFEP1030
40
GHCGFEP1040
50
GHCGFEP1050
60
GHCGFEP1060
2
2
2
Circuit Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
GHCGFEP
2
2
2
V4-T2-132
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
Contents
Description
Page
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04). . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
Product Selection
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
25
GHC1025D
GHC2025D
GHC3025D
30
GHC1030D
GHC2030D
GHC3030D
35
GHC1035D
GHC2035D
GHC3035D
40
GHC1040D
GHC2040D
GHC3040D
45
GHC1045D
GHC2045D
GHC3045D
50
GHC1050D
GHC2050D
GHC3050D
60
GHC1060D
GHC2060D
GHC3060D
70
GHC1070D
GHC2070D
GHC3070D
80
GHC1080D
GHC2080D
GHC3080D
90
GHC1090D
GHC2090D
GHC3090D
100
GHC1100D
GHC2100D
GHC3100D
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
277 Vac Maximum
Single-Pole
Type
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Cable-in
15
GHC1015HID
20
GHC1020HID
15
GHB1015HID
20
GHB1020HID
Bolt-on
Catalog
Number
2
2
2
2
Note
1 Use two outside poles.
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-133
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-134
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-135
V4-T2-136
V4-T2-147
V4-T2-148
V4-T2-150
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
FDC 3 100 L
Circuit Breaker
Type
EHD
FDB
FD
HFD
FDC
Suffix
E = 100% protected (four-pole only) neutral pole
EH = 50% protected (four-pole only)
K = High magnetic molded case switch
L = Line and load terminals
S = Stainless steel terminals
V = 50 C calibration
W = Without terminals
Y = Line terminals only
Z = Aluminum terminals (100 amperes)
Trip Amperes
Number of
Poles
1 = 1 pole
2 = 2 poles
3 = 3 poles
4 = 4 poles
010
015
020
025
030
035
040
045
050
060
070
080
090
100
110
125
150
175 (FD, HFD, FDC, two-, three-, four-pole only)
200 (FD, HFD, FDC, two-, three-, four-pole only)
225 (FD, HFD, FDC, two-, three-, four-pole only)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
EDC 3 200 L
Circuit Breaker
Type
EDB
EDS
ED
EDH
EDC
Number of
Poles
2 = 2 poles
3 = 3 poles
Trip
Amperes
100
125
150
175
200
225
2
2
Suffix
L = Line and load terminals
W = Without terminals
Y = Line terminals only
Z = Aluminum terminals (100 amperes)
2
2
2
2
FDE 3 225 32
Circuit Breaker
Type
FDE
HFDE
FDCE
Number of
Poles
3 = 3 poles
Trip
Amperes
80
160
225
Trip Unit
33 = LS
32 = LSI
35 = LSG
36 = LSIG
W
Suffix
ZG
= Zone
selective
interlocking
Blank = No option
2
Suffix
W
= Without terminals
L
= Line and load terminals
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-135
2.3
2
2
2
Product Selection
Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
ED2015
ED3015
20
ED2020
ED3020
25
ED2025
ED3025
30
ED2030
ED3030
35
ED2035
ED3035
40
ED2040
ED3040
50
ED2050
ED3050
60
ED2060
ED3060
100
ED2100
ED3100
125
ED2125
ED3125
150
ED2150
ED3150
175
ED2175
ED3175
200
ED2200
ED3200
225
ED2225
ED3225
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
20
25
30
35
40
50
60
100
EDH2100
EDH3100
125
EDH2125
EDH3125
150
EDH2150
EDH3150
175
EDH2175
EDH3175
200
EDH2200
EDH3200
225
EDH2225
EDH3225
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-136
2.3
Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
20
25
30
35
40
50
60
100
EDC2100
EDC3100
125
EDC2125
EDC3125
150
EDC2150
EDC3150
175
EDC2175
EDC3175
200
EDC2200
EDC3200
225
EDC2225
EDC3225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
100
EDB2100
EDB3100
110
EDB2110
EDB3110
125
EDB2125
EDB3125
150
EDB2150
EDB3150
175
EDB2175
EDB3175
200
EDB2200
EDB3200
225
EDB2225
EDB3225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-137
2.3
2
Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
100
EDS2100
EDS3100
110
EDS2110
EDS3110
125
EDS2125
EDS3125
150
EDS2150
EDS3150
175
EDS2175
EDS3175
200
EDS2200
EDS3200
225
EDS2225
EDS3225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
10 1
EHD1010
EHD2010
EHD3010
15
EHD1015 2
EHD2015
EHD3015
20
EHD1020 2
EHD2020
EHD3020
25
EHD1025
EHD2025
EHD3025
30
EHD1030
EHD2030
EHD3030
35
EHD1035
EHD2035
EHD3035
40
EHD1040
EHD2040
EHD3040
45
EHD1045
EHD2045
EHD3045
50
EHD1050
EHD2050
EHD3050
60
EHD1060
EHD2060
EHD3060
70
EHD1070
EHD2070
EHD3070
80
EHD1080
EHD2080
EHD3080
90
EHD1090
EHD2090
EHD3090
100
EHD1100
EHD2100
EHD3100
2
2
2
Notes
1 Not UL listed. 5 kAIC interrupting rating.
2 UL listed for SWD applications, see NEC Article 240.83(d).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-138
2.3
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
10 1
FDB2010
FDB3010
FDB4010
15
FDB2015
FDB3015
FDB4015
20
FDB2020
FDB3020
FDB4020
25
FDB2025
FDB3025
FDB4025
30
FDB2030
FDB3030
FDB4030
35
FDB2035
FDB3035
FDB4035
40
FDB2040
FDB3040
FDB4040
45
FDB2045
FDB3045
FDB4045
50
FDB2050
FDB3050
FDB4050
60
FDB2060
FDB3060
FDB4060
70
FDB2070
FDB3070
FDB4070
80
FDB2080
FDB3080
FDB4080
90
FDB2090
FDB3090
FDB4090
100
FDB2100
FDB3100
FDB4100
110
FDB2110
FDB3110
FDB4110
125
FDB2125
FDB3125
FDB4125
150
FDB2150
FDB3150
FDB4150
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Not UL listed. 5 kAIC interrupting rating.
2 UL listed for SWD applications, see NEC Article 240.83(d).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-139
2.3
2
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
10 1
FD1010
15
FD1015 2
FD2015
FD3015
FD4015
20
FD1020 2
FD2020
FD3020
FD4020
25
FD1025
FD2025
FD3025
FD4025
30
FD1030
FD2030
FD3030
FD4030
35
FD1035
FD2035
FD3035
FD4035
40
FD1040
FD2040
FD3040
FD4040
45
FD1045
FD2045
FD3045
FD4045
50
FD1050
FD2050
FD3050
FD4050
60
FD1060
FD2060
FD3060
FD4060
70
FD1070
FD2070
FD3070
FD4070
80
FD1080
FD2080
FD3080
FD4080
90
FD1090
FD2090
FD3090
FD4090
100
FD1100
FD2100
FD3100
FD4100
110
FD1110
FD2110
FD3110
FD4110
125
FD1125
FD2125
FD3125
FD4125
150
FD1150
FD2150
FD3150
FD4150
175
FD2175
FD3175
FD4175
200
FD2200
FD3200
FD4200
225
FD2225
FD3225
FD4225
Notes
1 Not UL listed. 5 kAIC interrupting rating.
2 UL listed for SWD applications, see NEC Article 240.83(d).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-140
2.3
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
HFD1015 1
HFD2015
HFD3015
HFD4015
20
HFD1020
HFD2020
HFD3020
HFD4020
25
HFD1025
HFD2025
HFD3025
HFD4025
30
HFD1030
HFD2030
HFD3030
HFD4030
35
HFD1035
HFD2035
HFD3035
HFD4035
40
HFD1040
HFD2040
HFD3040
HFD4040
45
HFD1045
HFD2045
HFD3045
HFD4045
50
HFD1050
HFD2050
HFD3050
HFD4050
60
HFD1060
HFD2060
HFD3060
HFD4060
70
HFD1070
HFD2070
HFD3070
HFD4070
80
HFD1080
HFD2080
HFD3080
HFD4080
90
HFD1090
HFD2090
HFD3090
HFD4090
100
HFD1100
HFD2100
HFD3100
HFD4100
110
HFD1110
HFD2110
HFD3110
HFD4110
125
HFD1125
HFD2125
HFD3125
HFD4125
150
HFD1150
HFD2150
HFD3150
HFD4150
175
HFD2175
HFD3175
HFD4175
200
HFD2200
HFD3200
HFD4200
225
HFD2225
HFD3225
HFD4225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Note
1 UL listed for SWD applications, see NEC Article 240.83(d).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-141
2.3
2
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
FDC2015
FDC3015
FDC4015
20
FDC2020
FDC3020
FDC4020
25
FDC2025
FDC3025
FDC4025
30
FDC2030
FDC3030
FDC4030
35
FDC2035
FDC3035
FDC4035
40
FDC2040
FDC3040
FDC4040
45
FDC2045
FDC3045
FDC4045
50
FDC2050
FDC3050
FDC4050
60
FDC2060
FDC3060
FDC4060
70
FDC2070
FDC3070
FDC4070
80
FDC2080
FDC3080
FDC4080
90
FDC2090
FDC3090
FDC4090
100
FDC2100
FDC3100
FDC4100
110
FDC2110
FDC3110
FDC4110
125
FDC2125
FDC3125
FDC4125
150
FDC215
FDC3150
FDC4150
175
FDC2175
FDC3175
FDC4175
200
FDC2200
FDC3200
FDC4200
225
FDC2225
FDC3225
FDC4225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-142
2.3
Types FDE, HFDE and FDCE 310+ Electronic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip Units
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-149.
2
2
Maximum
Ampere
Rating
Standard
LS
Optional
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup with I2t
Short Delay Ramp
Independently
Adjustable Short Time
Pickup and Delay
Independently Adjustable
Short Time Pickup and
Ground Fault Protection
Catalog Number
Neutral
CT for LSG
and LSIG
Catalog Number
80
FDE308033
FDE308032
FDE308035
FDE308036
CTF080
160
FDE316033
FDE316032
FDE316035
FDE316036
CTF160
225
FDE322533
FDE322532
FDE322535
FDE322536
CTF225
2
2
HFDE308033
HFDE308032
HFDE308035
HFDE308036
CTF080
160
HFDE316033
HFDE316032
HFDE316035
HFDE316036
CTF160
225
HFDE322533
HFDE322532
HFDE322535
HFDE322536
CTF225
2
2
FDCE308033
FDCE308032
FDCE308035
FDCE308036
CTF080
160
FDCE316033
FDCE316032
FDCE316035
FDCE316036
CTF160
225
FDCE322533
FDCE322532
FDCE322535
FDCE322536
CTF225
LSI w/ZSI
LSIG w/ZSI
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
2
2
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Frame
Ratings
225
160
80
2
2
80
FDE308032ZG
FDE308036ZG
160
FDE316032ZG
FDE316036ZG
225
FDE322532ZG
FDE322536ZG
80
HFDE308032ZG
HFDE308036ZG
160
HFDE316032ZG
HFDE316036ZG
225
HFDE322532ZG
HFDE322536ZG
2
2
FDCE308032ZG
FDCE308036ZG
160
FDCE316032ZG
FDCE316036ZG
225
FDCE322532ZG
FDCE322536ZG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-143
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
Series C
2
2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Two-Pole
100
EHD2100K
FD2100K
HFD2100K
150
FD2150K
HFD2150K
225
FD2225K
HFD2225K
Three-Pole
100
EHD3100K
FD3100K
HFD3100K
150
FD3150K
HFD3150K
225
FD3225K
HFD3225K
Four-Pole
100
FD4100K
HFD4100K
150
FD4150K
HFD4150K
225
FD4225K
HFD4225K
2
2
Note
Molded case switches will open above 1800 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-144
2.3
Ordering Information
F-Frame circuit breakers and
molded case switches have
load terminals only as
standard equipment. When
standard line-end terminals
(same as standard load-end
terminals) are required, add
Suffix L to the circuit breaker
catalog number. When nonstandard or optional line and/
or load terminals are required,
order by style number.
Specify if factory installation
is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal Body
Material
Package of Three
Terminals
Wire Type
AWG Wire
Range
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
2
2
Steel
Cu/AI
1410
2.54
3T20FB 2
100
Steel
Cu/AI
141/0
2.550
3T100FB
225
Aluminum
Cu/AI
44/0
2595
3TA225FD
Cu/AI
144
2.525
3TA50FB 2
2
2
Aluminum
100
Aluminum
Cu/AI
141/0
2.550
3TA100FD
200
Stainless steel
Cu
44/0
2595
3T150FB
225
Copper
Cu
44/0
2595
3T225FD
225
Aluminum
Cu/AI
6300 kcmil
16150
3TA225FDK 3
2
2
2
Notes
1 Use on FDE, HFDE and FDCE electronic trip only.
2 Not for use with ED, EDH, EDC breakers.
3 Includes terminal shield kit. Adds approximately 3 inches (76.2) to breaker height. Available for use on three-pole breaker only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-145
2.3
2
2
Collar
Collar
Nut
Screw
2
2
2
2
Clip
Conductor
Washer
Conductor
Conductor
Screw
Wire Clamp
Extrusion
3T20FB
3T100FB, 3T150FB
3TA225FD
2
2
2
Collar
Conductor
Collar
2
2
2
2
Washer
Conductor
Screw
Washer
Screw
3TA50FB
3TA100FD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-146
2.3
Accessories
Different combinations of accessories can be supplied, depending on the types of accessories and the number of poles
in the circuit breaker.
FD Frame Accessories
Description
Reference
Page
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Center
Left
Left
Right
Center
Four-Pole
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
2
2
V4-T2-273
V4-T2-273
V4-T2-273
V4-T2-275
V4-T2-275
V4-T2-277
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-279
V4-T2-283
V4-T2-285
2
2
2
2
External Accessories
End cap kit
V4-T2-306
Keeper nut
V4-T2-306
V4-T2-307
Multiwire connectors
V4-T2-308
V4-T2-308
V4-T2-308
Terminal shields
V4-T2-310
V4-T2-311
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-311
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-313
Cylinder lock
V4-T2-313
V4-T2-314
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-316
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-317
V4-T2-319
V4-T2-320
Handle mechanisms
LFD current limiter
V4-T2-425
V4-T2-322
2
2
2
2
2
IQ Energy Sentinel
V4-T2-322
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-323
2
2
V4-T2-115
Marine/naval application
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2
2
2
2
2
Note
Internal accessories are listed with Underwriters Laboratories (UL) for factory installation.
They are not listed with UL for field installation.
2
V4-T2-147
2.3
Circuit Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
240
277
480
600
125
250 23
EDB
2, 3
22
10
EDS
2, 3
42
10
ED
2, 3
65
10
EDH
2, 3
100
10
EDC
2, 3
200
10
EHD
10
2, 3
18
14
10
FDB
2, 3, 4
18
14
14
10
FD
35
10
2, 3, 4
65
35
18
10
FDE 4
65
35
18
HFD
65
10
2, 3, 4
100
65
25
22
HFDE 4
100
65
25
FDC 5
2, 3, 4
200
100
35
22
FDCE 456
200
100
25
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volts DC 1
Circuit Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
220, 240
380, 415
440
500
125
250 23
EDB
2, 3
22
10
EDS
2, 3
42
10
ED
2, 3
65
10
EDH
2, 3
100
10
EDC
2, 3
200
10
EHD
14
10
2, 3
18
14
10
FDB
2, 3, 4
18
14
14
14
10
FD
35
10
2, 3, 4
65
35
35
18
10
HFD
65
10
2, 3, 4
100
65
65
25
22
FDC
2, 3, 4
200
100
100
35
22
2
2
2
2
Circuit Breaker
Type
Ratings
Description
Catalog
Number
Frame
225
MTST230V
160
5108A03H01
CTF225
CTF160
CTF080
TRIP-LED
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
2
2
2
80
Notes
1 DC ratings apply to substantially non-inductive circuits.
2 Two-pole circuit breaker, or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
3 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum at 22 kA.
4 Electronics available on three-pole only, no DC rating for FDE, HFDE, FDCE.
5 Current limiting.
6 Check with Eaton for availability.
2
2
2
V4-T2-148
2.3
Description
Specification
310+ Settings
80 A
160 A
225 A
Frame designation
FD
15
60
100
Frames available
80 A, 160 A 225 A
20
70
110
15225 A
30
80
125
16225A
40
90
150
50
100
160
100% rated
No
60
125
175
70
150
200
H (= In)
80
160
225
Position 1
Position 2
Breaker Type
FD Frame
Protection
Ordering options
No
No
No
Position 3
No
Position 4
10
10
10
No
Position 5
12
12
12
LSI, LSIG
Position 6
15
15
15
Yes
Position 7
20
20
20
No
Position 8
24
24
24
Position 1
2x
2x
2x
Position 2
3x
3x
3x
Position 3
4x
4x
4x
Position 4
5x
5x
5x
Position 5
6x
6x
6x
Position 6
7x
7x
7x
Position 7
8x
8x
8x
Position 8
10x
10x
10x
Position 9
12x
12x
12x
tsd
(LS, LSG)
Fixed
67
at10x
67
at10x
67
at10x
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
Position 3
300
300
300
Position 1
16
32
45
Position 2
24
48
67
Position 3
32
64
90
Position 4
48
96
135
Position 5
64
128
180
Thru-cover accessories
Position 6
80
160
225
Position 1
Inst
Inst
Inst
Position 2
120
120
120
Position 3
300
300
300
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Not available for FD. Independently adjustable Ii setting available in LG, NG and
RG ALSI and ALSIG trip units.
2 Maintenance Mode not available for FD frames. It is available for KD, LD, MDL, LG, NG
and RG.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-149
2.3
2
2
Number of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
1.38 (35.1)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
2.75 (70.0)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
4.13 (105.0)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
5.50 (139.7)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
2
2
2
FD Frame, Three-Pole
Side View
Front View
2
2
2
On
Off
2
2
6.00
(152.4)
2
2
2
2
3.38
(85.7)
4.13
(104.9)
2
2
FD Frame
Breaker Type
3 (1.4)
4.5 (2.0)
2 (0.9)
3 (1.4)
4.5 (2.0)
6 (2.7)
4.5 (2.0)
Number of Poles
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-150
2.3
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-152
V4-T2-153
V4-T2-156
V4-T2-157
V4-T2-158
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-151
2.3
2
2
2
JD 3 250 F
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
JDB
JD
HJD
JDC
2
2
Number of
Poles
2 = 2 poles
3 = 3 poles
4 = 4 poles
2
2
Circuit Breaker/Frame
Ampere Rating
070
090
100
125
150
175
200
225
250
Suffix
C = Non-aluminum terminals
F = Frame only
K = High magnetic molded case switch
V = 50 C calibration
W = Without terminals
X = Load side terminals only
Y = Line side terminals only
2
2
Trip Unit
JT 3 250 T
2
2
2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
2 = 2 poles
3 = 3 poles
4 = 4 poles
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-152
Suffix
T = Trip unit
thermal-magnetic
fixed thermal
adj. magnetic
V = 50 C calibration
(thermal-magnetic
trip units only)
2.3
Product Selection
2
2
Types JD, HJD and JDC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
Standard Interrupting Capacity
600 Vac Rated
35 kAIC at 480 Vac
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals 1
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals 1
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals 1
See Page
V4-T2-155
for Optional
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
JD2070
HJD2070
JDC2070
JT2070T
TA250KB 2
90
JD2090
HJD2090
JDC2090
JT2090T
100
JD2100
HJD2100
JDC2100
JT2100T
125
JD2125
HJD2125
JDC2125
JT2125T
150
JD2150
HJD2150
JDC2150
JT2150T
175
JD2175
HJD2175
JDC2175
JT2175T
200
JD2200
HJD2200
JDC2200
JT2200T
225
JD2225
HJD2225
JDC2225
JT2225T
250
JD2250
HJD2250
JDC2250
JT2250T
70
JD3070
HJD3070
JDC3070
JT3070T
90
JD3090
HJD3090
JDC3090
JT3090T
100
JD3100
HJD3100
JDC3100
JT3100T
125
JD3125
HJD3125
JDC3125
JT3125T
150
JD3150
HJD3150
JDC3150
JT3150T
175
JD3175
HJD3175
JDC3175
JT3175T
200
JD3200
HJD3200
JDC3200
JT3200T
225
JD3225
HJD3225
JDC3225
JT3225T
250
JD3250
HJD3250
JDC3250
JT3250T
125
JD4125
HJD4125
JDC4125
JT3125T
150
JD4150
HJD4150
JDC4150
JT3150T
175
JD4175
HJD4175
JDC4175
JT3175T
200
JD4200
HJD4200
JDC4200
JT3200T
225
JD4225
HJD4225
JDC4225
JT3225T
250
JD4250
HJD4250
JDC4250
JT3250T
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit Only 1
Standard
Terminals Only
2
2
2
2
Two-Pole
2
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole
TA250KB 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Four-Pole 34
TA250KB 2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Magnetic trip adjustable 510 times continuous ampere rating.
2 Individually packed.
3 Fully rated neutral pole with no protection.
4 Neutral is in right pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-153
2.3
Standard Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
35 kAIC at 480 Vac
High Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
65 kAIC at 480 Vac
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
HJD2250F
JDC2250F
2
2
JD2250F
JD3250F
Three-Pole
HJD3250F
2
2
2
Four-Pole
JD4250F
HJD4250F
JDC4250F
Type JDB Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with NonInterchangeable Thermal-Magnetic Trip Units Suitable for
Reverse Feed Application
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Two-Pole
70
JDB2070W
JDB2070
90
JDB2090W
JDB2090
250
100
JDB2100W
JDB2100
125
JDB2125W
JDB2125
150
JDB2150W
JDB2150
175
JDB2175W
JDB2175
200
JDB2200W
JDB2200
225
JDB2225W
JDB2225
250
JDB2250W
JDB2250
Three-Pole
70
JDB3070W
JDB3070
90
JDB3090W
JDB3090
100
JDB3100W
JDB3100
125
JDB3125W
JDB3125
150
JDB3150W
JDB3150
175
JDB3175W
JDB3175
200
JDB3200W
JDB3200
225
JDB3225W
JDB3225
250
JDB3250W
JDB3250
250
Suitable for
Reverse Feed Use
See PageV4-T2-155
for Optional Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
JD2250KW
JDB2250KW
TA250KB 1
HJD2250KW
HJDB2250KW
JD3250KW
JDB3250KW
TA250KB 1
HJD3250KW
HJDB3250KW
JD4250KW
JDB4250KW
TA250KB 1
HJD4250KW
HJDB4250KW
Four-Pole
Notes
1 Individually packed.
Molded case switches may open above 2500 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-154
Standard
Terminals Only
Three-Pole
250
Two-Pole
JDC3250F
2
2
Two-Pole
2
2
2.3
2
Ordering Information
J-Frame circuit breakers use
Cu/AI terminals as standard.
When optional copper-only
terminals are required, order
by catalog number. Specify if
factory installation is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Collar
Collar
2
Nut
Slotted
Screw
T250KB Terminal
Slotted
Screw
2
Line and Load Terminals
Maximum
Breaker
Amperes
Terminal
Body
Material
2
Wire
Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
Cu/AI
4350 kcmil
25185
TA250KB
Cu
4350 kcmil
25185
T250KB
Aluminum
Stainless Steel
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-155
2.3
Accessories
2
2
JD Frame Accessories
Description
Reference
Page
Two-, Three-Pole
V4-T2-273
V4-T2-275
Left
V4-T2-275
V4-T2-277
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-280
V4-T2-283
V4-T2-287
V4-T2-306
Plug nut
V4-T2-307
V4-T2-307
Multiwire connectors
V4-T2-308
V4-T2-309
Terminal shields
V4-T2-310
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-311
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-313
Cylinder lock
V4-T2-313
V4-T2-314
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-317
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-317
V4-T2-319
V4-T2-320
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-425
Handle extension
V4-T2-440
IQ Energy Sentinel
V4-T2-322
Special calibration
V4-T2-115
Marine/naval application
2
2
2
2
2
2
Center
Four-Pole
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
External Accessories
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2
2
V4-T2-156
2.3
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
480
600
125
250 12
JDB
2, 3
65
35
18
10
JD
2, 3, 4
65
35
18
10
HJD
2, 3, 4
100
65
25
22
JDC 3
2, 3, 4
200
100
35
22
Volts DC
2
2
2
2
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
380
415
600
125
250 12
JD
2, 3, 4
65
35
35
10
HJD
2, 3, 4
100
65
65
22
JDC
2, 3, 4
200
100
100
22
Volts DC
2
2
2
Notes
1 Two-pole circuit breaker or two outside poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
2 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum at 22 kA.
3 Current limiting.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-157
2.3
2
2
Number of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
2, 3
4.13 (105.0)
10.00 (254.0)
4.06 (104.1)
5.50 (139.7)
10.00 (254.0)
4.06 (104.1)
JD-Frame, Three-Pole
Front View
Front View Cutout
1.56
(39.7)
0.34 R
(8.7 R)
2
2
3.94
(100.0)
0.72
(18.2)
0.50 (12.7)
Diameter
3 Megger Holes
if Required
0.19 R
(4.8) R
Side View
4.13
(104.8)
0.78
(19.8)
2.92
(74.2)
CL Breaker
2
2
CL Handle
0.88
(22.2)
3.33
(84.5)
ON
10.00
(254.0)
OFF
2.75
(69.9)
1.38
(34.9)
3.50
(88.9)
1.75
(44.5)
4.06
(103.2)
2
2
JD Frame
Breaker
Type
Complete Breaker
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
JDB
11.25 (5.1)
12.50 (5.7)
JD
11.25 (5.1)
12.50 (5.7)
13.25 (6.0)
9.00 (4.1)
10.00 (4.5)
10.50 (4.8)
2.00 (0.9)
2.00 (0.9)
2.25 (1.0)
HJD
11.25 (5.1)
12.50 (5.7)
13.25 (6.0)
9.00 (4.1)
10.00 (4.5)
10.50 (4.8)
2.00 (0.9)
2.00 (0.9)
2.25 (1.0)
JDC
12.25 (5.6)
13.50 (6.1)
14.25 (6.5)
10.00 (4.5)
11.00 (5.0)
11.50 (5.2)
2.00 (0.9)
2.00 (0.9)
2.25 (1.0)
Frame Only
Trip Unit
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-158
2.3
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-160
V4-T2-162
V4-T2-178
V4-T2-179
V4-T2-182
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-159
2.3
2
2
KD 3 400 F
2
2
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
DK
KD
KDB
HKD
KDC
2
2
Number
of Poles
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
2
2
2
2
KT 3 400 F
2
2
2
2
2
2
Suffix
= Copper terminals
= 50% protected neutral pole (four-pole electronic
trip unit circuit breaker only)
F
= Frame only (400 A only)
K
= High-magnetic molded-case switch
V
= 50 calibration (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
W
= Without terminals
X
= Load terminals only
Y
= Line side terminals only
Blank = Standard load and line side terminals
C
E
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Ampere
Rating
100
125
150
175
200
225
250
300
350
400
Number
of Poles
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Ampere
Rating
100
125
150
175
200
225
250
300
350
400
Notes
1 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., KD3400F or HKD3400F.
Ampere rating available with electronic trip unit only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-160
Suffix
T = Trip unit only
2.3
2
2
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Ampere Rating
125
250
400
T33
T32
T35
T36
T38
T39
=
=
=
=
=
=
Frame Designation
F
Feature
Blank = No feature
B20 = High load alarm
B21 = Ground fault alarm, with trip
B22 = Ground fault alarm, no trip
ZG
= Zone selective interlocking
Terminals
W = No terminals
L = Line and load
2
2
2
Trip Unit
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
310+ Electronic ALSI with Maintenance Mode
310+ Electronic ALSIG with Maintenance Mode
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Ampere Rating
125
250
400
Trip Unit
LS =
310+ Electronic LS
LSI =
310+ Electronic LSI
LSG=
310+ Electronic LSG 2
LSIG=
310+ Electronic LSIG 2
ALSI=
310+ Electronic LSI with Maintenance Mode
ALSIG= 310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode 2
Feature
Blank = No feature
B20 = High load alarm
B21 = Ground fault alarm, with trip 2
B22 = Ground fault alarm, no trip 2
ZG
= Zone selective interlocking
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
KD 3 125 T5 7 W
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
KD
HKD
KDC
CKD
CHKD
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Circuit Breaker/Frame
Ampere Rating
125
250
400
Trip Model
T5 = Model 550
T10 = Model 1050
2
Trip Type
2 = LSI
6 = LSIG
7 = LSIA
Suffix
W = Without terminals
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Cannot combine B2X suffixes with B2X suffixes.
2 Not available in four-pole configurations.
3 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., KD3400F, HKD3400F, etc.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-161
2.3
2
2
Types KD, HKD and KDC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
2
2
2
Series C
Product Selection
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Standard Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
35 kAIC at 480 Vac
High Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
65 kAIC at 480 Vac
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit Only 1
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals 1
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals 1
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals 1
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Two-Pole
100
KD2100
HKD2100
KDC2100
KT2100T
TA300K 2
125
KD2125
HKD2125
KDC2125
KT2125T
TA300K 2
150
KD2150
HKD2150
KDC2150
KT2150T
TA300K 2
175
KD2175
HKD2175
KDC2175
KT2175T
TA300K 2
200
KD2200
HKD2200
KDC2200
KT2200T
TA300K 2
225
KD2225
HKD2225
KDC2225
KT2225T
TA300K 2
250
KD2250
HKD2250
KDC2250
KT2250T
TA350K 2
300
KD2300
HKD2300
KDC2300
KT2300T
TA350K 2
350
KD2350
HKD2350
KDC2350
KT2350T
TA350K 2
400
KD2400
HKD2400
KDC2400
KT2400T
2TA400K 3
Three-Pole
100
KD3100
HKD3100
KDC3100
KT3100T
TA300K 2
125
KD3125
HKD3125
KDC3125
KT3125T
TA300K 2
150
KD3150
HKD3150
KDC3150
KT3150T
TA300K 2
175
KD3175
HKD3175
KDC3175
KT3175T
TA300K 2
200
KD3200
HKD3200
KDC3200
KT3200T
TA300K 2
225
KD3225
HKD3225
KDC3225
KT3225T
TA300K 2
250
KD3250
HKD3250
KDC3250
KT3250T
TA350K 2
300
KD3300
HKD3300
KDC3300
KT3300T
TA350K 2
350
KD3350
HKD3350
KDC3350
KT3350T
TA350K 2
400
KD3400
HKD3400
KDC3400
KT3400T
3TA400K 3
Four-Pole
100
KD4100
HKD4100
KDC4100
KT3100T
TA300K 2
125
KD4125
HKD4125
KDC4125
KT3125T
TA300K 2
175
KD4175
HKD4175
KDC4175
KT3175T
TA300K 2
200
KD4200
HKD4200
KDC4200
KT3200T
TA300K 2
225
KD4225
HKD4225
KDC4225
KT3225T
TA300K 2
250
KD4250
HKD4250
KDC4250
KT3250T
TA350K 2
300
KD4300
HKD4300
KDC4300
KT3300T
TA350K 2
350
KD4350
HKD4350
KDC4350
KT3350T
TA350K 2
400
KD4400
HKD4400
KDC4400
KT3400T
4TA400K 3
2
2
2
Notes
1 Magnetic trip adjustable 510 times continuous ampere rating.
2 Individually packed.
3 2TA400K, 3TA400K and 4TA400K terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
2
2
2
V4-T2-162
2.3
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
HKD2400F
KDC2400F
HKD3400F
KDC3400F
HKD4400F
KDC4400F
2
2
2
Two-Pole
KD2400F
Three-Pole
KD3400F
Four-Pole
KD4400F
Types KD, HKD and KDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable 310+ Trip Units
Order as individual components: breaker frame, trip unit and terminals. See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-180.
Types KD, HKD and KDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable 310+ Trip UnitsThree-Pole
Max.
Cont.
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Standard
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac
Rated
35 kAIC at
480 Vac
Standard
Options
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Independently
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup and
Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
High
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac
Rated
65 kAIC at
480 Vac
Ultra High
Interrupting
Capacity
Current
Limiting
600 Vac
Rated
100 kAIC
at 480 Vac
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup with
I2t Short
Delay Ramp
Independently
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup and
Delay
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup with
I2t Short
Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
Catalog Number
2
2
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
Catalog Number Information
125
KD3400F
HKD3400F
KDC3400F
KES3125LS
KES3125LSI
KES3125LSG
KES3125LSIG
LGFCT125
250
KD3400F
HKD3400F
KDC3400F
KES3250LS
KES3250LSI
KES3250LSG
KES3250LSIG
LGFCT250
400
KD3400F
HKD3400F
KDC3400F
KES3400LS
KES3400LSI
KES3400LSG
KES3400LSIG
LGFCT400
See Page
V4-T2-177
Max.
Cont.
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Standard
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac
Rated
35 kAIC at
480 Vac
High
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac
Rated
65 kAIC at
480 Vac
2
2
2
2
Types KD, HKD and KDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable 310+ Trip UnitsFour-Pole 45
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
2
2
Standard
Options
LS
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup with
I2t Short
Delay Ramp
Independently
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup and
Delay
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup with
I2t Short
Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
Independently
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup and
Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
Catalog Number
2
2
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
Catalog Number Information
125
KD4400F
HKD4400F
KDC4400F
KES4125LS
KES4125LSI
250
KD4400F
HKD4400F
KDC4400F
KES4250LS
KES4250LSI
400
KD4400F
HKD4400F
KDC4400F
KES4400LS
KES4400LSI
See Page
V4-T2-177
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For AC use only.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 Included with LSG and LSIG trip units.
4 Trip unit includes protected neutral pole. Use corresponding three-pole trip unit if protected neutral pole is not required.
5 Fully rated neutral pole protection is standard. For 50% rated protection on neutral pole, add Suffix E to four-pole trip unit catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-163
2.3
2
Type KDB with Digitrip 310+ Non-Interchangeable Trip Unit Suitable for Reverse Feed
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-180.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Factory Assembled Circuit Breaker Consisting of Frame and Trip Unit Less Terminals 1
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Number
of Poles
2
2
2
Optional
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Independently Adjustable
Neutral CT for
Short Time Pickup and
LSG and LSIG 23
Ground Fault Protection
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
125
KDB3125FT33W
KDB3125FT32W
KDB3125FT35W
KDB3125FT36W
LGFCT125
250
KDB3250FT33W
KDB3250FT32W
KDB3250FT35W
KDB3250FT36W
LGFCT250
400
KDB3400FT33W
KDB3400FT32W
KDB3400FT35W
KDB3400FT36W
LGFCT400
Terminal
Information
See Page
V4-T2-178
Type HKDB with Digitrip 310+ Non-Interchangeable Trip Unit Suitable for Reverse Feed
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-180.
Factory Assembled Circuit Breaker Consisting of Frame and Trip Unit Less Terminals 1
2
2
Standard
LS
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Number
of Poles
Standard
LS
Optional
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Independently Adjustable
Neutral CT for
Short Time Pickup and
LSG and LSIG 23
Ground Fault Protection
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
125
HKDB3125FT33W
HKDB3125FT32W
HKDB3125FT35W
HKDB3125FT36W
LGFCT125
250
HKDB3250FT33W
HKDB3250FT32W
HKDB3250FT35W
HKDB3250FT36W
LGFCT250
400
HKDB3400FT33W
HKDB3400FT32W
HKDB3400FT35W
HKDB3400FT36W
LGFCT400
Terminal
Information
See Page
V4-T2-178
2
2
2
2
Standard
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Standard
Interrupting
Capacity
High
Interrupting
Capacity
35 kAIC at
480 Vac
65 kAIC at
480 Vac
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup with
I2t Short
Delay Ramp
Options
Independently
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup and
Delay
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup with
I2t Short
Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
Independently
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup and
Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
Catalog Number
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 23
Catalog Number
125
CKD3400F
CHKD3400F
KES3125LS
KES3125LSI
KES3125LSG
KES3125LSIG
LGFCT125
250
CKD3400F
CHKD3400F
KES3250LS
KES3250LSI
KES3250LSG
KES3250LSIG
LGFCT250
400
CKD3400F
CHKD3400F
KES3400LS
KES3400LSI
KES3400LSG
KES3400LSIG
LGFCT400
Notes
1 For AC use only.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 Included with LSG and LSIG trip units.
2
2
2
V4-T2-164
Terminal
Information
See Page
V4-T2-177
2.3
Types DK and KDB Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip Units
Suitable for reverse feed application.
2
2
Types DK and KDB Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip Units
240 Vac Rated, 250 Vdc
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
With Line
Terminals Only
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
100
KDB2100W
KDB2100
125
KDB2125W
KDB2125
150
KDB2150W
KDB2150
175
KDB2175W
KDB2175
200
KDB2200W
KDB2200
225
KDB2225W
KDB2225
250
DK2250W
DK2250Y
DK2250
KDB2250W
KDB2250
300
DK2300W
DK2300Y
DK2300
KDB2300W
KDB2300
350
DK2350W
DK2350Y
DK2350
KDB2350W
KDB2350
400
DK2400W
DK2400Y
DK2400
KDB2400W
KDB2400
100
KDB3100W
KDB3100
125
KDB3125W
KDB3125
150
KDB3150W
KDB3150
175
KDB3175W
KDB3175
200
KDB3200W
KDB3200
225
KDB3225W
KDB3225
250
DK3250W
DK3250Y
DK3250
KDB3250W
KDB3250
300
DK3300W
DK3300Y
DK3300
KDB3300W
KDB3300
350
DK3350W
DK3350Y
DK3350
KDB3350W
KDB3350
400
DK3400W
DK3400Y
DK3400
KDB3400W
KDB3400
2
2
Two-Pole
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-165
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Three-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
DK2400K
KD2400K
KDB2400K
HKD2400K
HKDB2400K
DK3400K
KD3400K
KDB3400K
HKD3400K
HKDB3400K
KD4400K
KDB4400K
HKD4400K
HKDB4400K
Two-Pole
400
Series C
2
2
400
Four-Pole
400
Note
Molded case switches may open above 4000 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-166
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit), rating plug, terminals.
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response)
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
OPTIM 550 2
Fixed Rating Plug
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
KD3125T57W
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
125
ORPK125A125
250
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
400
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
KD3125T52W
KD3250T52W
KD3400T52W
KD3125T56W
KD3250T56W
KD3400T56W
KD3250T57W
KD3400T57W
2
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-167
2.3
2
Series C
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
HKD3125T57W
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
125
ORPK125A125
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
HKD3125T52W
HKD3250T52W
HKD3125T56W
HKD3250T56W
HKD3250T57W
2
2
2
2
2
2
400
HKD3400T52W
HKD3400T56W
HKD3400T57W
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-168
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
2
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
125
ORPK125A125
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
KDC3125T52W
KDC3250T52W
KDC3400T52W
KDC3125T56W
KDC3250T56W
KDC3400T56W
KDC3125T57W
KDC3250T57W
KDC3400T57W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-169
2.3
2
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit), rating plug, terminals.
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I
G
A
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 2
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
KD3125T106W
KD3125T107W
125
ORPK125A125
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A22
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
250
KD3250T106W
KD3250T107W
400
KD3400T106W
KD3400T107W
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-170
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
2
OPTIM 1050 2
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
125
ORPK125A125
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
HKD3125T106W
HKD3250T106W
HKD3400T106W
HKD3125T107W
HKD3250T107W
HKD3400T107W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-171
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 2
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
KDC3125T106W
KDC3250T106W
KDC3125T107W
KDC3250T107W
2
2
2
125
ORPK125A125
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
2
2
400
KDC3400T106W
KDC3400T107W
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-172
2.3
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit), rating plug, terminals.
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
OPTIM 550 2
Fixed Rating Plug
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
CKD3125T57W
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
125
ORPK125A125
250
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
400
CKD3125T52W
CKD3250T52W
CKD3400T52W
CKD3125T56W
CKD3250T56W
CKD3400T56W
CKD3250T57W
CKD3400T57W
2
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number
(refer to Page V4-T2-291).
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-173
2.3
2
Series C
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I
G
A
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
CHKD3125T57W
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
CHKD3125T52W
CHKD3250T52W
CHKD3125T56W
CHKD3250T56W
CHKD3250T57W
2
2
2
125
ORPK125A125
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
2
2
400
CHKD3400T52W
CHKD3400T56W
CHKD3400T57W
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-174
2.3
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit), rating plug, terminals.
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
OPTIM 1050 2
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
400
CKD3125T106W
CKD3250T106W
CKD3400T106W
CKD3125T107W
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
125
ORPK125A125
CKD3250T107W
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
CKD3400T107W
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
2
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-175
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 2
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPK125A70
90
ORPK125A90
100
ORPK125A100
110
ORPK125A110
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
CHKD3125T106W
CHKD3250T106W
CHKD3125T107W
CHKD3250T107W
2
2
2
125
ORPK125A125
125
ORPK025A125
150
ORPK025A150
175
ORPK025A175
200
ORPK025A200
225
ORPK025A225
250
ORPK025A250
200
ORPK40A200
225
ORPK40A225
250
ORPK40A250
300
ORPK40A300
350
ORPK40A350
400
ORPK40A400
2
2
400
CHKD3400T106W
CHKD3400T107W
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-176
2.3
Ordering Information
K-Frame circuit breakers use
Cu/AI terminals as standard.
When optional copper or Cu/
AI terminals are required,
order by catalog number.
Specify if factory installation
is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
TA400K, T400K
TA350K, T350K
TA300K, T300K
T400KCW, TA400KCW,
TA401KCW
TA402K, T402K
Terminal
Body
Material
Terminal
Wire
Type
AWG Wire
Range/No.
Conductors
Terminals with
Control Wire Termination
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
225
Aluminum
Cu/AI
3350 (1)
35185
TA300K 1
400
Aluminum
Cu/AI
250500 (1)
120240
TA350K 1
400
Aluminum
Cu/AI
3/0250 (2)
95120
2TA400K 23
2TA400KCW 23
400
Aluminum
Cu/AI
3/0250 (2)
95120
3TA400K 24
3TA400KCW 24
400
Aluminum
Cu/AI
3/0250 (2)
95120
4TA400K 56
4TA400KCW 56
Cu
3350 (1)
35185
T300K1
400
Copper
Cu
250500 (1)
120240
T350K 1
400
400
400
Copper
Aluminum
Aluminum
Cu
Cu/AI
Cu/AI
3/0250 (2)
2/0250 (2)
or
2/0500 (1)
500750 (1)
95120
2T400K
Copper
Cu
500750 (1)
3T400KCW 24
4T400K 5
4T400KCW 56
70120
2TA401K 23
2TA401KCW 23
70240
3TA401K 24
3TA401KCW 24
70240
4TA401K 56
4TA401KCW 56
300400
2TA402K 23
24
4TA402K 56
2T402K 23
3T402K 24
4T402K 56
2
2
2
2
23
3T400K 4
3TA402K
400
2T400KCW
2
2
225
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Individually packed.
2 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
3 Two-pole kit.
4 Three-pole kit.
5 Four-pole kit.
6 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and three interphase barriers.
2
2
2
V4-T2-177
2.3
Accessories
2
2
KD Frame Accessories
Reference
Page
Description
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-277
Shunt tripstandard 2
V4-T2-280
V4-T2-283
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-288
V4-T2-291
Two-Pole 1
Three-Pole
Left
Right
Left
Center
Four-Pole
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
External Accessories
End cap kit
V4-T2-306
Keeper nut
V4-T2-306
V4-T2-307
Terminal adapter
V4-T2-307
Multiwire connectors
V4-T2-308
V4-T2-308
V4-T2-309
Terminal shields
V4-T2-311
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-311
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-313
V4-T2-314
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-316
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-317
V4-T2-319
V4-T2-320
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-425
Handle extension
V4-T2-440
IQ Energy Sentinel
V4-T2-322
V4-T2-322
V4-T2-313
Cylinder lock
V4-T2-323
Digitrip OPTIMizer
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-323
2
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
Notes
Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 Shunt trip and UVR cannot be mounted in right poles on KES or OPTIM trip units. Standard internal accessories cannot be mounted in right pole on any K-Frame OPTIM trip unites. Special OPTIM
ground fault and zone interlock accessories are available for field installation in the right pole of K-Frame 550 OPTIM trip units. Factory installed 2a/2b and bell/aux are available for factory
installation. K-Frame breakers equipped with OPTIM 1050 trip units include aux-bell alarm in the right pole.
1
2
V4-T2-178
2.3
Reference
Page
Two-Pole 1
Three-Pole
Left
Right
Left
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
Special calibration
V4-T2-115
Marine/naval application
Description
Four-Pole
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
2
2
2
Catalog Number
MTST230V
5108A03H01
LGFCT400 3
LGFCT250 3
LGFCT125
TRIP-LED
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06 4
2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
277
480
600
250 56
DK
2, 3
65
10
KDB
2, 3, 4
65
35
25
10
KD
2, 3, 4
65
35
25
10
HKD, HKDB
2, 3, 4
100
65
35
22
KDC 7
2, 3, 4
200
100
65
22
CKD
65
35
25
CHKD
100
65
35
Volts DC
2
2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
380
415
440
500
600
250 56
DK
2, 3
65
10
KDB
2, 3, 4
65
40
40
10
KD
2, 3, 4
65
40
40
10
Volts DC
HKD, HKDB
2, 3, 4
100
65
65
22
KDC
2, 3, 4
200
100
100
22
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 MTST230V applies to 100230 Vac.
3 Included with all LD LSG and LSIG trip units and breakers.
4 Includes 6 ft cable for remote mounting; NEMA 3R rated.
5 Two-pole circuit breaker or two outside poles of three-pole circuit breaker.
6 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds minimum at 22 kA.
7 Current limiting.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-179
2.3
2
310+ Specifications
Trip Unit Type
Breaker Type
Frame
Frames available
55400 A
2
2
K-Frame
310+ Settings
125A
250 A
400 A
A (=Ir)
55
100
160
B (=Ir)
60
125
200
50400 A
C (=Ir)
70
150
225
D (=Ir)
80
160
250
100% rated
Yes
E (=Ir)
90
175
300
F (=Ir)
100
200
315
G (=Ir)
110
225
350
Ir = continuous current or
long delay pickup (amperes)
(All 310+)
Protection
Ordering options
Yes
Yes
Ir \ In
H (=Ir=In)
125
250
400
10
10
10
10
12
12
12
12
15
15
15
15
Thru-cover accessories
No
20
20
20
20
24
24
24
24
Position 1
2x
2x
Position 2
3x
3x
Position 3
4x
4x
Position 4
5x
5x
Position 5
6x
6x
Position 6
7x
7x
Position 7
8x
8x
Position 8
10
10x
10x
12x
12x
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Position 9
12
Fixed
67 @10x
Position 1
Inst
Position 2
120
Position 3
300
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Position 1
25
50
80
Position 2
37.5
75
120
Position 3
50
100
160
Position 4
75
150
240
Position 5
100
200
320
Position 6
125
250
400
Position 1
Inst
Position 2
120
Position 3
300
625
1000
Fixed
312
Notes
1 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2 Not available for KD. Independently adjustable I setting available in LG, NG and RG ALSI and
i
ALSIG trip units.
2
2
2
V4-T2-180
2.3
Specifications
rms sensing
Yes
Yes
Frame
Ampere range
125400 A
125400 A
Ordering options
LSI(A), LSIG
Yes
Yes
Overtemperature trip
Yes
Yes
2
2
Breaker Type
Protection
No
No
0.41.0 x (In)
0.41.0 x (In)
224 seconds
224 seconds
15 seconds
15 seconds
Yes
Yes
0.51.0 x Ir
0.51.0 x Ir
150800% x (Ir)
150800% x (Ir)
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes
Yes
2
2
200800% x (In)
200800% x (In)
Discriminator
Yes
Yes
Instantaneous override
Yes
Yes
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes
Yes
Yes
2
2
Yes
System Diagnostics
Status LEDs
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
1
Yes
Yes
Optional
Included
Digital display
Yes 2
Yes 2
Current
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Power qualityharmonics
No
Yes
Power factor
No
Yes
Yes 3
Yes
System Monitoring
Communications
PowerNet
Testing
Testing method
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
2
2
Notes
1 Zone interlock kit.
2 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
3 Eatons PowerNet kit.
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-181
2.3
2
2
Number
of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
2, 3
5.50 (149.7)
10.13 (257.3)
4.10 (104.1)
7.22 (183.4)
10.13 (257.3)
4.10 (104.1)
2
2
4.31
(109.6)
5.49
(139.4)
0.34 R
(8.7 R)
3.75
(95.3)
2
2
Side View
Front View
CL Handle
0.83
(21.0)
0.19 R
(4.8 R)
1.64
(41.7)
ON
1.25
(31.8)
10.13
(257.2)
1.31
(33.3)
OFF
2.63
(66.7)
2.39
(60.7)
4.78
(121.5)
2
2
2
2
2
2
Trip Unit 1
Frame Only
Breaker
Type
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
DK
10.0 (4.5)
11.5 (5.2)
KDB
10.0 (4.5)
11.5 (5.2)
KD
10.0 (4.5)
11.5 (5.2)
7.5 (3.4)
8.5 (3.9)
1.5 (0.7)
1.5 (0.7)
HKD, HKDB
10.0 (4.5)
11.5 (5.2)
7.5 (3.4)
8.5 (3.9)
1.5 (0.7)
1.5 (0.7)
KDC
10.0 (4.5)
11.5 (5.2)
7.5 (3.4)
8.5 (3.9)
1.5 (0.7)
1.5 (0.7)
2
2
Note
1 Weights shown are for thermal-magnetic trip units. Three-pole electronic trip units weigh 2.5 lbs (1.1 kg).
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-182
2.3
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-184
V4-T2-186
V4-T2-202
V4-T2-204
V4-T2-208
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
CE marked
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-183
2.3
2
2
2
LD 3 600 F
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
LDB
LD
HLD
LDC
CLD
CHLD
CLDC
2
2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
LT 3 400 T
2
2
2
2
Suffix
C = Copper terminals
F = Frame only (600 A only)
K = High magnetic molded case switch
V = 50 C (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
W = Without terminals
X = Load side terminals only
Y = Line side terminals only
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Ampere
Rating
300
350
400
450
500
600
Number
of Poles
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Suffix
T = Trip unit thermal-magnetic fixed thermal
adjustable magnetic
V = 50 C calibration (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
Note
1 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., LD3600F, HLD3600F, etc.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-184
2.3
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Terminals
W = No terminals
Amperes
600
Designation
T33
T32
T35
T36
T38
T39
=
=
=
=
=
=
Trip Unit
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG 1
310+ Electronic LSIG 1
310+ Electronic LSI with Maintenance Mode
310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode 1
Blank =
B20 =
B21 =
B22 =
ZG =
Features
No feature
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip 1
Ground fault alarm, no trip 1
Zone selective interlocking
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Trip Unit Type
LES
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Amperes
600
LS
=
LSI =
LSG =
LSIG =
ALSI =
ALSIG =
Trip Unit
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG 1
310+ Electronic LSIG 1
310+ Electronic LSI with Maintenance Mode
310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode 1
Blank =
B20 =
B21 =
B22 =
ZG =
Features
No feature
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip 1
Ground fault alarm, no trip 1
Zone selective interlocking
2
2
LD 3 125 T5 7 W
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
2
2
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
LD
HLD
LDC
CLD
CHLD
CLDC
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Ampere Rating
125 (Available on Model 1050 only)
250 (Available on Model 1050 only)
400
600
2
Trip Type
2 = LSI (550 only)
6 = LSIG
7 = LSIA
Suffix
W = Without terminals
2
2
Trip Model
T5 = Model 550
T10 = Model 1050
2
2
Notes
1 Not available in four-pole configurations.
2 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., LD3600F, HLD3600F, etc.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-185
2.3
Product Selection
Types LD, HLD and LDC Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C 1
Standard Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
35 kAIC at 480 Vac
High Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
65 kAIC at 480 Vac
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting of
Frame, Trip Unit and
Terminals
Factory Assembled
Factory Assembled Circuit
Circuit Consisting of Frame, Consisting of Frame,
Trip Unit and Terminals
Trip Unit and Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit Only
Standard Terminals Only
Two-Pole
300
LD2300
HLD2300
LDC2300
LT2300T
TA602LD 2
350
LD2350
HLD2350
LDC2350
LT2350T
TA602LD 2
400
LD2400
HLD2400
LDC2400
LT2400T
TA602LD 2
450
LD2450
HLD2450
LDC2450
LT2450T
TA602LD 2
500
LD2500
HLD2500
LDC2500
LT2500T
TA602LD 2
600
LD2600
HLD2600
LDC2600
LT2600T
2TA603LDK 3
300
LD3300
HLD3300
LDC3300
LT3300T
TA602LD 2
350
LD3350
HLD3350
LDC3350
LT3350T
TA602LD 2
400
LD3400
HLD3400
LDC3400
LT3400T
TA602LD 2
450
LD3450
HLD3450
LDC3450
LT3450T
TA602LD 2
500
LD3500
HLD3500
LDC3500
LT3500T
TA602LD 2
600
LD3600
HLD3600
LDC3600
LT3600T
3TA603LDK 3
300
LD4300
HLD4300
LDC4300
LT4300T
TA602LD 2
350
LD4350
HLD4350
LDC4350
LT4350T
TA602LD 2
400
LD4400
HLD4400
LDC4400
LT4400T
TA602LD 2
450
LD4450
HLD4450
LDC4450
LT4450T
TA602LD 2
500
LD4500
HLD4500
LDC4500
LT4500T
TA602LD 2
600
LD4600
HLD4600
LDC4600
LT4600T
4TA603LDK 3
2
2
2
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Two-Pole
HLD2600F
LDC2600F
Three-Pole
HLD3600F
LDC3600F
HLD4600F
LDC4600F
2
2
2
2
LD2600F
LD3600F
Four-Pole
LD4600F
Notes
1 Magnetic trip range 510 times continuous ampere rating.
2 Individually packed.
3 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
4 Neutral is in right pole.
2
2
V4-T2-186
2.3
Types LD, HLD and LDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
Order as individual components: breaker frame, trip unit and terminals. See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-180.
Types LD, HLD and LDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable 310+ Trip Units
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Standard
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac
Rated
35 kAIC at
480 Vac
High
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
65 kAIC at
480 Vac
Ultra High
Interrupting
Capacity
Current
Limiting
600 Vac Rated
100 kAIC at
480 Vac
Catalog Number
Standard
LS
Optional
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Adjustable
Short Time
Pickup with I2t
Short Delay
Ramp
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
Delay
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup with
I2t Short Delay
and Ground Fault
Protection
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
Ground Fault
Protection
LES3600LSI
LES3600LSG
LES3600LSIG
Catalog Number
2
2
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
Catalog Number Information
Three-Pole
600
LD3600F
HLD3600F
LDC3600F
LES3600LS
LGFCT600
See Page
V4-T2-178
Four-Pole 4
600
LD4600F
HLD4600F
LDC4600F
LES4600LS
LES4600LSI
See Page
V4-T2-178
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Number
of Poles
600
LDB3600FT33W
LDB3600FT32W
600
HLDB3600FT33W
600
LDCB3600FT33W
Independently Adjustable
Short Time Pickup and
Neutral CT for
Ground Fault Protection
LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
Catalog Number Information
LDB3600FT35W
LDB3600FT35W
HLDB3600FT32W
HLDB3600FT35W
HLDB3600FT36W
LDCB3600FT32W
LDCB3600FT35W
LDCB3600FT36W
LGFCT600
See Page
V4-T2-178
100% Rated Types CLD, CHLD and CLDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
The NEC allows the breaker to be rated at 100% of its frame size in an assembly, provided that 90 C wire is applied at the 75 C
ampacity. All 100% rated circuit breakers have electronic trip units. Order as individual components: breaker frame, trip unit and
terminals. See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-180.
100% Rated Types CLD, CHLD and CLDC Electronic Circuit Breakers with 310+ Interchangeable Trip Units
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Standard
Interrupting
Capacity 600 Vac
Rated 35 kAIC at
480 Vac
Ultra High
Interrupting
High Interrupting Capacity Current
Capacity 600 Vac Limiting 600 Vac
Rated 65 kAIC at Rated 100 kAIC
480 Vac
at 480 Vac
Optional
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup with
Adjustable Short Independently
Time Pickup with Adjustable Short I2t Short Delay
2
Time Pickup and and Ground Fault
I t Short Delay
Ramp
Delay
Protection
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
Ground Fault
Neutral CT for
Protection
LSG and LSIG 23 Terminal
Catalog Number Information
LES3600LS
LES3600LSIG
Catalog Number
Three-Pole
600
CLD3600F
CHLD3600F
CLDC3600F
LES3600LSI
LES3600LSG
LGFCT600
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
LSIG
Catalog Number
Factory Assembled Circuit Breaker Consisting of Frame and Trip Unit Less Terminals 1
LSG
Circuit Breaker Frame Including Digitrip RMS 310+ Electronic Trip Unit Less Terminals
Types LDB, HLDB and LDCB with Digitrip 310+ Non-Interchangeable Trip Units
Optional
LSI
Types LDB, HLDB and LDCB Electronic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable 310+ Electronic Trip Units Suitable for Reverse Feed
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-180.
Standard
LS
See Page
V4-T2-178
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For AC use only.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 Included with LSG and LSIG trip units.
4 Neutral is in right pole.
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-187
2.3
2
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
300
LDB2300W
LDB2300
350
LDB2350W
LDB2350
400
LDB2400W
LDB2400
450
LDB2450W
LDB2450
500
LDB2500W
LDB2500
600
LDB2600W
LDB2600
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
Two-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Three-Pole
300
LDB3300W
LDB3300
600
LD2600WK
2TA603LDK
350
LDB3350W
LDB3350
600
LDB2600WK 1
2TA603LDK
400
LDB3400W
LDB3400
600
HLD2600WK
2TA603LDK
450
LDB3450W
LDB3450
Three-Pole
500
LDB3500W
LDB3500
600
LD3600WK
3TA603LDK
600
LDB3600W
LDB3600
600
LDB3600WK 1
3TA603LDK
600
HLD3600WK
3TA603LDK
600
LD4600WK
4TA603LDK
600
LDB4600WK 1
4TA603LDK
600
HLD4600WK
4TA603LDK
Two-Pole
Four-Pole
Notes
1 Factory sealedsuitable for reverse feed application.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-188
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
2
OPTIM 550 2
Fixed Rating Plug
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
LD3125T57W
ORPL125A070
ORPL125A090
ORPL125A100
ORPL125A110
ORPL125A125
ORPL025A125
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
ORPL025A200
ORPL025A225
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
2
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
600
LD3125T52W
LD3250T52W
LD3400T52W
LD3600T52W
LD3125T56W
LD3250T56W
LD3400T56W
LD3600T56W
LD3250T57W
LD3400T57W
LD3600T57W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-189
2.3
2
Series C
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
HLD3125T57W
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
HLD3125T52W
HLD3250T52W
HLD3125T56W
HLD3250T56W
HLD3250T57W
2
2
2
2
400
600
HLD3400T52W
HLD3600T52W
HLD3400T56W
HLD3600T56W
HLD3400T57W
HLD3600T57W
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-190
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
2
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
ORPL125A070
ORPL125A090
ORPL125A100
ORPL125A110
ORPL125A125
ORPL025A125
ORPL025A150
ORPL025A175
ORPL025A200
ORPL025A225
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
600
LDC3125T52W
LDC3250T52W
LDC3400T52W
LDC3600T52W
LDC3125T56W
LDC3250T56W
LDC3400T56W
LDC3600T56W
LDC3125T57W
LDC3250T57W
LDC3400T57W
LDC3600T57W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-191
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I
G
A
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
2
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
LD3125T106W
LD3250T106W
LD3125T107W
LD3250T107W
2
2
2
400
LD3400T106W
LD3400T107W
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
2
2
600
LD3600T106W
LD3600T107W
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-192
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
2
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
600
HLD3125T106W
HLD3250T106W
HLD3400T106W
HLD3600T106W
HLD3125T107W
HLD3250T107W
HLD3400T107W
HLD3600T107W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-193
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
LDC3125T106W
LDC3250T106W
LDC3125T107W
LDC3250T107W
2
2
2
2
400
600
LDC3400T106W
LDC3600T106W
LDC3400T107W
LDC3600T107W
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-194
2.3
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Order as individual components: Breaker Frame (which includes Trip Unit), Rating Plug, Terminals.
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
2
OPTIM 550 2
Fixed Rating Plug
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
CLD3125T57W
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
600
CLD3125T52W
CLD3250T52W
CLD3400T52W
CLD3600T52W
CLD3125T56W
CLD3250T56W
CLD3400T56W
CLD3600T56W
CLD3125T57W
CLD3400T57W
CLD3600T57W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-195
2.3
2
Series C
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I
G
A
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
CHLD3125T57W
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A125
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
CHLD3125T52W
CHLD3250T52W
CHLD3125T56W
CHLD3250T56W
CHLD3125T57W
2
2
2
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
400
600
CHLD3400T52W
CHLD3600T52W
CHLD3400T56W
CHLD3600T56W
CHLD3400T57W
CHLD3600T57W
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-196
2.3
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
600
CLDC3125T52W
CLDC3250T52W
CLDC3400T52W
CLDC3600T52W
CLDC3125T56W
CLDC3250T56W
CLDC3400T56W
CLDC3600T56W
CLDC3125T57W
CLDC3125T57W
CLDC3400T57W
CLDC3600T57W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-197
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 35 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
CLD3125T106W
CLD3250T106W
CLD3125T107W
CLD3250T107W
2
2
2
2
400
600
CLD3400T106W
CLD3600T106W
CLD3400T107W
CLD3600T107W
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-198
2.3
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I
G
A
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
2
2
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
400
600
CHLD3125T106W
CHLD3250T106W
CHLD3400T106W
CHLD3600T106W
CHLD3125T107W
CHLD3250T107W
CHLD3400T107W
CHLD3600T107W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-199
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breaker with Interchangeable Rating Plug, continued
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
ORPL125A070
90
ORPL125A090
100
ORPL125A100
110
ORPL125A110
125
ORPL125A125
125
ORPL025A125
150
ORPL025A150
175
ORPL025A175
200
ORPL025A200
225
ORPL025A225
250
ORPL025A250
200
ORPL40A200
225
ORPL40A225
250
ORPL40A250
300
ORPL40A300
350
ORPL40A350
400
ORPL40A400
300
ORPL60A300
350
ORPL60A350
400
ORPL60A400
500
ORPL60A500
600
ORPL60A600
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity Current Limiting 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
125
250
CLDC3125T106W
CLDC3250T106W
CLDC3125T107W
CLDC3250T107W
2
2
2
2
400
600
CLDC3400T106W
CLDC3600T106W
CLDC3400T107W
CLDC3600T107W
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-200
2.3
Ordering Information
L-Frame circuit breakers use
Cu/AI terminals as standard.
When optional copper
terminals are required, order
by catalog Number. Specify if
factory installation is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminals
TA401LD or TA603LD
Terminal (Step-Type
Terminal Requires
Terminal Cover and
Warning Label.
See Inset.)
Pan-Head Screws
and Lockwashers
TA450LD or TA602LD or
T602LD Terminal
2
2
Terminal Cover
2
2
2
2
Warning Label
Retainer
Screws
Circuit Breaker
Line Terminal Cover
2
2
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire
Type
Terminals with
Control Wire Termination
Terminal
AWG Wire
Range/Number
of Conductors
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Poles
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
2
2
400
Aluminum
Cu/AI
4/0600 (1)
120300
Two-pole kit 1
2TA401LDK
400
Aluminum
Cu/AI
4/0600 (1)
120300
Three-pole kit 1
3TA401LDK
400
Aluminum
Cu/AI
4/0600 (1)
120300
Four-pole kit 1
4TA401LDK
450
Aluminum
Cu/AI
44/0 (2)
2595
TA450LD
500
Aluminum
Cu/AI
3/0350 (2)
95150
TA602LD
TA602LDCW
600
Aluminum
Cu/AI
400500 (2)
185240
Two-pole kit 1
2TA603LDK
2TA603LDKCW
600
Aluminum
Cu/AI
400500 (2)
185240
Three-pole kit 1
3TA603LDK
3TA603LDKCW
600
Aluminum
Cu/AI
400500 (2)
185240
Four-pole kit 1
4TA603LDK
4TA603LDKCW
120250
T602LD
T602LDCW
2
2
2
Copper
Cu
250350 (2)
Notes
1 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
2 Individually packed.
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-201
2.3
Accessories
2
2
LD Frame Accessories
Reference
Page
Two-Pole 1, Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Left
Right
Left
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-278
V4-T2-278
Shunt tripstandard 4
V4-T2-280
V4-T2-283
V4-T2-289
V4-T2-291
V4-T2-306
V4-T2-307
V4-T2-309
Terminal shields
V4-T2-311
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-311
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-313
V4-T2-314
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-316
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-318
V4-T2-319
V4-T2-320
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-425
Handle extension
V4-T2-440
V4-T2-322
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Description
Internal Accessories (Only One Internal Accessory Per Pole)
Center
Center
Right
Neutral 2
External Accessories
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
Notes
Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 Refer to Eaton for appropriate neutral pole accessory combinations.
3 OPTIM model 1050 is factory sealed and does not have the right pole space available for accessories.
4 Shunt trip and UVR cannot be mounted in right poles on LES or OPTIM trip units. Standard non-tripping internal accessories can be mounted in the left or right poles of LES and 550 OPTIM trip units.
1
2
2
2
V4-T2-202
2.3
Reference
Page
Two-Pole 1, Three-Pole
Left
Center
Right
Four-Pole
Left
Center
Right
Neutral
V4-T2-322
V4-T2-322
V4-T2-323
Digitrip OPTIMizer
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-323
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-115
Marine/naval application
2
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
2
2
Catalog Number
MTST230V 3
5108A03H01
LGFCT600 4
TRIP-LED
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Two-pole breaker supplied in three-pole frame. Current carrying parts omitted from center pole.
2 Refer to Eaton for appropriate neutral pole accessory combinations.
3 MTST230V applies to 100230 Vac.
4 Included with all LD LSG and LSIG trip units and breakers.
5 Includes 6 ft cable for remote mounting; NEMA 3R rated.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-203
2.3
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
277
480
600
125
250 23
LDB
2, 3
65
35
25
22
LD
2, 3, 4
65
35
25
22
CLD 4
2, 3, 4
65
35
25
HLD, HLDB
2, 3, 4
100
65
35
25
CHLD 4
2, 3, 4
100
65
35
LDC, LDCB 5
2, 3, 4
200
100
50
30
CLDC 45
2, 3, 4
200
100
50
2
2
2
Volts DC
Volts DC
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
Icu
Ics
Icu
Ics
Icu
Ics
Icu
Ics
LDB
2, 3
85
85
45
45
20
10
20
10
LD
2, 3, 4
85
85
45
45
20
10
20
10
2, 3, 4
85
85
45
45
20
10
HLD, HLDB
2, 3, 4
100
100
70
70
25
13
20
10
CHLD 4
2, 3, 4
100
100
70
70
25
13
LDC, LDCB
2, 3, 4
200
100
100
75
35
18
20
10
CLDC 4
2, 3, 4
200
100
100
75
35
18
2
2
2
2
CLD
240
415
250 23
690
Notes
1 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
2 L/R = 8 milliseconds minimum.
3 Two-pole circuit breaker or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker. Incorporating thermal-magnetic trip unit only.
4 100% rated breakers.
5 Current limiting.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-204
2.3
310+ Specifications
Description
Trip Unit Type
Breaker Type
Frame designation
LD
Frames available
600 A
250600 A
120600 A
100% rated
Description
LD Frame
Specification
310+ settings
600 A
Specification
Yes
Protection
Ordering options
250
300
315
350
400
450
500
H (= In)
600
2
2
Ir
A
2
2
2
2
Yes
Yes
10
10
12
12
15
15
20
20
Thru-cover accessories
No
24
24
Position 1
2x
Position 2
3x
Position 3
4x
Position 4
5x
Position 5
6x
Position 6
7x
Position 7
8x
Position 8
8x
Position 9
8x
tsd
(LS and LSG)
Fixed
67 @10x
Position 1
Inst
Position 2
120
Position 3
300
Position 1
120
Position 2
180
Position 3
240
Position 4
360
Position 5
480
Position 6
600
Position 1
Inst
Position 2
120
Position 3
300
Fixed
1500
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2 Not available for LD. Independently adjustable Ii setting available in LG, NG, and RG ALSI and
ALSIG trip units.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-205
2.3
2
rms sensing
Yes
Yes
Frame
Ampere range
200600 A
200600 A
Protection
LSI, LSI(A), LSIG
LSI(A), LSIG
Breaker Type
Ordering options
Fixed rated plug (In)
Yes
Yes
Overtemperature trip
Yes
Yes
No
No
0.41.0 x (In)
0.41.0 x (In)
224 seconds
224 seconds
15 seconds
15 seconds
Yes
Yes
0.51.0 x Ir
0.51.0 x Ir
150800% x (Ir)
150800% x (Ir)
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes 1
Yes
200800% x (In)
2
2
Instantaneous pickup
Discriminator
Yes
Yes
Instantaneous override
Yes
Yes
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes 1
Yes
Yes
Yes
2
2
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
Note
1 Zone interlock kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-206
2.3
Status LEDs
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes 1
Yes
Optional
Included
Digital display
Yes 2
Yes 2
Current
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Power qualityharmonics
No
Yes
Power factor
No
Yes
Yes 3
Yes
2
2
System Diagnostics
2
2
2
System Monitoring
2
2
2
2
Communications
PowerNet
Testing
Testing method
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
2
2
Notes
1 Zone interlock kit.
2 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
3 Eatons PowerNet kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-207
2.3
2
2
Number of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
2, 3
8.25 (209.6)
10.75 (273.1)
4.06 (103.1)
11.00 (279.4)
10.75 (273.1)
4.06 (103.1)
Side View
3.81
(96.8)
CL Handle
CL Breaker
3.44
(87.3)
1.72
(43.7)
2
2
Front View
3.28
(83.3)
0.25 (6.4) R
1.33
(33.7)2.29
(58.2)
10.75
(273.1)
1.50
(38.1)
3.64
(92.5)
8.21
(208.6)
0.19 R
(4.8) R
7.28
(184.9)
2
2
8.25
(209.6)
2
2
LD Frame
Breaker
Type
18 (8.2)
20 (9.1)
25 (11.3)
14 (6.4)
15 (6.8)
20 (9.1)
3 (1.4)
4 (1.8)
5 (2.3)
LDB
18 (8.2)
20 (9.1)
25 (11.3)
Complete Breaker
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Frame Only
Four-Pole
Two-Pole
Trip Unit
Three-Pole
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-208
Four-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
2.3
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-210
V4-T2-211
V4-T2-216
V4-T2-217
V4-T2-219
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
CE marked
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-209
2.3
2
2
2
MDL 3 800 F
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
MDL, MDLB
HMDL, HMDLB
2
2
Number
of Poles
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
2
2
Number
of Poles
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
2
2
2
2
Suffix
Frame only (800 A only)
High magnetic molded case switch
50 C (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
Without terminals
Load side terminals only
Line side terminals only
T
V
Suffix
= Thermal-magnetic
= 50 C (thermal-magnetic trip units only)
2
2
=
=
=
=
=
=
MT 3 800 T
F
K
V
W
X
Y
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Ampere Rating
500
300 1
600
350 1
700
400
800
450
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Terminals
W = No terminals
Amperes
800
2
2
Designation
F
T33
T32
T35
T36
T38
T39
=
=
=
=
=
=
Trip Unit
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
310+ Electronic LSI with Maintenance Mode
310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode
Blank =
B20 =
B21 =
B22 =
ZG =
Features
No feature
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip
Ground fault alarm, no trip
Zone selective interlocking
Blank =
B20 =
B21 =
B22 =
ZG =
Features
No feature
High load alarm
Ground fault alarm, with trip
Ground fault alarm, no trip
Zone selective interlocking
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Amperes
800
LS
=
LSI =
LSG =
LSIG =
ALSI =
ALSIG =
Trip Unit
310+ Electronic LS
310+ Electronic LSI
310+ Electronic LSG
310+ Electronic LSIG
310+ Electronic LSI with Maintenance Mode
310+ Electronic LSIG with Maintenance Mode
Note
1 Frames are the same for thermal-magnetic or 310+ electronic trip units, e.g., MDL3800F, HMDL3800F, etc.
V4-T2-210
2.3
Product Selection
Types MDL and HMDL Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip UnitsTwo-Pole
Standard Interrupting Capacity
600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit Only
For Use with Standard
or High or Ultra High
Interrupting Frames
2
2
Standard
Terminals
Only 1
Frame Only
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals
Frame Only
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
300
MDL2300
MDL2800F
HMDL2300
HMDL2800F
MT2300T
TA700MA1
350
MDL2350
HMDL2350
MT2350T
TA700MA1
400
MDL2400
HMDL2400
MT2400T
TA700MA1
450
MDL2450
HMDL2450
MT2450T
TA700MA1
500
MDL2500
HMDL2500
MT2500T
TA700MA1
600
MDL2600
HMDL2600
MT2600T
TA700MA1
700
MDL2700
HMDL2700
MT2700T
TA700MA1
800
MDL2800
HMDL2800
MT2800T
TA800MA2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals
See Page
V4-T2-215 for
Optional Terminals
2
2
2
2
2
Types MDL and HMDL Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip UnitsThree-Pole
Standard Interrupting Capacity
600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit Only
For Use with Standard
or High or Ultra High
Interrupting Frames
Frame Only
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals
Frame Only
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
MDL3800F
HMDL3300
HMDL3800F
MT3300T
TA700MA1
HMDL3350
MT3400T
TA700MA1
HMDL3400
MT3400T
TA700MA1
MDL3450
HMDL3450
MT3450T
TA700MA1
500
MDL3500
HMDL3500
MT3500T
TA700MA1
600
MDL3600
HMDL3600
MT3600T
TA700MA1
700
MDL3700
HMDL3700
MT3700T
TA700MA1
800
MDL3800
HMDL3800
MT3800T
TA800MA2
Factory Assembled
Circuit Consisting
of Frame, Trip Unit
and Terminals
Catalog
Number
300
MDL3300
350
MDL3350
400
MDL3400
450
Standard
Terminals
Only 1
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
See Page
V4-T2-215 for
Optional Terminals
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Note
1 Two terminals are required per pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-211
2.3
2
Types MDLB and HMDLB Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip UnitsTwo-Pole 1
Standard Interrupting Capacity
600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
300
MDLB2300
HMDLB2300
TA700MA1
350
MDLB2350
HMDLB2350
TA700MA1
400
MDLB2400
HMDLB2400
TA700MA1
450
MDLB2450
HMDLB2450
TA700MA1
500
MDLB2500
HMDLB2500
TA700MA1
600
MDLB2600
HMDLB2600
TA700MA1
700
MDLB2700
HMDLB2700
TA700MA1
800
MDLB2800
HMDLB2800
TA800MA2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Types MDLB and HMDLB Thermal-Magnetic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip UnitsThree-Pole 1
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
300
MDLB3300
HMDLB3300
TA700MA1
350
MDLB3350
HMDLB3350
TA700MA1
400
MDLB3400
HMDLB3400
TA700MA1
450
MDLB3450
HMDLB3450
TA700MA1
500
MDLB3500
HMDLB3500
TA700MA1
600
MDLB3600
HMDLB3600
TA700MA1
700
MDLB3700
HMDLB3700
TA700MA1
800
MDLB3800
HMDLB3800
TA800MA2
Notes
1 Factory sealed for reverse feed application.
2 Two terminals are required per pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-212
2.3
Types MDL and HMDL Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
Order as Individual Components: breaker frame, trip unit and terminals.
See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-218.
2
2
Types MDL and HMDL Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable 310+ Trip UnitsThree-Pole
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Standard
LS
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
600
Standard
Interrupting
Capacity 600 Vac
Rated 50 kAIC at
480 Vac
High Interrupting
Capacity 600 Vac Adjustable Short
Rated 65 kAIC at Time Pickup with I2t
Short Delay Ramp
480 Vac
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog Number
MDL3800F
HMDL3800F
MES3800LS
Optional
LSI
LSG
LSIG
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
Delay
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup with I2t
Short Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
Ground Fault
Protection
2
2
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 23
Catalog Number
MES3800LSI
MES3800LSG
MES3800LSIG
Types MDLB and HMDLB Electronic Circuit Breakers with Non-Interchangeable 310+ Trip Units
LGFCT600
Terminal
Information
See Page
V4-T2-216
LS
LSI
LSG
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
MDLB3800FT33W
MDLB3800FT32W
HMDLB3800FT33W
HMDLB3800FT32W
LGFCT600
HMDLB3800FT35W
HMDLB3800FT36W
LGFCT600
100% Rated Types CMDL and CHMDL Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable 310+ Trip UnitsThree-Pole
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
800
Standard
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
50 kAIC at
480 Vac
High
Interrupting
Capacity
600 Vac Rated
65 kAIC at
480 Vac
Options
LSI
Independently
Adjustable Short
Adjustable Short
2
Time Pickup with I t Time Pickup and
Short Delay Ramp Delay
LSG
LSIG
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup with I2t
Short Delay and
Ground Fault
Protection
Independently
Adjustable Short
Time Pickup and
Ground Fault
Protection
Catalog Number
CMDL3800F
CHMDL3800F
MES3800LS
MES3800LSI
MES3800LSG
MES3800LSIG
2
2
2
2
MDLB3800FT36W
100% Rated Types CMDL and CHMDL Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Trip Units
The NEC allows the breaker to be rated at 100% of its frame size in an assembly, provided that 90 C wire is applied at the 75 C
ampacity. All 100% rated circuit breakers have electronic trip units. Order as individual components: breaker frame, trip unit and
terminals. See 310+ adjustability specifications on Page V4-T2-218.
MDLB3800FT35W
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
2
2
LSIG
Catalog Number
800
2
2
Factory-Assembled Circuit Breaker Consisting of Frame and Trip Unit Less Terminals
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
2
Neutral CT for
LSG and LSIG 23
Catalog Number
Terminal
Information
LGFCT600
2
2
2
Notes
1 For AC use only.
2 Required for four-wire systems if neutral protection is desired.
3 Included with LSG and LSIG trip units or breakers.
4 Factory sealed, suitable for reverse feed application. CMDLB and CHMDLB are also available.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-213
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Series C
Two-Pole
800
2
2
MDL2800WK
MDLB2800WK 1
HMDL2800WK
Three-Pole
800
MDL3800WK
MDLB3800WK 1
HMDL3800WK
Notes
1 MDLB and HMDLB are suitable for reverse feed applications.
Molded case switch may trip above 6000 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-214
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
TA700MA1
TA800MA2
TA801MA
2
2
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire
Type
AWG Wire
Range/No.
Conductors
Terminal
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
TA700MA1CWT
2
2
Aluminum
Cu/AI
TA700MA1
800 std.
Aluminum
Cu/AI
TA800MA2
TA800MA2CWT
800
Aluminum
Cu/AI
TA801MA
TA801MACWT
2
2
2
Copper
Cu
T600MA1
800
Copper
Cu
T800MA1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-215
2.3
Accessories
2
2
2
MD Frame Accessories
Description
Reference
Page
Two-Pole 1
Left
Right
Left
Three-Pole
Center
Right
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-278
V4-T2-278
Shunt tripstandard 2
V4-T2-281
V4-T2-283
V4-T2-289
External Accessories
V4-T2-308
V4-T2-309
Terminal shields
V4-T2-311
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-311
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-313
V4-T2-314
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-316
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-318
V4-T2-319
V4-T2-320
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-425
Handle extension
V4-T2-440
V4-T2-322
Special calibration
V4-T2-115
Marine/naval application
2
2
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
2
2
V4-T2-216
2.3
Catalog Number
MTST230V 1
5108A03H01
LGFCT600 2
TRIP-LED
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06 3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
480
600
250
MDL, MDLB
2, 3
65
50
25
22
CMDL
2, 3
65
50
25
Volts DC 56
HMDL, HMDLB
2, 3
100
65
35
25
CHMDL
2, 3
100
65
35
2
2
2
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
415
690
MDL, MDLB
2, 3
65/65
50/50
20/10
20/10
CMDL
2, 3
65/65
50/50
20/10
HMDL, HMDLB
2, 3
100/100
70/50
25/13
20/10
CHMDL
2, 3
100/100
70/50
25/13
Volts DC 56
250
2
2
2
Notes
1 MTST230V applies to 100230 Vac.
2 Included with all LD LSG and LSIG trip units and breakers.
3 Includes 6 ft cable for remote mounting; NEMA 3R rated.
4 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
5 Two-pole or two poles of three-pole circuit breaker. Thermal-magnetic trip units only, MDL, HMDL breakers with electronic trip unit are not DC rated.
6 Time constant is 3 milliseconds minimum at 10 kA and 8 milliseconds at 22 kA.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-217
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
310+ Specifications
Description
MDL Frame
Specification
Description
310+ settings
Breaker Type
Frame designation
MDL
Frames available
800 A
320800 A
160800 A
50, 65
Yes
800 A
Ir
A
320
400
450
500
600
630
Protection
Yes
Yes
10
10
12
12
15
15
20
20
Thru-cover accessories
No
24
24
Position 1
2x
Position 2
3x
Position 3
4x
Position 4
5x
Position 5
6x
Position 6
7x
Position 7
8x
Position 8
8x
2
2
Ordering options
700
H (= In)
800
Position 9
8x
Fixed
67 @10x
Position 1
Inst
Position 2
120
Position 3
300
Position 1
160
Position 2
240
Position 3
320
Position 4
480
Position 5
640
2
Ig (x In) = ground fault pickup (amperes)
(310+ w/ ground fault)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Position 6
800
Position 1
Inst
Position 2
120
Position 3
300
Fixed
2000
Notes
1 B2x suffixes cannot be combined with B2x suffixes.
2 Not available for MDL. Independently adjustable Ii setting available in LG, NG, and RG ALSI
and ALSIG trip units.
2
2
2
V4-T2-218
2.3
MD Frame
Number of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
2, 3
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
4.06 (103.1)
2
2
Front View
Side View
3.44
(87.3)
1.72
(43.7)
2
2
R 0.25
(6.4)
CL Breaker
2
R 0.19
(4.8)
CL Handle
1.33
(33.7)
1.50
(38.1)
16.00
(406.4)
3.28
(83.3)
2
2
0.97
(24.6)
3.64
(92.5)
7.28
(184.9)
4.06
(103.2)
8.25
(209.6)
2
2
MD Frame
Trip Unit 1
Complete Breaker
Frame Only
Breaker Type
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Two-Pole
26.5 (12.0)
29.0 (13.2)
24.5 (11.1)
26.0 (11.8)
2.5 (1.1)
3.0 (1.4)
30.0 (13.6)
26.0 (11.8)
4.0 (1.8)
Three-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
2
2
Note
1 Thermal-magnetic only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-219
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-220
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-221
V4-T2-222
V4-T2-230
V4-T2-231
V4-T2-234
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
2
2
Circuit Breaker/Frame
ND 3 12 T3 2 W
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
ND
HND
NDC
NDU
CND
CHND
CNDC
Number
of Poles
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Circuit Breaker/Frame
Ampere Rating
800 = 800 amperes
12 = 1200 amperes
T3
T5
T7
T10
Trip Model
= Model 310
= Model 550
= Model 750
= Model 1050
2
Trip Type
2 = LSI
3 = LS
5 = LSG
6 = LSIG
7 = LSIA
E
EH
K
W
X
Y
=
=
=
=
=
=
Suffix
100% R.P. protected (four-pole)
50% R.P. protected (four-pole)
High magnetic molded case switch
Without terminals
Load only terminals
Line only terminals
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-221
2.3
Product Selection
2
2
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I
G
A
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 550 2
Fixed
Rating Plug
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
ND3800T57W
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
2
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
ND3800T52W
ND3800T56W
2
2
1200
ND312T52W
ND312T56W
ND312T57W
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
HND3800T52W
HND3800T56W
HND3800T57W
2
2
2
2
1200
HND312T52W
HND312T56W
HND312T57W
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-222
2.3
Digitrip OPTIM 550 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
Fixed
Rating Plug
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
NDC3800T57W
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200
NDC3800T52W
NDC312T52W
NDC3800T56W
NDC312T56W
NDC312T57W
2
2
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-223
2.3
2
L Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
S Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
2
2
Series C
Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Fixed
Rating Plug
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
2
2
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200
ND3800T106W
ND312T106W
ND3800T107W
ND312T107W
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
HND3800T106W
HND3800T107W
1200
HND312T106W
HND312T107W
2
2
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200
NDC3800T106W
NDC312T106W
NDC3800T107W
NDC312T107W
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch and one Form C bell (trip) alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
V4-T2-224
2.3
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit), rating plug, terminals.
2
2
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
Fixed
Rating Plug
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
OPTIM 550 2
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
CND3800T57W
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200 3
CND3800T52W
CND312T52W
CND3800T56W
CND312T56W
CND312T57W
1200 3
CHND3800T52W
CHND312T52W
CHND3800T56W
CHND312T56W
CHND3800T57W
CHND312T57W
2
2
2
2
2
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
3 Includes conductor extension kit, which increases breaker length 3.75 on each end. Terminal ordered separate.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-225
2.3
2
Series C
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 550 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs, continued
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I
G
A
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 550 2
Fixed
Rating Plug
LSI
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
CNDC3800T57W
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200 3
CNDC3800T52W
CNDC312T52W
CNDC3800T56W
CNDC312T56W
CNDC312T57W
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 Zone interlocking, PowerNet, or both features can be added at the factory by adding suffixes ZG, PN or ZGP respectively to above catalog number.
3 Includes conductor extension kit, which increases breaker length 3.75 on each end. Terminal ordered separate.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-226
2.3
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
L
S
I Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
G Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
A Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
2
Fixed
Rating Plug
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 50 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200
CND3800T106W
CND312T106W
CND3800T107W
CND312T107W
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200
CHND3800T106W
CHND312T106W
CHND3800T107W
CHND312T107W
2
2
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch one Form C bell (trip) alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-227
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
100% Rated Digitrip OPTIM 1050 Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs, continued
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time (I2t or I4t Response) 1
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
OPTIM 1050 23
LSIG
LSIA
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Fixed
Rating Plug
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
400
ORPN80A400
450
ORPN80A450
500
ORPN80A500
550
ORPN80A550
600
ORPN80A600
700
ORPN80A700
800
ORPN80A800
600
ORPN12A600
700
ORPN12A700
800
ORPN12A800
1000
ORPN12A100
1200
ORPN12A120
2
2
2
Three-Pole Ultra High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
800
1200
CNDC3800T106W
CNDC3800T107W
CNDC312T106W 4
CNDC312T107W
Three-Pole
Four-Pole 5
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
800
ND3800WK
ND4800WK
1200
HND3800WK
HND4800WK
ND312WK
ND412WK
HND312WK
HND412WK
Notes
1 Long delay I4t response selection limits short delay time to flat response.
2 One Form C auxiliary switch one Form C bell (trip) alarm switch supplied with breaker as standard.
3 Factory sealed.
4 Includes conductor extension kit, which increases breaker length 3.75 on each end. Terminal ordered separate.
5 Neutral is in right pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-228
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
TA700NB1
TA1000NB1
TA1200NB1
TA1201NB1
T700NB1
T1000NB1
Terminal Body
Material
Wire
Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
2
2
Aluminum
Cu/AI
50240
TA700NB1
1000
Aluminum
Cu/AI
95185
TA1000NB1 1
2
2
1200
Aluminum
Cu/AI
120240
TA1200NB1
1200
Aluminum
Cu/AI
300400
TA1201NB1 2
Copper
Cu
70240
T700NB1
1000
Copper
Cu
95240
T1000NB1
1200
Copper
Cu
95185
T1200NB3
2
2
Notes
1 Terminal rating is AL9CU.
2 Terminal rating is AL7CU.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-229
2.3
Accessories
2
2
ND Frame Accessories
Description
Reference
Page
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-274
Three-Pole
Left
Four-Pole
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-276
V4-T2-278
V4-T2-278
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-282
V4-T2-283
V4-T2-290
V4-T2-291
Neutral
External Accessories
V4-T2-309
Interphase barriers
V4-T2-311
Terminal shield
V4-T2-311
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-313
V4-T2-314
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-315
V4-T2-317
Plug-in adapters
V4-T2-318
V4-T2-319
V4-T2-320
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-425
Handle extension
V4-T2-440
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-322
V4-T2-322
V4-T2-323
Digitrip OPTIMizer
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-323
Special calibration
V4-T2-115
Marine/naval application
2
2
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
May be mounted on left or right polenot both
Accessory available/modification available
Note
OPTIM 550 and 1050 are factory sealed and do not have the right pole available for accessories.
V4-T2-230
2.3
2
2
Number
of Poles
277
480
600
ND
2, 3, 4
65
50
25
CND 2
2, 3, 4
65
50
25
HND
2, 3, 4
100
65
35
CHND 2
2, 3, 4
100
65
35
NDC
2, 3, 4
200
100
65
2, 3, 4
200
100
65
CNDC 2
NDU
300
150
75
2
2
2
2
2
415
690
Icu
2, 3, 4
85
50
20
Ics
2, 3, 4
85
50
10
Icu
2, 3, 4
85
50
20
Ics
2, 3, 4
85
50
10
2, 3, 4
100
70
25
2, 3, 4
100
50
13
Icu
2, 3, 4
100
70
25
Ics
2, 3, 4
100
50
13
Icu
2, 3, 4
200
100
35
Ics
2, 3, 4
100
50
18
Icu
2, 3, 4
200
100
35
Ics
2, 3, 4
100
50
18
ND
CND 2
HND
Icu
Ics
CHND
NDC
CNDC 2
Notes
1 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
2 100% rated breakers.
3 800 amperes maximum rating.
4 Successfully tested at 300 kAIC, although UL recognizes maximum of 200 kAIC at 240 Vac.
5 Successfully tested at 75 kAIC, although UL recognizes maximum of 65 kAIC at 600 Vac.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-231
2.3
2
N-Frame Digitrip
Trip Unit Type
rms sensing
Yes
Yes
Frame
Ampere range
4001200 A
4001200 A
Protection
LSI, LSIG, LSI(A)
LSI(A), LISG
Breaker Type
Ordering options
Fixed rated plug (In)
Yes
Yes
Overtemperature trip
Yes
Yes
No
No
0.41.0 x (In)
0.41.0 x (In)
224 seconds
224 seconds
15 seconds
15 seconds
Yes
Yes
No
0.51.0 x Ir
150800% x (Ir)
150800% x (Ir)
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes
Yes
200800% x (In)
Instantaneous pickup
Discriminator
Yes
Yes
Instantaneous override
Yes
Yes
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
20100% x (Is)
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes 1
Yes
Yes
Yes
Status LEDs
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes 1
Yes
Optional
Included
2
2
2
2
System Diagnostics
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
Note
1 Zone interlock kit.
2
2
2
V4-T2-232
2.3
Yes 1
Yes 1
2
2
System Monitoring
Digital display
Current
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Power qualityharmonics
No
Yes
Power factor
No
Yes
No 2
Yes
OPTIMizer, BIM,
PowerNet
OPTIMizer, BIM,
PowerNet
2
2
2
Communications
Eaton PowerNet
Testing
Testing method
2
2
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting
2
2
Notes
1 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
2 Eatons PowerNet kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-233
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
ND Frame
Number of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
2, 3
4
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
5.50 (139.7)
11.13 (282.6)
16.00 (406.4)
5.50 (139.7)
2
2
3.44
(87.3)
2
2
2
2
2
1.72
(43.6)
1.91
(48.4)
0.25 R
(6.4 R)
CL Handle
CL Handle
16.00
(406.4)
0.19 R
(4.8 R)
3.68
(93.2)
OFF/O
3.19
(80.9)
6.38
(161.9)
8.25
(209.6)
2
2
2
2
ON/I
1.50
(38.1)
2
2
Side View
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
37 (16.8)
45 (20.4)
58 (26.3)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-234
5.50
(139.7)
2.3
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes)
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-236
V4-T2-237
V4-T2-249
V4-T2-250
V4-T2-253
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-235
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
RD 3 16 T53 W
Circuit Breaker/
Frame Type
RD
RDC
CRD 2
CRDC 2
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
Circuit Breaker/Frame
Ampere Rating
16 = 1600 amperes
20 = 2000 amperes
25 = 2500 amperes
T53
T65
T86
T96
T106
T107
Trip Type 1
= Digitrip RMS 510 LS
= Digitrip RMS 610 LSG
= Digitrip RMS 810 LSIG
= Digitrip RMS 910 LSIG
= Digitrip OPTIM 1050 LSIG
= Digitrip OPTIM 1050 LSIA
Notes
1 For complete list of available trip types, refer to Pages V4-T2-237 to V4-T2-246.
2 No four-pole for CRD and CRDC.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-236
W
P
R
K
=
=
=
=
Suffix
Without terminals
100% protected neutral pole
Ground fault remote (310 only)
Molded case switch
2.3
Product Selection
Digitrip RMS 510 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit) and rating plug.
2
2
Digitrip RMS 510 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
2
LSIG
Catalog Number
Rated
Current
(In)
Fixed
Rating Plug
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
Catalog Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
2500
RD316T51W
RD320T51W
RD325T51W
RD316T53W
RD320T53W
RD325T53W
RD316T52W
RD320T52W
RD325T52W
RD316T54W
RD320T54W
RD325T54W
RD316T55W
RD320T55W
RD325T55W
RD316T56W
RD320T56W
RD325T56W
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
2500
RDC316T51W
RDC320T51W
RDC325T51W
RDC316T53W
RDC320T53W
RDC325T53W
RDC316T52W
RDC320T52W
RDC325T52W
RDC316T54W
RDC320T54W
RDC325T54W
RDC316T55W
RDC320T55W
RDC325T55W
RDC316T56W
RDC320T56W
RDC325T56W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-237
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
2
2
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I 2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Rated
Current
(In)
Fixed
Rating Plug
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
2
2
2
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
Catalog Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRD316T51W
CRD316T53W
CRD316T52W
CRD316T54W
CRD316T55W
CRD316T56W
2
2
2000 1
CRD320T51W
CRD320T53W
CRD320T52W
CRD320T54W
CRD320T55W
CRD320T56W
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRDC316T53W
CRDC316T52W
CRDC316T54W
CRDC316T55W
CRDC316T56W
2
2
Catalog Number
2000 1
CRDC320T51W
CRDC320T53W
CRDC320T52W
CRDC320T54W
CRDC320T55W
Note
1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-238
CRDC320T56W
2.3
Digitrip RMS 610 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit) and rating plug.
2
2
Digitrip RMS 610 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
Catalog Number
Rated
Current
(In)
Fixed
Rating Plug
Catalog Number
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
2500
RD316T61W
RD320T61W
RD325T61W
RD316T63W
RD320T63W
RD325T63W
RD316T62W
RD320T62W
RD325T62W
RD316T64W
RD320T64W
RD325T64W
RD316T65W
RD320T65W
RD325T65W
RD316T66W
RD320T66W
RD325T66W
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
2500
RDC316T61W
RDC320T61W
RDC325T61W
RDC316T63W
RDC320T63W
RDC325T63W
RDC316T62W
RDC320T62W
RDC325T62W
RDC316T64W
RDC320T64W
RDC325T64W
RDC316T65W
RDC320T65W
RDC325T65W
RDC316T66W
RDC320T66W
RDC325T66W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-239
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
2
2
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Rated
Current
(In)
Fixed
Rating Plug
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
2
2
2
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
Catalog Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRD316T61W
CRD316T63W
CRD316T62W
CRD316T64W
CRD316T65W
CRD316T66W
2
2
2000 1
CRD320T61W
CRD320T63W
CRD320T62W
CRD320T64W
CRD320T65W
CRD320T66W
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRDC316T61W
CRDC316T63W
CRDC316T62W
CRDC316T64W
CRDC316T65W
CRDC316T66W
2
2
Catalog Number
2000 1
CRDC320T61W
CRDC320T63W
CRDC320T62W
CRDC320T64W
CRDC320T65W
Note
1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-240
CRDC320T66W
2.3
Digitrip RMS 810 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit) and rating plug.
2
2
Digitrip RMS 810 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I 2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
Catalog Number
2000
2500
RD316T81W
RD320T81W
RD325T81W
RD316T83W
RD320T83W
RD325T83W
RD316T82W
RD316T84W
RD320T82W
RD320T84W
RD325T82W
RD325T84W
RD316T85W
RD320T85W
RD325T85W
RD316T86W
RD320T86W
RD325T86W
Fixed
Rating Plug
Catalog Number
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
2500
RDC316T81W
RDC320T81W
RDC325T81W
RDC316T83W
RDC320T83W
RDC325T83W
RDC316T82W
RDC320T82W
RDC325T82W
RDC316T84W
RDC320T84W
RDC325T84W
RDC316T85W
RDC320T85W
RDC325T85W
RDC316T86W
RDC320T86W
RDC325T86W
2
2
2
2
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
Rated
Current
(In)
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-241
2.3
2
2
2
Series C
2
2
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Rated
Current
(In)
Fixed
Rating Plug
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
2
2
2
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
Catalog Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRD316T81W
CRD316T83W
CRD316T82W
CRD316T84W
CRD316T85W
CRD316T86W
2
2
2000 1
CRD320T81W
CRD320T83W
CRD320T82W
CRD320T84W
CRD320T85W
CRD320T86W
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRDC316T81W
CRDC316T83W
CRDC316T82W
CRDC316T84W
CRDC316T85W
CRDC316T86W
2
2
Catalog Number
2000 1
CRDC320T81W
CRDC320T83W
CRDC320T82W
CRDC320T84W
CRDC320T85W
Note
1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-242
CRDC320T86W
2.3
Digitrip RMS 910 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit) and rating plug.
2
2
Digitrip RMS 910 Electronic Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I 2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
Catalog Number
Fixed
Rating Plug
2000
2500
RD316T91W
RD320T91W
RD325T91W
RD316T93W
RD320T93W
RD325T93W
RD316T92W
RD320T92W
RD325T92W
RD316T94W
RD320T94W
RD325T94W
RD316T95W
RD320T95W
RD325T95W
RD316T96W
RD320T96W
RD325T96W
Catalog Number
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
2500
RDC316T91W
RDC320T91W
RDC325T91W
RDC316T93W
RDC320T93W
RDC325T93W
RDC316T92W
RDC320T92W
RDC325T92W
RDC316T94W
RDC320T94W
RDC325T94W
RDC316T95W
RDC320T95W
RDC325T95W
RDC316T96W
RDC320T96W
RDC325T96W
2
2
2
2
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
Rated
Current
(In)
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
RP6R20A200
1600
RP6R25A160
2000
RP6R25A200
2500
RP6R25A250
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-243
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
Series C
2
2
L
S
I
G
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I 2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LI
LS
LSI
LIG
LSG
LSIG
Catalog Number
Rated
Current
(In)
Fixed
Rating Plug
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
Catalog Number
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRD316T91W
CRD316T93W
CRD316T92W
CRD316T94W
CRD316T95W
CRD316T96W
1600
RP6R16A160
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
800
RP6R16A080
1000
RP6R16A100
1000
RP6R16A100
1200
RP6R16A120
1000
RP6R20A100
1200
RP6R20A120
1600
RP6R20A160
2000
RP6R20A200
2000 1
CRD320T91W
CRD320T93W
CRD320T92W
CRD320T94W
CRD320T95W
CRD320T96W
2
2
2
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRDC316T91W
CRDC316T93W
CRDC316T92W
CRDC316T94W
CRDC316T95W
CRDC316T96W
2
2
2000 1
CRDC320T91W
CRDC320T93W
CRDC320T92W
CRDC320T94W
CRDC320T95W
Note
1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-244
CRDC320T96W
2.3
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
L
S
I
G
A
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LSIA 1050
LSIG 1050
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Fixed
Rating Plug
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
800
ORPR16A080
1000
ORPR16A100
1200
ORPR16A120
1600
ORPR16A160
1000
ORPR20A100
1200
ORPR20A120
1600
ORPR20A160
2000
ORPR20A200
1600
ORPR25A160
2000
ORPR25A200
2500
ORPR25A250
800
ORPR16A080
1000
ORPR16A100
1200
ORPR16A120
1600
ORPR16A160
1000
ORPR20A100
1200
ORPR20A120
1600
ORPR20A160
2000
ORPR20A200
1600
ORPR25A160
2000
ORPR25A200
2500
ORPR25A250
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
2500
RD316T107W
RD320T107W
RD325T107W
RD316T106W
RD320T106W
RD325T106W
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000
2500
RDC316T107W
RDC320T107W
RDC325T107W
RDC316T106W
RDC320T106W
RDC325T106W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-245
2.3
2
100% Rated 600 Volts AC Digitrip OPTIM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Order as individual components: breaker frame (which includes trip unit) and rating plug.
2
2
100% Rated 600 Volts AC Digitrip OPTIM Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Rating Plugs
Circuit Breaker Frame Only
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
L
S
I
G
A
Adjustable Long Delay Pickup (Ir) with Adjustable Long Delay Time
Adjustable Short Delay Pickup with Adjustable Short Delay Time (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Instantaneous Pickup
Adjustable Ground Fault Pickup with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
Adjustable Ground Fault Alarm with Adjustable Ground Fault Time Delay (I2t or Flat Response)
LSIA 1050
LSIG 1050
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Fixed
Rating Plug
Ampere
Rating
Catalog
Number
800
ORPR16A080
1000
ORPR16A100
1200
ORPR16A120
Three-Pole Standard Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 65 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
CRD316T107W
CRD316T106W
1600
ORPR16A160
1000
ORPR20A100
1200
ORPR20A120
1600
ORPR20A160
2000
ORPR20A200
800
ORPR16A080
1000
ORPR16A100
1200
ORPR16A120
1600
ORPR16A160
1000
ORPR20A100
1200
ORPR20A120
1600
ORPR20A160
2000
ORPR20A200
2000 1
CRD320T107W
Three-Pole High Interrupting Capacity 600 Vac Rated 100 kAIC at 480 Vac
1600
2000 1
CRDC316T107W
2
2
2
2
2
2
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
at 40 C
CRDC316T106W
CRDC320T107W
CRD320T106W
CRDC320T106W
Four-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
1600
RD316WK
RD416WK
2000
RD320WK
RD420WK
Notes
1 Includes B2016RDL rear connectors.
Molded case switch may trip above 17,500 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-246
2.3
Ordering Information
R-Frame circuit breakers have
Cu/AI terminals as standard
and Cu only terminals as an
option. Specify if factory
installation is required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal
Body
Material
Wire
Type
Hardware
AWG/kcmil
Wire Range/
No. Conductors
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
2
2
Wire Terminals
1600
Aluminum
Cu/AI
English
5001000 (4)
300500
TA1600RD
1600
Copper
Cu
English
1600 (4)
50300
T1600RD
2000
Aluminum
Cu/AI
English
2600 (6)
35300
TA2000RD 1
English
B2016RD
Rear Connectors
2000
Copper
2000
Copper
English
B2016RDL
2500
Copper
English
B2500RD 3
2
2
Notes
1 Catalog Number includes bus connection, terminals and hardware for either line side or load side of three-pole breaker.
2 For use with 100% rated 1600 A and 2000 A frame. Do not order separately unless for replacement purposes. Included in breaker carton when
100% rated device is ordered.
3 For use with 2500 A frame. Do not order separately unless for replacement purposes. Included in breaker carton when 2500 A breaker is ordered.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-247
2.3
2
2
Mounting Hardware
Breaker Line/Load
Conductors
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
TA2000RD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-248
2.3
Accessories
RD Frame Accessories
Description
Reference
Page
Three-Pole
Left
Four-Pole
Center
Right
Left
Center
Right
Neu.
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-274
V4-T2-274
Shunt tripstandard
V4-T2-282
V4-T2-283
V4-T2-290
V4-T2-291
2
2
2
External Accessories
Base mounting hardware
V4-T2-309
V4-T2-312
V4-T2-314
V4-T2-315
2
2
Internal Accessories 1
2
2
2
V4-T2-317
Handle mechanisms
V4-T2-425
Handle extension 3
V4-T2-440
V4-T2-323
Digitrip OPTIMizer
V4-T2-323
V4-T2-323
Special calibration
V4-T2-115
Marine/naval application
2
2
Legend
Applicable in indicated pole position
Accessory available/modification available
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
All accessories mount in the RH cavity which will accept one each shunt trip, UVR, auxiliary switch and alarm switch.
2 Mounts outside breaker.
3 Included with breaker.
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-249
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
Circuit
Breaker
Type
Number
of Poles
277
480
600
RD
3, 4
125
65
50
50
CRD 2
125
65
RDC
3, 4
200
100
65
CRDC 2
200
100
65
2
2
2
2
2
415
690
Icu
3, 4
135
70
25
Ics
3, 4
100
50
13
RD
RDC
Icu
3, 4
200
100
35
Ics
3, 4
100
50
18
2
2
Notes
1 Utilization Category A circuit breakers.
2 100% rated breakers.
See Page V4-T2-251 for Trip Unit Specifications.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-250
2.3
Specifications
2
2
R-Frame Digitrip
Trip Unit Type
Digitrip
RMS 510
Digitrip
RMS 610
Digitrip
RMS 810
Digitrip
RMS 910
Digitrip
OPTIM 1050
rms sensing
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Frame
Ampere range
8002500 A
8002500 A
8002500 A
8002500 A
8002500 A
LSI(A), LISG
2
2
Breaker Type
Protection
Ordering options
Fixed rated plug (In)
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Overtemperature trip
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
No
No
No
No
0.51.0 x (In)
0.51.0 x (In)
0.51.0 x (In)
0.41.0 x (In)
224 seconds
224 seconds
224 seconds
224 seconds
224 seconds
No
No
No
No
15 Seconds
2
2
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
0.85 x Ir
0.85 x Ir
0.85 x Ir
0.5-1.0 x Ir
200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
200600%
S1 and S2 x (Ir)
150-800% x (Ir) 12
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
200600%
M1and M2 x (In)
200600%
M1and M2 x (In)
200600%
M1and M2 x (In)
200600%
M1and M2 x (In)
200800% x (In) 2
2
2
Yes 3
Yes 3
Yes 3
Yes 3
Yes
Instantaneous override
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
2
2
No
No
No
No
25100% x (In)
25100% x (Is)
25-100% x (Is)
25100% x (Is)
25100% x (Is)
25100% x (In)
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
100 500 ms
100500 ms
100500 ms
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
2
2
2
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting x In
2
2
2
Notes
1 Except 2500 ampere frame is 200600%.
2 Varies by frame.
3 LS/LSG only.
4 Not to exceed 1200 amperes.
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-251
2.3
Digitrip
RMS 510
Digitrip
RMS 610
Digitrip
RMS 810
Digitrip
RMS 910
Digitrip
OPTIM 1050
Yes
System Diagnostics
Status LEDs
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Digital display
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes 1
System Monitoring
Current
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Voltage
No
No
No
Yes
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Power qualityharmonics
No
No
No
Yes
Yes
Power factor
No
No
Yes (over
Eaton PowerNet only)
Yes
Yes
Communications
No
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Testing
Integral
Integral
Integral
Integral
OPTIMizer, BIM,
PowerNet
Eaton PowerNet
Testing method
Legend
BIM = Breaker Interface Module
(A) = GF Alarm
Is = Sensor Rating
In = Rating Plug
Ir = Long Delay Pickup Setting x In
Note
1 By OPTIMizer/BIM.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-252
2.3
RD Frame
Number
of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
15.50 (393.7)
16.00 (406.4)
9.75 (247.7)
20.00 (508.0)
16.00 (406.4)
9.75 (247.7)
2
2
2
Front View
7.25
(184.2)
14.50
(368.3)
15.50
(393.7)
Side View
9.00
(228.6)
C
L Breaker
5.09
(129.4)
9.69
(246.1)
7.75
(196.9)
C
L Handle
16.00
(406.4)
15.00
(381.0)
Push
To
Trip
6.65
(166.7)
12.91
(327.8)
0.16
(4.0)
R Typ.
2
2
RD Frame
Complete Breaker
Breaker Type
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
102 (46.3)
135 (61.2)
2
2
1600 Amperes
RD, CRD 1, RDC, CRDC 1
2000 Amperes
RD, RDC
102 (46.3)
135 (61.2)
CRD, CRDC
130 (59.0)
175 (79.4)
135 (61.2)
182 (82.6)
2500 Amperes
RD, RDC
Note
1 No four-pole for CRD and CRDC.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-253
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP)
Catalog Number Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
An innovative design of
internal components allows
higher MCP-starter
combination interrupting
ratings. The MCP is marked
to permit proper electrical
application within the
assigned equipment ratings.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Note: Interrupting ratings are
dependent on starter it is used
with.
2
2
V4-T2-254
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-255
V4-T2-256
V4-T2-257
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2.3
2
2
HMCP 003 A0 C
Motor Circuit
Protective Type
HMCP = Three-pole
HM2P = Two-pole 1
HMCPS = Three-pole
Continuous Ampere
Rating
003
007
015
025
030
050
A0 =
C0 =
E0 =
D0 =
H1 =
G2 =
K2 =
J2 =
M2 =
L3 =
R3 =
T4 =
U4 =
A5 =
C5 =
D5 =
F5 =
G5 =
J5 =
K5 =
L5 =
W5 =
N5 =
R5 =
X5 =
Y5 =
L6 =
X6 =
Y6 =
X7 =
Y8 =
070
100
150
250
400
600
800
1200
2
2
Suffix
Non-aluminum terminals
Without terminals
Load terminals only
Line terminals only
Stainless steel terminals
(150A frame only)
No Suffix: Standard terminals on line and load
C =
W=
X =
Y =
S =
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
GMCP 003 A0 C
Motor Circuit
Protective Device
GMCP = Three-pole
Continuous
Ampere
Rating
003
007
015
030
050
060
063
Magnetic Trip
Range/NEMA
Starter Size
A0 = 1530/0
C0 = 3570/0
E0 = 75150/0
H1 = 150300/1
K2 = 250500/2
J2 = 300600/2
M2 = 320630/2
2
2
Suffix
C = Non-aluminum terminals
2
2
2
2
Note
1 On J- and K-Frame HMCPs only.
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-255
2.3
Product Selection
G-Frame
2
2
Continuous
Amperes
Cam Setting
MCP
Trip Setting
MCP
Catalog Number
1.11.2
15
GMCP003A0C
1.31.5
18
1.61.7
21
1.81.9
24
2.02.2
27
2
2
2
2.32.5
30
2.63.1
35
3.23.6
42
3.73.9
49
4.34.7
56
4.85.2
63
5.35.7
70
5.76.8
75
6.97.9
90
8.09.1
105
9.210.3
120
10.411.4
135
11.512.6
150
11.513.7
150
13.816.0
180
16.118.3
210
18.420.6
240
20.722.9
270
23.025.2
300
19.322.9
250
23.026.8
300
26.930.6
350
30.734.5
400
34.638.3
450
38.442.1
500
23.127.5
300
27.732.2
360
32.336.7
420
36.941.4
480
41.546.0
540
46.250.5
600
24.232.1
320
29.134.8
380
38.846.4
500
43.648.9
570
48.553.7
630
2
2
2
15
30
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
50
60
63
GMCP007C0C
GMCP015E0C
GMCP030H1C
GMCP050K2C
GMCP060J2C
GMCP063M2C
Notes
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate Cam settings and/or
MCP ratings should be used.
All GMCP 363A come with line and load steel body terminals for Cu only wire. Refer to Page V4-T2-121 under Optional Terminal Types.
UL recognized and CSA approved.
V4-T2-256
2.3
Accessories
2
2
Internal Accessories 1
Electrical Ratings
Type Accessory
Volts
Frequency
Amperes
Contact
Arrangement
Shunt trip 2
120
50/60 Hz
1.1
S5
1373D62G18
Shunt trip 2
240
50/60 Hz
2.1
S6
1373D62G19
Auxiliary switch 3
240
50/60 Hz
6.0
1A/1B
A3
1288C74G03
Auxiliary switch 3
240
50/60 Hz
6.0
2A/2B
A6
1288C73G03
Alarm switch
Factory
Suffix
Style
Number
2
2
240
50/60 Hz
6.0
Make/Break
B3
1288C75G03
240
50/60 Hz
6.0
1A/1B Make/Break
B13
1288C76G09
Number Units
in Package
Style
Number
1294C01H01
Mounting hardware
624B375G23
10
1225C79G02
2
2
2
2
2
GMCP-Frame
IP
Catalog
Number
1/3R/12
54
GMHMVD12B / 68C6039G05
4/4X
65
GMHMVD12BX / 68C6039G07
1/3R/12
54
GMHMVD12R / 68C6039G06
4/4X
65
GMHMVD12RX / 68C6039G08
Description
NEMA
2
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms
G Direct 5
Black Handle
Yellow Handle
With Shroud
Without Shroud
With Shroud
Without Shroud
Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
GMCP
HRGMC1S
HRGMC10
HRGMC3S
HRGMC30
Notes
1 Only one accessory may be installed in GMCP.
2 LH only.
3 RH only.
4 For use with standard 35 mm DIN rail such as, 35 x 7.5 or 15 mm per DIN EN50022.
5 Suitable for use on two- or three-pole G-Frame.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-257
2.3
F-Frame
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes
(FLA) 1
MCP
Trip
Setting
MCP
Trip
Setting
2
MCP
Catalog
Number
HMCP070M2C
MCP
Catalog
Number
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
0.690.91
HMCP003A0C
70
16.121.4
210
0.921.0
12
21.5 26.8
280
1.11.2
15
26.9 32.2
350
1.31.5
18
32.337.5
420
1.61.7
21
37.642.9
490
1.81.9
24
43.048.3
560
2.02.2
27
48.453.7
630
2.32.5
30
53.859.1
700
1.52.0
21
23.030.6
300
2.12.5
28
30.738.3
400
2.63.1
35
38.446.0
500
3.23.6
42
46.153.7
600
3.73.9
49
53.8 61.4
700
4.34.7
56
61.5 69.1
800
4.85.2
63
69.276.8
900
5.35.7
70
76.984.5
1000
3.44.5
45
34.646.0
450
4.65.6
60
46.157.5
600
5.76.8
75
57.669.1
750
6.97.9
90
69.280.6
900
8.09.1
105
69.280.6
900
9.210.3
120
80.792.2
1050
10.411.4
135
92.3103.7
1200
11.5 12.6
150
103.8115.2
1350
15
6.99.1
90
9.211.4
120
11.513.7
100
150
115.3126.7
1500
57.0 75.0
750
150
76.095.0
1000
13.816.0
180
96.0114.0
1250
16.118.3
210
115.0130.7
1500
18.420.6
240
1750
20.722.9
270
2000
23.025.2
300
2250
11.515.2
150
2500
15.319.1
200
19.222.9
250
23.026.8
300
26.930.6
350
30.74.5
400
34.638.3
450
38.442.1
500
30
HMCP015E0C
HMCP007C0C
50
HMCP030H1C
Cam
Setting
150
HMCP050K2C
HMCP150T4C
HMCP150U4C
Notes
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate Cam
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Settings above 130 amperes are for special applications. NEC Article 430.110(a) requires the
ampere rating of the disconnecting means to be not less than 115% of the motor full load
ampere rating.
HMCP 3100 A come with line and load steel body terminals, 3T100FB. HMCP 150A come with
line and load steel body terminals, 3T150FB.
2
2
2
V4-T2-258
HMCP100R3C
2.3
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
MCP
Trip
Setting 1
MCP
Catalog
Number
25
40
HMCP025D0C
43
49
52
55
58
60
80
87
93
98
103
109
115
120
115
122
130
139
145
153
160
170
50
70
100
160
174
185
196
207
218
229
240
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP050G2C
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP070J2C
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP100L3C
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
HMCP 25100 A come with line and load steel body terminals, 3T100FB.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-259
2.3
MCPs for Application with Motor Starters Equipped with Electronic Overload Relays
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Motor Full
Load Current
Amperes
(FLA) 1
MCP
Trip
Setting
B
C
D
E
MCP
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
Number
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
0.690.91
HMCPS003A0C
100
0.921.0
12
1.11.2
15
38.446.0
500
1.31.5
18
46.153.7
600
1.61.7
21
53.861.4
700
1.81.9
24
61.569.1
800
2.02.2
27
69.276.8
900
2.32.5
30
76.984.5
1000
1.52.0
21
34.646.0
450
2.12.5
28
46.157.5
600
2.63.1
35
57.669.1
750
3.23.6
42
69.280.6
900
3.73.9
49
80.792.2
1050
4.34.7
56
92.3103.7
1200
4.85.2
63
103.8115.2
1350
5.35.7
70
115.3126.7
1500
3.44.5
45
57.075.0
750
4.65.6
60
76.095.0
1000
5.76.8
75
96.0114.0
1250
6.97.9
90
115.0130.7
1500
8.09.1
105
1750
9.210.3
120
2000
10.411.4
135
2250
11.512.6
150
2500
6.99.1
90
9.211.4
120
11.513.7
150
13.816.0
180
16.118.3
210
18.420.6
240
20.722.9
270
23.025.2
300
11.515.2
150
15.319.1
200
19.222.9
250
23.026.8
300
26.930.6
350
30.734.5
400
34.638.3
450
38.442.1
500
15
30
2
2
50
2
2
HMCPS007C0C
HMCPS015E0C
HMCPS030H1C
150
150
MCP
Catalog
Number
23.030.6
300
HMCPS100R3C
30.738.3
400
HMCPS150T4C
HMCPS150U4C
Notes
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Settings above 130A are for special applications. NEC Article 430.110(a) requires the
ampere rating of the disconnecting means to be not less than 115% of the motor full load
ampere rating.
HMCP 25100 A come with line and load steel body terminals, 3T100FB.
HMCPS 3100 A come with line and load steel body terminals, 3T100FB. HMCPS 150A come
with line and load steel body terminals, 3T150FB.
HMCPS050K2C
2
2
2
V4-T2-260
Cam
Setting
2.3
J-Frame
MCP
Catalog
Number 3
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes
(FLA) 1
27.030.7
350
HMCP250A5C
250
67.475.3
30.833.8
400
75.483.8
980
33.936.9
440
83.992.3
1090
37.040.3
480
92.4100.7
1200
40.443.8
525
100.8109.2
1310
43.946.9
570
109.3117.6
1420
47.050.7
610
117.7126.1
1530
47.050.7
660
126.2134.6
1640
47.050.7
700
34.738.8
450
38.943.4
43.547.6
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes
(FLA) 1
250
250
250
250
250
250
MCP
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
Number 3
875
HMCP250J5C
134.7142.8
1750
77.086.6
1000
505
86.696.1
1125
565
96.2105.7
1250
47.752.2
620
105.8115.3
1375
52.356.5
680
115.4124.9
1500
56.660.7
735
125.0134.6
1625
60.864.9
790
134.7144.2
1750
65.069.2
845
144.3153.8
1875
69.373.5
900
153.9163.3
2000
38.543.4
500
86.697.3
1125
43.548.0
565
97.4108.4
1265
48.153.0
625
108.5118.8
1410
53.157.6
690
118.9129.9
1545
57.762.3
750
130.0140.7
1690
62.467.3
810
140.8151.5
1830
67.471.9
875
151.6162.3
1970
72.076.9
935
162.4173.0
2110
77.081.6
1000
173.1183.6
2250
48.153.8
625
96.2108.0
1250
53.959.9
700
108.1119.9
1405
60.066.1
780
120.0132.3
1560
66.272.3
860
132.4144.2
1720
72.478.4
940
144.3156.1
1875
78.583.8
1020
156.2168.0
2030
83.989.9
1090
168.1179.9
2185
90.096.1
1170
180.0192.3
2340
96.2102.0
1250
192.4204.0
2500
57.764.6
750
64.771.9
840
72.079.2
935
79.386.5
1030
86.693.8
1125
93.9101.1
1220
101.2108.4
1315
108.5115.3
1410
115.4122.4
1500
HMCP250C5C
HMCP250D5C
HMCP250F5C
HMCP250G5C
250
250
250
MCP
Trip
Setting
2
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP250K5C
2
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP250L5C
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP250W5C
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 times the minimum FLA
value shown. Where a 13 times setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate
cam settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Three-pole catalog numbers shown. Two-pole catalog numbers begin with HM2P in place
of HMCP.
All HMCP and HM2P 250A come with line and load steel body terminals, T250KB. (With suffix
C, without C comes with TA250KB.)
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-261
2.3
K-Frame
2
2
MCP
Catalog
Number 3
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
27.030.7
350
HMCP400A5C
400
30.833.8
400
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
400
A
B
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes
(FLA) 1
MCP
Trip
Setting
MCP
Trip
Setting
2
MCP
Catalog
Number 3
77.086.5
1000
HMCP400K5C
86.696.1
1125
33.936.9
440
37.040.3
480
40.443.8
525
115.4124.9
1500
43.946.9
570
125.0134.6
1625
47.050.7
610
134.7144.2
1750
50.853.8
660
144.3153.8
1875
53.957.2
700
153.9163.3
2000
38.543.4
500
86.697.3
1125
43.548.0
565
97.4108.4
1265
48.153.0
626
108.5118.8
1410
53.157.6
690
118.9129.9
1545
57.762.3
750
130.0140.7
1690
62.467.3
810
140.8151.5
1830
67.471.9
875
151.6162.3
1970
72.076.9
935
162.4173.0
2110
77.081.6
1000
173.1183.6
2250
48.153.8
625
96.2108.0
1250
53.959.9
700
108.1119.9
1405
60.066.1
780
120.0132.3
1560
66.272.3
860
132.4144.2
1720
72.478.4
940
144.3156.1
1875
78.583.8
1020
156.2168.0
2030
83.989.9
1090
168.1179.9
2185
90.096.1
1170
180.0192.3
2340
96.2102.0
1250
192.4204.0
2500
57.764.6
750
115.4129.9
1500
64.771.9
840
130.0144.2
1690
72.079.2
935
144.3158.4
1875
79.386.5
1030
158.5173.0
2060
86.693.8
1125
173.1187.6
2250
93.9101.1
1220
187.7201.9
2440
101.2108.4
1315
202.0216.1
2625
108.5115.3
1410
216.2230.7
2810
115.4122.4
1500
230.8244.9
3000
67.475.3
875
75.483.8
980
83.992.3
1090
92.4100.7
1200
100.8109.2
1310
109.3117.6
1420
117.7126.1
1530
126.2134.6
1640
134.7142.8
1750
400
400
2
2
400
400
400
V4-T2-262
HMCP400A5C
HMCP400D5C
HMCP400F5C
HMCP400G5C
HMCP400J5C
400
400
400
96.2105.7
1250
105.8115.3
1375
HMCP400L5C
HMCP400W5C
HMCP400N5C
Notes
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Three-pole catalog numbers shown. Two-pole catalog numbers begin with HM2P in place
of HMCP.
All HMCP and HM2P 400 A come with aluminum body terminals, 3TA400K. Catalog numbers
with suffix C as shown above come with copper body terminals 3T400K.
2.3
L-Frame
600 Vac Maximum, 250 Vdc Maximum, continued
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes
(FLA) 1
400
400
400
MCP
Catalog
Number 3
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
Cam
Setting
Motor
Full Load
Current
Amperes
(FLA) 1
134.7151.5
1750
HMCP400R5C
600
138.5184.5
1800
151.6168.4
1970
184.6230.7
2400
168.5185.3
2190
230.8276.8
3000
185.4201.9
2410
276.9323.0
3600
202.0218.8
2625
323.1369.1
4200
218.9235.7
2845
369.2415.3
4800
235.8252.6
3065
415.4461.4
5400
252.7269.2
3285
461.5507.7
6000
38.546.1
500
46.261.4
600
MCP
Trip
Setting
MCP
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
Number
HMCP600L6W
269.3285.7
3500
153.9173.0
2000
173.1192.3
2250
61.576.8
800
192.4211.5
2500
76.996.1
1000
211.6230.7
2750
96.2115.3
1250
230.8249.9
3000
115.4153.7
1500
250.0269.2
3250
153.8192.2
2000
269.3288.4
3500
288.5307.6
3750
307.7326.9
4000
173.1194.5
2250
194.6216.1
2530
216.2237.6
2810
192.3230.7
2500
237.7259.5
3090
230.8269.1
3000
259.6281.1
3375
269.2307.6
3500
281.2302.6
3655
307.7346.1
4000
302.7324.1
3935
324.2346.1
4215
346.2368.1
4500
600
HMCP400X5C
HMCP400Y5C
600
192.3230.7
2500
76.996.1
1000
96.2115.3
1250
115.4153.7
1500
153.8192.2
2000
2
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP600X6W
2
2
2
2
2
HMCP600Y6W
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13 x the minimum FLA
value shown. Where a 13 x setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam
settings and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2 For DC applications, actual trip levels are approximately 40% higher than values shown.
3 Three-pole catalog numbers shown. Two-pole catalog numbers begin with HM2P in place
of HMCP.
4 Equipped with electronic trip device.
All HMCP and HM2P 400 A come with aluminum body terminals, 3TA400K. Catalog numbers
with suffix C as shown above come with copper body terminals 3T400K.
All HMCP 600 A come without terminals. For terminals, see Page V4-T2-215.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-263
2.3
N-Frame
NEMA
Starter
Size
Cont.
Amps
800
Cam
Setting
Motor Full
Load Current
Amperes (FLA) 2
MCP
Trip
Setting
MCP
Catalog
Number
HMCP800X7W
123.1184.5
1600
184.6246.1
2400
246.2307.6
3200
307.7369.1
4000
369.2430.7
4800
430.8492.2
5600
492.3553.7
6400
184.6276.8
2400
276.9369.1
3600
369.2461.4
4800
461.5553.7
6000
553.8646.1
7200
646.2738.4
8400
738.5830.7
9600
2
2
2
2
2
1200
2
2
2
2
HMCP12Y8W
Notes
1 Equipped with electronic trip device.
2 Motor FLA ranges are typical. The corresponding trip setting is at 13X the minimum FLA value
shown. Where a 13X setting is required for an intermediate FLA value, alternate cam settings
and/or MCP ratings should be used.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-264
2.3
Contents
Description
Page
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB)
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-266
V4-T2-266
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Disconnecting means
Branch circuit short-circuit
protection
Overload protection
Time delay of 1 or
2 seconds before
breaker trips
Thermal memory to
prevent immediate restart
after overload trip to allow
motor to cool down
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-265
2.3
Product Selection
2
2
2
2
2
Continuous Amperes
35 kA With Phase
Unbalance and Adjustable
Motor Class Protection
65 kA With Phase
Unbalance and Adjustable
Motor Class Protection
80
FDMP3080L
FDMP3080JL
HFDMP3080L
HFDMP3080JL
100
FDMP3100L
FDMP3100JL
HFDMP3100L
HFDMP3100JL
160
FDMP3160L
FDMP3160JL
HFDMP3160L
HFDMP3160JL
205
FDMP3205L
FDMP3205JL
HFDMP3205L
HFDMP3205JL
80
40
50
60
70
80
100
80
90
100
160
100
115
130
145
160
205
160
170
180
195
205
2
2
Specifications
2
2
Feature
FDMP
HFDMP
65 kA
100 kA
35 kA
65 kA
18 kA
25 kA
Icu/Ics at 240 V
65 kA/33 kA 1
100 kA/50 kA 1
Icu/Ics at 415 V
35 kA/18 kA 1
65 kA/33 kA 1
100% rated
No
No
40205
40205
5, 10, 15, 20
5, 10, 15, 20
Yes
Yes
Pre-detection relays
Factory installed
Factory installed
Internal accessories
Notes
1 IEC ratings available only on FWMP and HFWMP.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-266
2.3
Contents
Description
Page
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04)
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Selection
Limiters are coordinated with
the MCP so that normal fault
currents are interrupted
automatically by the MCP
without any damage to the
limiter. Only the rare very
high fault is opened by
the limiter. Faults that are
interrupted by the limiter
also magnetically trip the
MCP, opening all three
poles, preventing singlephase operation.
Each of the three poles of the
Type ELC limiter is equipped
with an indicator that extends
when a fault is interrupted by
the limiter.
Catalog
Number
ELC3003R
ELC3007R
15
ELC3015R
30
ELC3030R
50
ELC3050R
100
ELC3100R
150
ELC3150R
2
2
2
2
2
2
Wire Range
AWG
Metric
(mm2)
50
142
2.535
100
14/0
5095
150
14/0
5095
50
142 2
2.535
100
150
2
2
2
Notes
1 Terminal wire connectors are UL listed for standard stranded wire sizes as defined in
UL 486A or UL 486B.
2 Optional on special order for copper cable only.
All HMCP 800 A and 1200 A come without terminals. For terminals, see Page V4-T2-215.
V4-T2-267
2
2
2
2
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Page
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-269
V4-T2-270
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
Product Overview
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-268
Application Description
High-performance breakers
are most commonly applied
when very high fault levels
are available and with
applications where the
current limiting capability is
used upstream of the final
load to limit current. Typical
loads include lighting, power
distribution, and motor
control applications.
UL 489
CSA C22.2
2.3
Product Selection
2
2
Product
Amperes
FDC 3P thermal-magnetic
Breaker only
15225
100
35
With limiter
40200
200
200
2
2
2
FD Frame
40
FDC3040Q01
FDC3040Q02
45
FDC3045Q01
FDC3045Q02
50
FDC3050Q01
FDC3050Q02
60
FDC3060Q01
FDC3060Q02
70
FDC3070Q01
FDC3070Q02
80
FDC3080Q01
FDC3080Q02
90
FDC3090Q01
FDC3090Q02
100
FDC3100Q01
FDC3100Q02
110
FDC3110Q01
FDC3110Q02
125
FDC3125Q01
FDC3125Q02
150
FDC3150Q01
FDC3150Q02
175
FDC3175Q01
FDC3175Q02
200
FDC3200Q01
FDC3200Q02
Ampere
Rating
2
2
Thermal-Magnetic
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Limiter Terminals
Maximum
Breaker Amperes
Terminal
Body Material
Wire Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
Cu/Al
10185
#8350 (1)
TA250FJ 4
2
2
Aluminum
Terminal
Body Material
Wire Type
AWG Wire
Range
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Package of
Three Terminals
Catalog Number
2
2
2
Steel
Cu/AI
141/0
2.550
3T100FB
225
Aluminum
Cu/AI
44/0
2595
3TA225FD
2
2
Notes
1 Line and load terminal included.
2 Two interphase barriers provided, mounted on line end of limiter, catalog number FJ1PBK.
3 Four interphase barriers provided, (2) line end of breaker, (2) load end of limiter.
4 Load side breaker terminations included for units configured with line mounted limiters.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-269
2.3
2
2
2
Height
Width
Depth
FD + limiter
12.06 (306.3)
4.13 (104.9)
3.39 (86.1)
8.50 (3.86)
2
2
2
2
4.13
(104.9)
4.12
(104.6)
2
2
2
2
12.06
(306.3)
2
2
2
3.34
(84.8)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-270
3.96
(100.5)
3.39
(86.1)
2.3
Contents
Description
Page
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module. . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-273
V4-T2-292
V4-T2-302
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Internal Accessories
Product Overview
Alarm Switch
For remote indication of
automatic trip operation.
Does not function with
manual switching; however,
it will operate when either a
shunt trip or undervoltage
release is operated. A
make contact closes and a
break contact opens when
the alarm/lockout switch
operates. The switch
automatically resets when
the circuit breaker is reset.
Auxiliary Switch
The auxiliary switch provides
circuit breaker contact status
information by monitoring the
position of the molded cross
bar that contains the moving
contact arms. The auxiliary
switch is used for remote
indication and interlock
system verification, and
consists of one or two SPDT
switches housed in a plug-in
module. Each SPDT switch
has one a and one b
contact. When the circuit
breaker contacts are open,
the a contact is open and
the b contact is closed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-271
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Undervoltage Release
Mechanism
The undervoltage release
mechanism monitors a
voltage (typically a line
voltage) and trips the circuit
breaker when the voltage
falls to between 70 and 35
percent of the solenoid coil
rating.
The undervoltage release
mechanism consists of a
continuous rated solenoid
with a plunger and tripping
lever mounted in a plug-in
module. The tab on the
tripping lever resets the
undervoltage release
mechanism when normal
voltage has been restored
and the circuit breaker handle
is moved to the reset (or OFF)
position. With less than
pickup voltage applied to the
undervoltage release
mechanism, the circuit
breaker contacts will not
touch when a closing
operation is attempted.
For convenience in
determining the appropriate
number of terminal block
points required, refer
to Page V4-T2-272.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-272
2.3
Product Selection
Alarm Switch
Alarm Switch
Electrical Ratings
Make
Frequency
Amperes
Contact
Arrangement
Factory
Suffix
Catalog
Number 234
1 Make/1 Break
B3
1288C75G03
B13
1288C76G09
Alarm Switch
Break
240
50/60 Hz
50/60 Hz
Factory Mounted
Terminal Block
Number of
Contacts
(Make and
Break)
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 6
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left 7
B01
B02
B03
B04
A1L1LPK
A1L1LTK
Right
B05
B06
B07
B08
A1L1RPK
A1L1RTK
1 (Make only)
Left
B09
B10
B11
A2L1LPK
A2L1LTK
Right
B12
B13
B14
A2L1RPK
A2L1RTK
Single-pole
B15 8
2
2
2
Factory Mounted
Terminal Block
Number of
Contacts
(Make and
Break)
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 6
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left 7
B01
B02
B03
B04
MA1L1LPK
MA1L1LTK
Right
B05
B06
B07
B08
MA1L1RPK
MA1L1RTK
B09
B10
B11
MA2L1LPK
MA2L1LTK
B12
B13
B14
MA2L1RPK
MA2L1RTK
Left
Right
2
2
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Number of
Contacts
(Make and
Break)
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 7
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left j
B01
B02
B03
B04
A1L2LPK
A1L2LTK
Right
B05
B06
B07
B08
A1L2RPK
A1L2RTK 6
Notes
1 F-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory. Internal accessories are UL listed for
factory installation under E7819. Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation
should be done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2 Includes 24-inch (609.6 mm) external pigtail leads,18 AWG (160.010).
3 A maximum of two internal accessories may be mounted in a three-pole circuit breaker.
4 Suitable for mounting in right pole only of two- or three-pole breaker.
5 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation.
6 Standard pigtail lead exit location.
7 Standard mounting location.
8 Factory installation only. Leads exit load end of circuit breaker.
9 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation on interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
j Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-273
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
Series C
Number of
Sets of
Contacts
(1M and 1B)
1
2
2
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
A1L3LTK
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Left 3
B01
B02
B03
B04
A1L3LPK
Right 4
B05
B06
B07
B08
A1L3RPK
A1L3RTK
Left 3
B09
B10
B11
A2L3LPK
A2L3LTK
Right 4
B12
B13
B14
A2L3RPK
A2L3RTK
2
2
Factory Mounted
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
B03
B04
A1L4LPK
A1L4LTK
B07
B08
A1L4RPK
A1L4RTK
B10
B11
A2L4LPK
A2L4LTK
B13
B14
A2L4RPK
A2L4RTK
Number of
Sets of
Contacts
(1M and 1B)
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Left 3
B01
B02
Right
B05
B06
Left 3
B09
Right
B12
2
2
2
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Number of
Sets of
Contacts
(1M and 1B)
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Left
B01
B02
B03
B04
A1L5LPK
A1L5LTK
Right 3
B05
B06
B07
B08
A1L5RPK
A1L5RTK
Left
B09
B10
B11
A2L5LPK
A2L5LTK
B12
B13
B14
A2L5RPK
A2L5RTK
2
2
Right
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Pigtail Leads
Number of Contacts
(Make and Break)
Suffix
Number 6
Catalog
Number 6
B05
A1L6RPK
B12
A2L6RPK
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation on interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
2 Standard mounting location.
3 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
4 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
5 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
6 A maximum of three ASL plug-in modules may be installed in a circuit breaker.
2
2
2
V4-T2-274
2.3
Auxiliary Switch
Auxiliary Switch
2
Electrical Ratings
a
b
Frequency
Amperes
Contact
Arrangement
Factory
Suffix
Catalog
Number 12
240
50/60 Hz
1a/1b
A3
1288C74G03
240
50/60 Hz
2a/2b
A6
1288C73G03
2
2
2
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Number of
Contacts
A and B
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Rear 3
Suffix
Number
Opposite Side
Suffix
Number
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left 5
A01
A02
A03
A04
A1X1PK
A1X1LTK
Left 5
A15 7
A16 7
A17 7
E1X1PK
A05
A06
A07
A08
A1X1PK
A1X1RTK 8
Right or Neutral 6
Right or Neutral
2
A18
A19
A20
Left 5
A09
A10
A11
A2X1LPK
A2X1LTK
Left 5
A21 7
A22 7
E2X1LPK
Right or Neutral 6
A12
A13
A14
A2X1RPK
A2X1RTK 8
Right or Neutral 6
A23 7
A24 7
E2X1RPK
2
2
2
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Factory Mounted
Connection Type and Location
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads
Number of
Contacts
A and B
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Rear
Suffix
Number
Opposite Side
Suffix
Number
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Right
A30
A31
A32
A1X1RPKFDE
2
2
2
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Number of
Contacts
A and B
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Rear 3
Suffix
Number
Opposite Side
Suffix
Number
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left
A01
A02
A03
A04
A1X2PK
A1X2LTK
Right k
A05
A06
A07
A08
A1X2PK
A1X2RTK 4
Left
A09
A10
A11
A2X2PK
A2X2LTK
Right k
A12
A13
A14
A2X2PK
A2X2RTK 4
Notes
1 Includes 24-inch external pigtail leads, 18 AWG (160.010).
2 A maximum of two internal accessories may be mounted in a three-pole circuit breaker. Suitable for mounting in right pole only of two- or three-pole breaker.
3 Standard pigtail lead exit location.
4 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories; for field installation.
5 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2).
6 Not for use on F-Frame with electronic trip unit.
7 125 volts (max.), 50/60 Hz switch for use in electronic circuit of 100 micro amperes and 15 Vdc minimum.
8 Not for use on four-pole circuit breakers.
9 Only for use on three-pole F-Frame breakers with electronic trip unit.
j Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation or interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
k Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-275
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Rear 2
Suffix
Number
Opposite Side
Suffix
Number
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left
A01
A02
A03
A04
A1X3PK
A1X3LTK
Right 23
A05
A06
A07
A08
A1X3PK
A1X3RTK 4
Left
A09
A10
A11
A2X3PK
A2X3LTK
Right 23
A12
A13
A14
A2X3PK
A2X3RTK 4
Right
A21
A22
1482D28G10 67
Left
A18
A15
A3X3LPK
A3X3LTK
Right 3
A17
A16
A3X3RPK
A3X3RTK 4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Field Mounted
Rear 2
Suffix
Number
Opposite Side
Suffix
Number
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left
A01
A02
A03
A04
A1X4PK
A1X4LTK
Right 2
A05
A06
A07
A08
A1X4PK
A1X4RTK 4
Left
A09
A10
A11
A2X4PK
A2X4LTK
A12
A13
A14
A2X4PK
A2X4RTK 4
Left
A18
A15
A3X4PK
A3X4LTK
Right 2
A17
A16
A3X4PK
A3X4RTK 4
Right
3
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
2
2
Factory Mounted
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads
Number of
Contacts
A and B
2
2
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
2
2
Field Mounted
2
2
Factory Mounted
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Rear 2
Suffix
Number
Opposite Side
Suffix
Number
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left
A01
A02
A03
A04
A1X5PK
A1X5LTK
Right 2
A05
A06
A07
A08
A1X5PK
A1X5RTK 4
Left
A09
A10
A11
A2X5PK
A2X5LTK
Right 2
A12
A13
A14
A2X5PK
A2X5RTK 4
Left
A18
A15
A3X5LPK
A3X5LTK
Right 2
A17
A16
A3X5RPK
A3X5RTK 4
Number of
Contacts
A and B
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Number of
Contacts
A and B
Pigtail Leads
Suffix
Number 5
Catalog
Number 5
A12
A2X6RPK
A19
A4X6RPK
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
4 Not for use on four-pole circuit breakers.
5 A maximum of two auxiliary switches (any combination of 2a/2b or 4a/4b plug-in modules may be installed in a circuit breaker.
6 This option is not field installable.
7 Available on the OPTIM 550 only. Communications are not available with this option.
V4-T2-276
2.3
a
b
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Terminal Block
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 2
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left 2
C01
C02
C03
AAL1LPK
AAL1LTK
Right
C04
C05
C06
AAL1RPK
AAL1RTK 3
2
2
2
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Terminal Block
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left 3
C01
C02
C03
MAAL1LPK
MAAL1LTK
Right
C04
C05
C06
MAAL1RPK
MAAL1RPK
Same Side
2
2
2
J-Frame and HMCP (J) Auxiliary Switch and Alarm Switch Combination
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Field Installation Kits 4
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 5
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Left
C01
C02
C03
AAL2LPK
AAL2LTK
Right 3
C04
C05
C06
AAL2RPK
AAL2RTK 3
Terminal Block
Field Mounted
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Same Side
Rear 5
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Left
C01
C02
Right 56
C04
C05
Right
C07
C08
Terminal Block
2
2
2
K-Frame and HMCP (K) Auxiliary Switch and Alarm Switch Combination
Factory Mounted
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
C03
AAL3LPK
AAL3LTK
C06
AAL3RPK 7
1482D28G09
AAL3RTK
89
Notes
1 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation.
2 Standard mounting location.
3 Not for use on four-pole circuit breakers
4 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation of interchangeable trip unit breakers under E64983.
5 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
6 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
7 Will not install on OPTIM Trip (RH).
8 Available on the OPTIM 550 only. Communications are not available with this option.
9 This option is not field installable.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-277
2.3
2
L-, HMCP (L) and (M) Frames and Auxiliary Switch and Alarm Switch Combination
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
C01
C02
C03
AA114LPK
AA114LTK
Right 2
C04
C05
C06
AA114RPK
AA114RTK 3
2A, 2B and
1 Make/1 Break
Left
3A, 3B and
1 Make/1 Break
C07
C08
C12
AA214LPK
AA214LTK
C10
C11
C13
AA214RPK
AA214RTK 3
Left
C14
AA314LPK
Right 2
C15
AA314RPK
Right
N-Frame and HMCP (N) Auxiliary Switch and Alarm Switch Combination
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
1A, 1B and
1 Make/1 Break
Left
2A, 2B and
1 Make/1 Break
Catalog
Number
Left
Same Side
Catalog
Number
1A, 1B and
1 Make/1 Break
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Terminal Block
Mounting
Location
(Pole)
Number of
Sets of
Contacts
Pigtail Leads
Number of
Sets of
Contacts
2
2
Factory Mounted
C01
C02
C03
AA115LPK
AA115LTK
C04
C05
C06
AA115RPK
AA115RTK 3
Left
C07
C08
C12
AA215LPK
AA215LTK
Right 2
C10
C11
C13
AA215RPK
AA215RTK 3
Right
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 Not for use on four-pole circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-278
2.3
Shunt Trip
Shunt Trip
2
2
ST
Catalog
Number
2
2
Volts
Frequency
Amperes
Suffix
Number
120
50/60 Hz
1.1
S1
1373D62G01
240
50/60 Hz
2.1
S2
1373D62G02
12
DC
2.8
S3
1373D62G15
24
DC
5.7
S4
1373D62G16
24
60 Hz
S7
1373D62G20
2
2
2
Factory Mounted
Connection Type and Location
18-Inch (457.2 mm) Pigtail Leads 2
Terminal Block
Same Side
Rear 3
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
S01
S02
S03
S04
SNT1LP03K
SNT1LT03K
S05
S06
S07
S08
SNT1LP08K
SNT1LT08K
S09
S10
S11
S12
SNT1LP12K
SNT1LT12K
S13
S14
S15
S16
SNT1LP18K
SNT1LT18K
S18
S19
S20
SNT1RP03K
SNT1RT03K 6
Voltage Rating
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz)
2
2
S17
S21
S22
S23
S24
SNT1RP08K
SNT1RT08K 6
S25
S26
S27
S28
SNT1RP12K
SNT1RT12K 6
S29
S30
S31
S32
SNT1RP18K
SNT1RT18K 6
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories, for field installation.
2 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2).
3 Standard pigtail lead exit location.
4 120 Vac marked suitable for ground fault protection devices.
5 Standard mounting location.
6 Not for use on four-pole circuit breakers.
2
2
2
G-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory.
Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation under E7819.
Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed.
Accessory installation should be done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-279
2.3
2
2
2
2
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
SNT2T04K
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
S41
S42
S43
S44
SNT2P04K
S49
S50
S51
S52
SNT2P06K
SNT2T06K
S09
S10
S11
S12
SNT2P11K
SNT2T11K
S13
S14
S15
S16
SNT2P14K
SNT2T14K
480600 Vac
S17
S18
S19
S20
SNT2P18K
SNT2T18K
S45
S46
S47
S48
SNT2P04K
SNT2T04K 4
S53
S54
S55
S56
SNT2P06K
SNT2T06K 4
S29
S30
S31
S32
SNT2P11K
SNT2T11K 4
S33
S34
S35
S36
SNT2P14K
SNT2T14K 4
480600 Vac
S37
S38
S39
S40
SNT2P18K
SNT2T18K 4
2
2
110240 Vac or
110125 Vdc 3
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
SNT3T04K
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Voltage Rating
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz)
S41
S42
S43
S44
SNT3P04K
S49
S50
S51
S52
SNT3P06K
SNT3T06K
S09
S10
S11
S12
SNT3P11K
SNT3T11K
S13
S14
S15
S16
SNT3P14K
SNT3T14K
480600 Vac
S17
S18
S19
S20
SNT3P18K
SNT3T18K
S46
S47
S48
SNT3P04K
SNT3T04K 4
S53
S54
S55
S56
SNT3P06K
SNT3T06K 4
S29
S30
S31
S32
SNT3P11K
SNT3T11K 4
S33
S34
S35
S36
SNT3P14K
SNT3T14K 4
480600 Vac
S37
S38
S39
S40
SNT3P18K
SNT3T18K 4
2
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 Suitable for use with Class 1 ground fault sensing element.
4 Not for use on four-pole circuit breakers.
5 For use with KT (thermal-magnetic) trip units only.
6 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-280
2.3
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
S01
S02
S03
S04
SNT4LP03K
SNT4LT03K
4860 Vac
S05
S06
S07
S08
SNT4LP05K
SNT4LT05K
4860 Vdc
S85
S86
S87
SNT4LP23K
SNT4LT23K
110240 Vac
S09
S10
S11
S12
SNT4LP11K
SNT4LT11K
110125 Vdc
S41
S42
S43
S44
SNT4LP26K
SNT4LT26K
S13
S14
S15
S16
SNT4LP14K
SNT4LT14K
480600 Vac
S17
S18
S19
S20
SNT4LP18K
SNT4LT18K
S21
S22
S23
S24
SNT4RP03K
SNT4RT03K
4860 Vac
S25
S26
S27
S28
SNT4RP05K
SNT4RT05K
4860 Vdc
S88
S89
S90
SNT4RP23K
SNT4RT23K
110240 Vac
S29
S30
S31
S32
SNT4RP11K
SNT4RT11K
110125 Vdc
S45
S46
S47
S48
SNT4RP26K
SNT4RT26K
S33
S34
S35
S36
SNT4RP14K
SNT4RT14K
480600 Vac
S37
S38
S39
S40
SNT4RP18K
SNT4RT18K
Voltage Rating
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz)
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories, for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 For use with LT (thermal-magnetic) three-pole trip units only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-281
2.3
2
Field Mounted
Same Side
Rear 2
Opposite Side
Same Side
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
S01
S02
S03
S04
SNT5LP03K
SNT5LT03K
4860 Vac
S05
S06
S07
S08
SNT5LP05K
SNT5LT05K
2
2
2
Terminal Block
110240 Vac
S09
S10
S11
S12
SNT5LP11K
SNT5LT11K
110125 Vdc
S41
S42
S43
S44
SNT5LP26K
SNT5LT26K
S13
S14
S15
S16
SNT5LP14K
SNT5LT14K
480600 Vac
S17
S18
S19
S20
SNT5LP18K
SNT5LT18K
4860 Vdc
S21
S22
S23
S24
SNT5LP23K
SNT5LT23K
2
2
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Pigtail Leads
Voltage Rating
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz)
Suffix
Number 4
Catalog
Number 4
24 Vac or Vdc
S21
SNT6P03K
4860 Vac
S25
SNT6P05K
110240 Vac
S29
SNT6P11K
S33
SNT6P14K
480600 Vac
S37
SNT6P18K
4860 Vdc
S88
SNT6P23K
110125 Vdc
S45
SNT6P26K
2
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 Supply voltages suitable for use with Class 1 GFP devices. Marking label included with accessory kits.
4 A maximum of two shunt trip plug-in modules may be installed in a circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-282
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
F-, J-, K-, L-, M-, N- and R-Frames and HMCPs Low Energy Shunt Trip 1
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Mounting
Positions
(Pole)
Suffix
Number
2
2
Terminal Block
Opposite
Side
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
2
F-Frame
4
LST1LTK
Left
NO1
NO2
NO3
NO4
LST1LPK
Right 3
NO5
NO6
NO7
NO8
LST1RPK 4
LST1RTK 4
Left
NO1
NO2
NO3
LST2LPK
Right 3
NO5
NO6
NO7
LST2RPK
NO1
NO2
NO3
LST3LPK
NO5
NO6
NO7
LST3RPK
2
2
J-Frame
K-Frame
Left 3
Right
56
L- and M-Frames
Left
NO1
NO2
NO3
LST4LPK
Right
NO5
NO6
NO7
LST4RPK
NO1
NO2
NO3
LST5LPK
NO1
LST6RPK
N-Frame
Left 3
R-Frame
Right
Notes
1 Cutoff provisions required in control circuit.
2 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
3 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
4 For F-Frame HMCP, add an M to beginning of catalog number. Field Installation Kit referenced for factory use only,
not UL listed for field installation.
5 For use with thermal-magnetic trip units only.
6 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-283
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Frequency (Hz)
Amperes
Factory
Suffix
120
50/60
0.05
1373D62G03
T1
24
50/60
0.22
1373D62G04
T2
48
50/60
0.11
1373D62G05
T3
60
50/60
0.10
1373D62G06
T4
110
50
0.049
1373D62G07
T5
208
60
0.026
1373D62G08
T6
220
50
0.025
1373D62G09
T7
240
50/60
0.024
1373D62G10
T8
380
50
0.015
1373D62G11
T9
415
50
0.013
1373D62G12
T10
440
50
0.012
1373D62G13
T11
480
60
0.01
1373D62G14
T12
UV
Notes
1 Includes 24-inch (609.6 mm) external pigtail leads, 18 AWG (160.010).
2 A maximum of two internal accessories may be mounted in a three-pole circuit breaker.
3 Suitable for mounting in left pole only of three-pole breaker.
2
2
G-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory.
Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation under E7819.
Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation
should be done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-284
2.3
Opposite Side
Same Side
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
12 Vac
U01
U02
U03
U04
24 Vac
U05
U06
U07
U08
48 Vac
U37
U38
U39
U40
60 Vac
U97
U98
U99
U100
110127 Vac
U13
U14
U15
U16
208240 Vac
U17
U18
U19
U20
380480 Vac
U21
U22
U23
U24
525600 Vac
U25
U26
U27
U28
Voltage Rating
(AC Freq. = 50/60 Hz)
Terminal Block
Same Side
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
U49
U50
U51
U52
24 Vac
U53
U54
U55
U56
48 Vac
U85
U86
U87
U88
60 Vac
U101
U102
U103
U104
110127 Vac
U61
U62
U63
U64
208240 Vac
U65
U66
U67
U68
380480 Vac
U69
U70
U71
U72
525600 Vac
U73
U74
U75
U76
12 Vdc
U29
U30
U31
U32
24 Vdc
U33
U34
U35
U36
48 Vdc
U37
U38
U39
U40
60 Vdc
U97
U98
U99
U100
110127 Vdc
U41
U42
U43
U44
220250 Vdc
U45
U46
U47
U48
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
U77
U78
U79
U80
24 Vdc
U81
U82
U83
U84
48 Vdc
U85
U86
U87
U88
60 Vdc
U101
U102
U103
U104
110127 Vdc
U89
U90
U91
U92
220250 Vdc
U93
U94
U95
U96
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Standard pigtail lead exit location.
2 Standard mounting location.
3 Not for use on right pole of four-pole circuit breaker.
F-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory.
Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation under E7819.
Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation should be
done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-285
2.3
2
Terminal Block
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
12 Vac
UVH1LP02K
UVH1LT02K
MUVH1LP02K
MUVH1LT02K
24 Vac
UVH1LP03K
UVH1LT03K
MUVH1LP03K
MUVH1LT03K
48 Vac
UVH1LP22K
UVH1LT22K
MUVH1LP22K
MUVH1LT22K
60 Vac
UVH1LP24K
UVH1LT24K
MUVH1LP24K
MUVH1LT24K
110127 Vac
UVH1LP08K
UVH1LT08K
MUVH1LP08K
MUVH1LT08K
208240 Vac
UVH1LP11K
UVH1LT11K
MUVH1LP11K
MUVH1LT11K
380480 Vac
UVH1LP15K
UVH1LT15K
MUVH1LP15K
MUVH1LT15K
525600 Vac
UVH1LP18K
UVH1LT18K
MUVH1LP18K
MUVH1LT18K
Voltage Rating
(AC Freq. = 50/60 Hz)
12 Vac
UVH1RP02K
UVH1RT02K
MUVH1RP02K
MUVH1RT02K
24 Vac
UVH1RP03K
UVH1RT03K
MUVH1RP03K
MUVH1RT03K
48 Vac
UVH1RP22K
UVH1RT22K
MUVH1RP22K
MUVH1RT22K
60 Vac
UVH1RP24K
UVH1RT24K
MUVH1RP24K
MUVH1RT24K
110127 Vac
UVH1RP08K
UVH1RT08K
MUVH1RP08K
MUVH1RT08K
208240 Vac
UVH1RP11K
UVH1RT11K
MUVH1RP11K
MUVH1RT11K
380480 Vac
UVH1RP15K
UVH1RT15K
MUVH1RP15K
MUVH1RT15K
525600 Vac
UVH1RP18K
UVH1RT18K
MUVH1RP18K
MUVH1RT18K
12 Vdc
UVH1LP20K
UVH1LT20K
MUVH1LP20K
MUVH1LT20K
24 Vdc
UVH1LP21K
UVH1LT21K
MUVH1LP21K
MUVH1LT21K
48 Vdc
UVH1LP22K
UVH1LT22K
MUVH1LP22K
MUVH1LT22K
60 Vdc
UVH1LP24K
UVH1LT24K
MUVH1LP24K
MUVH1LT24K
110127 Vdc
UVH1LP26K
UVH1LT26K
MUVH1LP26K
MUVH1LT26K
220250 Vdc
UVH1LP28K
UVH1LT28K
MUVH1LP28K
MUVH1LT28K
12 Vdc
UVH1RP20K
UVH1RT20K
MUVH1RP20K
MUVH1RT20K
24 Vdc
UVH1RP21K
UVH1RT21K
MUVH1RP21K
MUVH1RT21K
48 Vdc
UVH1RP22K
UVH1RT22K
MUVH1RP22K
MUVH1RT22K
60 Vdc
UVH1RP22K
UVH1RT22K
MUVH1RP22K
MUVH1RT22K
110127 Vdc
UVH1RP26K
UVH1RT26K
MUVH1RP26K
MUVH1RT26K
220250 Vdc
UVH1RP28K
UVH1RT28K
MUVH1RP28K
MUVH1RT28K
2
2
2
Notes
1 Not listed with Underwriters Laboratories, for field installation.
2 Standard mounting location.
3 Not for use on right pole of four-pole circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-286
2.3
Field Mounted
Terminal
Block 1
Same Side
Rear 2
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block 3
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
2
U05
U06
U07
U08
UVH2LP02K
UVH2LT02K
24 Vac
U09
U10
U11
U12
UVH2LP03K
UVH2LT03K
4860 Vac
U13
U14
U15
U16
UVH2LP05K
UVH2LT05K
110127 Vac
U17
U18
U19
U20
UVH2LP08K
UVH2LT08K
208240 Vac
U21
U22
U23
U24
UVH2LP11K
UVH2LT11K
380480 Vac
U25
U26
U27
U28
UVH2LP15K
UVH2LT15K
2
2
2
2
12 Vac
U37
U38
U39
U40
UVH2RP02K
UVH2RT02K
24 Vac
U41
U42
U43
U44
UVH2RP03K
UVH2RT03K
4860 Vac
U45
U46
U47
U48
UVH2RP05K
UVH2RT05K
110127 Vac
U49
U50
U51
U52
UVH2RP08K
UVH2RT08K
208240 Vac
U53
U54
U55
U56
UVH2RP11K
UVH2RT11K
380480 Vac
U57
U58
U59
U60
UVH2RP15K
UVH2RT15K
2
2
2
2
T01
T02
T03
T04
UVH2LP20K
UVH2LT20K
24 Vdc
T05
T06
T07
T08
UVH2LP21K
UVH2LT21K
4860 Vdc
T09
T10
T11
T12
UVH2LP23K
UVH2LT23K
110127 Vdc
T13
T14
T15
T16
UVH2LP26K
UVH2LT26K
220250 Vdc
T17
T18
T19
T20
UVH2LP28K
UVH2LT28K
2
2
2
2
T21
T22
T23
T24
UVH2RP20K
UVH2RT20K
24 Vdc
T25
T26
T27
T28
UVH2RP21K
UVH2RT21K
4860 Vdc
T29
T30
T31
T32
UVH2RP23K
UVH2RT23K
110127 Vdc
T33
T34
T35
T36
UVH2RP26K
UVH2RT26K
220250 Vdc
T37
T38
T39
T40
UVH2RP28K
UVH2RT28K
2
2
2
Notes
1 For electrical rating data for manual, automatic and electrical reset undervoltage release mechanisms, refer to Eaton.
2 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
3 Not for use on right pole of four-pole circuit breakers.
4 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-287
2.3
2
Field Mounted
Terminal
Block
Same Side
Rear 2
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Voltage Rating
(AC Freq. = 50/60 Hz)
U05
U06
U07
U08
UVH3LP02K
UVH3LT02K
24 Vac
U09
U10
U11
U12
UVH3LP03K
UVH3LT03K
4860 Vac
U13
U14
U15
U16
UVH3LP05K
UVH3LT05K
110127 Vac
U17
U18
U19
U20
UVH3LP08K
UVH3LT08K
208240 Vac
U21
U22
U23
U24
UVH3LP11K
UVH3LT11K
380480 Vac
U25
U26
U27
U28
UVH3LP15K
UVH3LT15K
U37
U38
U39
U40
UVH3RP02K
UVH3RT02K
24 Vac
U41
U42
U43
U44
UVH3RP03K
UVH3RT03K
4860 Vac
U45
U46
U47
U48
UVH3RP05K
UVH3RT05K
110127 Vac
U49
U50
U51
U52
UVH3RP08K
UVH3RT08K
208240 Vac
U53
U54
U55
U56
UVH3RP11K
UVH3RT11K
380480 Vac
U57
U58
U59
U60
UVH3RP15K
UVH3RT15K
T01
T02
T03
T04
UVH3LP20K
UVH3LT20K
24 Vdc
T05
T06
T07
T08
UVH3LP21K
UVH3LT21K
4860 Vdc
T09
T10
T11
T12
UVH3LP23K
UVH3LT23K
110127 Vdc
T13
T14
T15
T16
UVH3LP26K
UVH3LT26K
220250 Vdc
T17
T18
T19
T20
UVH3LP28K
UVH3LT28K
12 Vdc
T21
T22
T23
T24
UVH3RP20K
UVH3RT20K
24 Vdc
T25
T26
T27
T28
UVH3RP21K
UVH3RT21K
4860 Vdc
T29
T30
T31
T32
UVH3RP23K
UVH3RT23K
110127 Vdc
T33
T34
T35
T36
UVH3RP26K
UVH3RT26K
220250 Vdc
T37
T38
T39
T40
UVH3RP28K
UVH3RT28K
2
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories, for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 For use with KT (thermal-magnetic) trip units only.
4 Not for use on right pole of four-pole circuit breaker.
5 Breakers with K-Frame OPTIM 550 can only accept accessories in left pole.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-288
2.3
Field Mounted
Terminal
Block
Same Side
Rear 2
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2
2
U05
U06
U07
U08
UVH4LP02K
UVH4LT02K
24 Vac
U09
U10
U11
U12
UVH4LP03K
UVH4LT03K
4860 Vac
U13
U14
U15
U16
UVH4LP05K
UVH4LT05K
110127 Vac
U17
U18
U19
U20
UVH4LP08K
UVH4LT08K
208240 Vac
U21
U22
U23
U24
UVH4LP11K
UVH4LT11K
380480 Vac
U25
U26
U27
U28
UVH4LP15K
UVH4LT15K
2
2
2
2
12 Vac
U37
U38
U39
U40
UVH4RP02K
UVH4RT02K
24 Vac
U41
U42
U43
U44
UVH4RP03K
UVH4RT03K
4860 Vac
U45
U46
U47
U48
UVH4RP05K
UVH4RT05K
110127 Vac
U49
U50
U51
U52
UVH4RP08K
UVH4RT08K
208240 Vac
U53
U54
U55
U56
UVH4RP11K
UVH4RT11K
380480 Vac
U57
U58
U59
U60
UVH4RP15K
UVH4RT15K
2
2
2
2
T01
T02
T03
T04
UVH4LP20K
UVH4LT20K
24 Vdc
T05
T06
T07
T08
UVH4LP21K
UVH4LT21K
4860 Vdc
T09
T10
T11
T12
UVH4LP23K
UVH4LT23K
110127 Vdc
T13
T14
T15
T16
UVH4LP26K
UVH4LT26K
220250 Vdc
T17
T18
T19
T20
UVH4LP28K
UVH4LT28K
2
2
2
2
T21
T22
T23
T24
UVH4RP20K
UVH4RT20K
24 Vdc
T25
T26
T27
T28
UVH4RP21K
UVH4RT21K
4860 Vdc
T29
T30
T31
T32
UVH4RP23K
UVH4RT23K
110127 Vdc
T33
T34
T35
T36
UVH4RP26K
UVH4RT26K
220250 Vdc
T37
T38
T39
T40
UVH4RP28K
UVH4RT28K
2
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 For use with LT (thermal-magnetic) trip units only.
4 Not for use on right pole of four-pole circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-289
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
Factory Mounted
Field Mounted
Terminal Block
Same Side
Rear 2
Pigtail Leads
Terminal Block
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
U05
U06
U07
U08
UVH5LP02K
UVH5LT02K
24 Vac
U09
U10
U11
U12
UVH5LP03K
UVH5LT03K
4860 Vac
U13
U14
U15
U16
UVH5LP05K
UVH5LT05K
110127 Vac
U17
U18
U19
U20
UVH5LP08K
UVH5LT08K
208240 Vac
U21
U22
U23
U24
UVH5LP11K
UVH5LT11K
380480 Vac
U25
U26
U27
U28
UVH5LP29K
UVH5LT29K
12 Vdc
T01
T02
T03
T04
UVH5LP20K
UVH5LT20K
24 Vdc
T05
T06
T07
T08
UVH5LP21K
UVH5LT21K
4860 Vdc
T09
T10
T11
T12
UVH5LP23K
UVH5LT23K
110127 Vdc
T13
T14
T15
T16
UVH5LP26K
UVH5LT26K
220250 Vdc
T17
T18
T19
T20
UVH5LP28K
UVH5LT28K
2
2
Field Mounted
Pigtail Leads
Voltage Rating
(AC Frequency = 50/60 Hz)
Suffix
Number 4
Catalog
Number 4
12 Vac
U37
UVH6RP02K
24 Vac
U41
UVH6RP03K
4860 Vac
U45
UVH6RP05K
110127 Vac
U49
UVH6RP08K
208240 Vac
U53
UVH6RP11K
380500 Vac
U57
UVH6RP29K
12 Vdc
T21
UVH6RP20K
24 Vdc
T25
UVH6RP21K
4860 Vdc
T29
UVH6RP23K
110125 Vdc
T33
UVH6RP26K
220250 Vdc
T37
UVH6RP28K
2
2
2
Notes
1 Listed with Underwriters Laboratories for field installation under E64983.
2 Standard mounting locationleads exit rear of breaker.
3 Endurance: 500 electrical operations plus 2500 mechanical operations.
4 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2). Leads are orange and brown.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-290
2.3
Field Mounted
Suffix
Number
Catalog
Number
Q01
TBRDK
2
2
2
Required Number
of Wires
Auxiliary switch
2a/2b
4a/4b
6
12
Alarm (Signal)/
Lockout switch
1m/1b
2m/2b
6
12
Shunt trip
N/A
N/A
N/A
Type of Accessory
2
2
2
Factory Install
Suffix
Catalog
Number
K-Frame
PN
ICK550K
L-Frame
PN
ICK550L
N-Frame
PN
ICK550N
2
2
2
Factory Install
Suffix
Catalog
Number
K-Frame
ZG
ZGK550K
L-Frame
ZG
ZGK550L
N-Frame
ZG
ZGK550N
2
2
Factory Install
Suffix
Catalog
Number
K-Frame
ZGP
ZGPK550K
L-Frame
ZGP
ZGPK550L
N-Frame
ZGP
ZGPK550N
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 One 24-point accessory terminal block provided with circuit breaker when ordered factory installed or shipped
from warehouse as separate item when ordered for field installation. See Digitrip RMS master connection diagram
(IL 29C714).
2 Installation of these kits restrict any other attachments from being installed in the RH pole.
3 Includes a ground fault alarm signal that can drive the ground fault alarm unit (catalog number GFAU).
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-291
2.3
Alarm Switch
2
2
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
Maximum
Voltage
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
125/250
50/60 Hz
63
2000
28
DC
33
2000
28
DC
54
2000
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Frequency
600
125
250
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
50/60 Hz
2500
Maximum
Voltage
DC
0.50 3
2500
DC
0.25 3
2500
67
Frequency
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
Notes
1 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
2 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
3 Non-inductive load.
4 Inductive (L/R = 0.026).
5 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
6 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2).
7 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
8 Endurance: 3000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
i Endurance: 500 electrical operations plus 2500 mechanical operations.
j Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2). Leads are red, black and blue.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-292
Frequency
56
Maximum
Voltage
Maximum
Voltage
2.3
Auxiliary Switch
Maximum
Voltage
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
Maximum
Voltage
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
125 3
50/60 Hz
2500
600
50/60 Hz
2500
4
2500
2500
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50
125
DC
0.50 4
2500
250
DC
0.25 4
250
DC
0.25 4
2500
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
Maximum
Voltage
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
2500
125
DC
0.50 4
2500
2500
250
DC
0.25 4
2500
2500
DC
0.50
250
DC
0.25 4
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
2
2
Frequency
600
50/60 Hz
125
DC
0.50 4
DC
0.25 4
250
Notes
1 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
2 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2).
3 For use in electronic circuit of 100 micro amperes and 15 Vdc minimum.
4 Non-inductive load.
5 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
6 Endurance: 3000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
7 Endurance: 500 electrical operations plus 2500 mechanical operations.
8 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2). Leads are red, black and blue.
0.25 4
Maximum
Current Amperes
2500
0.50
DC
Maximum
Voltage
2500
DC
250
125
2
2
125
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-293
2.3
2
2
Maximum
Voltage
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Maximum
Voltage
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2200
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2200
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
Maximum
Voltage
2
2
2
2
2
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
Maximum
Voltage
600
50/60 Hz
2500
125
DC
0.50 3
2500
250
DC
0.25 3
2500
Frequency
Frequency
Maximum
Current Amperes
Dielectric
Withstand Voltage
Notes
1 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
2 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2).
3 Non-inductive load.
4 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
5 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
6 Endurance: 3000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-294
2.3
Shunt Trip
DC
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
12
6.75
24
50/60 Hz
VA
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
75
12
6.75
300
24
48
36
92
60
36
140
110
156
120
DC
VA
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
VA
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
100
12
VA
45
12
8.4
35
400
24
200
24
8.4
170
48
36
100
60
36
160
48
830
48
710
60
1280
60
1105
480
110
77
55
110 5
156
570
120
60
100
110
77
110
77
66
120 5
60
120
120
77
130
127
156
640
125
77
71
127 5
208
156
60
140
125
77
140
180
208 5
60
420
220
156
200
220 5
60
470
240
156
240
240 5
60
550
380
300
610
127
72
380
285
95
220
154
41
415
300
130
220
110
400
285
108
250
154
54
440
300
330
250
140
415
285
120
154
480
300
380
440
285
136
154
525
300
450
480
360
40
550
300
530
525
360
50
600
300
590
550
360
50
600
360
70
DC
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
VA
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
VA
12
31
12
8.4
50
24
173
24
8.4
247
48
36
686
48
33.6
1094
60
36
1014
60
33.6
1698
60.5
66
110
77
112
120 5
60.5
84
120
77
138
127 5
60.5
102
125
77
150
208 5
60.5
354
77
220 5
60.5
396
110
240
60.5
432
380
285
180
110
154
40
400
285
200
120
154
58
415
285
240
125
154
440
285
610
127
154
480
360
34
525
360
42
550
360
50
600
360
60
Notes
1 Average unlatching time: 6 milliseconds.
2 Average circuit breaker contact total opening time: 18 milliseconds.
3 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
4 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
5 Supply voltages suitable for use with Class 1 GFP devices. Marking label included with
accessory kits.
6 Approximate unlatching time: 6 milliseconds.
7 Approximate total circuit breaker contact opening time: 8 milliseconds.
8 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-295
2.3
50/60 Hz
50/60 Hz
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
12
DC
VA
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
45
12
24
200
48
34
60
34
110 4
4
DC
VA
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
VA
Supply
Voltage
Minimum
Operating Voltage
VA
35
24
16.8
200
24
16.8
170
24
170
48
33.6
830
48
33.6
710
830
48
34
710
60
33.6
1280
60
33.6
1150
1280
60
34
1105
110 4
60
100
110
77
110
60
100
110
77
110
120 4
60
120
120
77
130
60
120
120
77
130
127 4
60
140
125
77
140
140
208 4
60
420
120
127 4
60
140
125
77
208 4
60
420
77
220 4
60
470
220 4
60
470
240 4
60
550
240 4
60
550
380
266
95
220
154
41
380
266
95
220
154
41
400
266
108
250
54
400
266
108
250
54
415
266
120
415
266
120
440
266
136
440
266
136
480
336
40
480
336
40
525
336
50
525
336
50
550
336
50
550
336
50
600
336
70
600
336
70
Notes
1 Approximate unlatching time: 6 milliseconds.
2 Approximate total circuit breaker contact opening time: 18 milliseconds.
3 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
4 Supply voltages suitable for use with Class 1 GFP devices. Marking label included with
accessory kits.
5 Endurance: 3000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-296
2.3
Suffix
Number
Voltage (V)
Frequency
(Hz)
Supply
Voltage (V)
Minimum
Operating Voltage (V)
Ip (A)
VA
03/03K
24
50/60
24
16.8
36.1
25.5
612
1050
24
DC
24
16.8
36.1
16.5
396
1050
4860
50/60
48
34.0
13.1
9.2
450
1120
4860
50/60
60
34.0
17.2
12.2
740
1120
110240
50/60
110
60.5
4.2
3.0
330
1480
110240
50/60
120
60.5
4.5
3.2
390
1480
110240
50/60
127
60.5
4.6
3.3
430
1480
110240
50/60
208
60.5
7.9
5.6
1170
1480
110240
50/60
220
60.5
8.5
6.0
1370
1480
110240
50/60
240
60.5
8.7
6.1
1470
1480
380440
50/60
380
266.0
4.5
3.2
1220
1880
380440
50/60
415
266.0
5.0
3.6
1500
1880
380440
50/60
440
266.0
5.3
3.7
1640
1880
220250
DC
220
154.0
2.4
530
1500
220250
DC
250
154.0
2.7
680
1500
480600
50/60
480
336.0
0.6
0.4
200
2200
480600
50/60
525
336.0
0.7
0.5
270
2200
480600
50/60
550
336.0
0.7
0.5
280
2200
480600
50/60
600
336.0
0.8
0.6
360
2200
4860
DC
48
34.0
9.8
470
1120
4860
DC
60
34.0
11.6
700
1120
05/05K
11/11K 3
14/14K
18/18K
23/23K
26/26K
110125
DC
110
77.0
3.3
370
1250
110125
DC
120
77.0
3.6
440
1250
110125
DC
125
77.0
3.8
480
1250
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Approximate unlatching time of 6 milliseconds.
2 Average circuit breaker contact total opening time approximately 62 milliseconds, at rated voltage.
3 Endurance: 500 electrical operations and 2500 mechanical operations.
4 Shunt trip can be operated up to a maximum of six times per minute.
5 Maximum operating voltage110% of maximum voltage range rating.
6 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2). Leads are yellow and white.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-297
2.3
50/60 Hz
DC
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
Supply
Voltage
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
12
4.2
6.3
7.6
1.3
12
4.2
6.3
7.6
2.5
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
2.8
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
2.8
1.4
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
1.6
48
21.0
33.6
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
1.2
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
1.3
40.8
1.9
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
110
44.5
2.0
77.0
93.5
1.3
110
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.5
120
127
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.5
120
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.7
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.7
125
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.9
208
84.0
145.6
176.8
2.2
220
87.5
154.0
187.0
2.6
220
84.0
145.6
176.8
2.4
250
87.5
154.0
187.0
3.4
240
84.0
145.6
176.8
2.9
380
168.0
266.0
323.0
2.9
415
168.0
266.0
323.0
3.5
440
168.0
266.0
323.0
3.9
480
168.0
266.0
323.0
4.6
525
210.0
367.0
446.0
4.3
550
210.0
367.0
446.0
4.8
600
210.0
367.0
446.0
5.8
Supply
Voltage
50/60 Hz
DC
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.6
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
3.1
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
2.0
3.8
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
3.1
93.5
1.8
110
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.6
77.0
93.5
2.1
120
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.9
77.0
93.5
2.4
125
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.2
84.0
145.6
176.8
2.7
220
87.5
154.0
187.0
3.1
220
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.1
250
87.5
154.0
187.0
4.0
240
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.8
380
168.0
266.0
323.0
3.4
415
168.0
266.0
323.0
4.0
440
168.0
266.0
323.0
4.6
480
168.0
266.0
323.0
5.4
Pickup Voltage
Supply
Voltage
Dropout Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.9
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
3.9
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
2.5
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
110
44.5
77.0
120
44.5
127
44.5
208
2
2
2
VA
Supply
Voltage
Notes
1 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 4000 mechanical operations.
2 Endurance: 6000 electrical operations plus 2000 mechanical operations.
3 For electrical rating data for manual, automatic and electrical reset undervoltage release mechanisms, refer to Eaton.
2
2
2
V4-T2-298
2.3
DC
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Maximum
Maximum
VA
Supply
Voltage
Dropout Voltage
Minimum
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.9
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.6
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
3.9
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
3.1
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
2.5
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
2.0
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
3.8
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
3.1
110
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.8
110
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.6
120
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.1
120
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.9
127
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.4
125
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.2
208
84.0
145.6
176.8
2.7
220
87.5
154.0
187.0
3.1
220
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.1
250
87.5
154.0
187.0
4.0
240
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.8
380
168.0
266.0
323.0
3.4
415
168.0
266.0
323.0
4.0
440
168.0
266.0
323.0
4.6
480
168.0
266.0
323.0
5.4
Supply
Voltage
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
DC
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
Supply
Voltage
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.9
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
3.8
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
3.1
110
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.8
110
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.6
120
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.1
120
44.5
77.0
93.5
1.9
127
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.4
125
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.2
208
84.0
145.6
176.8
2.7
220
87.5
154.0
187.0
3.1
220
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.1
250
87.5
154.0
187.0
4.0
240
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.8
380
168.0
266.0
323.0
3.4
415
168.0
266.0
323.0
4.0
440
168.0
266.0
323.0
4.6
480
168.0
266.0
323.0
5.4
Supply
Voltage
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.6
3.9
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
3.1
2.5
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
2.0
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Note
1 Endurance: 5000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-299
2.3
2
2
DC
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
Supply
Voltage
Dropout Voltage
Pickup Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.9
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
3.9
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
1.6
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
3.1
2.5
48
21.0
33.6
40.8
2.0
60
21.0
33.6
110
44.5
77.0
40.8
3.8
60
21.0
33.6
40.8
3.1
93.5
1.8
110
44.5
77.0
93.5
120
44.5
1.6
77.0
93.5
2.1
120
44.5
77.0
93.5
127
1.9
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.4
125
44.5
77.0
93.5
2.2
208
84.0
145.6
176.8
2.7
220
87.5
154.0
187.0
3.1
220
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.1
220
87.5
154.0
187.0
240
84.0
145.6
176.8
3.8
250
4.0
380
175.0
266.0
323.0
3.4
415
175.0
266.0
323.0
4.0
480
175.0
266.0
323.0
4.6
500
175.0
266.0
323.0
5.4
2
2
Supply
Voltage
Note
1 Endurance: 3000 electrical operations plus 1000 mechanical operations.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-300
2.3
Catalog
Suffix
Voltage
(V)
Supply
Voltage
(V)
Minimum
02/02K
12
12
4.2
03/03K
24
24
05/05K
4860
48
08/08K
11/11K
29/29K
110127
208240
380500
VA
Minimum
UVR
Response 3
Initiation
Circuit Breaker
Contact Separation 4
Maximum Circuit
Breaker
Contact Opening
Dielectric
Withstand
Voltage (V) 5
2.3
46
77
1024
20.4
3.1
46
77
1048
40.8
3.4
46
77
1120
33.5
40.8
6.0
46
77
1120
44.5
77.0
93.5
3.3
46
77
1254
44.5
77.0
93.5
3.6
46
77
1254
Pickup
Voltage
(V) Max.
8.4
10.2
8.4
16.8
21.0
33.5
60
21.0
110
120
127
44.5
77.0
93.5
3.8
46
77
1254
208
84.0
145.6
176.8
4.2
46
77
1480
220
84.0
145.6
176.8
6.6
46
77
1480
240
84.0
145.6
176.8
7.2
46
77
1480
380
168.0
266.0
323.0
3.8
46
77
2000
415
168.0
266.0
323.0
8.3
46
77
2000
440
168.0
266.0
323.0
8.8
46
77
2000
480
168.0
266.0
323.0
9.6
46
77
2000
500
168.0
266.0
323.0
10.0
46
77
2000
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Application
Ratings
Catalog
Suffix
Voltage
(V)
Supply
Voltage
(V)
Minimum
Maximum
20/20K
12
12
4.2
8.4
10.2
3.4
46
77
1024
21/21K
24
24
8.4
16.8
20.4
4.3
46
77
1048
23/23K
4860
48
21.0
33.5
40.8
4.8
46
77
1120
60
21.0
33.5
40.8
7.2
46
77
1120
110
43.8
77.0
93.5
3.3
46
77
1250
120
43.8
77.0
93.5
3.6
46
77
1250
125
43.8
77.0
93.5
3.8
46
77
1250
26/26K
28/28K
110127
220250
VA
Minimum
UVR
Response 3
2
2
Initiation
Circuit Breaker
Contact Separation 4
Maximum Circuit
Breaker
Contact Opening
Dielectric
Withstand
Voltage (V) 5
220
87.5
154.0
187.0
6.6
46
77
1500
250
87.5
154.0
187.0
7.5
46
77
1500
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Endurance: 500 electrical operations plus 2500 mechanical operations.
2 Pigtail wire size: 18 AWG (0.82 mm2). Leads are orange and brown.
3 UVR will override a momentary voltage dip up to the response time shown.
4 Unlatching occurs 1 millisecond before circuit breaker contacts begin to separate.
5 For 1 minute.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-301
2.3
2
Contents
Description
Page
Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Standards and Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Quick Reference . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
G-Frame (15100 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
F-Frame (10225 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
J-Frame (70250 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
K-Frame (70400 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
L-Frame (125600 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M-Frame (300800 Amperes). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
N-Frame (4001200 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
R-Frame (8002500 Amperes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Circuit Protectors (MCP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Motor Protection Circuit Breakers (MPCB) . . . . . . . .
Type ELC Current Limiter Attachment (Size 04) . . . . .
Current Limiting Circuit Breaker Module . . . . . . . . . . .
Internal Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
External Accessories
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-115
V4-T2-116
V4-T2-117
V4-T2-120
V4-T2-134
V4-T2-151
V4-T2-159
V4-T2-183
V4-T2-209
V4-T2-220
V4-T2-235
V4-T2-254
V4-T2-265
V4-T2-267
V4-T2-268
V4-T2-271
V4-T2-306
V4-T2-324
V4-T2-325
V4-T2-326
2
2
2
External Accessories
Product Overview
Keeper Nut
The keeper nut slides onto
the line or load conductor of
the circuit breaker and acts as
a threaded adapter for the
conductor to accept a ring
terminal or other bolt-on
connector. The keeper nut
is available with English and
metric thread sizes. Screws
and washers are supplied by
customer. (Field installation
only.) Listed per UL File
E7819.
Terminal Adapter
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Multiwire Connectors
Eatons field-installed
multiwire connectors for the
load side (OFF) end terminals
are used to distribute the load
from the circuit breaker to
multiple devices without the
use of separate distribution
terminal blocks.
Multiwire lug kits include
mounting hardware,
insulators and tin-plated
aluminum connectors to
replace three mechanical
load lugs. UL listed as used
on the load side (OFF) end.
Terminal Shields
Terminal shields provide
protection against accidental
contact with live line side
terminations. Terminal
shields are fabricated from
high dielectric insulating
material and fasten over
the front terminal access
openings. Small openings in
the shields provide limited
access to the terminals for
tightening connectors.
(Field installation only.)
2
V4-T2-302
Cylinder Lock
The cylinder lock internally
blocks the trip bar in the
tripped position to prevent
the circuit breaker from
being switched to ON.
The cylinder lock is factory
installed in the left pole only
of the circuit breaker cover.
Other internally mounted
accessories cannot be
installed in the same
pole as the cylinder lock.
(Factory installation only.)
Key Interlock Kit
(Lock Not Included)
The key interlock is used to
externally lock the circuit
breaker handle in the OFF
position. When the key
interlock is locked, an
extended deadbolt blocks
movement of the circuit
breaker handle. Uniquely
coded keys are removable
only with the deadbolt
extended. Each coded key
controls a group of circuit
breakers for a given specific
customer installation.
The key interlock assembly is
Underwriters Laboratories
listed for field installation
under UL File E7819 and
consists of a mounting kit
and a purchaser supplied
deadbolt lock. The mounting
kit comprises a mounting
plate, which is secured to the
circuit breaker cover in either
the left- or right-pole position,
key interlock mounting
screws, and a wire seal.
Specific mounting kits are
required for individual key
interlock types.
Sliding Bar Interlock
The sliding bar interlock
provides mechanical
interlocking between two
adjacent three-pole circuit
breakers. It is installed on the
enclosure cover between the
circuit breakers. When the
sliding bar interlock handle
is moved from one side to the
other, a bar extends to
alternately block movement
of the circuit breaker handles
and prevents both circuit
breakers from being switched
to ON at the same time.
Sliding bar interlocks are
not UL listed. (Field
installation only.)
2.3
V4-T2-303
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IQ Energy Sentinel
The IQ Energy Sentinel
is a highly accurate,
microprocessor-based,
breaker-mounted device
designed to monitor power
and energy readings. It
represents an alternative to
watt meters, watt-hour
meters, and watt demand
meters. Key advantages
include savings in space,
lower installation costs, and
remote monitoring capability.
The IQ Energy Sentinel
mounts on the load side
of a Series C F-Frame
(150 ampere) circuit breaker.
It can be applied on threephase, four-wire systems,
or single-phase, three-wire
systems with voltage
connected through
Phases A and C.
For more information, see
Descriptive Bulletin 8178.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-304
Digitrip OPTIMizer
The Digitrip OPTIMizer is a
hand-held programmer that
is used to access, configure,
test and display information
from OPTIM trip units. The
OPTIMizer plugs into the
front of an OPTIM trip unit via
an eight-pin telephone jack
and is powered by a nine-volt
battery or the auxiliary power
module. One highlighted
feature is the Copy and
Download commands.
Setting up multiple OPTIM
trips can be finished in
minutes and with no errors.
An Auxiliary Power Module
connection provides a trip test
when control power is not
present at the breaker. The
OPTIMizer is supplied as a
standard package to include
the programmer, the eightpin connection cord, battery
and carrying case. The
auxiliary power module
is optional.
Auxiliary Power Module
The auxiliary power module
is a power supply requiring
120 Vac input at 50 or 60 Hz
that provides a 32 Vdc output.
The auxiliary power module
provides control power for
testing an OPTIM trip unit
when other means of control
power is not available or
for continuous OPTIMizer
operation versus temporary
with a battery. The auxiliary
power module connects
into the top of the Digitrip
OPTIMizer via a keyed
receptacle. The main
application for the auxiliary
power module would be for
the testing of a standalone
non-communicating OPTIM
breaker that ordinarily would
not have control power.
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-305
2.3
Product Selection
Thread
Size
Catalog
Number
Imperial
1032
KPEK12
Metric
M5
KPEKM12
1032
KPEK1
Metric
M5
KPEKM1
Imperial
1032
KPEK14
Metric
M5
KPEKM14
Imperial
0.31218
KPEK2
Metric
M8
KPEKM2
Four-Pole J-Frame
Imperial
0.31218
KPEK24
Metric
M8
KPEKM24
Imperial
0.31218
KPEK3
Metric
M8
KPEKM3
Imperial
0.31218
KPEK34
Metric
M8
KPEKM34
Three-Pole J-Frame
Three-Pole K-Frame
Four-Pole K-Frame
Three-Pole L-Frame
Imperial
0.312-18
KPEK4
Metric
M-8
KPEKM4
Four-Pole L-Frame
Imperial
0.31218
KPEK44
Metric
M8
KPEKM44
Thread
Type
Thread
Size
Catalog Number
Package of 12
(Priced Individually)
Imperial
1032
KPR1A
Metric
M5
KPR1AM
2
2
Thread
Type
Thread
Size
Line/Load
End
Catalog Number
Package of 3
Imperial
0.37516
Line
KPR3A
Load
KPR3B
Metric
Line
KPR3AM
Load
KPR3BM
M8
Note
L-, M-, N-Frames not required. Terminals are threaded.
2
V4-T2-306
2.3
Termination Hardware
J-Frame Plug Nut
Thread
Type
K-Frame Terminal
Adapter
Catalog Number
Package of 6
Imperial
0.25020
PLN2
Metric
M6
PLN2M
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
TAD3
2
2
2
Maximum
Amperes
Catalog
Number
150
FCWTK
225
FCWTK225
2
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
KCWTK
2
2
2
2
AWG Wire
Range/Number Conductors
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
Al/Cu
3/0350 kcmil (2)
95150
TA602LDCW 3
Cu
250350 kcmil (2)
120250
T602LDCW 3
Al/Cu
400500 kcmil (2)
185240
2TA603LDKCW 45
Al/Cu
400500 kcmil (2)
185240
3TA603LDKCW 46
Al/Cu
400500 kcmil (2)
185240
4TA603LDKCW 47
2
2
Notes
1 K-Frame terminal adapter for use in replacing LB/DA breakers.
2 Not for use with T250KB terminals.
3 Individually packed.
4 Terminal kits contain one terminal for each pole and one terminal cover.
5 Two-pole kit.
6 Three-pole kit.
7 Four-pole kit.
2
2
2
V4-T2-307
2.3
2
Termination Hardware
Description
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
5652B38G01
GCWTK
2
2
Multiwire Connectors
Wires per
Terminal
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
Kit Catalog
Number 1
142
3TA100G3K
146
3TA100G6K
142
3TA150F3K
146
3TA150F6K
142
3TA250J3K
146
3TA250J6K
142/0
3TA400K3K
143
3TA400K6K
G-Frame 2
100
F-Frame
225
J-Frame
250
K-Frame
400
2
2
Frame
Maximum
Amperes
Wire Size
Range AWG Cu
Catalog
Number 1
FD
150
144/0
TA150FDRF
150
144/0
3TA150FDRF
225
6300 kcmil
TA225FDRF
225
6300 kcmil
3TA225FDRF
400
250500 kcmil
TA350KRF
400
250500 kcmil
3TA350KRF
800
TA800MDLRF
800
3TA800MDLRF
2
2
2
KD
MDL
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
G-Frame
2
2
624B375G23
8703C80G05
Notes
1 When catalog number starts with a 3, it indicates a kit with three terminals in each kit.
Catalog number beginning with a TA indicates one terminal.
2 GD breakers require special tapping for multiwire lugs, as described in the IL or use with standard aluminum collars.
2
2
2
V4-T2-308
2.3
Description
Type of
Mounting
Catalog
Number
Individual
624B375G01
Group 1
624B375G02
F-Frame
1
2
2
2
2
Individual
4218B80G01
3, 4
Individual
BMH1
Individual
BMH2
Individual
BMH3
0.250-20 x 1.5 inch filister-head steel screws and lockwashers and flat washers
Individual
BMH4
0.3125-18 x 1.25 inch filister-head steel screws and lockwashers and flat washers
Individual
BMH5
Individual
BMH5
J-Frame
2, 3, 4
K-Frame
2, 3, 4
L-Frame
2, 3, 4
M-Frame
2, 3
N-Frame
2, 3, 4
R-Frame
Supplied by customer
2
2
Description
Type of
Mounting
Catalog
Number
F-Frame
1
Individual
4218B80G09
Group 1
4218B80G10
2
2
2
Individual
4218B80G11
3, 4
Individual
BMH1M
Individual
BMH2M
Individual
BMH3M
Individual
BMH4M
Individual
BMH5M
Individual
BMH5M
J-Frame
2, 3, 4
K-Frame
2, 3, 4
L-Frame
2, 3
M-Frame
2, 3
N-Frame
2, 3
R-Frame
Supplied by customer
Note
1 One set of hardware for two circuit breakers.
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-309
2.3
2
Terminal Shields
Catalog
Number
10
GTSK3
2
2
F-Frame
2
2
2
2
2
2
J-Frame
2
2
2
Number
of Poles
Location
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Line
625B229G06
Line
625B229G07
Line
625B229G08
4210B95G01
Line
625B229G09
4210B95G02
Location
Catalog Number
(Package of 10)
2, 3
Line End
1266C07G01
Line End
6631C01G01
2, 3
Load End
6641C16G01
Load End
6641C16G02
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-310
2.3
K-Frame
Location
Catalog Number
(Package of 10)
2, 3
Line
TS33LN
Line
TS34LN
Load
TS33LD
Interphase Barriers
Ordering Information
Two per package.
Interphase Barrier
2
2
Interphase Barriers
Frame
Catalog
Number
IPB1
J, K
IPB3
IPB4
IPB4
IPB5
2
2
2
2
Catalog Number
(Package of 1)
314C420G05
2
2
Number of Units
in Package
Catalog
Number
207B513G01
Catalog Number
(Package of 1)
208B966G01
Number of Units
in Package
Catalog
Number
1, 2
10
1225C79G01
10
1225C79G02 1
NTS3K
Key Operated
Attachment
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
10
GKOA
2
2
2
Number of Units
in Package
Catalog
Number
Conductor Opening
Diameter in Inches (mm)
Catalog
Number
1294C01H01
TEC1
TEC2
2
2
2
Note
1 For use on three-pole breakers only.
2
2
2
V4-T2-311
2.3
Non-Padlockable
Handle Block
Frame
Catalog
Number
LKD1
J, K
LKD3
L, M, N
LKD4
2
2
2
2
Padlockable Handle
Padlockable Handle
2
2
Catalog
Number 1
10
1223C77G03
10
1223C77G05 2
10
1223C77G06 2
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
GPHBOFF
J, K
PHB3
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
PHL1
2
2
2
Notes
1 Accepts 0.285 Lock Shank.
2 Padlockable in the OFF position only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-312
2.3
Catalog
Number
Description
F-Frame
Single-pole breakers
PHL1
PLK1
PLK1LOFF
PLK1ROFF
2
2
2
J, K-Frames
Two-, three- and four-pole breakers
PLK3
PLK3LOFF 1
PLK3ROFF
2
2
Lock ON or OFF
HLK4
HLK4LOFF 1
Lock ON or OFF
HLK4S
HLK4SOFF 1
M-Frame
Lock ON or OFF
HLK4
HLK4LOFF 1
HLK4S
HLK4SOFF
2
2
N-Frame
Side mounted
PLK5
PLK5S
PLK5SOFF 1
Lock ON/OFF
HLK6
HLK6OFF 1
R-Frame
2
2
Cylinder Lock
Cylinder Lock
Cylinder Lock
Frame
Catalog
Number
F, J, K
Order by description
2
2
Note
1 For padlockable handle lock hasp to padlock handle in OFF
position only, order either catalog number.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-313
2.3
2
2
2
2
Bolt Projection in
Withdrawn Position
in Inches (mm)
Kit
Catalog
Number
Superior
B-4003-1
0.38 (9.5)
KYK1
Kirk
0.38 (9.5)
KYK1
Castell 1
K or QK
0.38 (9.5)
CTK1
Superior
B-4003-1
0.38 (9.5)
KYK3
Kirk
0.38 (9.5)
KYK3
Castell 1
K or QK
0.38 (9.5)
CTK3
photo
2
2
Lock
Manufacturer
F-Frame
position
J, K-Frames
B-4003-1
0.38 (9.5)
KYK4
Kirk
0.38 (9.5)
KYK4
Castell 1
K or QK
0.38 (9.5)
CTK4
R-Frame
Superior
B-4003-1
1.0 (25.4)
KYK6
Kirk
1.0 (25.4)
KYK6
Castell 1
K or QK
1.0 (25.4)
CTK6
Superior
B-4003-1
0.38 (9.5)
KYKJG
Kirk
0.38 (9.5)
KYKJG
Castell 1
K or QK
0.38 (9.5)
CTKJG
Superior
B-4003-1
0.38 (9.5)
KYKLG
Kirk
0.38 (9.5)
KYKLG
Castell 1
K or QK
0.38 (9.5)
CTKLG
JG-Frame
LG-Frame
2
2
Note
1 When ordering Castell Interlock, it is necessary for customer to specify that the mounting bolt holes must be
10 mm in diameter
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-314
2
spacing as indicated in table
and enclosure front panel
thickness of 1/8 or 3/16 inch
(3.2 or 4.8 mm). (For field
installation only.)
2
2
2
Centerline Spacing
in Inches (mm)
Catalog
Number
4.19 (106.4)
SBK1
4.38 (111.3)
SBK2
5.75 (146.0)
SBK3
L, M
8.50 (215.9)
SBK4
8.50 (215.9)
SBK5
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
WBL1
WBL3
L, M
WBL4A
WBL5
R1
WBL6
2
2
2
Note
1 Three-pole only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-315
2.3
Electrical Operator
2
2
Terminal Block
Voltage
Frequency
Catalog
Number
120
AC
EOP1T07
EOP1P07
240
AC
EOP1T11
EOP1P11
2
2
Frequency
Catalog
Number
120
50/60 Hz AC
MOPFD120C
24
DC
MOPFD24D
125
DC
MOPFD120C
208240
50/60 Hz
MOPFD240C
220250
DC
MOPFD240C
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Frequency
Catalog
Number
120
50/60 Hz AC
EOP2T07
240
50/60 Hz AC
EOP2T11
Frequency
Catalog
Number
120
50/60 Hz AC
EOP3MT07
240
50/60 Hz AC
EOP3MT11
Catalog
Number
BBMK3
2
2
2
Operating
Voltage
Frequency
Catalog
Number
120
50/60 Hz
EOP4MT07
208
50/60 Hz
EOP4MT11
240
50/60 Hz
EOP4MT11A
480
50/60 Hz
EOP4MT15
125
DC
EOP4MT26
24
DC
EOP4MT21
2
2
2
Note
1 Motor operators MOP1P07, MOP1P03DC, MOP1P05DC and MOP1P07DC are replaced by MOPFD
motor operators listed in table.
V4-T2-316
2.3
Operating
Voltage
Frequency
Catalog
Number
120
50/60 Hz
EOP5T07
208
50/60 Hz
EOP5T09
240
50/60 Hz
EOP5T11
480
50/60 Hz
EOP5T15
24
DC
EOP5T21
48
DC
EOP5T22
125
DC
EOP5T26
2
2
2
2
Operating
Voltage
Frequency
Catalog
Number
120
50/60 Hz
EOP6T08K
240
50/60 Hz
EOP6T11K
48
DC
EOP6T21K
2
2
Plug-In Adapters
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
100225
1480D13G01
1480D13G02
1480D13G07 1
Mounting plate
176C511H01
507C047H01
2
2
2
2
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Terminal
End
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
Line
1260C86G05
1260C86G06
1231C67G01
Load
1260C86G07
1260C86G08
1231C67G02
506C144G27
506C144G28
PMP23
Mounting plate
2
2
2
2
2
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Continuous Current
Rating (Amperes)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
400
PAD32
PAD33
Mounting plate
PMP33
2
2
Notes
1 100 ampere maximum.
2 Use three-pole mounting plate for two-pole circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-317
2.3
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Continuous Current
Rating (Amperes)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
506C059G03
506C059G04
PAD44
1288C19G01
1288C19G02
6636C55H01
Mounting plate
504C824H01
504C824H01
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole
Continuous Current
Rating (Amperes)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
800
2614D53G05
2614D53G06
Mounting plate
1290C73H01
1290C73H01
2
2
2
2
2
Three-Pole
Continuous Current
Rating (Amperes)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
1200
2614D53G03
2614D53G04
Mounting plate
1290C73H01
1290C73H01
Plug-In Adapters
Frame
Number of
Poles
Standard
Certification
Catalog
Number
FD
IEC
PAD3F
FD
IEC
PAD4F
JD
IEC
PAD3JD
KD
IEC
PAD3K
LD
IEC
PAD3LD
LD
IEC
PAD4LD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-318
2.3
F-Frame 1
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Tube
Catalog
Number
Stud Catalog
Number
314C960G07
314C960G08
100 A short
451D874G01
32B9446H20
100 A short
451D874G01
32B9446H21
100 A short
451D874G01
32B9446H22
100 A short
451D874G01
32B9446H23
100 A long
451D874G02
32B9446H24
100 A long
451D874G02
32B9446H25
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Stud
Catalog
Number
100 A long
451D874G02
32B9446H26
225
314C960G01
100 A long
451D874G02
32B9446H27
400
314C960G04
400
314C960G05
400
314C960G06
600
314C960G07
600
314C960G08
600
314C960G09
800
314C960G10
800
314C960G11
800
314C960G12
374D883G01
374D883H06
225A short
374D883G01
374D883H07
225A short
374D883G01
374D883H08
225A short
374D883G01
374D883H09
225A long
374D883G02
374D883H10
225A long
374D883G02
374D883H11
225A long
374D883G02
374D883H12
225A long
374D883G02
374D883H13
314C960G09
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Stud
Catalog
Number
Tube
Catalog
Number
250A short
5010D23G01
456D983H05
250A short
5010D23G01
456D983H06
250A short
5010D23G01
456D983H07
250A long
5010D23G02
5010D23H05
250A long
5010D23G02
5010D23H06
250A long
5010D23G02
5010D23H07
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Stud
Catalog
Number
800
623B222G01
800
623B222G02
800
623B222G03
1200
373B375G04
1200
373B375G03
2
2
2
2
2
Note
1 Not UL listed.
2
2
K-Frame 1
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Stud
Catalog
Number
Standard Tube
Catalog
Number
400 A short
6642C14G02
313C909H17
400 A short
6642C14G04
313C909H18
400 A short
6642C14G06
313C909H19
400 A long
6642C14G03
313C909H20
400 A long
6642C14G05
313C909H21
400 A long
6642C14G07
313C909H22
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-319
2.3
Bus
Spacing
in Inches
(mm)
Continuous
Current
Rating
(Amperes)
2.75 (69.9)
2.75 (69.9)
Outside
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
50
673B142G02
673B142G09
100
673B142G02
673B142G10
2.75 (69.9)
150
673B142G04
673B142G03
3.50 (88.9)
50
1253C72G01
1253C72G03
3.50 (88.9)
100
1253C73G03
1253C73G06
3.50 (88.9)
150
1253C73G01
1253C73G05
2
2
2
2
Number of Poles
Catalog
Number
624B600H02
624B600H01
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Continuous
Current
Rating
(Amperes)
3.50 (88.9)
250
Outside
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
2600D26G01
2600D26G02
Continuous
Current
Rating
(Amperes)
3.50 (88.9)
400
Outside
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
4212B78G02
4212B77G01
Number of Poles
Catalog
Number
2, 3
208B264H01
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-320
2.3
Outside
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
624B609G01
506C052G01
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
2, 3
208B297H01
2
2
2
2
Continuous
Current
Rating
(Amperes)
3.50 (88.9)
800
Catalog
Number
Short
314C996G01
Medium
314C996G02
Long
314C996G03
2
2
2
2
2
315C270H01
2
2
Continuous
Current
Rating
(Amperes)
Connector
Type
Catalog
Number
3.50 (88.9)
1200
Short
505C606G04
Medium
505C606G05
Long
505C606G06
2
2
2
2
2
315C270H01
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-321
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
interrupting capacity at up to
600 Vac. LFD current limiters
for thermal-magnetic circuit
breakers are listed with
Underwriters Laboratories
under File E47239.
Catalog
Number
1570
LFD3070R
80160
LFD3150R
2
2
Series C
2
2
GF Alarm Unit
Description
Catalog
Number
GFAU
1264C67G01
Catalog
Number
DOPTMLN
IQ Energy Sentinel
The IQ Energy Sentinel
is a highly accurate,
microprocessor-based,
breaker-mounted device
designed to monitor power
and energy readings. It
represents an alternative to
watt meters, watt-hour
meters, and watt demand
meters. Key advantages
include savings in space,
lower installation costs, and
remote monitoring capability.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-322
Catalog
Number
STK2
Auxiliary Power
Module
Catalog
Number
Digitrip OPTIMizer
The Digitrip OPTIMizer is a
hand-held programmer that is
used to access, configure,
test and display information
from OPTIM trip units. The
OPTIMizer plugs into the
front of an OPTIM trip unit via
an eight-pin telephone jack
and is powered by a nine-volt
battery or the auxiliary power
module. One highlighted
feature is the Copy and
Download commands.
Setting up multiple OPTIM
trips can be finished in
minutes and with no errors.
An Auxiliary Power Module
connection provides a trip test
when control power is not
present at the breaker. The
OPTIMizer is supplied as a
standard package to include
Digitrip OPTIMizer
2
2
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
PRTBAPMDV
BIMII
Digitrip OPTIMizer
2.3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
DIGIVIEW
DIGIVIEWR06
2
breaker trips, the module
indicates the cause of trip
(long delay, short delay,
instantaneous and ground) via
LED indication. The module is
reset after the breaker is
reset.
2
2
2
2
Catalog
Number
OPTIMizerstandard package
Catalog
Number
TRIP-LED
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-323
2.3
Accessories
Wire Seal
The wire seal can be used to secure the cover on the trip unit to
prevent adjustments after settings are confirmed.
Handle Length
in Inches (mm)
Catalog
Number 2
Wire Seal
4 (101.6)
C361KJ4
6 (152.4)
C361KJ6
Roller Latch 3
C361KR
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Description
Catalog
Number
Wire seal
5108A03H01
Notes
1 Customer: Consult with box manufacturer for correct door hardware and any adapters
required for assembly.
2 The 1/4-inch x 1/2-inch (6.35 x 12.7 mm) standard mill rectangular locking bar is not supplied
with these kits.
3 Third roller latch for use with 4- or 6-inch (101.6 or 152.4 mm) handle when 3 point latching is
required.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-324
2.3
Electrical Operator
F-Frame Electrical (Solenoid) Operator Rating Data 12
Voltage 3
Frequency
Inrush Current
Amperes
Maximum
Operating Time
Fuse
Amperes 4
120
50/60 Hz AC
10
240
50/60 Hz AC
Frequency
Inrush Current
Amperes
120
AC
24
DC
48
DC
125
DC
168j
Operating Voltage 3
120 AC
31
208 AC
13
240 AC
12
125 DC
21
24 DC
50
2
2
2
Frequency
Fuse
Amperes
50/60 Hz
31
208
50/60 Hz
21
240
50/60 Hz
19
3
2
120
480
50/60 Hz
Voltage 3
Inrush Current
Amperes
Fuse
Amperes
24
DC
50
120
30
48
DC
80
240
16
125
DC
21
2
2
2
Operating
Voltage 3
Inrush Current
Amperes
Fuse
Amperes
Operating
Voltage q
Frequency
120
30
120
50/60 Hz
40
240
50/60 Hz
27
48
DC
53
24
DC
58
240
16
Inrush Current
Amperes
Operating
Voltage 3
1689
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 UL listed under UL File E64983.
2 The electrical operator design is endurance tested for 8000 electrical operations.
3 Tolerance: +10%, 15% of nominal voltage.
4 Use current-limiting type fuse where required.
5 UL listed under UL File E64124.
6 Frequency: 50/60 Hz.
7 Maximum operating time: 3 seconds max. Operator is an intermittent duty device. The safe
duty cycle (OFF to ON to OFF) should not exceed one per minute.
8 The electrical operator design has been endurance tested for 6000 electrical operations.
9 Maximum operating time: 5 cycles (80 mS).
j Maximum operating time: 12 cycles.
k The electrical operator design has been endurance tested for 2,500 electrical operations.
l Maximum operating time: 12 cycles max. Operator is an intermittent duty device. The safe
duty cycle (OFF to ON to OFF) should not exceed one per minute.
m Operator is an intermittent duty service. The safe duty cycle (OFF to ON to OFF) should not
exceed one per minute.
n Electric Operating time at rated voltage; (a) To turn breaker ON1/2 second max. (b) To turn
breaker OFF1/2 second max.
o Motor operating temperature; Class A temperature limits apply.
p A minimum 1 kVA power source is recommended for motor operation.
q Applied voltage should be no less than 85% or no more than 110% of rated voltage.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-325
2.3
2
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
F-Frame 1
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Stud
Catalog
Number
Panel Thickness
Tube Length
Tube
Catalog
Number
Dimensions
D
451D874G01
1.00 (25.4)
1.06 (26.9)
32B9446H20
3.63 (92.1)
0.31 (7.9)18
100 A short
451D874G01
1.38 (34.9)
32B9446H21
3.63 (92.1)
0.31 (7.9)18
100 A short
451D874G01
1.69 (42.9)
32B9446H22
3.63 (92.1)
0.31 (7.9)18
100 A short
451D874G01
2.00 (50.8)
32B9446H23
3.63 (92.1)
0.31 (7.9)18
100 A long
451D874G02
1.00 (25.4)
3.44 (87.3)
32B9446H24
6.13 (155.6)
0.31 (7.9)18
100 A long
451D874G02
3.75 (95.2)
32B9446H25
6.13 (155.6)
0.31 (7.9)18
100 A long
451D874G02
4.06 (103.1)
32B9446H26
6.13 (155.6)
0.31 (7.9)18
100 A long
451D874G02
4.38 (111.3)
32B9446H27
6.13 (155.6)
0.31 (7.9)18
225A short
374D883G01
1.00 (25.4)
1.06 (26.9)
374D883H06
4.25 (108.0)
0.44 (11.1)14
225A short
374D883G01
1.38 (34.9)
374D883H07
4.25 (108.0)
0.44 (11.1)14
225A short
374D883G01
1.69 (42.9)
374D883H08
4.25 (108.0)
0.44 (11.1)14
225A short
374D883G01
2.00 (50.8)
374D883H09
4.25 (108.0)
0.44 (11.1)14
2
2
2
2
225A long
374D883G02
1.00 (25.4)
3.44 (87.3)
374D883H10
7.50 (190.5)
0.44 (11.1)14
225A long
374D883G02
3.75 (95.2)
374D883H11
7.50 (190.5)
0.44 (11.1)14
225A long
374D883G02
4.06 (103.1)
374D883H12
7.50 (190.5)
0.44 (11.1)14
225A long
374D883G02
4.38 (111.3)
374D883H13
7.50 (190.5)
0.44 (11.1)14
F-Frame
2
2
2
2
E
B
Mounting Panel
2
.75
(19.1)
2
2
F Thread
Breaker Mounting
Surface
.06
(1.5)
C
D
Note
1 Not UL listed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-326
2.3
J-Frame
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Stud
Catalog
Number
Panel Thickness
Tube Length
Tube
Catalog
Number
250A short
5010D23G01
0.751.00 (19.125.4)
0.84 (21.4)
456D983H05
250A short
5010D23G01
0.500.75 (12.719.1)
1.09 (27.7)
456D983H06
250A short
5010D23G01
0.250.50 (6.412.7)
1.03 (26.2)
456D983H07
250A long
5010D23G02
0.751.00 (19.125.4)
3.88 (98.6)
5010D23H05
250A long
5010D23G02
0.500.75 (12.719.1)
4.13 (104.9)
5010D23H06
250A long
5010D23G02
0.250.50 (6.412.7)
4.38 (111.3)
5010D23H07
1.59
(40.4)
0.59
(15.0)
0.06
(1.5)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
6.66
(169.2)
A
0.03
(0.7)
2
2
Breaker
Mounting Panel
3.63
(92.2)
2
2
K-Frame 1
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Stud
Catalog
Number
Panel Thickness
Tube Length
400 A short
6642C14G02
0.751 (19.125.4)
400 A short
6642C14G04
0.500.75 (12.718.4)
400 A short
6642C14G06
0.250.5 (6.3512.7)
400 A long
6642C14G03
0.751 (19.125.4)
400 A long
6642C14G05
0.500.75 (12.718.4)
400 A long
6642C14G07
Dimensions
Standard Tube
Catalog
Number
0.84 (21.3)
313C909H17
3.66 (93.0)
0.7516 (19.1406.4)
1.09 (27.69)
313C909H18
1.03 (26.16)
313C909H19
3.78 (96.0)
313C909H20
4.03 (102.4)
313C909H21
6.58 (167.1)
4.28 (108.7)
313C909H22
2
2
2
2
2
E
B
Mounting Panel
2
2
F Thread
Breaker Mounting
Surface
2
0.06
(1.5)
1.67
(42.4)
2
A
Note
1 Not UL listed.
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-327
2.3
L-Frame
Stud Catalog
Number
5.47 (138.9)
314C960G07
7.97 (202.4)
314C960G08
10.47 (265.9)
314C960G09
2
2
.44
(11.2)
Insulators
Washer
Nut
2
2
Circuit Breaker
Insulating Panel
Rear
Connecting
Stud
2
2
M-Frame
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Diameter
and
Thread
Extension
Back of
Breaker
Stud
Catalog
Number
225
0.50 (12.7)13
3.66 (93.0)
314C960G01
400
0.75 (19.1)16
5.91 (150.1)
314C960G04
400
0.75 (19.1)16
8.41 (213.6)
314C960G05
400
0.75 (19.1)16
10.91 (277.0)
314C960G06
600
1.00 (25.4)12
5.91 (150.1)
314C960G07
600
1.00 (25.4)12
8.41 (213.6)
314C960G08
600
1.00 (25.4)12
10.91 (277.0)
314C960G09
800
1.13 (28.7)12
5.91 (150.1)
314C960G10
800
1.13 (28.7)12
8.41 (213.6)
314C960G11
800
1.13 (28.7)12
10.91 (277.0)
314C960G12
Stud
Ampere
Rating
Diameter
and
Thread
Extension
Back of
Breaker
Stud
Catalog
Number
800
1.13 (28.7)12
5.5 (139.7)
623B222G01
800
1.13 (28.7)12
8.0 (203.2)
623B222G02
800
1.13 (28.7)12
10.5 (266.7)
623B222G03
1200
1.25 (31.8)12
5.5 (139.7)
373B375G04
1200
1.25 (31.8)12
10.5 (266.7)
373B375G03
2
2
2
N-Frame
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-328
2.4
Contents
Description
Page
V4-T2-330
V4-T2-330
V4-T2-332
V4-T2-332
V4-T2-332
V4-T2-332
V4-T2-333
V4-T2-334
V4-T2-332
V4-T2-335
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Overview
GP, FP, KP, LP and MP Frames
15800 Amperes
NEMA 480 Vac
Eatons Definite Purpose
molded case circuit breakers
are available in three-pole
configurations, and are
designed to meet the specific
requirements of HVAC/R
and pumping applications.
As with other members of
Eatons family of molded
case circuit breakers, Definite
Purpose breakers provide
high quality, reliability,
unmatched performance
and outstanding value.
External Accessories
Definite Purpose breakers
use the same external
accessories as Series C
breakers: handle
mechanisms, motor
operators, lock-off devices,
busbar extensions and
multiple terminal
arrangements.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-329
2.4
2
2
Electrical Characteristics
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Breaker Type
GPS
FPS
FPH
KPS
KPH
Amperage range
15100 A
15225A
15225A
200400 A
200400 A
H
Performance level
240 Vac
65
65
100
65
100
480 Vac
22
35
65
35
65
600 Vac
18
25
25
35
Number of poles
480
600
600
600
600
Thermal-magnetic
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-330
2.4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Breaker Type
LPS
LPH
MPS
MPH
Amperage range
450600 A
450600 A
700800 A
700800 A
Performance level
240 Vac
65
100
65
100
480 Vac
35
65
50
65
600 Vac
25
35
25
35
Number of poles
Maximum voltage (Vac)
600
600
600
600
Thermal-magnetic
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-331
2.4
Features
English
Metric
GP
Included
FP
BMH1
BMH1M
KP
BMH3
BMH3M
LP
BMH4
BMH4M
MP
BMH5
BMH5M
2
2
2
2
2
Termination
Type
Awg Wire
Range
Metric Wire
Range (mm)
Wire
Type
Bolt Size
English
Bolt Size
Metric
Torque
LbIn
Torque
Nm
Catalog
Number
GP
Wire
#141/0
2.550
Cu only
45
5.1
Included
Breaker
Maximum
Amperes
Awg Wire
Range
Wire
Type
Catalog
Number
Catalog Number
with Control Wire
Termination
100
#14#10
Cu/Al
3T100FB 1
100
#8
Cu/Al
3T100FB 1
100
#6#4
Cu/Al
3T100FB 1
100
#34/0
Cu/Al
3T100FB 1
200
#34/0
Cu only
3T150FB 1
225
#44/0
Cu/Al
3TA225FB 1
225
#6300
Cu/Al
3TA225FDK 1
400
250500 (1)
Cu/Al
TA350K
400
3/0250 (2)
Cu/Al
3TA400K 1
3TA400KCW
TA602LDCW
FP
KP
LP
MP
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
500
250350 (2)
Cu/Al
TA602LD
600
400500 (2)
Cu/Al
3TA603LDK 1
3TA603LDKCW
800
3/0400 (3)
Cu/Al
TA800MA2
TA800MA2CWT
800
500750 (2)
Cu/Al
TA801MA
TA801MACWT
Note
1 Package of three terminals.
Accessories
End Cap Accessory Kit
End caps for line and load
conductor termination are
optional with each breaker.
End caps secure the
conductor with a ring-type
connector. The kit includes
one end cap, three cap
screws, three nuts and three
lock washers.
Series C Accessories
For internal accessories, see
Page V4-T2-271.
For external accessories, see
Page V4-T2-302.
2
2
V4-T2-332
2.4
FP S 3 150 L
Frame Size
GP = GP-Frame
FP = FP-Frame
KP = KP-Frame
LP = LP-Frame
MP = LP-Frame
GP-Frame
015 = 15A
020 = 20 A
025 = 25 A
030 = 30 A
035 = 35A
040 = 40 A
045 = 45A
050 = 50 A
060 = 60 A
070 = 70 A
080 = 80 A
090 = 80 A
100 = 100 A
FP-Frame
015 = 15A
020 = 20 A
025 = 25 A
030 = 30 A
035 = 35A
040 = 40 A
045 = 45A
050 = 50 A
060 = 60 A
070 = 70 A
080 = 80 A
100 = 100 A
110 = 110 A
125 = 125A
150 = 150 A
175 = 175A
200 = 200 A
225 = 225A
2
2
Options
Interrupting Rating
S = Standard
H = High 1
Number of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Ampere Rating
KP-Frame
LP-Frame
175 = 175A
450 = 450 A
200 = 200 A
500 = 500 A
250 = 250 A
600 = 600 A
300 = 300 A
400 = 400 A
2
2
2
MP-Frame
700 = 700 A
800 = 800 A
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Not available on GP-Frame.
2 When choosing a molded case switch, select the highest amperage rating for the frame and the standard interrupting rating.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-333
2.4
Product Selection
Catalog Numbers
When ordering Definite Purpose breakers, use the appropriate
catalog numbers given below.
2
2
GP 100
GP-Frame/15100 A
FP 225
FP-Frame/15225 A
Three-Pole
2
2
Three-Pole
Frame/
Ampere Rating
Catalog
Number
Frame/
Ampere Rating
Catalog
Number
GPS3015
FPS3015
GPS3020
FPS3020
GPS3025
FPS3025
GPS3030
FPS3030
GPS3035
FPS3035
GPS3040
FPS3040
GPS3045
FPS3045
GPS3050
FPS3050
GPS3060
FPS3060
GPS3070
FPS3070
GPS3080
FPS3080
GPS3090
FPS3090
GPS3100
FPS3100
GPS3100K
FPS3110
Note: All GP frames come standard with line and load terminals
FPS3125
FPS3150
FPS3175
FPS3200
FPH3015
FPS3225
FPH3020
FPH3030
FPH3040
FPH3025
FPH3035
FPH3045
FPH3060
FPH3050
FPH3070
FPH3080
FPH3100
FPH3090
FPH3110
FPH3150
FPH3125
FPH3175
FPH3200
FPH3225
2
V4-T2-334
FPS3225K
KP 250
KP-Frame/200400 A
2.4
Dimensions
Three-Pole
Frame/
Ampere Rating
Catalog
Number
KPS3175
KPS3200
KPS3400
KPH3175
KPH3200
KPH3250
KPH3300
KPH3400
KP/400 A molded case switch
LP 400
Breaker Type
GP
Width 3.00 (76.2)
FP
KP
LP
MP
4.13 (104.9)
5.49 (139.4)
8.25 (209.6)
8.25 (209.6)
6.00 (152.4)
10.12 (257.0)
10.75 (273.1)
16.00 (406.4)
3.38 (85.9)
4.31 (109.6)
3.81 (96.8)
4.06 (103.1)
KPS3400K
Frame/
Ampere Rating
Catalog
Number
LPS3450
2
2
LPS3500
LPS3600
LPH3450
LPH3500
LPH3600
LPS3600K
2
2
MP-Frame/700800 A
Three-Pole
Frame/
Ampere Rating
Catalog
Number
MPS3700
2
2
2
MPS3800
MPH3700
MPH3800
MP/800 A molded case switch
2
Three-Pole
MP 800
LP-Frame/450600 A
2
2
KPS3250
KPS3300
MPS3800K
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-335
2.5
2
Contents
PM3 Modules
Description
Page
2
2
2
Learn
Online
V4-T2-337
V4-T2-337
V4-T2-338
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
Application Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Communications via
Modbus and Eatons
INCOM protocol;
compatible with Eatons
PXG for Web page and
Ethernet capabilities
Works in 240 Vac PM3,
480 Vac and 600 Vac
applications
Communicates electrical
system data and circuit
breaker status
Calculates power and
energy to an accuracy of
1.0% of reading
Configurable with thermalmagnetic or electronic
trip units
Suitable for reverse-feed
applications
Easy to install
Arcflash Reduction
Maintenance System
Cause-of-trip localized
information through
Digiview and TRIP-LED
Modbus/INCOM
communications
HMI connectivity
through PXG
2
2
V4-T2-336
2.5
Product Selection
PM3 Modules
Frame
Catalog Number
480 V
Description
600 V
Specification
Current Inputs
Modbus
FD
PM3FM
Pickup current
0.3A rms
JG
PM3JM
KD and LG
PM3LM
Accuracy
0.5% of reading
INCOM
FD
PM3FI480
PM3FI600
Voltage Inputs
JG
PM3JI480
PM3JI600
Range
KD and LG
PM3LI480
PM3LI600
Supported systems
Description
FD
LG
Input impedance
996 kiloohm/phase
Neutral connection
KD
Frame
JG
2
2
Frequency
Frequency
50/60 Hz
Accuracy
0.1 Hz
Resolution
0.1 Hz
2
2
Isolation
All inputs and outputs are galvanically isolated to 2500 V.
IA, IB, IC
Apparent Power A, B, C;
Apparent Power Total;
Reactive Power A, B, C;
Reactive Power Total; Real
Power A, B, C;
Real Power Total
Frequency, Apparent
Power Factor, Apparent
PFA, Apparent PFB,
Apparent PFC
Environmental Ratings
Operating temperature
20 C to +50 C
Storage temperature
20 C to +50 C
Operating humidity
5 to 95% RH noncondensing
Voltage, current
True rms
Sampling rate
Sensing Method
Update Rate
Watts, VAR and VA
1.03 sec at 60 Hz
1.07 sec at 60 Hz
DC voltage
1830 Vdc
Maximum current
30.0 mA at 24 Vdc
Burden
0.72W
2
2
01247
Data format
Protocols
Modbus RTU
Default: 8, N, 2
Default: Enabled
V4-T2-337
2
2
2.5
2
1.38
(35.1)
2
2
2.88
(73.2)
3.63
(92.2)
3.63
(92.2)
On
Off
6.00
(152.4)
CL
Handle
0.69
(17.5)
Line End
7.00
(177.8)
CL
Handle
O
N
O
F
F
LED
5.50
(139.7)
3.95
(100.3)
11.00
(279.4)
10.50
(266.7)
O
N
12.00
(304.8)
1 2 3 4 5 6
123456789101112131415
2.06
(52.3)
3.34
(84.8)
Load End
123456789101112131415
2.06
(52.3)
3.42
(86.9)
3.94 (100.1)
4.13 (104.9)
Load End
1.72
(43.7)
2
2
0.86
(21.8)
Line End
12.14
(308.4)
CL
Handle
10.13
(257.3)
Power Monitoring/
Metering Module
Tx
ON O
Rx
Settings
1 2 3 4 5 6
2 3 4 5 6
MODBUS
COM
EARTH
24 Vdc (+)
24 Vdc ()
13.83
(351.3)
Network Address
Power
Bell Alarm
COM
COM
Aux. Alarm
V Neutral
Power Monitoring/
Metering Module
Tx
ON O
MODBUS
COM
EARTH
Load End
Rx
Settings
1 2 3 4 5 6
2 3 4 5 6
STATUS
Network Address
N1
24 Vdc (+)
2.74
(69.6)
5.48 (139.2)
CL
Handle
10.13
(257.3)
3.98
(101.1)
Power
Bell Alarm
COM
COM
Aux. Alarm
V Neutral
See breaker for terminal information.
See instruction sheet for high voltage tests.
For use on Series G, L-Frame or Series C, K-Frame
Circuit Breaker, Switch, Motor Circuit Protector.
2.74
(69.6)
5.48 (139.2)
4.06
(103.1)
4.88 (124.0)
13.82
(351.0)
Load End
Frame
FD
1.26 (0.57)
JG
1.60 (0.73)
KD/LG
2.25 (1.02)
5.58
(141.7)
CL
Handle
24 Vdc ()
Line End
4.31 (109.5)
4.06
(103.1)
3.98
(101.1)
5.58
(141.7)
8.44
(214.4)
12.14
(308.4)
STATUS
N1
0.86
(21.8)
4.73
(120.1)
5.77
(146.6)
CL
Handle
Off/O
8.44
(214.4)
1.72
(43.7)
On/I
4.31 (109.5)
4.06
(103.1)
3.81
(96.8)
5.77
(146.6)
4.92
(125.0)
3.34
(84.8)
3.42
(86.9)
4.41 (112.0)
4.13 (104.9)
LED
1 2 3 4 5 6
CL
Handle
PUSH TO
TRIP
FACTO
O
N
9.53
(242.1)
3.57 (90.7)
3.44
(87.4)
3.34
(84.8)
3.95
(100.3)
3.17
(80.5)
CL
Handle
S
RY EA
4.50
(114.3)
2
2
Line End
1.38
(35.1)
FACTO
3.50 (88.9)
3.39
(86.1)
3.19
(81.0)
123456789101112131415
0.69
(17.5)
S
RY EA
V4-T2-338
FD
JG
KD/LG
FD/JG
KD/LG
3.98
(101.1)
4.06
(103.1)
5.43 (137.9)
2.6
Contents
Description
Engine Generator Circuit Breakers
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories Selection Guide and
Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Options and Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Technical Data and Specifications . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions and Weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct Current Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers600 Vdc Per-Pole
and 1000 Vdc Poles-in-Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
E2 Mining Service Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . .
Classic Mining Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR . . . .
Learn
Online
Page
V4-T2-340
V4-T2-341
V4-T2-343
V4-T2-343
V4-T2-344
V4-T2-344
V4-T2-345
V4-T2-358
V4-T2-370
V4-T2-396
V4-T2-410
Drawings
Online
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Application Description
2
2
2
Underwriters Laboratories
Standard UL 489, Molded
Case Circuit Breakers and
Circuit Breaker Enclosures
File E7819
Canadian Standards
Association Standard
C22.2 No. 5, Service
Entrance and Branch Circuit
Breakers
International
Electrotechnical
Commission
Recommendations IEC
947-2, Circuit Breakers
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-339
2.6
2
2
2
2
2
2
FG 3 100 W
2
2
Frame
FG
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Number of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Trip Amperes
015
020
025
030
035
040
045
050
060
070
080
090
100
125
150
175
200
225
JG
175
200
225
250
KG
300
350
400
2
2
LG
450
500
600
NG
700
800
900
1000
1200
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-340
Suffix
W = Without terminals
2.6
Product Selection
The following table lists FG
through NG engine generator
breakers with the maximum
generator kVA and kW rating.
Engine generator breakers
are applied at 115% of the
2
2
2
Thermal-Magnetic
Engine Generator
Breaker 3
240 Vac
480 Vac
600 Vac
kVA 1
kW 2
kVA 1
kW 2
kVA 1
kW 2
Catalog
Number
Fixed
11
14
11
FG3015 4
Fixed
14
12
18
14
FG3020 4
Fixed
18
14
23
18
FG3025 4
Fixed
11
22
17
27
22
FG3030 4
Fixed
13
10
25
20
32
25
FG3035 4
Fixed
14
12
29
23
36
29
FG3040 4
Fixed
16
13
32
26
41
32
FG3045 4
Fixed
18
14
36
29
45
36
FG3050 4
Fixed
22
17
43
35
54
43
FG3060 4
Fixed
25
20
51
40
63
51
FG3070 4
Fixed
29
23
58
46
72
58
FG3080 4
4
Fixed
32
26
65
52
81
65
FG3090
Fixed
36
29
72
58
90
72
FG3100 4
Fixed
40
32
79
64
99
79
FG3110 4
Fixed
45
36
90
72
113
90
FG3125 4
Fixed
54
43
108
87
135
108
FG3150 4
4
Fixed
63
51
126
101
158
126
FG3175
Fixed
72
58
144
116
181
144
FG3200 4
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Fixed
81
65
162
130
203
162
FG3225
350700
63
51
126
101
158
126
JG3175W 5
350700
63
51
126
101
158
126
JG3175 4
350700
72
58
144
116
181
144
JG3200W 5
350700
72
58
144
116
181
144
JG3200 4
350700
81
65
162
130
203
162
JG3225W 5
350700
81
65
162
130
203
162
JG3225 4
350700
90
72
181
144
226
181
JG3250W 5
350700
90
72
181
144
226
181
JG3250 4
5001000
108
87
217
173
271
217
KG3300W 5
5001000
108
87
217
173
271
217
KG3300 4
5001000
126
101
253
202
316
253
KG3350W 5
5001000
126
101
253
202
316
253
KG3350 4
10002000
144
116
289
231
361
289
KG3400 4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Breaker continuous current is based on 115% of the generator full load ampere rating.
2 Based on three-phase generators at 80% power factor.
3 FG, JG, KG include thermal-magnetic trip units, LG and NG include electronic trip units.
4 Breaker includes line and load terminals.
5 Without terminals.
2
2
2
The following catalog numbers have center tap studs for dual voltage applications: JG3070CT, JG3100CT, JG3125CT, KG3175CT, LG3300CTW.
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-341
2.6
2
2
Electronic
Engine Generator
Breaker 3
240 Vac
kVA 1
kW 2
kVA 1
kW 2
kVA 1
kW 2
Catalog
Number
5002500
162
130
325
260
406
325
LG3450 4
5002500
181
144
361
289
451
361
LG3500 4
5002500
217
173
433
347
542
433
LG3600 4
5002500
253
202
505
404
632
505
NG3700 4
5002500
289
231
578
462
722
578
NG3800 4
12505000
325
260
650
520
812
650
NG3900 4
12505000
361
289
722
578
903
722
NG31000 4
12505000
433
347
867
693
1083
867
NG31200 4
2
2
2
480 Vac
600 Vac
Notes
1 Breaker continuous current is based on 115% of the generator full load ampere rating.
2 Based on three-phase generators at 80% power factor.
3 FG, JG, KG include thermal-magnetic trip units, LG and NG include electronic trip units.
4 Breaker includes line and load terminals.
The following catalog numbers have center tap studs for dual voltage applications: JG3070CT, JG3100CT, JG3125CT, KG3175CT, LG3300CTW.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-342
Enclosures
Type 1 General Purpose
Standard Terminals
Interchangeable hubs
(through 400 amperes)
151200 ampere range
600 Vac, 500 Vdc
FG
15225
JG
175250
KG
300400
LG
450600
NG
7001200
Enclosure
Type Class
Breaker
Frame
Max. Amp
Rating
AWG Wire
Range
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Catalog
Number
FG
100
141/0
2.550
3T100FB 1
FG
150
44/0
2595
3TA225FD 1
JG
250
4350 kcmil
25185
TA250KB
KG
350
250500 kcmil
120240
TA350K
KG
400
95120
3TA400K 1
LG
600
120240
3TA603LDK
NG
700
50300
TA700NB1
NG
1000
95185
TA1000NB1
NG
1200
120300
TA1200NB1
No knockouts or other
openings
151200 ampere range
600 Vac, 500 Vdc
2.6
Catalog
Number
Type 1
SFDN225
Type 3R
RFDN225
Type 12
JFDN225
Type 1
SJDN250
Type 3R
RJDN250
Type 12
JJDN250
Type 1
SKDN400
Type 3R
RKDN400
Type 12
JKDN400
Type 1
SLDN600
Type 3R
RLDN600
Type 12
JLDN600
Type 1
SNDN1200
Type 3R
RNDN1200
Type 12
JNDN1200
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Ground Lug
Size Cu/Al
Catalog
Number
100
(1) 141/0
(1) 141/0
INK100
250
INK250
400
INK400
600
INK600
1200
INK1200
2
2
2
Internal Accessories
Auxiliary Switch 2
1A-1B
2A-2B
Breaker
Frame
Factory
Mounted
Field Kit
Catalog Number
Factory
Mounted
Field Kit
Catalog Number
FG 3
A06
A1X1PK
A13
A2X1RPK
JG
A06
A1X2PK
A13
A2X2PK
KG
A06
A1X3PK
A13
A2X3PK
LG
A06
A1X4PK
A13
A2X4PK
NG
A06
A1X5PK
A13
A2X5PK
Shunt Trip 2
Breaker
Frame
Rating
Factory
Mounted
Field Kit
Catalog Number
FG 3
1224 Vdc
S02
SNT1LP03K
JG
1224 Vdc
S42
SNT2P04K
KG
1224 Vdc
S42
SNT3P04K
LG
1224 Vdc
S02
SNT4LP03K
NG
1224 Vdc
S02
SNT5LP03K
Notes
1 Package of three terminals.
2 Other accessories are available. Same as standard frame breakers.
3 Field installation on the FG Frame is not UL listed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-343
2.6
Interrupting Capacity
(Symmetrical Amperes)
240
18,000
480
14,000
600
10,000
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volts AC
(50/60 Hz)
Interrupting Capacity
(Symmetrical Amperes)
220, 240
18,000/ 9,000
380, 415
14,000/ 7,000
660, 690
18,000/ 9,000
14,000/ 7,000
10,000/5,000
Breaker
Frame
Amperes
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Enclosure
Type Class
FG
15225
JG
175250
KG
300400
LG
450600
NG
7001200
2
2
2
Approx. Weight
Lbs (kg)
Conduit Sizes,
Inches
Type 1
23.25 (590.6)
8.41 (213.6)
6.28 (159.5)
18.75 (476.3)
1.20 (30.5)
15 (7)
Type 3R
25.66 (651.8)
8.84 (224.7)
9.31 (236.5)
24.28 (616.7)
1.70 (43.2)
19 (9)
Type 12
25.66 (651.8)
8.84 (224.7)
9.31 (236.5)
24.28 (616.7)
1.70 (43.2)
18 (8)
JFDN225
Type 1
34.70 (881.4)
10.92 (277.4)
7.20 (182.9)
30.00 (762.0)
1.88 (47.8)
31 (14)
SJDN250
Type 3R
37.50 (952.5)
11.56 (293.6)
10.22 (259.6)
35.77 (908.6)
1.94 (49.3)
40 (18)
RJDN250
Type 12
37.53 (953.3)
11.56 (293.6)
10.22 (259.6)
35.77 (908.6)
1.94 (49.3)
37 (17)
JJDN250
Type 1
38.81 (985.8)
11.06 (280.9)
10.94 (277.9)
34.00 (863.6)
2.28 (57.9)
53 (24)
Type 3R
41.69 (1058.9)
11.75 (298.5)
14.06 (357.1)
39.90 (1013.5)
1.97 (50.0)
60 (27)
RKDN400
Type 12
41.69 (1058.9)
11.75 (298.5)
14.06 (357.1)
39.90 (1013.5)
1.97 (50.0)
53 (24)
JKDN400
Type 1
45.88 (1165.4)
14.31 (363.5)
12.38 (314.5)
46.56 (1182.6)
1.91 (48.5)
81 (37)
SLDN600
Type 3R
48.31 (1227.1)
14.91 (378.7)
15.50 (393.7)
46.56 (1182.6)
1.92 (48.8)
84 (38)
RLDN600
Type 12
48.31 (1227.1)
14.91 (378.7)
15.50 (393.7)
46.56 (1182.6)
1.92 (48.8)
81 (37)
JLDN600
Type 1
61.22 (1555.0)
21.44 (544.6)
15.41 (391.4)
61.84 (1570.7)
1.97 (50.0)
178 (81)
SNDN1200
Type 3R
63.59 (1615.2)
22.00 (558.8)
17.63 (447.8)
61.84 (1570.7)
1.97 (50.0)
175 (79)
RNDN1200
Type 12
63.59 (1615.2)
22.00 (558.8)
17.63 (447.8)
61.84 (1570.7)
1.97 (50.0)
170 (77)
JNDN1200
Type 3R Rainproof
E
B
2
2
ON
A
D
ON
OFF
OFF
2
V4-T2-344
Catalog
Number
2.6
Contents
Description
Engine Generator Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct Current Circuit Breakers
Catalog Number Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Wiring Diagrams. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers600 Vdc Per-Pole
and 1000 Vdc Poles-in-Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
E2 Mining Service Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . .
Classic Mining Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Add-On Ground Fault ProtectionType GFR . . . .
Page
V4-T2-339
V4-T2-347
V4-T2-348
V4-T2-355
V4-T2-356
V4-T2-357
V4-T2-358
V4-T2-370
V4-T2-396
V4-T2-410
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
DC (direct current)
systems and applications
are becoming commonplace
as alternative energy sources
have expanded and the
number of DC devices
and data centers using DC
power has swelled.
Eaton offers molded case
circuit breakers and switches
to meet circuit protection and
switching requirements for a
host of different DC end user
requirements. Applications
include UPS battery supply
circuits, solar systems and
electric vehicle charging, as
well as commercial and
industrial distribution.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-345
2.6
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Amperes
125
Poles in
Series
250 2
Poles in
Series
500
600
Poles in
Series
750 2
Poles in
Series
EGEDC
100
10
35
35
EGSDC
100
35
42
50
EGHDC
100
42
50
65
HFDDC
225
42
50
42
42
JGEDC
250
35
35
35
JGSDC
250
42
42
50
JGHDC
250
50
50
65
HJDDC
250
42
50
42
HKDDC
400
42
50
42
LGEDC
600
22
22
35
LGSDC
600
22
22
50
LGHDC
600
50
50
65
HLDDC
600
42
50
35
HLDDC 3
1200
42
50
HMDLDC
800
42
50
35
NBDC
1200
42
50
50
RGHDC
3000
42
50
65
Ics
Poles in
Series
Icu
Ics
Poles in
Series
Icu
Ics
Poles in
Series
2
2
2
Maximum
Amperes
125 Volts DC
Icu
250 Volts DC
600 Volts DC
EGEDC
100
10
10
10
10
EGSDC
100
35
35
35
35
EGHDC
100
42
42
42
42
JGEDC
250
22
22
22
22
JGSDC
250
22
22
22
22
JGHDC
250
42
42
42
42
HJDDC
250
20
10
LGEDC
600
22
22
22
22
LGSDC
600
22
22
22
22
LGHDC
600
42
42
42
42
2
2
2
2
HLDDC
600
20
10
HMDLDC
800
20
10
Notes
1 DC ratings apply to substantially non-inductive circuits. Time constants per UL 489.
2 EGEDC through HMDLDC have been tested up to 300 Vdc to allow for battery charging voltages. 750 Vdc is common in transportation applications.
HFDDC, four-pole 750 Vdc is available up to 150 A maximum. 300 Vdc and 750 Vdc are not UL 489 listed voltage ratings.
3 Four-pole frame with two-poles connected in parallel.
See Page V4-T2-356 for series connection diagrams. Use NEC rated cable to connect/short poles in series as shown.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-346
2.6
2
2
DC Circuit Breaker
HFDDC 3 150 W
Frame
EGEDC = Series GE (100 A max.)
EGSDC = Series GE (100 A max.)
EGHDC = Series GE (100 A max.)
HFDDC = Series CF (225 A max.)
JGEDC = Series GJ (250 A max.)
JGSDC = Series GJ (250 A max.)
JGHDC = Series GJ (250 A max.)
HJDDC = Series CJ (250 A max.)
HKDDC = Series CK (400 A max.)
LGEDC = Series GL (600 A max.)
LGSDC = Series GL (600 A max.)
LGHDC = Series GL (600 A max.)
HLDDC = Series CL (1200 A max.)
HMDLDC = Series CM (800 A max.)
NBDC
= NB (1200 A max.)
RGHDC = Series GR (3000 A max.)
Number of Poles
1 = Single-pole
2 = Two-pole
3 = Three-pole
4 = Four-pole
2
Suffix
Series C, NB Frames
K
= Molded case switch
L
= Line and load terminals, F-Frame
MW = 135% magnetic trip unit, without terminals
W = Without terminals
Series G Frames
FFG = Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic trip unit, with terminals
FFW = Fixed thermal, fixed magnetic trip unit, without terminals
FAG = Fixed thermal, adjustable magnetic trip unit, with terminals
FAW = Fixed thermal, adjustable magnetic trip unit, without terminals
KSG = Molded case switch, with terminals
KSW = Molded case switch, without terminals
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-347
2.6
Product Selection
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
25
30
Catalog
Number
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
EGEDC3025FFG
EGEDC3025FFW
25
EGHDC3025FFG
EGHDC3025FFW
EGEDC3030FFG
EGEDC3030FFW
30
EGHDC3030FFG
EGHDC3030FFW
35
EGEDC3035FFG
EGEDC3035FFW
35
EGHDC3035FFG
EGHDC3035FFW
40
EGEDC3040FFG
EGEDC3040FFW
40
EGHDC3040FFG
EGHDC3040FFW
45
EGEDC3045FFG
EGEDC3045FFW
45
EGHDC3045FFG
EGHDC3045FFW
50
EGEDC3050FFG
EGEDC3050FFW
50
EGHDC3050FFG
EGHDC3050FFW
60
EGEDC3060FFG
EGEDC3060FFW
60
EGHDC3060FFG
EGHDC3060FFW
70
EGEDC3070FFG
EGEDC3070FFW
70
EGHDC3070FFG
EGHDC3070FFW
80
EGEDC3080FFG
EGEDC3080FFW
80
EGHDC3080FFG
EGHDC3080FFW
90
EGEDC3090FFG
EGEDC3090FFW
90
EGHDC3090FFG
EGHDC3090FFW
100
EGEDC3100FFG
EGEDC3100FFW
100
EGHDC3100FFG
EGHDC3100FFW
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
25
EGSDC3025FFG
EGSDC3025FFW
30
EGSDC3030FFG
EGSDC3030FFW
35
EGSDC3035FFG
EGSDC3035FFW
40
EGSDC3040FFG
EGSDC3040FFW
45
EGSDC3045FFG
EGSDC3045FFW
50
EGSDC3050FFG
EGSDC3050FFW
60
EGSDC3060FFG
EGSDC3060FFW
70
EGSDC3070FFG
EGSDC3070FFW
80
EGSDC3080FFG
EGSDC3080FFW
90
EGSDC3090FFG
EGSDC3090FFW
100
EGSDC3100FFG
EGSDC3100FFW
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-348
2.6
HFDDC
Single-Pole
Two-Pole
Three-Pole
Four-Pole
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
15
HFDDC1015L
HFDDC2015L
HFDDC3015L
HFDDC4015L
20
HFDDC1020L
HFDDC2020L
HFDDC3020L
HFDDC4020L
25
HFDDC1025L
HFDDC2025L
HFDDC3025L
HFDDC4025L
30
HFDDC1030L
HFDDC2030L
HFDDC3030L
HFDDC4030L
35
HFDDC1035L
HFDDC2035L
HFDDC3035L
HFDDC4035L
40
HFDDC1040L
HFDDC2040L
HFDDC3040L
HFDDC4040L
45
HFDDC1045L
HFDDC2045L
HFDDC3045L
HFDDC4045L
50
HFDDC1050L
HFDDC2050L
HFDDC3050L
HFDDC4050L
60
HFDDC1060L
HFDDC2060L
HFDDC3060L
HFDDC4060L
70
HFDDC1070L
HFDDC2070L
HFDDC3070L
HFDDC4070L
80
HFDDC1080L
HFDDC2080L
HFDDC3080L
HFDDC4080L
90
HFDDC1090L
HFDDC2090L
HFDDC3090L
HFDDC4090L
100
HFDDC1100L
HFDDC2100L
HFDDC3100L
HFDDC4100L
110
HFDDC1110L
HFDDC2110L
HFDDC3110L
HFDDC4110L
125
HFDDC1125L
HFDDC2125L
HFDDC3125L
HFDDC4125L
150
HFDDC1150L
HFDDC2150L
HFDDC3150L
HFDDC4150L
175
HFDDC2175L
HFDDC3175L
200
HFDDC2200L
HFDDC3200L
225
HFDDC2225L
HFDDC3225L
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Complete
Breaker
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 2
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
JGEDC3070FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3070FA
T250FJ
90
JGEDC3090FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3090FA
T250FJ
100
JGEDC3100FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3100FA
T250FJ
125
JGEDC3125FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3125FA
T250FJ
150
JGEDC3150FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3150FA
T250FJ
175
JGEDC3175FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3175FA
T250FJ
200
JGEDC3200FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3200FA
T250FJ
225
JGEDC3225FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3225FA
T250FJ
250
JGEDC3250FAG
JGEDC3250NN
JT3250FA
T250FJ
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For breaker without terminals, replace L with W at end of catalog number.
2 For complete breaker, order individual frame, trip unit and terminals for field installation.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-349
2.6
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Complete
Breaker
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
JGSDC3070FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3070FA
T250FJ
90
JGSDC3090FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3090FA
T250FJ
100
JGSDC3100FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3100FA
T250FJ
125
JGSDC3125FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3125FA
T250FJ
150
JGSDC3150FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3150FA
T250FJ
175
JGSDC3175FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3175FA
T250FJ
200
JGSDC3200FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3200FA
T250FJ
225
JGSDC3225FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3225FA
T250FJ
250
JGSDC3250FAG
JGSDC3250NN
JT3250FA
T250FJ
2
2
2
JGHDC3250NN
Complete
Breaker
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
JGHDC3070FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3070FA
T250FJ
90
JGHDC3090FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3090FA
T250FJ
100
JGHDC3100FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3100FA
T250FJ
125
JGHDC3125FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3125FA
T250FJ
150
JGHDC3150FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3150FA
T250FJ
175
JGHDC3175FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3175FA
T250FJ
200
JGHDC3200FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3200FA
T250FJ
225
JGHDC3225FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3225FA
T250FJ
250
JGHDC3250FAG
JGHDC3250NN
JT3250FA
T250FJ
2
2
2
2
2
HJDDC3250
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
70
HJDDC3250F
JT3070T
TA250KB
90
HJDDC3250F
JT3090T
TA250KB
100
HJDDC3250F
JT3100T
TA250KB
125
HJDDC3250F
JT3125T
TA250KB
150
HJDDC3250F
JT3150T
TA250KB
175
HJDDC3250F
JT3175T
TA250KB
200
HJDDC3250F
JT3200T
TA250KB
225
HJDDC3250F
JT3225T
TA250KB
250
HJDDC3250F
JT3250T
TA250KB
2
2
2
2
2
Note
1 For complete breaker, order individual frame, trip unit and terminals for field installation.
2
2
2
V4-T2-350
2.6
HKDDC3400
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
100
HKDDC3400F
KT3100T
TA300K
125
HKDDC3400F
KT3125T
TA300K
150
HKDDC3400F
KT3150T
TA300K
175
HKDDC3400F
KT3175T
TA300K
200
HKDDC3400F
KT3200T
TA300K
225
HKDDC3400F
KT3225T
TA300K
250
HKDDC3400F
KT3250T
TA350K
300
HKDDC3400F
KT3300T
TA350K
350
HKDDC3400F
KT3350T
TA350K
400
LGEDC3630NN
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
HKDDC3400F
KT3400T
3TA400K
2
2
2
2
2
Complete
Breaker
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGEDC3250FAG
LGEDC3630NN
LT3250FA
TA350LK
300
LGEDC3300FAG
LGEDC3630NN
LT3300FA
TA350LK
350
LGEDC3350FAG
LGEDC3630NN
LT3350FA
TA350LK
400
LGEDC3400FAG
LGEDC3630NN
LT3400FA
TA350LK
500
LGEDC3500FAG
LGEDC3630NN
LT4500FA
3TA632LK 2
600
LGEDC3600FAG
LGEDC3630NN
LT3600FA
3TA632LK 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Complete
Breaker
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGSDC3250FAG
LGSDC3630NN
LT3250FA
TA350LK
300
LGSDC3300FAG
LGSDC3630NN
LT3300FA
TA350LK
350
LGSDC3350FAG
LGSDC3630NN
LT3350FA
TA350LK
400
LGSDC3400FAG
LGSDC3630NN
LT3400FA
TA350LK
500
LGSDC3500FAG
LGSDC3630NN
LT4500FA
3TA632LK 2
600
LGSDC3600FAG
LGSDC3630NN
LT3600FA
3TA632LK 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For complete breaker, order individual frame, trip unit and terminals for field installation.
2 Three-pole kit.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-351
2.6
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Complete
Breaker
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
250
LGHDC3250FAG
LGHDC3630NN
LT3250FA
TA350LK
300
LGHDC3300FAG
LGHDC3630NN
LT3300FA
TA350LK
350
LGHDC3350FAG
LGHDC3630NN
LT3350FA
TA350LK
400
LGHDC3400FAG
LGHDC3630NN
LT3400FA
TA350LK
500
LGHDC3500FAG
LGHDC3630NN
LT4500FA
3TA632LK 2
600
LGHDC3600FAG
LGHDC3630NN
LT3600FA
3TA632LK 2
2
2
2
HLDDC
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
300
HLDDC3600F
LT3300T
TA602LD
350
HLDDC3600F
LT3350T
TA602LD
400
HLDDC3600F
LT3400T
TA602LD
450
HLDDC3600F
LT3450T
TA602LD
500
HLDDC3600F
LT3500T
TA602LD
600
HLDDC3600F
LT3600T
3TA603LDK 2
2
2
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Complete
Breaker
600
HLDDC20600
700
HLDDC20700
800
HLDDC20800
900
HLDDC20900
1000
HLDDC21000
1200
HLDDC21200
2
2
Catalog
Number
Notes
1 For complete breaker, order individual frame, trip unit and terminals for field installation.
2 Three-pole kit.
3 Includes breaker frame, trip unit and terminals.
4 Four-pole breaker with two poles wired in parallel.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-352
2.6
HMDLDC3800F
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Circuit Breaker
Frame Only 1
Thermal-Magnetic
Trip Unit
Standard
Terminals
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
300
HMDLDC3800F
MT3300T
TA700MA1
350
HMDLDC3800F
MT3350T
TA700MA1
400
HMDLDC3800F
MT3400T
TA700MA1
450
HMDLDC3800F
MT3450T
TA700MA1
500
HMDLDC3800F
MT3500T
TA700MA1
600
HMDLDC3800F
MT3600T
TA700MA1
700
HMDLDC3800F
MT3700T
TA700MA1
800
HMDLDC3800F
MT3800T
TA800MA2
2
2
2
2
2
Standard
Terminals
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Includes Magnetic
Trip Unit Calibrated at 135%
Catalog
Number
700
NBDC3700MW
Included
TA1000NB1
800
NBDC3800MW
Included
TA1000NB1
900
NBDC3900MW
Included
TA1000NB1
1000
NBDC31000MW
Included
TA1000NB1
1200
NBDC31200MW
Included
TA1200NB1
2
2
2
2
2
RGHDC3300FFWM
Maximum
Continuous
Ampere Rating
at 40 C
Imperial Mounting
Hardware
Metric Mounting
Hardware
Standard Rear
Connectors
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Includes Magnetic
Trip Unit Calibrated at 135%
Catalog
Number
1600
RGHDC3160FFWE
RGHDC3160FFWM
Included
B2016RDM
2000
RGHDC3200FFWE
RGHDC3200FFWM
Included
B2016RDM
2500
RGHDC3250FFWE
RGHDC3250FFWM
Included
B2500RDM
3000
RGHDC3300FFWE
RGHDC3300FFWM
Included
B3000RDM
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Includes frame and trip unit. Order terminals or connectors separately.
2 Six rear connectors included as standard complete circuit breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-353
2.6
2
2
Maximum Breaker
Ampacity
Terminal Body
Material
Wire Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Number of
Terminals Included
Standard Terminal
Catalog Number
100
Aluminum
Cu/Al
141/0
2.550
3TA125EF
HFDDC
20
Steel
Cu/Al
1410 (1)
2.54 (1)
3T20FB
100
Steel
Cu/Al
141/0 (1)
2.550 (1)
3T100FB
225
Aluminum
Cu/Al
44/0 (1)
2595 (1)
3TA225FD
250
Stainless steel
Cu
4350 (1)
25185 (1)
T250FJ
HJDDC
250
Aluminum
Cu/Al
25185 (1)
TA250KB
HKDDC
225
Aluminum
Cu/Al
35185 (1)
TA300K
350
Aluminum
Cu/Al
120240 (1)
TA350K
400
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95120 (1)
3TA400K
400
Aluminum
Cu/Al
2500 (1)
35240 (1)
TA350LK
630
Aluminum
Cu/Al
35240 (2)
TA632L
630
Aluminum
Cu/Al
35240 (2)
3TA632LK
500
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95150 (2)
TA602LD
600
Aluminum
Cu/Al
185240 (2)
3TA603LDK
600
Aluminum
Cu/Al
TA700MA1
800
Aluminum
Cu/Al
TA800MA2
700
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95185 (3)
TA1000NB1
800
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95185 (3)
TA1000NB1
900
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95185 (3)
TA1000NB1
1000
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95185 (3)
TA1000NB1
1200
Aluminum
Cu/Al
120240 (4)
TA1200NB1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
HLDDC
HMDLDC
NBDC
2
2
2
2
2
Interrupting Capacity
(Volts DC)
Poles in
Series
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
42
HFDDC3100KL
HFDDC3100KW
150
42
HFDDC3150KL
HFDDC3150KW
225
42
HFDDC3225KL
HFDDC3225KW
250
65
JGKDC3250KSG
JGKDC3250KSW
250
42
HJDDC3250K
HJDDC3250KW
400
35
HKDDC3400K
HKDDC3400KW
65
LGKDC3400KSG
LGKDC3400KSW
600
65
LGKDC3630KSG
LGKDC3630KSW
35
HLDDC3600K
HLDDC3600WK
800
35
HMDLDC3800K
HMDLDC3800WK
100
65
EGK3100KSG
EGK3100KSW
50
HFDDC2100KL
HFDDC2100KW
150
50
HFDDC2150KL
HFDDC2150KW
225
50
HFDDC2225KL
HFDDC2225KW
1200
50
HLDDC21200K 1
HLDDC21200WK 1
Note
1 Four-pole frame with two-pole connected in parallel.
2
V4-T2-354
2.6
Accessories
Internal Accessories
JGEDC,
JGSDC,
JGHDC
Description
Factory
Installation
(HFDDC)
HFDDC 1
EGEDC,
EGSDC,
EGHDC
LGEDC,
LGSDC,
LGHDC
HJDDC
HKDDC
HLDDC
HMDLDC
NBDC
RGHDC
Right-Pole Mounting
2
2
Auxiliary switch
1A-1B
A06
A1X1PK
AUX1A1BPK
AUX1A1BPK
A1X2PK
A1X3PK
A1X4PK
A1X4PK
4980D16G05
2A-2B
A13
A2X1RPK
AUX2A2BPK
AUX2A2BPK
A2X2PK
A2X3PK
A2X4PK
A2X4PK
4980D16G06
A2X6RPK
B06
A1L1RPK
ALM1M1BEPK ALM1M1BJPK
A1L2RPK
A1L3RPK
A1L4RPK
A1L4RPK
A1L6RPK
AAL1RPK
AUXALRMEPK AUXALRMJPK
AAL2RPK
AAL3RPK
AA114RPK
AA114RPK
A2L6RPK
Alarm switch
1 make/1 break
Left-Pole Mounting
Shunt trip
12 Vdc
S02
SNT1LP03K
SNT012CPK
SNT012CPK
SNT2P04K
SNT3P04K
SNT4LP03K
SNT4LP03K
2606D58G14
24 Vdc
S02
SNT1LP03K
SNT060CPK
SNT060CPK
SNT2P04K
SNT3P04K
SNT4LP03K
SNT4LP03K
2606D58G13
SNT6P03K 2
48 Vdc
S06
SNT1LP08K
SNT060CPK
SNT060CPK
SNT2P06K
SNT3P06K
SNT4LP23K
SNT4LP23K
2606D58G12
SNT6P23K 2
60 Vdc
S06
SNT1LP08K
SNT060CPK
SNT060CPK
SNT2P06K
SNT3P06K
SNT4LP23K
SNT4LP23K
2606D58G11
SNT6P23K 2
125 Vdc
S10
SNT1LP12K
SNT120CPK
SNT120CPK
SNT2P11K
SNT3P11K
SNT4LP26K
SNT4LP26K
2606D58G10
SNT6P23K 2
250 Vdc
S14
SNT1LP18K
SNT2P14K
SNT3P14K
SNT4LP14K
SNT4LP14K
2606D58G09
SNT6P14K
120 Vac
S06
SNT1LP12K
SNT120CPK
SNT120CPK
SNT2P11K
SNT3P11K
SNT4LP11K
SNT4LP11K
2060D58G05
SNT6P11K 2
12 Vdc
U30
UVH1LP20K
UVR012DPK
UVR012DPK
UVH2LP20K
UVH3LP20K
UVH4LP20K
UVH4LP20K
372D032G06
UVH6RP20K 2
24 Vdc
U34
UVH1LP21K
UVR024DPK
UVR024DPK
UVH2LP21K
UVH3LP21K
UVH4LP21K
UVH4LP21K
372D032G07
UVH6RP21K 2
48 Vdc
U38
UVH1LP22K
UVR048DPK
UVR048DPK
UVH2LP22K
UVH3LP22K
UVH4LP22K
UVH4LP22K
372D032G08
UVH6RP23K 2
125 Vdc
U42
UVH1LP26K
UVR125DPK
UVR125DPK
UVH2LP26K
UVH3LP26K
UVH4LP26K
UVH4LP26K
372D032G09
UVH6RP26K 2
250 Vdc
U46
UVH1LP28K
UVR250DPK
UVR250DPK
UVH2LP28K
UVH3LP28K
UVH4LP28K
UVH4LP28K
372D032G10
UVH6RP28K 2
120 Vac
U14
UVH1LP08K
UVR120APK
UVR120APK
UVH2LP08K
UVH3LP08K
UVH4LP08K
UVH4LP08K
373D632G05
UVH6RP08K 2
Undervoltage release
Notes
1 F-Frame circuit breakers are factory sealed. Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories be installed at the factory. Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation
under E7819. Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation should be done before the circuit breaker
is mounted and connected.
2 Right-pole mounted.
One accessory can be mounted per pole, per breaker. Factory installation of accessories is available. Contact Eaton for assistance with part number configuration.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-355
2.6
Wiring Diagrams
2
2
2
2
Load
2
2
2
2
Load
(A)
Suitable for use on ungrounded systems, or grounded
systems that have one end of load (A) connected to
grounded terminal, opposite poles in series connection.
Load
2
2
2
2
2
2
Load
(A)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Load
Load
(A)
Notes
1 Poles in series connection is customer supplied. Use rated cable per NEC.
2 For grounded systems, all poles in series must be connected on non-grounded terminal, with load connected to grounded terminal.
2
2
V4-T2-356
2.6
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
DC Breaker Dimensions
Frame
Number
of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
3.00 (76.2)
5.50 (139.7)
2.99 (75.9)
HFDDC
1.38 (35.1)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
2.75 (70.0)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
4.13 (105.0)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
5.50 (139.7)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
4.13 (104.9)
7.00 (177.8)
3.57 (90.7)
HJDDC
2, 3
4.13 (105.0)
10.00 (254.0)
4.06 (103.1)
HKDDC
2, 3
5.50 (139.7)
10.13 (257.3)
4.10 (104.1)
5.48 (139.2)
10.13 (257.3)
4.09 (103.9)
2, 3
8.25 (209.6)
10.75 (273.1)
4.06 (103.1)
11.00 (279.4)
10.75 (273.1)
4.06 (103.1)
HMDLDC
2, 3
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
4.06 (103.1)
NBDC
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
5.50 (139.7)
RGHDC
15.50 (393.7)
16.00 (406.4)
9.75 (247.7)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-357
2.6
2
Contents
Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Page
V4-T2-339
V4-T2-345
V4-T2-359
V4-T2-359
V4-T2-359
V4-T2-360
V4-T2-362
V4-T2-365
V4-T2-368
V4-T2-369
V4-T2-370
V4-T2-396
V4-T2-410
2
2
2
2
PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers600 Vdc Per-Pole and 1000 Vdc Poles-in-Series
Product Overview
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
Photovoltaic (PV) systems
convert the energy of the sun
into electrical power that is
fed directly into the electric
grid. Within the balance of
system (BOS), direct current
(DC) circuit breakers protect
the wiring connected from
the PV modules to the
combiner or the inverter,
while also behaving as
a disconnect.
Eaton is a global leader in
circuit protection and brings
this expertise to bear in the
photovoltaic market. PVGard
solar circuit breakers are part
of a product family that
combines a disconnect with
circuit protection in a single,
compact, resettable device
to protect and isolate DC
circuits as needed in
photovoltaic systems.
PVGard breakers can replace
fuses, fuse holders and
disconnects in combiner box
and inverter applications
saving space, streamlining
design, purchasing and
receiving, and reducing spare
parts requirements.
2
V4-T2-358
Application Description
Features
2.6
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-359
2.6
2
2
2
Product Selection
Catalog number includes breaker frame and trip unit. Order terminals separately. See Page V4-T2-364.
For complete internal and external accessories, see accessory section of each frame.
JG PVS Frame
80% Rated
100% Rated
Trip Unit
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
90
JGPVS3090W
CJGPVS3090W
100
JGPVS3100W
CJGPVS3100W
125
JGPVS3125W
CJGPVS3125W
150
JGPVS3150W
CJGPVS3150W
175
JGPVS3175W
CJGPVS3175W
200
JGPVS3200W
CJGPVS3200W
225
JGPVS3225W
CJGPVS3225W
250
JGPVS3250W
CJGPVS3250W
2
2
2
KD PVS Frame
80% Rated
100% Rated
Trip Unit
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
100
KDPVS3100W
CKDPVS3100W
125
KDPVS3125W
CKDPVS3125W
150
KDPVS3150W
CKDPVS3150W
175
KDPVS3175W
CKDPVS3175W
200
KDPVS3200W
CKDPVS3200W
225
KDPVS3225W
CKDPVS3225W
250
KDPVS3250W
CKDPVS3250W
300
KDPVS3300W
CKDPVS3300W
350
KDPVS3350W
CKDPVS3350W
400
KDPVS3400W
CKDPVS3400W
Note
1 Terminals not included with frames.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-360
2.6
2
Catalog number includes breaker frame and trip unit. Order terminals separately. See Page V4-T2-364.
2
FD PV Frame
KD PV Frame
100% Rated
Poles in Series
Trip Unit
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
30
FDPV4030W
CFDPV4030W
40
FDPV4040W
CFDPV4040W
50
FDPV4050W
CFDPV4050W
60
FDPV4060W
CFDPV4060W
70
FDPV4070W
CFDPV4070W
80
FDPV4080W
CFDPV4080W
90
FDPV4090W
CFDPV4090W
100
FDPV4100W
CFDPV4100W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
100% Rated
Poles in Series
Trip Unit
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
125
KDPV4125W
CKDPV4125W
150
KDPV4150W
CKDPV4150W
175
KDPV4175W
CKDPV4175W
200
KDPV4200W
CKDPV4200W
225
KDPV4225W
CKDPV4225W
250
KDPV4250W
CKDPV4250W
300
KDPV4300W
CKDPV4300W
350
KDPV4350W
CKDPV4350W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
LG PV Frame
100% Rated
Poles in Series
Trip Unit
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
250
LGPV4250W
CLGPV4250W
300
LGPV4300W
CLGPV4300W
350
LGPV4350W
CLGPV4350W
400
LGPV4400W
CLGPV4400W
2
2
2
2
2
MDL PV Frame
100% Rated
Poles in Series
Trip Unit
Catalog Number
Catalog Number
300
MDLPV3300W
CMDLPV3300W
350
MDLPV3350W
CMDLPV3350W
400
MDLPV3400W
CMDLPV3400W
450
MDLPV3450W
CMDLPV3450W
500
MDLPV3500W
CMDLPV3500W
600
MDLPV3600W
CMDLPV3600W
Note
1 Terminals not included with frames.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-361
2.6
Accessories
Available Accessories
Auxiliary switch
Shunt trip
Electrical operator
Alarm lockout
Undervoltage release
Terminals
Lock-off devices
2
2
2
2
Optional modifications
Freeze testing
External Accessories
Description
Frame
Catalog
Number
FD PV
BMH1
KD PV
KD PVS
BMH3
JG PVS
N/A
LG PV
N/A
MDL PV
BMH5
FD PV
BMH1M
KD PV
KD PVS
BMH3M
JG PVS
Included 1
LG PV
Included 1
MDL PV
BMH5M
Interphase Barriers
FD PV
IPB1
KD PV
KD PVS
IPB3
JG PVS
FJIPBK 2
LG PV
IPB3
MDL PV
IPB4
FD PV
LKD1
KD PV
KD PVS
LKD3
JG PVS
N/A
F01
KD PV and KD PVS
F01
LG PV
F01
MDL PV
F01
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 50 C
2
2
LG PV
N/A
MDL PV
LKD4
Poles in
Series
Catalog
Number
100
3000
FDPV4100KW
200
5000
KDPV4200KW
250
5000
KDPV4250KW
350
5000
KDPV4350KW
400
5000
LGPV4400KSW
600
7500
MDLPV3600KSW
Notes
1 Base mounting hardware is included with a circuit breaker or a molded case switch
(included with breaker). If required separately, order 66A2546G02.
2 Individually priced.
3 Locks in ON and OFF position.
4 Add 20% to list price.
FD PV
PLK1
KD PV
KD PVS
PLK3
JG PVS
FJPHL
LG PV
LPHL
MDL PV
HLK4
2
2
2
V4-T2-362
Interrupting
Capacity Vdc
F01
JG PVS
Modification Code
FD PV
Frame
2.6
FD PV 1
JG PVS
KD PV
KD PVS
Factory
Field Kit
Modification Catalog
Code
Number
Factory
Field Kit
Modification Catalog
Code
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Field Kit
Catalog
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Field Kit
Catalog
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Field Kit
Catalog
Number
1A-1B
A06
A1X1PK
A1
AUX1A1BPK
A06
A1X3PK
A1
AUX1A1BPK
A06
A1X4PK
2A-2B
A13
A2X1RPK
A2
AUX2A2BPK
A13
A2X3PK
A2
AUX2A2BPK
A13
A2X4PK
B06
A1L1RPK
B1
ALM1M1BJPKL B06
A1L3RPK
B1
ALM1M1BJPK B06
A1L4RPK
AAL1RPK
B2w
AUXALRMJPK C05
AAL3RPK
B2
AUXALRMJPK C05
AA114RPK
LG PV
MDL PV
Auxiliary Switch
Alarm Switch
1 make/1 break
FD PV 1
JG PVS
KD PV
KD PVS
Factory
Field Kit
Modification Catalog
Code
Number
Factory
Field Kit
Modification Catalog
Code
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Field Kit
Catalog
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Field Kit
Catalog
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Field Kit
Catalog
Number
S02
S4
S42
SNT3P04K
S4
SNT012CPK
S02
SNT4LP03K
LG PV
MDL PV
Shunt Trip
SNT1LP03K
2
2
12 Vdc
SNT012CPK
24 Vdc
S02
SNT1LP03K
S1
SNT060CPK
S42
SNT3P04K
S1
SNT060CPK
S02
SNT4LP03K
48 Vdc
S06
SNT1LP08K
S1
SNT060CPK
S50
SNT3P06K
S1
SNT060CPK
S86
SNT4LP23K
2
2
2
2
2
60 Vdc
S06
SNT1LP08K
S1
SNT060CPK
S50
SNT3P06K
S1
SNT060CPK
S86
SNT4LP23K
125 Vdc
S10
SNT1LP12K
S5
SNT125DPK
S10
SNT3P11K
S2
SNT120CPK
S42
SNT4LP26K
250 Vdc
S14
SNT1LP18K
S14
SNT3P14K
S14
SNT4LP14K
120 Vac
S10
SNT1LP12K
S2
SNT120CPK
S10
SNT3P11K
S2
SNT120CPK
S10
SNT4LP11K
2
2
Undervoltage Release
12 Vdc
U30
UVH1LP20K
T02
UVH3LP20K
U1
UVR012DPK
T02
UVH4LP20K
24 Vdc
U34
UVH1LP21K
U2
UVR024CPK
T02
UVH3LP21K
U2
UVR024DPK
T06
UVH4LP21K
48 Vdc
U38
UVH1LP22K
U4
UVR048DPK
T10
UVH3LP22K
U4
UVR048DPK
T10
UVH4LP22K
60 Vdc
U4
UVR048DPK
125 Vdc
U42
UVH1LP26K
U6
UVR125DPK
T14
UVH3LP26K
U6
UVR125DPK
T14
UVH4LP26K
250 Vdc
U46
UVH1LP28K
U8
UVR250DPK
T18
UVH3LP28K
U8
UVR250DPK
T18
UVH4LP28K
120 Vac
U14
UVH1LP08K
U5
UVR120APK
U18
UVH3LP08K
U5
UVR120APK
U18
UVH4LP08K
Notes
1 Underwriters Laboratories requires that internal accessories for the FD PV be installed at the factory. Internal accessories are UL listed for factory installation
under E7819. Where local codes and standards permit and UL listing is not required, internal accessories can be field installed. Accessory installation should be
done before the circuit breaker is mounted and connected.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-363
2.6
2
2
2
Specialty Breakers
Breaker
Frame
FD PV
2
2
JG PVS
Maximum
Breaker
Ampacity
Terminal Body
Material
Wire Type
Metric Wire
Range mm2
Number of
Terminals
Included
Standard
Terminal
Catalog
Number
50
Steel
Cu/Al
144 (1)
2.525 (1)
3TA50FB
100
Aluminum
Cu/Al
16150 (1)
3TA225FDK
100
Copper
Cu
44/0 (1)
2595 (1)
3T225FD
Comments
250
Aluminum
Cu/Al
TA250FJ
250
Aluminum
Cu/Al
3TA251FJK1
250
Aluminum
Cu/Al
3TA251FJK2
250
Copper
Cu
T250FJ
225
Aluminum
Cu/Al
35185 (1)
TA300K
250
Aluminum
Cu/Al
120240 (1)
TA350K
250
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95120 (1)
4TA400K
250
Aluminum
Cu/Al
70240 (2)
4TA401K
300
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95120 (2)
4TA401K
350
Aluminum
Cu/Al
95120 (2)
4TA401K
225
Copper
Cu
35185 (1)
T300K
250
Copper
Cu
120240 (1)
T350K
250
Copper
Cu
95120 (1)
4T400K
300
Copper
Cu
95120 (2)
4TA401K
350
Copper
Cu
95120 (2)
4TA401K
400
Aluminum
Cu/Al
35240 (2)
4TA632LK
250
Copper
Cu
35240 (1)
T350LK
400
Copper
Cu
35240 (2)
4T632LK
300
Aluminum
Cu/Al
TA700MA1
600
Aluminum
Cu/Al
TA800MA2
2
2
2
2
2
2
KD PV
KD PVS
LG PV
MDL PV
2
2
Endcap Kits
Breaker Frame
Number of Poles
Thread Type
Thread Size
Catalog Number
FD PV
Imperial
1032
KPEK14
Metric
M5
KPEKM14
Imperial
FJ3RTDK
Metric
FJ3RTWK
Imperial
0.31218
KPEK34
Metric
M8
KPEKM34
KD PVS
Imperial
KPEK3
Metric
KPEKM3
LG PV
Imperial
N/A
Metric
M-10
L4RTWK
MDL PV
Imperial
Metric
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
JG PVS
KD PV
Notes
1 Three terminals with terminal shield as a kit.
2 Three terminals with two interphase barriers as a kit.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-364
2.6
Thermal-magnetic circuit
breakers
Designed to meet UL 489B
for solar photovoltaic circuit
protection
100% rated of the
continuous current rating
50 C calibrated
Can be applied in
grounded, ungrounded or
bi-polar systems
Ability to open on signal
from DC arc or ground fault
detector
UL File EE350638,
Category Control
Number DIUR
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Circuit
Breaker Type
Minimum
Amperes
JG PVS
KD PVS
Maximum
Amperes
kA Rating
90
250
1.2
100
400
2
2
2
2
Minimum
Amperes
Maximum
Amperes
kA Rating
Poles in
Series
FD PV
30
100
KD PV
125
350
LG PV
250
400
MDL PV
300
600
7.5
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-365
2.6
2
PVGard 600 Vdc Per-Pole Solar PV Circuit Breakers (100% and 80% Rated Frames)
JG PVS
KD PVS
600 Vdc
600 Vdc
Ampere range
90250 A
100400 A
1.2 kA
3 kA
Time constant
1 ms
1 ms
Thermal-magnetic
Thermal-magnetic
8 kV
4 kV
8 kV
4 kV
10,000
400
240 per hour
6000
400
240 per hour
UL 489B
UL 489B
50 C
93%
85%
50 C
93%
85%
20 C to +50 C
20 C to +70 C
Option
0 to 95% noncondensing
20 C to +50 C
20 C to +70 C
Option
0 to 95% noncondensing
Yes
Yes
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
90
90
2
2
2
2
Connection diagrams
Terminations
Al/Cu wire
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Cu wire
7.00 (177.8)
4.13 (104.9)
3.57 (90.7)
10.13 (257.3)
5.50 (139.7)
4.10 (104.1)
6.6
11.42
Notes
1 Three terminals with terminal shield as a kit.
2 Three terminals with two interphase barriers as a kit.
3 Not UL 489B recognized size for maximum of 400 A breaker.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-366
2.6
PVGard 1000 Vdc Solar PV Circuit Breakers (100% and 80% Rated Frames)
FD PV
KD PV
Number of poles
1000 Vdc
LG PV
MDL PV
1000 Vdc
1000 Vdc
1000 Vdc
100 A
350 A
400 A
600 A
3 kA
5 kA
5 kA
7.5 kA
Time constant
1 ms
1 ms
1 ms
1 ms
Ampere range
15100 A
125350 A
250400 A
300600 A
Thermal-magnetic
Thermal-magnetic
Thermal-magnetic
Thermal-magnetic
8 kV
4 kV
8 kV
4 kV
8 kV
4 kV
8 kV
4 kV
10,000
1000
300 per hour
10,000
400
240 per hour
8000
400
240 per hour
8000
400
240 per hour
UL 489B
UL 489B
UL 489B
UL 489B
50 C
91%
88%
50 C
91%
88%
50 C
93%
88%
50 C
93%
88%
20 C to +50 C
20 C to +70 C
Option
0 to 95% noncondensing
20 C to +50 C
20 C to +70 C
Option
0 to 95% noncondensing
20 C to +50 C
20 C to +70 C
Option
0 to 95% noncondensing
20 C to +50 C
20 C to +70 C
Option
0 to 95% noncondensing
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
2
2
2
2
2
Endurance
Mechanical operations
Electrical operations
Maximum switching frequency
Third-party certification
2
2
2
Environment
90
90
90
90
2
2
1
Connection diagrams
2
2
2
2
Load
Load
(A)
Terminations
Al/Cu wire
#6300 kcmil
Cu wire
#44/0
6.00 (152.4)
5.50 (139.7)
3.38 (85.9)
10.13 (257.3)
7.22 (183.4)
4.09 (103.9)
10.13 (257.3)
7.22 (183.4)
4.09 (103.9)
16.00 (406.4)
8.25 (209.5)
4.06 (103.1)
20
20
29
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Suitable for use on ungrounded systems, or grounded systems that have one end of load (A) connected to grounded terminal, opposite poles in series connection.
2 Suitable for use on ungrounded systems only.
2
2
2
V4-T2-367
2.6
2
2
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
PVGard Solar Circuit Breakers600 Vdc Per-Pole
2
2
Frame
Number of
Circuits in
a Frame
Width
Height
Depth
JG PVS
4.13 (104.9)
7.00 (177.8)
3.44 (87.4)
KD PVS
5.49 (139.4)
10.13 (257.2)
4.31 (109.6)
Frame
Number
of Poles
Width
Height
Depth
FD PV
5.50 (139.7)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (86.0)
KD PV
7.22 (183.4)
10.13 (257.3)
4.09 (103.9)
LG PV
7.22 (183.4)
10.13 (257.3)
4.09 (103.9)
MDL PV
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
4.06 (103.1)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-368
2.6
Wiring Diagrams
2
2
2
2
Load
2
2
2
2
2
Load
Load
(A)
2
2
Load
2
2
2
Load
(A)
2
2
Notes
1 Poles in series connection is customer supplied. Use rated cable per NEC.
2 For grounded systems, all poles in series must be connected on non-grounded terminal, with load connected to grounded terminal.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-369
2.6
2
Contents
Description
Page
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-339
V4-T2-345
V4-T2-358
V4-T2-372
V4-T2-376
V4-T2-387
V4-T2-390
V4-T2-396
V4-T2-410
2
2
2
2
Product Overview
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
State-of-the-art E2 mining
service breakers incorporate
the rigid specifications and
testing procedures developed
by a focus group led by
engineers from several
large coal companies and
Eaton design engineers.
Additionally, the performance
of these breakers was proven
and verified during hundreds
of hours of field testing in
harsh mine environments.
E2
Series C
E2
FBM
FDBM
HFBM
FDM
Series C
E2M
E2F
HFM
E2FM
E2F
JDCM
E2JM
E2F
HKAM
KDCM
E2KM
JDM
E2J
HLAM
LDCM
E2LM
KDM
E2K
HLCM
LDCM
E2LM
KDM
E2K
HMAM
E2MM
LDM
E2L
HMCM
E2MM
LAMH
LDM
E2L
HNBM
E2NM
LCM
LDM
E2L
HNBMH
E2NM
LCMH
LDM
E2L
HNCM
E2NM
E2M
HLCLM
E2NM
E2M
HPBM
E2RM 1
MCM
E2M
MCMH
E2M
NBM
E2N
NBMH
E2N
NCM
E2N
NCMH
E2N
KAM
KAMH
LAM
MAM
MAMH
Description
TD01217001E
BR01217001E
TC01217001E
www.eaton.com/mining
Note
1 E2R/E2RM is a new frame physically different than the HPBM. See DS29-170MS.
2
V4-T2-370
2.6
2
2
2
2
2
2
250
Conductor
Size
Maximum
Breaker
Instantaneous
Setting
Maximum
Ampere
75 C Insulated
Conductor
E2/E2M/E2W
Instantaneous
Only
Setting
10
14
50
15
E2K 150 A
10
12
75
20
E2K 150 A
B
C
A
Circuit
Breaker Type
480
600
1000Y/577
1200
E2F
65
25
18
E2J
65
35
18
E2K
65
35
25
10
10
150
30
E2K 150 A
E2LME
100
65
35
42
200
50
E2K 225 A
E2L
65
35
25
22
300
65
E2K 225 A
E2M
65
35
25
22
500
85
C/A
E2N
65
50
25
600
100
D/B
E2R
125
65
50
800
115
E/C
E2FM
65
25
18
10
10
1000
130
F/D
E2JM
65
35
18
10
22
1/0
1250
150
G/E
E2KM
65
35
25
14
10
2/0
1500
175
H/F
E2LMZ
100
65
35
10
42
3/0
2000
200
E2L 400 A
E2LM
35
25
18
22
4/0
2500
230
E2L 400 A
E2MM
35
25
18
22
250
2500
255
E2L 400 A
E2NM 2
50
25
25
300
2500
285
E2L 400 A
E2RM
65
50
25
350
2500
310
E2L 400 A
E2KW
10
10
400
2500
335
E2L 400 A
500
2500
380
E2L 400 A
E2LW
10
10
E2MW
12
12
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Frequency
Maximum Current
Amperes
600
50/60 Hz
6.0
125
DC
250
DC
2
2
2
2
Frequency
Maximum Current
Amperes
600
50/60 Hz
6.0
125
DC
250
DC
2
2
2
Notes
1 Two poles in series. DC rating applies to breakers with thermal-magnetic trip unit.
Breakers with electronic trip units are not DC rated.
2 Series rated for application with Eatons E2KM and E2LM breakers.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-371
2.6
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Frame Size
E2K
E2L
E2M
E2N
E2R
2
2
Voltage
Blank = 600 Vac max.
M
= 1000Y/577 Vac max.
Frame Size
K
L
M
Electronic Trip
E = Electronic trip
Trip Unit
T
Voltage
M = 600 V and 1000 V
interchangeable
Current Ampere
Rating
1002000
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
2
2
K E M 3 400 38 T 2 B20
B20 2 = No terminals
Terminal
W
= No terminals
Blank = Standard terminals
2
2
Magnetic Rating
(If Applicable)
Blank = Standard mag.
2
= High mag.
Current Ampere
Rating
1002000
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
2
2
Optional Features
Electronic Trip
E 1 = Electronic trip
Notes
1 All N- and R-Frame breakers equipped with 310+ Electronic Trip Unit. No E suffix required.
2 Not available with instantaneous only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-372
Magnetic Rating
(If Applicable)
Blank = Standard mag.
2
= High mag.
Optional Features
B20 1 = High load alarm
2.6
E2K M 3 400 F
Frame Size
E2J
E2K
E2L
E2M
Voltage
Blank = 600 Vac max.
M
= 1000Y/577 Vac max.
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Current Ampere
Rating
70800
2
2
Frame
Designation
2
2
E2K M 3 400 M K W
Frame Size
E2F
E2J
E2K
E2L
E2M
Voltage
Blank = 600 Vac max.
M
= 1000Y/577 Vac max.
W 2 = 1200 Vac max.
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Terminal
W
= No terminals
Blank = Standard terminals
2
2
2
E2K 3 400 T M A
Frame Size
E2J
E2K
E2L
E2M
Number
of Poles
3 = Three-pole
Current Ampere
Rating
70800
2
2
Current Ampere
Rating
3800
E2
Trip Unit
T
2
Trip Unit Function
M
= Magnetic only
Blank = Thermal-magnetic
2
2
Notes
1 Does not apply to E2LME/LMZ.
2 Only available in K-, L- and M-Frames.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-373
2.6
2
2
2
Specialty Breakers
2
2
2
Pickup Voltage
Supply Voltage
Minimum
Maximum
Maximum
VA
110 Vac
44.5
77
93.5
1.3
120 Vac
1.5
127 Vac
1.7
110 Vdc
1.5
120 Vdc
1.7
125 Vdc
E2J/E2JM
110 Vac
1.9
44.5
77
93.5
1.8
120 Vac
2.1
127 Vac
2.4
110 Vdc
1.6
120 Vdc
1.9
125 Vdc
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
2
2
2
110 Vac
2.2
44.5
77
93.5
120 Vac
2.1
127 Vac
2.4
110 Vdc
1.6
120 Vdc
1.9
125 Vdc
E2LME/E2LMZ
110 Vac
2.2
44.5
77
93.5
120 Vac
110 Vdc
1.25
43.8
77
93.5
120 Vdc
0.96
1.13
127 Vac
1.8
0.94
1.12
125 Vdc
1.21
127 Vac
2.4
110 Vdc
1.6
120 Vdc
1.9
77
93.5
E2N/E2NM
2
2
E2R/E2RM
110 Vac
1.8
2.1
125 Vdc
44.5
2.2
44.5
77
93.5
1.8
120 Vac
2.1
127 Vac
2.4
110 Vdc
1.6
120 Vdc
1.9
125 Vdc
2.2
110 Vac
44.5
77
93.5
120 Vac
3.3
3.6
127 Vac
120 Vdc
3.6
125 Vdc
3.8
110 Vdc
3.8
43.8
77
93.5
2
2
2
V4-T2-374
3.3
2.6
Operating Voltage
Breaker Type
Supply Voltage
Minimum
VA
Breaker Type
Supply Voltage
Minimum
VA
E2F/E2FM
48 Vac
33.6
92
E2L/E2LM/E2LW/E2M/
E2MM/E2MW
48 Vac
34
830
60 Vac
140
110 Vac
480
110 Vac
120 Vac
570
120 Vac
640
127 Vac
180
48 Vdc
220 Vac
200
60 Vdc
230 Vac
240
110 Vdc
100
120 Vdc
130
160
125 Vdc
140
127 Vac
208 Vac
48 Vdc
146
33.6
60 Vdc
110 Vdc
E2J/E2JM
77
110 Vac
60
100
710
77
60
110
120
127 Vac
140
66
110 Vdc
120 Vac
84
120 Vdc
130
127 Vac
102
125 Vdc
140
125 Vdc
110 Vac
60
120 Vac
127 Vac
110 Vdc
77
112
2
2
110 Vdc
120
120 Vdc
440
140
125 Vdc
480
430
77
370
2
2
110
2
2
41
18
60 Vac
139
210
60
92
127 Vac
117
24 Vdc
120
18
60 Vdc
83
120 Vac
110 Vdc
330
127 Vac
140
48 Vdc
390
150
130
110 Vac
60.5
110
100
125 Vdc
48 Vac
110 Vac
120 Vac
120 Vdc
24 Vac
E2R/E2RM
138
77
100
120 Vac
77
1105
71
60.5
140
34
66
110 Vac
120
125 Vdc
120 Vdc
E2LME/E2LMZ
E2N/E2NM
1280
120 Vdc
110 Vdc
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
55
60 Vac
2
2
475
720
82
99
120 Vdc
120
125 Vdc
121
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-375
2.6
2
2
Product Selection
3 A150 A
E2F/E2FM
2
2
E2F/E2FM
Sealed Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip UnitInclude Line/Load Terminals, Non-Electronic Trip Units 1
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Thermal-Magnetic
15
E2F3015
20
E2F3020
E2FM3020
25
E2F3025
E2FM3025
30
E2F3030
35
E2F3035
40
E2F3040
E2FM3040
45
E2F3045
50
E2F3050
E2FM3050
60
E2F3060
E2FM3060
70
E2F3070
E2FM3070
80
E2F3080
E2FM3080
90
E2F3090
E2FM3090
100
E2F3100
E2FM3100
125
E2F3125
E2FM3125
150
E2F3150
E2FM3150
930
E2F003AM
2170
E2F007CM
15
45150
E2F015EM
30
90300
E2F030HM
50150
E2F030EM
50
150500
E2F050KM
E2FM050KM
66190
E2F050YM
E2FM050YM
70
210700
E2F070MM
E2FM070MM
100
150500
E2F100KM
E2FM100KM
3001000
E2F100RM
E2FM100RM
150
4501500
E2F150TM
E2FM150TM
7502500
E2F150UM
E2FM150UM
Magnetic Only
2
2
2
2
2
Note
1 For two-pole application, use outer poles.
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-376
2.6
70 A250 A
E2J/E2JM
E2J/E2JM
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
70
300650
E2J3070T
E2J3070W
E2JM3070W
90
450900
E2J3090T
E2J3090W
E2JM3090W
100
5001000
E2J3100T
E2J3100W
E2JM3100W
125
6251250
E2J3125T
E2J3125W
E2JM3125W
150
7501500
E2J3150T
E2J3150W
E2JM3150W
175
8751750
E2J3175T
E2J3175W
E2JM3175W
200
10002000
E2J3200T
E2J3200W
E2JM3200W
225
300650
E2J3225TA
E2J3225AW
E2JM3225AW
5001000
E2J3225TD
E2J3225DW
E2JM3225DW
2
2
2
2
2
2
11252250
E2J3225T
E2J3225W
E2JM3225W
12502500
E2J3250T
E2J3250W
E2JM3250W
300650
E2J3250TMA
E2J3250MAW
E2JM3250MAW
450900
E2J3250TMC
E2J3250MCW
E2JM250MCW
5001000
E2J3250TMD
E2J3250MDW
E2JM3250MDW
6251250
E2J3250TMF
E2J3250MFW
E2JM3250MFW
7501500
E2J3250TMG
E2J3250MGW
E2JM3250MGW
8751750
E2J3250TMJ
E2J3250MJW
E2JM3250MJW
10002000
E2J3250TMK
E2J3250MKW
E2JM3250MKW
11252250
E2J3250TML
E2J3250MLW
E2JM3250MLW
12502500
E2J3250TM
E2J3250MW
E2JM3250MW
Magnetic Only
250
2
2
Thermal-Magnetic
250
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Frame only: E2J3250F.
2 Frame only: E2JM3250F.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-377
2.6
2
2
2
100 A400 A
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
E2K/E2KM
2
2
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
100
5001000
E2K3100T
E2K3100W
E2KM3100W
E2KW3100W
125
6251250
E2K3125T
E2K3125W
E2KM3125W
E2KW3125W
150
7501500
E2K3150T
E2K3150W
E2KM3150W
E2KW3150W
175
8751750
E2K3175T
E2K3175W
E2KM3175W
E2KW3175W
200
10002000
E2K3200T
E2K3200W
E2KM3200W
E2KW3200W
225
300650
E2K3225TA
E2K3225AW
E2KM3225AW
E2KW3225AW
5001000
E2K3225TD
E2K3225DW
E2KM3225DW
E2KW3225DW
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Thermal-Magnetic
2
2
11252250
E2K3225T
E2K3225W
E2KM3225W
E2KW3225W
250
12502500
E2K3250T
E2K3250W
E2KM3250W
E2KW3250W
300
15003000
E2K3300T
E2K3300W
E2KM3300W
E2KW3300W
320
16003200
E2KW3320W
350
17503500
E2K3350T
E2K3350W
E2KM3350W
E2KW3350W
400
20004000
E2K3400T
E2K3400W
E2KM3400W
300650
E2K3400TMA
E2K3400MAW
E2KM3250MAW
E2KW3250MAW
5001000
E2K3400TMD
E2K3400MDW
E2KM3400MDW
E2KW3350MDW
6251250
E2K3400TMF
E2K3400MFW
E2KM3400MFW
E2KW3350MFW
7501500
E2K3400TMG
E2K3400MGW
E2KM3400MGW
E2KW3350MGW
8751750
E2K3400TMJ
E2K3400MJW
E2KM3400MJW
E2KW3350MJW
10002000
E2K3400TMK
E2K3400MKW
E2KM3400MKW
E2KW3350MKW
11252250
E2K3400TML
E2K3400MLW
E2KM3400MLW
E2KW3350MLW
12502500
E2K3400TMW
E2K3400MWW
E2KM3400MWW
E2KW3350MWW
15003000
E2K3400TMN
E2K3400MNW
E2KM3400MNW
E2KW3350MNW
16003200
E2KW3350MVW
17503500
E2K3400TMR
E2K3400MRW
E2KM3400MRW
E2KW3350MRW
20004000
E2K3400TM
E2K3400MW
E2KM3400MW
Magnetic Only
400
2
2
Notes
1 Frame only: E2K3400F.
2 Frame only: E2KM3400F.
3 1200 V breakers are sold as complete breakers only.
4 Maximum continuous ampere rating at 50 C.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-378
2.6
100 A400 A
E2KE/E2KEM
E2KM
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
2
2
2
150
50800
KEM3150TM
E2KE3150MW
E2KEM3150MW
225
2001500
KEM3225TM
E2KE3225MW
E2KEM3225MW
5002500
KEM3225TM2
E2KE3225M2W
E2KEM3225M2W
400
2001500
KEM3400TM
E2KE3400MW
E2KEM3400MW
5002500
KEM3400TM2
E2KE3400M2W
E2KEM3400M2W
100
125
50800
50800
KEM3100T
KEM3125T
E2KE3100W
E2KE3125W
E2KEM3100W
E2KEM3125W
150
50800
KEM3150T
E2KE3150W
E2KEM3150W
200
2001500
KEM3200T
E2KE3200W
E2KEM3200W
225
2001500
KEM3225T
E2KE3225W
E2KEM3225
5002500
KEM3225T2
E2KE32252W
E2KEM32252W
400
2001500
KEM3400T
E2KE3400W
E2KEM3400W
5002500
KEM3400T2
E2KE34002W
E2KEM34002W
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
50800
KEM310038T
E2KE310038W
E2KEM310038W
125
50800
KEM312538T
E2KE312538W
E2KEM312538W
150
50800
KEM315038T
E2KE315038W
E2KEM315038W
200
2001500
KEM320038T
E2KE320038W
E2KEM320038W
225
2001500
KEM322538T
E2KE322538W
E2KEM322538
5002500
KEM322538T2
E2KE3225238W
E2KEM3225238W
400
2001500
KEM340038T
E2KE340038W
E2KEM340038W
5002500
KEM340038T2
E2KE3400238W
E2KEM3400238W
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Frame only: E2K3400F.
2 Frame only: E2KM3400F.
3 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2KE340038B20W, KEM3400TB20.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-379
2.6
2
2
2
160 A400 A
E2LME/E2LMZ (Series G)
Circuit Breakers
2
2
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
36004400
LT3400KM
E2LME3400KMW
E2LMZ3400KMW
Magnetic Only
400
160
3201920
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
200
4002400
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
225
4502700
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
250
5003000
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
300
6003600
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
315
6303780
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
350
7004200
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
400
8004800
LT340031M
E2LME340031W
E2LMZ340031W
Notes
1 Frame only: E2LME3400NN.
2 Frame only: E2LMZ3400NN.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-380
2.6
300 A600 A
E2L/E2LM/E2LW
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
2
2
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
300
15003000
E2L3300T
E2L3300W
E2LM3300W
E2LW3300W
320
22504500
E2L3450T
E2L3450W
E2LM3450W
E2LW3320W
350
16003200
E2LW3350W
400
17503500
E2L3350T
E2L3350W
E2LM3350W
E2LW3400W
450
20004000
E2L3400T
E2L3400W
E2LM3400W
E2LW3450W
500
25005000
E2L3500T
E2L3500W
E2LM3500W
600
30006000
E2L3600T
E2L3600W
E2LM3600W
2
2
Thermal-Magnetic
11252250
E2L3600TL
2
2
2
2
Magnetic Only
450
600
16003200
E2LW3450MVW
11252250
E2LW3450MLW
15003000
E2LW3450MNW
17503500
E2LW3450MRW
20004000
E2LW3450MXW
22504500
E2LW3450MYW
11252250
E2L3600TML
E2L3600MLW
E2LM3600MLW
15003000
E2L3600TMN
E2L3600MNW
E2LM3600MNW
17503500
E2L3600TMR
E2L3600MRW
E2LM3600MRW
20004000
E2L3600TMX
E2L3600MXW
E2LM3600MXW
22504500
E2L3600TMY
E2L3600MYW
E2LM3600MYW
25005000
E2L3600TMP
E2L3600MPW
E2LM3600MPW
30006000
E2L3600TM
E2L3600MW
E2LM3600MW
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Frame only: E2L3600F.
2 Frame only: E2LM3600F.
3 Maximum continuous ampere rating at 50 C.
4 600 A thermal 11252250 T.A.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-381
2.6
2
2
2
300 A600 A
E2LE/E2LEM
E2LM
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
400
600
5002500
LEM3400TM
E2LE3400MW
E2LEM3400MW
10004000
LEM3400TM2
E2LE3400M2W
E2LEM3400M2W
5002500
LEM3600TM
E2LE3600MW
E2LEM3600MW
25005000
LEM3600TM2
E2LE3600M2W
E2LEM3600M2W
300
5002500
LEM3300T
E2LE3300W
E2LEM3300W
350
5002500
LEM3350T
E2LE3350W
E2LEM3350W
400
5002500
LEM3400T
E2LE3400W
E2LEM3400W
10004000
LEM3400T2
E2LE34002W
E2LEM34002W
600
5002500
LEM3600T
E2LE3600W
E2LEM3600W
25005000
LEM3600T2
E2LE36002W
E2LEM36002W
300
5002500
LEM330038T
E2LE330038W
E2LEM330038W
350
5002500
LEM335038T
E2LE335038W
E2LEM335038W
400
5002500
LEM340038T
E2LE340038W
E2LEM340038W
10004000
LEM340038T2
E2LE3400238W
E2LEM3400238W
600
5002500
LEM360038T
E2LE360038W
E2LEM360038W
25005000
LEM360038T2
E2LE3600238W
E2LEM3600238W
Notes
1 Frame only: E2L3600F.
2 Frame only: E2LM3600F.
3 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2LE360038B20W, LEM3600TB20.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-382
2.6
300 A 800 A
E2M/E2MM/E2MW
E2M/E2MM/E2MW
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
400
10002000
E2MW3400W
500
12502500
E2MW3500W
600
15003000
E2M3600TN
E2M3600W
E2MM3600W
E2MW3600W
630
16003200
E2MW3630W
800
20004000
E2M3800TX
E2M3800W
E2MM3800W
E2MW3800W
15003000
E2M3800TMN
E2M3800MNW
E2MM3800MNW
E2MW3800MNW
16003200
E2MW3800MVW
20004000
E2M3800TMX
E2M3800MXW
E2MM3800MXW
E2MW3800MXW
25005000
E2M3800TMP
E2M3800MPW
E2MM3800MPW
30006000
E2M3800TMW
E2M3800MWW
E2MM3800MWW
Thermal-Magnetic
2
2
2
2
2
Magnetic Only
800
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Frame only: E2M3800F.
2 Frame only: E2MM3800F.
3 1200 V breakers are sold as complete breakers only.
4 Maximum continuous ampere rating at 50 C.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-383
2.6
2
2
2
800 A
E2ME/E2MEM
E2MN
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
800
5002500
MEM3800TM
E2ME3800MW
E2MEM3800MW
10004000
MEM3800TM2
E2ME3800M2W
E2MEM3800M2W
5002500
MEM3800T
E2ME3800W
E2MEM3800W
10004000
MEM3800T2
E2ME38002W
E2MEM38002W
800
5002500
MEM380038T
E2ME380038W
E2MEM380038W
10004000
MEM380038T2
E2ME3800382W
E2MEM3800382W
Notes
1 Frame only: E2M3800F.
2 Frame only: E2MM3800F.
3 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2ME380038B20W, MEM3800TB20.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-384
2.6
400 A1200 A
E2N/E2NM
E2NM
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
2
2
2
800
5002500
E2N3800MW
E2NM3800MW
1200
12505000
E2N312MW
E2NM312MW
400
5002500
E2N3400W
E2NM3400W
500
5002500
E2N3500W
E2N3M500W
600
5002500
E2N3600W
E2NM3600W
700
5002500
E2N3700W
E2NM3700W
800
5002500
E2N3800W
E2NM3800W
900
12505000
E2N3900W
E2NM3900W
1000
12505000
E2N310W
E2NM310W
1200
12505000
E2N312W
E2NM312W
2
2
2
2
2
2
5002500
E2N340038W
E2NM340038W
500
5002500
E2N350038W
E2NM350038W
600
5002500
E2N360038W
E2NM360038W
700
5002500
E2N370038W
E2NM370038W
800
5002500
E2N380038W
E2NM380038W
900
12505000
E2N390038W
E2NM390038W
1000
12505000
E2N31038W
E2NM31038W
1200
12505000
E2N31238W
E2NM31238W
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2N380038B20W.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-385
2.6
2
2
2
1600 A2000 A
E2R/E2RM
E2RM
2
2
Maximum Continuous
Ampere Rating at 40 C
Magnetic
Trip Range
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
Complete Breaker
Catalog Number
1600
28 x In
E2R316W
E2RM316W
2000
28 x In
E2R320W
E2RM320W
2
2
1600
28 x In
E2R316T38W
E2RM316T38W
2000
28 x In
E2R320T38W
E2RM320T38W
Notes
1 For High Load Alarm option (B20): E2R1638B20W.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-386
2.6
Accessories
Maximum
Breaker Amperes
Wire
Type
Catalog
Number
E2F/E2FM
100
Cu/AI
#141/0 (1)
150
Cu
#44/0 (1)
E2J/E2JM
250
Cu
#4350 (1)
T250KB
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
225
Cu
#3350 (1)
T300K
350
Cu
250500 (1)
T350K
2/0250 (2)
400
Cu
E2LME/E2LMZ
400
Cu/AI
500750 (1)
3TA631LK
E2L/E2LM/E2LW
400
Cu/AI
4/0600 (1)
600
Cu
250350 (2)
T602LD
E2M/E2MM/E2MW
600
Cu
T600MA1
600
Cu/AI
TA700MA1
800 std.
Cu/AI
TA800MA2
800
Cu/AI
TA801MA
800
Cu
T800MA1
700
Cu
2/0500 (2)
T700NB1
1000
Cu
3/0500 (3)
T1000NB1
1200
Cu
3/0400 (4)
T1200NB3
E2N/E2NM
1600
Cu/AI
5001000 (4)
TA1600RD
2000
Cu/AI
2600 (6)
TA2000RD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Breaker
Type
Maximum
Breaker Amperes
Catalog
Number
Metric
Catalog
Number
Imperial
E2F/E2FM
150
KPEK1
KPEMK1
E2J/E2JM
250
KPEK2
KPEMK2
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
400
KPEK3
KPEMK3
E2LME/E2LMZ
400
L3RTWK
E2L/E2LM/E2LW
600
KPEK4
KPEMK4
2
2
2
2
External Accessories
Padlockable Handle
Lock Hasp
Breaker Type
Catalog
Number
E2F/E2FM
PLK1
E2J/E2JM
PLK3
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
PLK3
E2LME/E2LMZ
LPHL
E2L/E2LM/E2LW
HLK4
E2M/E2MM/E2MW
HLK4
E2N/E2NM
PLK5
E2R/E2RM
HLK6
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-387
2.6
Internal Accessories
Undervoltage Release 1
2
2
2
2
Breaker
Type
UVR
Type
Voltage
Rating
Mounting
Location
Catalog
Number
Factory
Modification Code
E2F/E2FM
Handle reset
208240 Vac
Left pole
U18
Handle reset
110127 Vdc
Left pole
U42
Handle reset
110127 Vac
Left pole
UVH2LP08K 2
U18
Handle reset
208240 Vac
Left pole
UVH2LP11K 2
U22
Handle reset
110125 Vdc
Left pole
UVH2LP26K 2
T14
E2J/E2JM
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
120 Vac
Left pole
UVM3LP08K
120 Vac
Left pole
UVM3LP08KT 24
U68
Handle reset
110127 Vac
Left pole
UVH3LP08K 2
U18
Handle reset
208240 Vac
Left pole
UVH3LP11K 2
U22
Handle reset
110125 Vdc
Left pole
UVH3LP26K 2
T14
E2LME/E2LMZ
Handle reset
110127 Vac
Left pole
UVR120APK
U5
Handle reset
110125 Vdc
Left pole
UVR125DPK
U6
E2L/E2LM/E2LW/E2M/E2MM/
E2MW
120 Vac
Left pole
UVM4LP08K 23
2
2
2
2
2
23
24
U66
U66
120 Vac
Left pole
UVM4LP08KT
Handle reset
110127 Vac
Left pole
UVH4LP08K 2
U18
Handle reset
208240 Vac
Left pole
UVH4LP11K 2
U22
Handle reset
110125 Vdc
Left pole
UVH4LP26K 2
T14
120 Vac
Left pole
UVM5LP08K 3
U66
120 Vac
Left pole
UVM5LT08K 4
U68
Handle reset
110127 Vac
Left pole
UVH5LP08K 2
U18
Handle reset
208240 Vac
Left pole
UVH5LP11K 2
U22
T14
2
2
E2N/E2NM
U68
Handle reset
110125 Vdc
Left pole
UVH5LP26K
120 Vac
Right pole
UVM6RP08K 35
U58
Handle reset
110127 Vac
Right pole
UVH6RP08K 5
U49
Handle reset
208240 Vac
Right pole
UVH6RP11K 5
U53
Handle reset
110125 Vdc
Right pole
UVH6RP26K 5
T33
2
2
2
E2R/E2RM
Notes
1 Contact Eaton for internal accessory voltage ratings not listed.
2 LH (RH also available).
3 Pigtail leads.
4 Terminal blocks.
5 RH only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-388
Shunt Trip 1
2.6
Breaker
Type
Voltage
Rating
E2F/E2FM
48127 Vac or
4860 Vdc
E2J/E2JM
Mounting
Location
Factory
Modification
Code
Catalog
Number
2
Left pole
SNT1LP08K
S06
208230 Vac or
110127 Vdc
Left pole
SNT1LP12K 2
S10
110240 Vac or
110125 Vdc
Left pole
SNT2P11K 3
S10
Breaker
Type
Number of Sets
of Contacts
(Make and
Break)
Mounting
Location
E2F/E2FM
Right
A1L1LPK/A1L1RPK B06
Right
A2L1LPK/A2L1RPK B13
Right
A1L2LPK/A1L2RPK B06
E2J/E2JM
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
Catalog
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Right
A1L3LPK/A1L3RPK B06
Right
A2L3LPK/A2L3RPK B13
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
110240 Vac or
110125 Vdc
Left pole
SNT3P11K 3
S10
Right
ALM1M1BJPK
B1
E2LME/E2LMZ
2460 Vac/dc
Left pole
SNT060CPK
S1
Right
ALM2M2BJPK
B3
110240 Vac/dc
Left pole
SNT120CPK
S2
A1L4LPK/A1L4RPK B06
Left pole
SNT4LP05K 2
S06
E2L/E2LM/E2LW/E2M/ 1
E2MM/E2MW
2
Right
4860 Vac
Right
A2L4LPK/A2L4RPK B13
4860 Vdc
Left pole
SNT4LP23K 2
S86
E2N/E2NM
Right
A1L5LPK/A1L5RPK B06
110240 Vac
Left pole
SNT4LP11K 2
S10
Right
A2L5LPK/A2L5RPK B13
110125 Vdc
Left pole
SNT4LP26K 2
S42
Right
A1L6RPK
B05
110240 Vac
Left pole
SNT5LP11K 2
S10
Right
A2L6RPK
B12
110125 Vdc
Left pole
SNT5LP26K 2
S42
110240 Vac
Right pole
SNT6P11K 4
S29
110125 Vdc
Right pole
SNT6P26K 4
S45
E2L/E2LM/E2LW/E2M/
E2MM/E2MW
E2N/E2NM
E2R/E2RM
E2LME/E2LMZ
E2R/E2RM
E2F/E2FM
E2J/E2JM
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
E2LME/E2LMZ
E2L/E2LM/E2LW/E2M/
E2MM/E2MW
E2N/E2NM
E2R/E2RM
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Contact Eaton for internal accessory voltage ratings not listed.
2 LH (RH also available).
3 LH or RH.
4 RH only.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Auxiliary Switch
Breaker
Type
Number of Sets
of Contacts
Mounting
(1A and 1B)
Location
Catalog
Number
Factory
Modification
Code
Right
A1X1PK
A06
Right
A2X1RPK
A13
Right
A1X2PK
A06
Right
A2X2PK
A13
Right
A1X3PK
A06
Right
A2X3PK
A13
Right
AUX1A1BPK
A1
Right
AUX2A2BPK
A2
Right
A1X4PK
A06
Right
A2X4PK
A13
Right
A1X5PK
A06
Right
A2X5PK
A13
Right
A2X6RPK
A12
Right
A4X6RPK
A19
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-389
2.6
2
2
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
Please see TD01217001E for detailed dimensions.
3 A150 A
70 A250 A
E2F/E2FM
Sealed Breakers with Non-Interchangeable Trip Unit
Include Line/Load Terminals Non-Electronic Trip Units
E2J/E2JM
Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Non-Electronic
Trip Units
2
2
On
Off
B
ON/
2
2
2
2
Front View
Side View
Description
4.13 (104.9)
6.00 (152.4)
3.38 (85.9)
3.50 (88.9)
OFF/
D
Front View
Description
4.13 (104.9)
10.00 (254.0)
4.06 (103.1)
4.31 (109.5)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-390
Side View
2.6
100 A400 A
100 A400 A
E2K/E2KM/E2KW
E2KE/E2KEM
2
2
2
2
ON
ON
OFF
OFF
2
2
2
2
2
2
D
Front View
Side View
Front View
Description
Description
5.49 (139.4)
5.49 (139.4)
10.13 (257.3)
10.13 (257.3)
4.06 (103.1)
4.06 (103.1)
4.31 (109.5)
4.31 (109.5)
Side View
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-391
2.6
2
2
2
160 A400 A
300 A600 A
E2LME/E2LMZ
E2L/E2LM/E2LW
Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Electronic Trip Units
Circuit Breakers
2
2
2
On/I
On/I
On/I
On/I
Off/O
Off/O
Off/O
Off/O
2
D
2
2
Front View
Side View
Front View
Description
Description
5.48 (139.2)
8.25 (209.6)
10.13 (257.3)
10.75 (273.1)
4.00 (101.6)
4.06 (103.1)
4.22 (107.1)
4.38 (111.3)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-392
Side View
2.6
300 A600 A
300 A800 A
E2LE/E2LEM
Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Electronic Trip Units
E2M/E2MM/E2MW
Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Non-Electronic
Trip Units
2
2
2
2
On/I
On/I
B
Off/O
Off/O
On/I
On/I
B
Off/O
Off/O
D
Front View
Side View
2
Description
8.25 (209.6)
10.75 (273.1)
4.06 (103.1)
4.38 (111.3)
2
2
2
D
Front View
Description
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
4.06 (103.1)
4.38 (111.3)
Side View
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-393
2.6
2
2
2
2
800 A
400 A1200 A
E2ME/E2MEM
E2N/E2NM
Circuit Breakers with Interchangeable Electronic Trip Units
2
2
2
2
2
On/I
On/I
ON/I
2
2
Off/O
Off/O
OFF/O
2
2
2
2
D
Front View
D
Front View
Side View
Description
Description
8.25 (209.6)
8.25 (209.6)
16.00 (406.4)
16.00 (406.4)
4.06 (103.1)
5.50 (139.7)
4.38 (111.3)
6.00 (152.4)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-394
Side View
2.6
1600 A2000 A
E2R/ E2RM
Circuit Breakers with Electronic Trip Units
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
D
Front View
Description
Side View
15.50 (393.7)
16.00 (406.4)
9.00 (228.6)
10.00 (254.0)
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-395
2.6
Contents
Description
Page
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-339
V4-T2-345
V4-T2-358
V4-T2-370
V4-T2-398
V4-T2-403
V4-T2-405
V4-T2-410
2
2
2
2
Product Overview
2
2
2
installed Westinghouse
equipment. To upgrade to the
current offering of E2 mining
circuit breakers, consult the
cross reference information
on Page V4-T2-405.
2
2
60 Hz
AC Volts
KAM
HKAM
HLAM 2
240
25,000
42,000
480
22,000
30,000
600
22,000
22,000
1000 1
10,000
12,000
14,000
2
2
Breaker Type
Single-Pole
Breaker
Type
Maximum
Ampere Rating
0.00.15 mH Inductance 3
0.150.5 mH Inductance
0.50.9 mH Inductance
KAM
225
15,000
10,000
15,000
5000
LAM
400/600
15,000
10,000
15,000
5000
MAM
800
15,000
10,000
15,000
5000
NBM
1200
15,000
10,000
15,000
5000
2
2
2
Notes
1 Based on circuit power factor of 50% or greater.
2 HLAM must be rear stud connected. If front connected, interrupting capacity rating is 10,000 amperes.
3 Resistive circuit.
4 Two poles in electrical series in ungrounded leg of circuit.
2
V4-T2-396
2.4 mH Inductance
2.6
Breaker
Type
Volts
Line
Amperes
Series
Resistors 1
Total
VA
KAM, HKAM 1
480/60
0.021
10,000
10.1
240/60
0.019
4.6
120/60
0.021
2.5
120/60 2
0.13
480/60
0.033
12,000
2
2
2
2
15.6
3
15.9
240/60
0.028
6,000
6.7
120/60
0.029
3.5
120/60 2
0.13
15.6
2
2
2
2
Volts
Amperes
VA
480/60
0.085
40.8
240/60
1.7
408
120/60
0.88
105.6
48 DC
8.0
384
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Supplied for external customer mounting.
2 New design electrical reset UVR.
3 16,000 for Type MAM and HMAM.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-397
2.6
2
Product Selection
For reference only. Replace these frames with E2 Series. See Cross-Reference information beginning on Page V4-T2-405.
Breaker
Type
Frame
Style Numbers 12
Poles
Amperes
KAM
2609D60G64
180
1291C26G07
180
2609D60G66
180
1291C26G01
1291C26G02
2
2
Trip
Type
Accessories
(Included in Frame)
None
200400
UVR 4
200400
200400
225
TM
UVR 4
300700
225
TM
UVR 4
5001000
2609D60G67
180
None
200400
1291C26G08
180
UVR 4
200400
3
2609D60G69
180
5685D48G75
225
TM
None
5685D48G74
225
TM
None
5001000
1291C26G03
225
TM
UVR 4
300700
1291C26G04
225
TM
UVR 4
5001000
2609D60G01
225
TM
300700
2609D60G02
225
TM
5001000
2609D60G40
225
None
300700
2609D60G41
225
None
500700
1291C26G05
225
UVR 4
300700
1291C26G06
225
UVR 4
5001000
1291C32G01
400
TM
UVR 4
5001000
2609D60G61
400
7501500
1291C32G03
400
TM
UVR 4
5001000
5685D48G73
400
TM
None
8001600
1291C32G02
400
TM
UVR 4
8001600
2609D60G03
400
TM
8001600
2609D60G44
400
None
8001600
1291C32G04
400
UVR 4
8001600
2
2
2
LAM
Notes
1 Terminals not included in style number.
2 All breakers listed are complete with accessories indicated.
3 Rated 120 volts/60 Hz: undervoltage release is handle reset type.
4 UVR is auto-reset type, 120 Vac.
M = magnetic only; TM = thermal-magnetic.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-398
200400
300700
2.6
For reference only. Replace these frames with E2 Series. See Cross-Reference information beginning on Page V4-T2-405.
Breaker
Type
Frame
Style Numbers 12
Poles
Amperes
Trip
Type
Accessories
(Included in Frame)
MAM
2609D60G17
600
TM
UVR 3
7501500
2609D60G18
800
TM
UVR 3
10002000
2609D60G63
400
TM
UVR 3
20004000
5685D48G72
600
TM
None
15003000
2609D60G19
600
TM
UVR 3
15003000
2609D60G04
600
TM
15003000
20004000
NBM
2609D60G05
800
TM
5685D48G71
800
TM
None
3
2
2
2
2
20004000
2609D60G20
800
TM
UVR
2609D60G46
800
None
15003000
2609D60G47
800
UVR 3
15003000
2609D60G48
800
None
20004000
2609D60G49
800
UVR 3
20004000
15003000
20004000
20004000
1229C37G13
1000
TM
UVR
1229C37G14
1200
TM
UVR 4
1227C36G10
1000
TM
None
25005000
1229C37G15
1000
TM
UVR 4
25005000
1227C36G13
1000
TM
25005000
1227C36G14
1200
TM
25005000
1227C36G09
1200
TM
None
25005000
1229C37G16
1200
TM
UVR 4
25005000
1227C36G19
1200
None
25005000
1229C37G17
1200
UVR 4
25005000
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Terminals not included in style number.
2 All breakers listed are complete with accessories indicated.
3 Rated 120 volts/60 Hz: undervoltage release is handle reset type.
4 UVR is auto-reset type, 120 Vac.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-399
2.6
Breaker
Type
Frame
Style Numbers
Poles
Amperes
Trip
Type
Accessories
(Included in Frame)
HKAM
2609D60G70
180
None
200400
1291C26G16
180
UVR 2
200400
5685D48G87
225
TM
None
300700
1291C26G12
225
TM
UVR 2
300700
5685D48G86
225
TM
None
5001000
1291C26G13
225
TM
UVR 2
5001000
1291C26G14
225
UVR 2
300700
HKAM
1291C26G15
225
UVR
5001000
2
2
HLAM
HLAM
5685D48G85
400
TM
None
8001600
1291C32G07
400
TM
UVR 2
8001600
1291C32G09
400
UVR 2
8001600
2
2
2
HMAM
HMAM
2
2
2
5685D48G84
600
TM
None
15003000
2609D60G28
600
TM
UVR 3
15003000
5685D48G83
800
TM
None
20004000
2609D60G29
800
TM
UVR 3
20004000
2609D60G57
800
UVR 3
15003000
20004000
2609D60G58
800
UVR
2
2
2
HNAM
2
2
HNBM
1227C36G12
1000
TM
None
25005000
1229C37G19
1000
TM
UVR 2
25005000
1227C36G11
1200
TM
None
25005000
1200
TM
UVR
1200
UVR 2
Notes
1 The magnetic trip range does not change when rating plug is changed.
2 120 volt, 60 Hz electrical reset type.
3 Rated 120 volts, 60 Hz; undervoltage release is handle reset type.
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-400
25005000
1229C37G18
2
2
25005000
1229C37G20
2
2
2.6
Frame Size,
Amperes
Number
of Poles
Style
Numbers
Breaker
Type
Frame Size,
Amperes
Number
of Poles
Style
Numbers
KAM 1
225
2602D86G11
MAM 2
800
2600D43G11
225
2602D86G12
800
2600D43G12
KAMH 1
225
2602D86G13
MAMH 2
800
2600D43G13
225
2602D86G14
800
2600D43G14
HKAM 1
225
1264C99G05
HMAM 2
800
1264C99G03
LAM 2
400
2602D99G05
NBM 2
1200
2610D64G07
400
2602D99G06
1200
2610D64G08
LAMH 2
400
2602D99G07
NBMH 2
1200
2610D64G09
400
2602D99G08
1200
2610D64G10
HLAM 2
400
1264C99G02
HNBM 2
1200
2610D64G13
LAM3600F
600
2603D48G07
LAMH3600F
600
2603D48G08
HLAM3600F
600
2603D48G09
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Magnetic Only
Breaker
Type
Conductor
Size
Maximum Continuous
Amperes
Three-Pole
Style Numbers
Three-Pole
Style Numbers
HKAM
#6
150400
180
2609D99G22
#4#3
300700
225
5685D48G40
2611D75G01
#4#1
5001000
225
5685D48G34
2611D75G02
#4#1
7501500
400
5685D48G97
2609D99G21
#2#2/0
8001600
400
5685D48G28
2611D75G03
#22/0
7501500
600
2609D99G20
2/0500 kcmil
15003000
600
2609D99G19
#2#2/0
7501500
600
2/0500 kcmil
15003000
600
5685D48G22
2611D75G04 4
#13/0
10002000
800
3/0500 kcmil
20004000
800
5685D48G16
2611D75G05
2/0500 kcmil
15003000
1000
4/0500 kcmil
25005000
1000
5685D48G10
3/0500 kcmil
20004000
1200
4/0500 kcmil
25005000
1200
5685D48G04
2611D75G07
HLAM
HLAM600
HMAM
HNBM
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Frame modified for left-hand mounting of UVR attachment.
2 Frame modified for right-hand mounting of UVR attachment.
3 Three-pole trip units only are suitable for replacement in 1000 volt mining service circuit breakers.
4 800 amperes.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-401
2.6
2
2
2
Terminal
Type
Maximum
Amperes
Wire Range,
Type
FBM, HFBM
100
624B100G02
#141/0 Al/Cu
50
624B100G10
#14#4 Al/Cu
100
624B100G17
# 44/0 Al/Cu
2
2
2
2
KAM, HKAM
LAM
Terminal
Type
225
T225LA
225
TA225LA1
225
T225LA
400
T401LA
2
2
TA225LA1
TA400LA1
400
TA401LA
600
T600LA
600
TA600LA
350
T350MA
225
400
2
2
Terminal
Catalog Number
Maximum
Amperes
600
T600MA1
800
T800MA1
600
TA700MA1
800
TA800MA2
800
TA801MA
1000
T1000NB1
1200
T1200NB1
1000
TA1000NB1
1200
TA1200NB1
1200
TA1201NB1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-402
2.6
Accessories
Stud
Length
Rear Connected Studs For Insulated Panels Only: Two Per Pole
clearances required by
Underwriters Laboratories.2
Two studs required per pole.
For List Prices, see Eatons
Price and Availability Digest.
Tube
Style
Numbers
Length In
Inches (mm)
Style
Numbers
Stud
Style Numbers
0.50 (12.7)13
3.22 (81.8)
1241 345
0.50 (12.7)13
6.28 (159.5)
1241 346
225 34
0.50 (12.7)13
4.97 (126.2)
1241 392
400 3
0.75 (19.1)16
5.47 (138.9)
05B7383G22
0.75 (19.1)16
7.97 (202.4)
05B7383G23
0.75 (19.1)16
10.47 (265.9)
05B7383G24
1.00 (25.4)12
5.91 (150.1)
314C960G16
1.00 (25.4)12
8.41 (213.6)
314C960G17
1.00 (25.4)12
10.91 (277.1)
314C960G18
656D565G01
0.84 (21.3)
456D983H05
Long
656D565G02
3.78 (96.0)
456D983H08
656D565G01
1.09 (27.7)
456D983H06
Long
656D565G02
4.03 (102.4)
456D983H09
Diameter, In
Inches (mm)
and Thread
Extension Back
of Breaker In
Inches (mm)
Stud
Ampere Number
600
Short
656D565G01
1.34 (34.0)
456D983H07
Long
656D565G02
4.28 (108.7)
456D983H10
225
0.50 (12.7)13
3.66 (93.0)
314C960G01
400
0.75 (19.1)16
5.91 (150.1)
314C960G04
0.75 (19.1)16
8.41 (213.6)
314C960G05
0.75 (19.1)16
10.91 (277.1)
314C960G06
1.00 (25.4)12
5.91 (150.1)
314C960G07
1.00 (25.4)12
8.41 (213.6)
314C960G08
1.00 (25.4)12
10.91 (277.1)
314C960G09
1.13 (28.7)12
4.91 (124.7)
314C960G10
1.13 (28.7)12
8.41 (213.6)
314C960G11
1.13 (28.7)12
10.91 (277.1)
314C960G12
1.13 (28.7)12
5.50 (139.7)
623B222G01
1.13 (28.7)12
8.00 (203.2)
623B222G02
1.13 (28.7)12
10.50 (266.7)
623B222G03
1.25 (31.8)12
5.50 (139.7)
373B375G04
1.25 (31.8)12
10.50 (266.7)
373B375G03
600
800
1200
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Description
Style Numbers
KAM
Line terminals
1261C93G01
Load terminals
1262C46G01
LAM-400
Line terminals
1261C95G01
Load terminals
1262C48G01
MAM
Line terminals
1261C97G01
Load terminals
1261C97G02
Notes
1 Not UL Iisted.
2 400 ampere LA studs of the same length have sufficient clearance; however, customer
connections may make it necessary to use a short stud adjacent to a long stud.
3 150, 300 and 400 ampere frames only.
4 This is a special stud that includes six contact nuts for use where bus contact nuts
must be used.
5 For breakers used with terminals and cable connections. Sold in packages of 10.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-403
2.6
Shunt Trips
For tripping breaker from a
remote point. A solenoid
device mounts within breaker
case. Breaker trips when coil
is energized. A cutoff switch
breaks the circuit to the
momentary rated coil when
breaker opens. Available for
Breaker
Type
KAM, HKAM
Right-Hand Mounting
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volts
LAM, HLAM
2
2
2
2
2
2
MAM, HMAM,
MAMH
NBM, HNBM,
NBMH
2
2
Style
Numbers
Breaker
Type
2
2
2
2
2605D15G16
240 Vac
2605D15G17
120 Vac
2605D15G19
480 Vac
2606D56G16
120 Vac 1
1228C76G03
240 Vac
2606D56G17
240 Vac
4995D12G13
120 Vac
2606D56G19
480 Vac
4995D12G14
48 Vdc
2606D56G07
125 Vdc
4995D12G09
480 Vac
2606D57G16
120 Vac
5672D69G11
240 Vac
2606D57G17
120 Vac 1
120 Vac
2606D57G19
240 Vac
5672D69G13
480 Vac
2606D58G16
480 Vac
5672D69G14
240 Vac
2606D58G17
120 Vac
4995D11G11
120 Vac
2606D58G19
120 Vac 1
1229C35G03
Left-Hand Mounting
240 Vac
4995D11G13
KAM, HKAM
480 Vac
4995D11G14
LAM, HLAM
MAM, HMAM,
MAMH
NBM, HNBM,
NBMH
480 Vac
2605D15G02
240 Vac
2605D15G03
120 Vac
2605D15G05
120 Vac
4995D10G01
480 Vac
2606D56G02
120 Vac 1
1228C76G03
240 Vac
2606D56G03
240 Vac
4995D10G03
120 Vac
2606D56G05
480 Vac
4995D10G04
480 Vac
2606D57G02
240 Vac
2606D57G03
120 Vac
2606D57G05
480 Vac
2606D58G02
240 Vac
2606D58G03
120 Vac
2606D58G05
LAM, HLAM
MAM, HMAM,
MAMH
Notes
1 Electrical reset UVR.
2 Auto reset type.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-404
480 Vac
4995D12G11
2
2
Style
Numbers
120 Vac
NBM, HNBM,
NBMH
Volts
(5060 Hz)
Right-Hand Mounting
Left-Hand Mounting
KAM, HKAM
2.6
Reference Information
E2
2
2
Cross-Reference
Series C Mining
Superseded by E2 Mining
Series C Mining
Superseded by E2 Mining
1491D72G31
E2J3070T
FDBM3040
E2F3040
1491D72G32
E2J3090T
FDBM3045
E2F3045
1491D72G33
E2J3100T
FDBM3050
E2F3050
1491D72G37
E2J3200T
FDBM3050U62
E2F3050U62
6622C87G27
E2K3225AWU66
FDBM3050WU62
E2F3050WU62
6622C87G28
E2K3225DWU66
FDBM3060
E2F3060
6622C87G32
E2K3400GWU66
FDBM3070
E2F3070
E2KM3100
E2KEM3100W
FDBM3070WU62
E2F3070WU62
E2KM3100U66
E2KEM3100WU66
FDBM3080
E2F3080
E2KM3125
E2KEM3125W
FDBM3090
E2F3090
E2KM3125U66
E2KEM3125WU66
FDBM3100
E2F3100
E2KM3150
E2KEM3150W
FDBM3100LM04U62
E2F3100M04U62
E2KM3150MU66
E2KEM3150WU66
FDBM3125
E2F3125
E2KM3150TM
E2KEM3150MW
FDBM3150
E2F3150
E2KM3150U66
E2KEM3150MWU66
FDBM3150L
E2F3150L
E2KM3200
E2KEM3200W
FDM3015
E2F3015
E2KM3200U66
E2KEM3200WU66
FDM3015L
E2F3015L
E2KM3225
E2KEM3225W
FDM3015LU62
E2F3015LU62
E2KM3225F
E2KM3400F
FDM3020
E2F3020
E2KM3225FUV
E2KM3400F
FDM3020LU62
E2F3020LU62
E2KM3225MU66
E2KEM3225MWU66
FDM3025
E2F3025
E2KM3225TM
E2KEM3225TM
FDM3025L
E2F3025L
E2KM3225U66
E2KEM3225WU66
FDM3025LS22
E2F3025LS22
E2LM3300U66
E2LEM3300WU66
FDM3025LU62
E2F3025LU62
E2LM3350U66
E2LEM3350WU66
FDM3030
E2F3030
E2LM34002U66
E2LEM34002WU66
FDM3030LS22
E2F3030LS22
E2LM3400F
E2LM3600F
FDM3040
E2F3040
E2LM3400FUV
E2LM3600F
FDM3040L
E2F3040L
E2LM3400M2U66
E2LEM3400M2WU66
FDM3040LU62
E2F3040LU62
E2LM3400MU66
E2LEM3400MWU66
FDM3050
E2F3050
E2LM3400U66
E2LEM3400WU66
FDM3050LU62
E2F3050LU62
FDBM3015
E2F3015
FDM3050U62
E2F3050U62
FDBM3015WU62
E2F3015WU62
FDM3060
E2F3060
FDBM3020
E2F3020
FDM3060LU62
E2F3060LU62
FDBM3025
E2F3025
FDM3070
E2F3070
FDBM3025U62
E2F3025U62
FDM3070A02U62
E2F3070A02U62
FDBM3030
E2F3030
FDM3080
E2F3080
FDBM3030U62
E2F3030WU62
FDM3090
E2F3090
FDBM3030WU62
E2F3030WU62
FDM3100
E2F3100
FDBM3035
E2F3035
FDM3100LS22
E2F3100LS22
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-405
2.6
2
E2 Cross-Reference, continued
Series C Mining
Superseded by E2 Mining
Series C Mining
Superseded by E2 Mining
FDM3100LU62
E2FLU62
JDCM3150W
E2JM3150W
FDM3125
E2F3125
JDCM3175W
E2JM3175W
FDM3125LU62
E2F3125LU62
JDCM3200W
E2JM3200W
FDM3150
E2F3150
JDCM3225A5W
E2JM3225AW
HFDM003AM
E2F003AM
JDCM3225D5W
E2JM3225DW
HFDM003AMLU62
E2F003AMLU62
JDCM3225W
E2JM3225W
HFDM007CM
E2F007CM
JDCM3250A5MW
E2JM3250MAW
HFDM007CMU62
E2F007CMU62
JDCM3250A5MWU18
E2JM3250MAWU18
HFDM015EM
E2F015EM
JDCM3250A5W
E2JM3250AW
HFDM015EMA02
E2F015EMA02
JDCM3250C5MW
E2JM3250MCW
HFDM015EMLU62
E2F015EMLU62
JDCM3250D5MW
E2JM3250MDW
HFDM015EMU62
E2F015EMU62
JDCM3250D5MWA06
E2JM3250MDWA06
HFDM030HM
E2F030HM
JDCM3250D5W
E2JM3250DW
HFDM030HMLU62
E2F030HMLU62
JDCM3250D5WS10
E2JM3250DWS10
HFDM030HMU62
E2F030HMU62
JDCM3250F
E2JM3250F
HFDM050KM
E2F050KM
JDCM3250F5MD01
E2JM3250MFD01
HFDM050KML
E2F050KML
JDCM3250F5MW
E2JM3250MFW
HFDM050KMLU62
E2F050KMLU62
JDCM3250G5MW
E2JM3250MGW
HFDM050KMU62
E2F050KMU62
JDCM3250G5WA02D01
E2JM3250MGA02D01
HFDM070MM
E2F070MM
JDCM3250J5MW
E2JM3250MJW
HFDM070MMU62
E2F070MMU62
JDCM3250J5MWA02
E2JM3250MJA02
HFDM1001M
E2F1001M
JDCM3250J5WA02D01
E2JM3250MJA02D01
HFDM1001MS22
E2F1001MS22
JDCM3250J5WD01
E2JM3250MJD01
HFDM100LM
E2F100LM
JDCM3250K5MW
E2JM3250MKW
HFDM100LMA02
E2F100LMA02
JDCM3250L5MW
E2JM3250MLW
HFDM100LMU62
E2F100LMU62
JDCM3250MW
E2JM3250MW
HFDM 100RM
E2F100RM
JDCM3250W
E2JM3250W
HFDM100RML
E2F100RML
JDCMAA2D1
E2JM3250MM02D01
HFDM100RMS22
E2F100RMS22
JDCMDD1S30
E2JM3250MDS30D01
HFDM100RMU62
E2F100RMU62
JDCMFD01
E2JM3250MFD01
HFDM150TM
E2F150TM
JDCMGA02D1
E2JM3250MGA02D01
HFDM150TML
E2F150TML
JDCMJA2D1
E2JM3250MJA02D01
HFDM150TMU62
E2F150TMU62
JDCMJD01
E2JM3250MJD01
HFDM150UM
E2F150UM
JDM2250F
E2JM3250F
JCDA2D1S30
E2JM250MDA2D1S30
JDM3070W
E2J3070W
JCMA2D1S30
E2JM250MFA2D1S30
JDM3090W
E2J3090W
JDCM3070W
E2JM3070W
JDM3100W
E2J3100W
JDCM3090W
E2JM3090W
JDM3125W
E2J3125W
JDCM3100W
E2JM3100W
JDM3150W
E2J3150W
JDCM3125W
E2JM3125W
JDM3150WU18
E2J3150WU18
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-406
E2 Cross-Reference,
2.6
continued
Series C Mining
Superseded by E2 Mining
Series C Mining
JDM3175W
E2J3175W
JM3250TL5M_1125-2250
E2J3250TML
JDM3200W
E2J3200W
JM3250TM
E2J3250TM
JDM3200WA06
E2J3200WA06
KDCM3100W
E2KM3100W
JDM3225A5W
E2J3225AW
KDCM3125W
E2KM3125W
JDM3225D5W
E2J3225DW
KDCM3150W
E2KM3150W
JDM3225W
E2J3225W
KDCM3175W
E2KM3175W
JDM3250A5MW
E2J3250MAW
KDCM3200W
E2KM3200W
JDM3250A5W
E2J3250AW
KDCM3225A5MW
E2KM3200MAW
JDM3250C5MW
E2J3250CW
KDCM3225D5MW
E2KM3200MDW
JDM3250D5MW
E2J3250MDW
KDCM3225W
E2KM3225W
JDM3250D5W
E2J3250DW
KDCM3250W
E2KM3250W
JDM3250F
E2J3250F
KDCM3250WU18
E2KM3250WU18
JDM3250F5MW
E2J3250MFW
KDCM3300W
E2KM3300W
JDM3250G5MW
E2J3250MGW
KDCM3350W
E2KM3350W
JDM3250J5MW
E2J3250MJW
KDCM3400D5MA02D09H04
E2KM3400MDA02D09H04
JDM3250K5MW
E2J3250MKW
KDCM3400D5MW
E2KM3400MDW
JDM3250L5MW
E2J3250MLW
KDCM3400D5MWA02D07
E2KM3400MDA02D07
JDM3250MW
E2J3250MW
KDCM3400D5W
E2KM3400DW
JDM3250W
E2J3250W
KDCM3400D5WD09
E2KM3400DD09
JDM3250WS10
E2J3250WS10
KDCM3400F
E2KM3400F
JM2225T1125-2250
E2J3225T
KDCM3400F5MW
E2KM3400MFW
JM3070T
E2J3070T
KDCM3400FD09G04
E2KM3400MFD09G04
JM3090T
E2J3090T
KDCM3400G5MW
E2KM3400MGD09G05
JM3100T
E2J3100T
KDCM3400G5MWD09H04
E2KM3400MGD09H04
JM3125T
E2J3125T
KDCM3400G5W
E2KM3400MGW
JM3150T
E2J3150T
KDCM3400G5WD07
E2KM3400MGD07
JM3175T
E2J3175T
KDCM3400J5MA02D09
E2KM3400MJA02D09
JM3200T
E2J3200T
KDCM3400J5MA2D9G4S30
E2KM3400MJA2D9G4S30
JM3225T
E2J3225T
KDCM3400J5MD09
E2KM3400MJD09
JM3225TA5
E2J3225TA
KDCM3400J5MD09H04S30
E2KM3400MJD09H04S30
JM3225TD5
E2J3225TD
KDCM3400J5MW
E2KM3400MJW
JM3250T
E2J3250T
KDCM3400J5MWA02D07
E2KM3400MJA02D07
JM3250TA5
E2J3250TA
KDCM3400J5MWA06
E2KM3400MJWA06
JM3250TA5M_350-700
E2J3250TMA
KDCM3400J5MWD07S30
E2KM3400MJD07S30
JM3250TC5M
E2J3250TMC
KDCM3400J5WD07
E2KM3400MJD07
JM3250TD5_500-1000
E2J3250TMD
KDCM3400K5MW
E2KM3400MKW
JM3250TF5M_625-1250
E2J3250TMF
KDCM3400K5MWS10
E2KM3400MKWS10
JM3250TG5M_750-1500
E2J3250TMG
KDCM3400K5MWU18
E2KM3400MKWU18
JM3250TJ5M_875-1750
E2J3250TMJ
KDCM3400L5MW
E2KM3400MLW
JM3250TK5M_1000-2000
E2J3250TMK
KDCM3400L5MWD09H04
E2KM3400MLD09H04
Superseded by E2 Mining
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-407
2.6
2
E2 Cross-Reference, continued
Series C Mining
Superseded by E2 Mining
Series C Mining
KDCM3400L5MWS10
E2KM3400MLWS10
KDM3300WS10
E2K3300WS10
KDCM3400L5WD07
E2KM3400MLD07
KDM3350W
E2K3350W
KDCM3400MW
E2KM3400MW
KDM3400D5MW
E2K3400MDW
KDCM3400N5MW
E2KM3400MNW
KDM3400D5W
E2K3400DW
KDCM3400N5MWA06
E2KM3400MNWA06
KDM3400D5WU18
E2K3400DWU18
KDCM3400N5WA02D07
E2KM3400MNA02D07
KDM3400F
E2K3400F
KDCM3400R5MW
E2KM3400MRW
KDM3400F5MW
E2K3400MFW
KDCM3400W
E2KM3400W
KDM3400FK37A06D09D18
E2KE3400A06D09D18
KDCM3400W5MW
E2KM3400MWW
KDM3400G5A06D09U18
E2K3400GA06D09U18
KDCMDMD07
E2KM3400MDD07
KDM3400G5A13D09U18
E2K3400GA13D09U18
KDCMNA2D7
E2KM3400MNA02D07
KDM3400G5MW
E2K3400MGW
KDM2400F
E2K2400F
KDM3400G5W
E2K3400GW
KDM2400G5MS50
E2K2400MGWS50
KDM3400G5WA06
E2K3400GWS10
KDM2400G5MW
E2K2400MGW
KDM3400G5WS10
E2K3400GWS10
KDM2400W5MW
E2K2400MWW
KDM3400G5WU18
E2K3400GWU18
KDM2400W5MWA06D07S10
E2K2400MWA06D07S10
KDM3400J5MW
E2K3400MJW
KDM2400W5MWA06D10S10
E2K2400MWA06D10S10
KDM3400K5MS54
E2K3400MKWS54
KDM2400W5MWD07
E2K2400MWD07
KDM3400K5MW
E2K3400MKW
KDM2400W5MWD07S10
E2K2400MWD07S10
KDM3400L5MW
E2K3400MLW
KDM2400W5MWD10
E2K2400MWD10
KDM3400MW
E2K3400MW
KDM2400W5MWD10S10
E2K2400MWD10S10
KDM3400MWA06U18
E2K3400MWA06U18
KDM2400W5MWS10
E2K2400MWWS10
KDM3400N5MW
E2K3400MNW
KDM3100W
E2K3100W
KDM3400R5MW
E2K3400MRW
KDM3125W
E2K3125W
KDM3400W
E2K3400W
KDM3150W
E2K3150W
KDM3400W5MW
E2K3400MWW
KDM3150WA06
E2K3150WA06
KEM3100T
KEM3100T
KDM3175W
E2K3175W
KEM3125T
KEM3125T
KDM3200W
E2K3200W
KEM3150T
KEM3150T
KDM3225A5W
E2K3225AW
KEM3150TM
KEM3150TM
KDM3225D5A13D09U18
E2K3225DA13D09U18
KEM3200T
KEM3200T
KDM3225D5MW
E2K3400MDW
KEM3225T
KEM3225T
KDM3225D5W
E2K3225DW
KEM3225T2
KEM3225T2
KDM3225F
E2K3400F
KEM3225TM
KEM3225TM
KDM3225W
E2K3225W
KEM3225TM2
KEM3225TM2
KDM3225WK37
E2KE3225W
KM2225TA5
E2K2225TA
KDM3225WK37U18
E2KE3225WU18
KM2225TA5M
E2K2400TMA
KDM3225WK38
E2KE3225MW
KM2225TD5
E2K2225TD
KDM3250W
E2K3250W
KM2225TD5M
E2K2400TMD
KDM3300W
E2K3300W
KM2400TD5
E2K2400TD
KDM3300WA06U18
E2K3300WA06U18
KM2400TD5M
E2K2400TMD
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-408
Superseded by E2 Mining
2.6
E2 Cross-Reference, continued
Series C Mining
Superseded by
E2 Mining
Series C
Mining
Superseded by
E2 Mining
KM2400TG5M
E2K2400TMG
LEM3300T
LEM3300T
KM2400TN5M
E2K2400TMN
LEM3350T
LEM3350T
KM2400TW5M
E2K2400TMW
LEM3400T
LEM3400T
KM3100T
E2K3100T
LEM3400T2
LEM3400T2
KM3125T
E2K3125T
LEM3400TM
LEM3400TM
KM3150T
E2K3150T
LEM3400TM2
LEM3400TM2
KM3175T
E2K3175T
LEM3600T
LEM3600T
KM3200T
E2K3200T
LEM3600TM
LEM3600TM
KM3225T
E2K3225T
LM3600TL6M
E2L3600TML
KM3225TA5
E2K3225TA
LM3600TN6M
E2L3600TMN
KM3225TA5M
E2K3400TMA
LM3600TP6M
E2L3600TMP
KM3225TD5
E2K3225TD
LM3600TR6M
E2L3600TMR
KM3225TD5M
E2K3400TMD
LM3600TS6M
E2L3600TM
KM3250T
E2K3250T
LM3600TX6M
E2L3600TMX
KM3300T
E2K3300T
UVE3LP08K
UVE3LP08K
KM3350T
E2K3350T
UVE4LP08K
UVE4LP08K
KM3400T
E2K3400T
KM3400TD5
E2K3400TD
KM3400TF5M
E2K3400TMF
Source
Description
KM3400TG5M
E2K3400TMG
TD01217001E
BR01217001E
TC01217001E
www.eaton.com/mining
KM3400TJ5M
E2K3400TMJ
KM3400TK5M
E2K3400TMK
KM3400TL5M
E2K3400TML
KM3400TM
E2K3400TM
KM3400TN5M
E2K3400TMN
KM3400TR5M
E2K3400TMR
KM3400TW5M
E2K3400TMW
LDCM3600EMA05W
E2LEM3600MA05W
LDCM3600F
E2LM3600F
LDM3600F
E2L3600F
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-409
2.6
2
Contents
GFR Relay
Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-410
Page
V4-T2-339
V4-T2-345
V4-T2-358
V4-T2-370
V4-T2-396
V4-T2-411
V4-T2-412
V4-T2-412
2.6
Product Selection
Each installation requires:
GFR Relay
2
2
2
2
GFR Relay
560
1001200
Catalog
Number 1
Catalog
Number 1
Catalog
Number 1
GFR12EI
GFR60EI
GFR1200EI
GFR12E
GFR60E
GFR1200E
GFR12MI
GFR60MI
GFR1200MI
GFR12M
GFR60M
GFR1200M
GFR1200EID
GFR1200ED
GFR1200MID
GFR1200MD
GFR Relay
Types
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Current Sensor
Window Size
in Inches (mm)
Catalog
Number
1283C45G01
179C768G01
1256C13G01
1257C88G04
1257C92G03
2
2
2
179C768G02
1256C13G02
179C767G02
1257C88G03
1257C90G02
1257C91G02
1257C89G02
1257C92G04
1255C39G03
2
2
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Suitable for either surface or semi-flush mounting.
2 One end removable for installation.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-411
2.6
Accessories
Options
Additional optional equipment
can be added to the protection
system to meet the
requirements of the specifying
engineer, including:
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Test
120 Volt
50/60 Hz
120 Volt
50/60 Hz
Ammeter Kit
Kit Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
112 ampere
752B820G01
560 ampere
752B820G02
GFRTP
1001200 ampere
752B820G03
Catalog
Number
Faceplate
752B410G01
2
2
2
Description
Catalog
Number
Manual reset
1234C67G01
Self-resetting
1234C67G02
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-412
Sensor
Electrical Ratings
GFR Relay
1 to 12, 5 to 60 or 100 to
1200 amperes
Output contacts:
Control power
requirements:
GFR System
Used with
Indicating Ammeter
The optional indicating
ammeter connects to the
sensor terminals through a
momentary contact
pushbutton, and will indicate
(in amperes) any ground fault
current flowing through the
sensor. Kit includes the
ammeter and pushbutton.
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
Page
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-421
V4-T2-422
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries G
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IN
Flange Mounted
Flex Shaft
Direct (Close-Coupled)
Universal Direct
R
Y
Through-the-Door
High-Performance Rotary
Universal Rotary
Product Overview
2
2
2
IM
P
R
E
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-413
2.7
2
Description
Handle Mechanisms
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
P
R
2
2
R
Y
IN
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
Features
The high-performance
external handle can accept
padlocks or multi-hasp locks.
The door is interlocked when
padlocked and cannot be
bypassed.
IM
V4-T2-415
V4-T2-418
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-421
V4-T2-422
V4-T2-413
R
A
F
T
Page
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-414
2.7
Product Selection
2
2
Kits Only (Kit Includes Shaft, Mechanism and Handle)EG-, JG- and LG-Frame
Description
S2 Blue Handle
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
1/3R/12
54
EGHMVD06B0 / 68C6040G25
4/4X
65
EGHMVD06BX0 / 68C6040G28
1/3R/12
54
EGHMVD12B0 / 68C6040G26
4/4X
65
EGHMVD12BX0 / 68C6040G29
1/3R/12
54
EGHMVD24B0 / 68C6040G27
4/4X
65
EGHMVD24BX0 / 68C6040G30
1/3R/12
54
EGHMVD06R0 / 68C6040G31
4/4X
65
EGHMVD06RX0 / 68C6040G34
1/3R/12
54
EGHMVD12R0 / 68C6040G32
4/4X
65
EGHMVD12RX0 / 68C6040G35
1/3R/12
54
EGHMVD24R0 / 68C6040G33
4/4X
65
EGHMVD24RX0 / 68C6040G36
S2 blue handle,
6-inch shaft
1/3R/12
54
EGHMVD06B / 68C6040G13
4/4X
65
S2 blue handle,
12-inch shaft
1/3R/12
54
4/4X
65
S2 blue handle,
24-inch shaft 1
1/3R/12
54
4/4X
65
S2 red handle,
6-inch shaft
1/3R/12
54
S2 red handle,
12-inch shaft
1/3R/12
S2 red handle,
24-inch shaft 1
1/3R/12
4/4X
65
4/4X
4/4X
65
JGHMVD06B0 / 68C6041G13
JGHMVD06BX0 / 68C6041G16
JGHMVD12B0 / 68C6041G14
JGHMVD12BX0 / 68C6041G17
JGHMVD24B0 / 68C6041G15
JGHMVD24BX0 / 68C6041G18
JGHMVD06R0 / 68C6041G19
JGHMVD06RX0 / 68C6041G22
JGHMVD12R0 / 68C6041G20
JGHMVD12RX0 / 68C6041G23
JGHMVD24R0 / 68C6041G21
JGHMVD24RX0 / 68C6041G24
JGHMVD06B / 68C6041G01
LGHMVD06B / 68C6042G01
EGHMVD06BX / 68C6040G16
JGHMVD06BX / 68C6041G04
LGHMVD06BX / 68C6042G04
EGHMVD12B / 68C6040G14
JGHMVD12B / 68C6041G02
LGHMVD12B / 68C6042G02
EGHMVD12BX / 68C6040G17
JGHMVD12BX / 68C6041G05
LGHMVD12BX / 68C6042G05
EGHMVD24B / 68C6040G15
JGHMVD24B / 68C6041G03
LGHMVD24B / 68C6042G03
EGHMVD24BX / 68C6040G18
JGHMVD24BX / 68C6041G06
LGHMVD24BX / 68C6042G06
EGHMVD06R / 68C6040G19
JGHMVD06R / 68C6041G07
LGHMVD06R / 68C6042G07
EGHMVD06RX / 68C6040G22
JGHMVD06RX / 68C6041G10
LGHMVD06RX / 68C6042G10
54
EGHMVD12R / 68C6040G20
JGHMVD12R / 68C6041G08
LGHMVD12R / 68C6042G08
65
EGHMVD12RX / 68C6040G23
JGHMVD12RX / 68C6041G11
LGHMVD12RX / 68C6042G11
54
EGHMVD24R / 68C6040G21
JGHMVD24R / 68C6041G09
LGHMVD24R / 68C6042G09
EGHMVD24RX / 68C6040G24
JGHMVD24RX / 68C6041G12
LGHMVD24RX / 68C6042G12
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
L
IM
S2 Red Handle
LG-Frame
A
R
Y
IP
JG-Frame
IN
NEMA
EG-Frame
D
R
A
F
T
Rating Type
Notes
1 24-inch handle comes with support bracket.
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
P
R
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-415
2.7
Kits Only (Kit Includes Shaft, Mechanism and Handle)NG- and RG-Frame
2
2
Handle Mechanisms
S3 Blue Handle
Rating Type
NG-Frame
RG-Frame
Description
NEMA
IP
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
S3 blue handle,
10-inch shaft
1/3R/12
54
NGHMVD08B / 68C6043G01
4/4X
65
NGHMVD08BX / 68C6043G03
S3 red handle,
10-inch shaft
1/3R/12
54
NGHMVD08R / 68C6043G02
4/4X
65
NGHMVD08RX / 68C6043G04
S4 blue handle,
10-inch shaft
1/3R/12
54
NGHMVD08BT / 68C6043G05
RGHMVD08B / 68C6044G01
4/4X
65
NGHMVD08BTX / 68C6043G07
S4 red handle,
10-inch shaft
1/3R/12
54
NGHMVD08RT / 68C6043G06
RGHMVD08R / 68C6044G02
4/4X
65
NGHMVD08RTX / 68C6043G08
RGHMVD08RX / 68C6044G04
2
2
2
S3 Red Handle
2
2
S4 Blue Handle
2
2
2
S4 Red Handle
IN
2
2
Note
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
IM
2
2
2
2
2
P
R
E
2
2
RGHMVD08BX / 68C6044G03
R
Y
R
A
F
T
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-416
2.7
10-Inch
12-Inch
24-Inch 1
Mechanism
Only
EG
8 mm
66A6010G95
66A6010G96
66A6010G97
1498D66G17
JG
8 mm
66A6010G95
66A6010G96
66A6010G98
69D6025G17
LG
8 mm
66A6010G95
66A6010G96
66A6010G99
69D6051G30
NG
12 mm
66A6013H01
69D9101G30
RG
12 mm
66A6013H01
69D9101G31
Handles Only
2
2
2
D
R
A
F
T
Shaft
Width
Shaft Length
Frame
NEMA
IP
S01
Blue/Black
S01
Red/Yellow
S2
Blue/Black
S2
Red/Yellow
EG
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G41
68C6048G42
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G43
68C6048G44
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G41
68C6048G42
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G43
68C6048G44
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
68C6048G07
68C6048G08
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G05
68C6048G06
68C6048G09
68C6048G10
4/4X
65
68C6048G07
68C6048G08
68C6048G11
68C6048G12
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G09
68C6048G10
4/4X
65
68C6048G11
68C6048G12
JG
LG
NG
RG
S3
Blue/Black
S3
Red/Yellow
S4
Blue/Black
S4
Red/Yellow
68C6048G05
68C6048G06
A
R
Y
Frame
IN
S2
66A6032H02
S3
66A6032H03
L
IM
HPHC0DGX
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
HPHC2DGX
HPHC3DGX
2
2
Catalog Number
66A6029G01
P
R
High-performance handle
replacement parts kit
Catalog Number
66A6032H01
Notes
1 24-inch handle comes with support bracket.
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-417
2.7
2
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in mm (Inches)
2
2
Handle Type
Direction of Operation
Door Drilling
Type S01
R
A
F
T
Front Operation
2
2
2
2
2
Type S2
R
Y
2
2
2
2
2
IN
2
Type S3
IM
2
2
2
2
2
2
P
R
E
2
Type S4
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-418
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-420
V4-T2-421
V4-T2-422
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rotary
Series C rotary
Metal
Black
45 deg.
6, 12, 16, 24
Universal rotary
Molded plastic
Yellow/Red/Black
90 deg.
6, 12, 24
P
R
E
IM
Features
IN
R
Y
Product Description
Handle
Material
Available
Handle
Colors
Handle
Rotation
Shaft
Lengths
(Inches)
Notes
1 Type 4/4X application requires special handle. See Ordering Information.
2 All rotary handle mechanisms include a handle Lock Off to prevent turning the breaker ON while in the OFF position.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-419
2.7
Product Selection
Universal Rotary
Handle
Color
EG-Frame
UL
Rating
Black
1, 12
2
2
Red
1, 12
2
2
Black
1, 12
Red
1, 12
2
2
1, 12
Red
1, 12
RG-Frame
Black
Series G Rotary
IM
Black
EHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8)
EHMVD12R
24.00 (609.6)
EHMVD24R
6.00 (152.4)
FJHMVD06B
12.00 (304.8)
FJHMVD12B
24.00 (609.6)
FJHMVD24B
6.00 (152.4)
FJHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8)
FJHMVD12R
24.00 (609.6)
FJHMVD24R
6.00 (152.4)
KLHMVD06B
12.00 (304.8)
KLHMVD12B
24.00 (609.6)
KLHMVD24B
6.00 (152.4)
KLHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8)
KLHMVD12R
24.00 (609.6)
KLHMVD24R
6.00 (152.4)
HMVD5B
9.00 (228.6)
HMVD6B
Complete
Catalog
Number 2
Catalog Number
Standard
Handle 3
Breaker
Mechanism 4
Shaft 5
IEC IP65 67
IEC IP66 67
HM5R06
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G08
WHM5R06
WHM5R06X
12.00 (304.8)
HM5R12
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G05
WHM5R12
WHM5R12X
16.00 (406.4)
HM5R16
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G06
WHM5R16
WHM5R16X
24.00 (609.6)
HM5R24
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G07
WHM5R24
WHM5R24X
P
R
E
EHMVD24B
6.00 (152.4)
IN
NG-Frame
EHMVD12B
24.00 (609.6)
EHMVD06B
R
Y
Black
6.00 (152.4)
12.00 (304.8)
LG-Frame
Complete
Catalog Number 1
JG-Frame
Shaft Length
in Inches (mm)
R
A
F
T
Handle Mechanisms
Notes
1 Complete catalog number includes handle, mechanism, shaft and mounting hardware.
2 Complete catalog number includes the standard handle, mechanism, shaft and support brace/bracket.
3 Handle is designed suitable for NEMA Types 1, 3R and 12 enclosures. Use style number 6648C22G03 for Type 4/4X handle or add X Suffix to complete catalog number.
Handle is cast aluminum.
4 Breaker mechanism includes a shaft support bracket and its parts. Shaft is.50-inch (12.7 mm).
5 Longer shafts,16-inch (406.4 mm) and 24-inch (609.6 mm), include an adjustable support extension.
6 IEC handle mechanism supplied with metric thread mounting hardware.
7 Complete catalog number includes a handle, mechanism and shaft.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-420
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
Application Description
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
IM
Product Selection
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Without Interlock
With Interlock
Without Interlock
Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
EG
EHMCCBI
EHMCCB
EHMCCRI
EHMCCR
JG
JHMCCBI
JHMCCB
JHMCCRI
JHMCCR
LG
LHMCCBI
LHMCCB
LHMCCRI
LHMCCR
P
R
E
Universal Direct
(EGLG)
IN
R
Y
Product Description
2
2
V4-T2-422
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-421
2.7
2
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IM
Flange-Mounted Handle
Mechanisms
Flange-mounted handle
mechanisms mount on the
flange of an enclosure door.
The Flex Shaft is an extra
heavy-duty mechanism that
includes a flexible shaft in
various lengths, 3 feet (0.9m)
through 10 feet (3m) for use
with various size enclosures.
P
R
E
R
Y
Flex Shaft
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
IN
V4-T2-423
V4-T2-424
V4-T2-424
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-421
R
A
F
T
Page
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Accessories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-422
2.7
Product Selection
Note: Type 4X handle
mechanisms are available.
Add Suffix X to the complete
Catalog Number.
Flex Shaft
2
2
2
12
4 (1.2)
5 (1.3)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
EG
EHMFS02
EHMFS03
EHMFS04
EHMFS05
JG
N/A
JHMFS03
JHMFS04
JHMFS05
LG
N/A
LHMFS04
NG
N/A
N/A
F5S04C
F5S05C
RG
N/A
N/A
F6S04
F6S05
6 (1.8)
D
R
A
F
T
2 (0.6)
Breaker
Frame
Catalog
Number
EHMFS06
JHMFS06
F5S06C
F6S06
7 (2.1)
8 (2.4)
9 (2.7)
Breaker
Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
10 (3.1)
EG
EHMFS07
EHMFS08
EHMFS09
JG
JHMFS07
JHMFS08
JHMFS09
JHMFS10
LG
LHMFS07
LHMFS10
NG
N/A
N/A
N/A
F5S10C
RG
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
EHMFS10
A
R
Y
Catalog
Number
2
2
Notes
1 Three-pole only for EG-; three- and four-pole for JG- and LG-Frame.
2 EG-, JG- and LG-Frame can be left- or right-hand mounted.
IN
2
2
2
L
IM
2
2
2
P
R
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-423
2.7
Accessories
Breaker
Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number 2
EG
AUX1EBFSEG
C361KJ4
JG
AUX1EBFSJG
C361KJ6
LG
AUX1EBFSLG
C361KR
R
A
F
T
2
2
2
2
2
Handle Length
in Inches (mm)
C361KJ4
4.00 (101.6)
C361KJ6
6.00 (152.4)
C361KR
Roller latch 3
Notes
1 Customer: Consult with box manufacturer for correct door hardware and any adapters
required for assembly.
2 The 1/4-inch x 1/2-inch (6.35 x 12.7 mm) standard mill rectangular locking bar is not supplied
with these kits.
3 Third roller latch for use with 4.00- or 6.00-inch (101.6 or 152.4 mm) handle when three-point
latching is required.
IM
2
2
2
2
2
P
R
E
2
2
Catalog
Number 2
R
Y
Dimensions
IN
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-424
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-421
V4-T2-422
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IN
Direct (Close-Coupled)
Universal Direct
Euro IEC
G Direct
R
Y
Through-the-Door
High-Performance Rotary
Series C Rotary
Universal Rotary
Product Overview
Handle mechanisms are used
to operate molded case
circuit breakers, molded case
switches and motor circuit
protectors. They are available
in three basic configurations
Flange Mounted, Throughthe-Door and Direct (CloseCoupled)providing safe,
dependable operation and
ease of installation.
Flange Mounted
Flex Shaft
C371
IM
2
2
P
R
E
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-425
2.7
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IN
2
2
2
IM
2
2
2
2
2
2
P
R
E
R
A
F
T
Flange-Mounted Handle
Mechanisms
Flange-mounted handle
mechanisms mount on the
flange of an enclosure door.
The Flex Shaft is an extra
heavy-duty mechanism that
includes a flexible shaft in
various lengths, 3 feet (0.9m)
through 10 feet (3m) for use
with various size enclosures.
R
Y
Through-the-Door Handle
Mechanisms
Eatons through-the-door
handle mechanisms mount
on the front of an enclosure
or cabinet door and externally
operate the circuit breaker via
a variable depth shaft or a
linear operator (Type MC).
Each rotary type handle
mechanism includes a
handle, base operating
mechanism and shaft that
can be cut to various lengths.
2
2
2
V4-T2-426
2.7
Description
Handle Mechanisms
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-421
V4-T2-422
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-428
V4-T2-430
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
IN
P
R
E
IM
The high-performance
external handle can accept
padlocks or multi-hasp locks.
The door is interlocked when
padlocked and cannot be
bypassed.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Features
R
Y
Product Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-427
2.7
Product Selection
Kits Only (Kit Includes Shaft, Mechanism and Handle)GC/GD- and GMCP-Frame
2
S01 Red Handle
GMCP-Frame
Description
NEMA
IP
Catalog
Number
1/3R/12
54
GCHMVD12B / 68C6039G01
4/4X
65
GCHMVD12BX / 68C6039G03
1/3R/12
54
GCHMVD12R / 68C6039G02
4/4X
65
GCHMVD12RX / 68C6039G04
2
2
Frame
Shaft
Width
Shaft Length
6-Inch
GC/GD
6 mm
GMCP
6 mm
GD
8 mm
66A6010G95
FD
8 mm
66A6010G95
JD
10 mm
66A6012G15
KD
10 mm
66A6012G15
LD
10 mm
66A6012G15
MDL
10 mm
66A6012G15
ND
12 mm
RD
12 mm
2
2
66A6013H02
GCHMVD / 2A92095G15
66A6013H02
GMHMVD / 2A92095G16
66A6010G96
1498D34G90
66A6010G96
1498D34G91
66A6012G16
1498D34G92
66A6012G16
1498D34G93
66A6012G16
1498D34G94
66A6012G16
1498D34G95
66A6013H01
69D9101G30
66A6013H01
69D9101G31
P
R
E
Mechanism
Only
2
2
12-Inch
GMHMVD12R / 68C6039G06
GMHMVD12RX / 68C6039G08
Note
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
GMHMVD12B / 68C6039G05
GMHMVD12BX / 68C6039G07
IM
10-Inch
IN
R
Y
GC/GD-Frame
Catalog
Number
Rating Type
R
A
F
T
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-428
2.7
Handles Only
Frame
NEMA
IP
S01
Blue/Black
S01
Red/Yellow
S2
Blue/Black
S2
Red/Yellow
S3
Blue/Black
S3
Red/Yellow
S4
Blue/Black
S4
Red/Yellow
GC/GD
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G41
68C6048G42
4/4X
65
68C6048G43
68C6048G44
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G41
68C6048G42
4/4X
65
68C6048G43
68C6048G44
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G41
68C6048G42
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G43
68C6048G44
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G41
68C6048G42
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G43
68C6048G44
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
FD
JD
KD
LD
MDL
ND
RD
4/4X
65
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
68C6048G01
68C6048G02
4/4X
65
68C6048G03
68C6048G04
1/3R/12
54
4/4X
65
1/3R/12
54
4/4X
65
D
R
A
F
T
GD
68C6048G05
68C6048G06
68C6048G07
68C6048G08
68C6048G05
68C6048G06
68C6048G07
68C6048G08
68C6048G05
68C6048G06
68C6048G09
68C6048G10
68C6048G07
68C6048G08
68C6048G11
68C6048G12
68C6048G09
68C6048G10
68C6048G11
68C6048G12
A
R
Y
GMCP
Note
Shaft guide (68C6048G49) is optional and can be used with any high-performance handle listed above for greater alignment tolerance.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IN
2
2
2
L
IM
2
2
2
P
R
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-429
2.7
2
Dimensions
Approximate Dimensions in mm (Inches)
2
2
Handle Type
Direction of Operation
Door Drilling
Type S01
R
A
F
T
Front Operation
2
2
2
2
2
Type S2
R
Y
2
2
2
2
2
IN
2
Type S3
IM
2
2
2
2
2
2
P
R
E
2
Type S4
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-430
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-421
V4-T2-422
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-432
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Series C Rotary
2
2
2
2
2
IN
2
2
2
IM
2
2
2
P
R
E
Features
Eatons through-the-door
handle mechanisms mount
on the front of an enclosure
or a cabinet door and
externally operate the circuit
breaker via a variable depth
shaft or a linear operator
(Type MC). Each rotary type
handle mechanism includes a
handle, a base operating
mechanism and a shaft that
can be cut to various lengths.
R
Y
Product Description
Rotary
Series C rotary
Metal
Black
45 deg.
6, 12, 16, 24
Universal rotary
Molded plastic
Yellow/Red/Black
90 deg.
6, 12, 24
International
Handle Indication:
Markings
ON/OFF TRIPPED/RESET ON (I) OFF (O)
Handle
Material
Available
Handle
Colors
Handle
Rotation
Shaft
Lengths
(Inches)
2
2
2
2
Notes
1 Type 4/4X application requires special handle. See Ordering Information.
2 All rotary handle mechanisms include a handle Lock Off to prevent turning the breaker ON while in the OFF position.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-431
2.7
Product Selection
Series C Rotary
Complete
Catalog
Number 1
Breaker
Mechanism 3
Catalog Number
Shaft 4
IEC IP65 56
IEC IP66 56
F-Frame
6.00 (152.4)
HM1R06
6648C22G25
6648C23G11
4217B37G08
WHM1R06
WHM1R06X
12.00 (304.8)
HM1R12
6648C22G25
6648C23G11
4217B37G05
WHM1R12
WHM1R12X
16.00 (406.4)
HM1R16
6648C22G25
6648C23G11
4217B37G06
WHM1R16
WHM1R16X
24.00 (609.6)
HM1R24
6648C22G25
6648C23G11
4217B37G07
WHM1R24
WHM1R24X
6.00 (152.4)
HM2R06
6648C22G01
6648C23G21
4217B37G08
WHM2R06
WHM2R06X
12.00 (304.8)
HM2R12
6648C22G01
6648C23G21
4217B37G05
WHM2R12
WHM2R12X
16.00 (406.4)
HM2R16
6648C22G01
6648C23G21
4217B37G06
WHM2R16
WHM2R16X
24.00 (609.6)
HM2R24
6648C22G01
6648C23G21
4217B37G07
WHM2R24
WHM2R24X
6.00 (152.4)
HM3R06
6648C22G01
6648C23G25
4217B37G08
WHM3R06
WHM3R06X
12.00 (304.8)
HM3R12
6648C22G01
6648C23G25
4217B37G05
WHM3R12
WHM3R12X
16.00 (406.4)
HM3R16
6648C22G01
6648C23G25
4217B37G06
WHM3R16
WHM3R16X
24.00 (609.6)
HM3R24
6648C22G01
6648C23G25
4217B37G07
WHM3R24
WHM3R24X
6648C23G19
4217B37G08
WHM4R06
WHM4R06X
6648C23G19
4217B37G05
WHM4R12
WHM4R12X
6648C23G19
4217B37G06
WHM4R16
WHM4R16X
6648C23G19
4217B37G07
WHM4R24
WHM4R24X
R
A
F
T
L- and MDL-Frame
R
Y
K-Frame
J-Frame
6.00 (152.4)
HM4R06
6648C22G11
12.00 (304.8)
HM4R12
6648C22G11
16.00 (406.4)
HM4R16
6648C22G11
24.00 (609.6)
HM4R24
6648C22G11
6.00 (152.4)
HM7R06
6648C22G21
6648C23G17
4217B37G08
12.00 (304.8)
HM7R12
6648C22G21
6648C23G17
4217B37G05
16.00 (406.4)
HM7R16
6648C22G21
6648C23G17
4217B37G06
24.00 (609.6)
HM7R24
6648C22G21
6648C23G17
4217B37G07
IM
IN
MD/MDS
6.00 (152.4)
HM5R06
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G08
WHM5R06
WHM5R06X
12.00 (304.8)
HM5R12
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G05
WHM5R12
WHM5R12X
16.00 (406.4)
HM5R16
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G06
WHM5R16
WHM5R16X
HM5R24
6648C22G21
6648C23G08
4217B37G07
WHM5R24
WHM5R24X
2
2
2
2
24.00 (609.6)
Notes
1 Complete catalog number includes the standard handle, mechanism, shaft and support brace/bracket.
2 Handle is designed suitable for NEMA Types 1, 3R and 12 enclosures. Use style number 6648C22G03 for Type 4/4X handle or add X Suffix to complete catalog number.
Handle is cast aluminum.
3 Breaker mechanism includes a shaft support bracket and its parts. Shaft is.50-inch (12.7 mm).
4 Longer shafts,16-inch (406.4 mm) and 24-inch (609.6 mm), include an adjustable support extension.
5 IEC handle mechanism supplied with metric thread mounting hardware.
6 Complete catalog number includes a handle, mechanism and shaft.
P
R
E
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-432
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-420
V4-T2-421
V4-T2-422
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-433
V4-T2-434
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Universal Rotary
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Rotary
Series C rotary
Metal
Black
45 deg.
6, 12, 16, 24
Universal rotary
Molded plastic
Yellow/Red/Black
90 deg.
6, 12, 24
P
R
E
IM
Features
IN
R
Y
Product Description
Handle
Material
Available
Handle
Colors
Handle
Rotation
Shaft
Lengths
(Inches)
Notes
1 Type 4/4X application requires special handle. See Ordering Information.
2 All rotary handle mechanisms include a handle Lock Off to prevent turning the breaker ON while in the OFF position.
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-433
2.7
Product Selection
Red
Red
2
2
6.00 (152.4)
GHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8)
GHMVD12R
6.00 (152.4)
FHMVD06B
12.00 (304.8)
FHMVD12B
6.00 (152.4)
FHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8)
FHMVD12R
24.00 (609.6)
FHMVD24R
6.00 (152.4)
JHMVD06B
12.00 (304.8)
JHMVD12B
J-Frame
Black
Red
K-Frame
6.00 (152.4)
JHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8)
Black
Red
L-Frame
6.00 (152.4)
2
2
KHMVD12B
KHMVD06R
KHMVD12R
6.00 (152.4)
LHMVD06B
12.00 (304.8)
LHMVD12B
6.00 (152.4)
LHMVD06R
12.00 (304.8)
LHMVD12R
IM
Black
Red
KHMVD06B
IN
12.00 (304.8)
JHMVD12R
6.00 (152.4)
12.00 (304.8)
Note
1 Only available as complete handle mechanism. Parts not sold separately.
P
R
E
GHMVD12B
Black
GHMVD06B
F-Frame
6.00 (152.4)
12.00 (304.8)
R
A
F
T
Black
Complete
Catalog Number
G-Frame
Shaft Length
in Inches (mm)
R
Y
Universal Rotary
F-Frame
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-434
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Description
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
Application Description
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-436
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-440
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
IN
R
Y
Product Description
2
2
V4-T2-422
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
2
2
IM
2
2
P
R
E
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-435
2.7
Product Selection
Frame
Catalog
Number
HMCC1B
HMCC2B
HMCC3B
L and M
HMCC4B
HMVD5B
HMVD6B
2
2
2
2
2
2
G Direct 1
Black Handle
Yellow Handle
With Shroud
Without Shroud
With Shroud
Without Shroud
Frame
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
GD/GHC
HRGCC1S
HRGCC10
HRGCC3S
GMCP
HRGMC1S
HRGMC10
HRGMC3S
Note
1 Suitable for use on two- or three-pole G-Frame.
IN
2
2
2
IM
2
2
2
2
P
R
E
2
2
HRGCC30
HRGMC30
R
A
F
T
Black Handle
R
Y
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-436
2.7
Contents
Handle Mechanisms
Page
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-421
Description
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-438
V4-T2-440
Flex Shaft
2
2
2
2
2
2
IN
2
2
2
2
IM
Flange-Mounted Handle
Mechanisms
Flange-mounted handle
mechanisms mount on the
flange of an enclosure door.
The Flex Shaft is an extra
heavy-duty mechanism that
includes a flexible shaft in
various lengths, 3 feet (0.9m)
through 10 feet (3m) for use
with various size enclosures.
R
Y
Product Description
2
2
R
A
F
T
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
P
R
E
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Volume 4Circuit Protection CA08100005EApril 2015 www.eaton.com
V4-T2-437
2.7
2
Product Selection
Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm)
Handle Mechanisms
Flex Shaft
Flexible Shaft Length in Feet (m)
4 (1.2)
5 (1.5)
6 (1.8)
7 (2.1)
8 (2.4)
9 (2.7)
10 (3.0)
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
G1
F0S03C
F0S04C
F0S05C
F0S06C
F1S03C
F1S04C
F1S05C
F1S06C
F1S07C
F (dual)
F1S03CD
F1S04CD
F1S05CD
F1S06CD
F1S07CD
F2S03C
F2S04C
F2S05C
F2S06C
F2S07C
F3S03C
F3S04C
F3S05C
F3S06C
F3S07C
L and MDL
F4S04C
F4S05C
F4S06C
F5S04C
F5S05C
F5S06C
F6S04
F6S05
F6S06
F7S04
F7S05
F7S06
Type C371
2
2
F1S08C
F1S09C
F1S10C
F1S08CD
F1S09CD
F1S10CD
F2S08C
F2S09C
F2S10C
F3S08C
F3S09C
F3S10C
F4S10C
F5S10C
F7S10C
R
Y
R
A
F
T
3 (0.9)
Breaker
Frame
Operating
Mechanism Only 4
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Catalog
Number
Frame
Size
150
6.5016 (165.1406.4)
C371E
C371E1
C371E2
250
6.5016.63 (165.1422.4)
C371F
C371F5
C371F6
400
6.5016.63 (165.1422.4)
C371F
C371F5
C371F6
600
8.5022 (215.9558.8)
C371G
C371G5
C371G6
800
8.7522 (222.3558.8)
C371K
C371K5
C371K6
Series C
HND, ND, NDC
1200
9.7522 (247.7558.8)
C371K
C371K5
C371K6
2
2
2
2
2
2
IN
IM
Notes
1 Suitable for GC/GD MCCB; not suitable for GMCP.
2 For increased maximum allowable depth, see connecting rods on Page V4-T2-439.
3 Dimensions shown are from panel flange surface.
4 Does not include handle.
P
R
E
Circuit Breaker or
Motor Circuit Protector
Variable Depth
Mounting Range
Min./Max. 23
Type 4/4X handle mechanisms are available. Add Suffix X to complete catalog number. Add Suffix I to complete catalog number for IEC handle. Original narrow handle design (No C Suffix) is available.
Remove C from catalog number.
When selecting the length of shaft, ensure minimum bending radius of 4 inches (101.6 mm) (5 inches, 12.7 mm for L-, N- and R-Frames) is maintained to operate properly. The standard method of
shipment includes the mechanism preset at the factory; however, minor field adjustments may be required.
Dual breakers operator available on F-Frame only. Only the F, J and K can mount LH and RH all other RH only.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-438
2.7
2
2
Handle Only
NEMA
Enclosure Type
Operating
Handle Length
Catalog
Number
150
1/3R/3/12
4.00 (101.6)
C371H1
4/4X
4.00 (101.6)
C371H2
1/3R/3/12
6.00 (152.4)
C371H3
4/4X
6.00 (152.4)
C371H4
1/3R/3/12
4.00 (101.6)
C371H5
4/4X
4.00 (101.6)
C371H6
1/3R/3/12
6.00 (152.4)
C371H7
4/4X
6.00 (152.4)
C371H8
Amperes
Catalog Number
6001200
C371CS6
Connecting Rods 1
Catalog Number
C371CS1
C371CS1
C371CS2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Application
R
Y
2501200
R
A
F
T
Circuit Breaker
Frame Size
(Amperes)
L
IM
IN
2
2
Note
1 Increase maximum allowable depth by 5 inches (127 mm).
2
2
2
2
P
R
E
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-439
2.7
2
Contents
Handle Extension
Description
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Handle Extension
Product Description
2
2
Product Selection
Handle Extension
Handle Extension 12
Frame
J, K
IM
IN
R
Y
Style
Number
HEX3
HEX5
HEX6
2
2
P
R
E
L, M
V4-T2-427
V4-T2-431
V4-T2-435
V4-T2-437
V4-T2-438
V4-T2-440
V4-T2-413
V4-T2-414
V4-T2-419
V4-T2-421
R
A
F
T
Page
Handle MechanismsSeries G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Universal Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft
Handle MechanismsSeries C
High-Performance Rotary Handle Mechanisms .
Series C Rotary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Direct (Close-Coupled) Handle Mechanisms . . .
Flex Shaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Product Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Handle Extension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
HEX4
Notes
1 Handle extension is not included with J, K, L, M and N-Frame
breakers. It must be purchased separately.
2 Handle extension is included with breaker with R-Frame
breakers.
2
2
2
2
V4-T2-440